Table of Contents




 
 
 
 
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, DC 20549
FORM 10-K
ý
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018
OR
  ¨
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from                     to                    
Commission file number 001-34034
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
63-0589368
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
1900 Fifth Avenue North, Birmingham, Alabama 35203
(Address of principal executive offices)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (800) 734-4667
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock, $.01 par value
 
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/40 th  Interest in a Share of 6.375% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A
 
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/40 th  Interest in a Share of 6.375% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B
 
New York Stock Exchange
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  ý    No   ¨
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes   ¨     No   ý
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes   ý     No   ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). Yes   ý    No   ¨  
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.   ý
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
 
Large accelerated filer   x
 
Accelerated filer  ¨
 
 
 
 
Non-accelerated filer ¨  
 
Smaller reporting company  ¨
 
 
 
 
 
 
Emerging growth company ¨
 
 
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes   ¨     No   ý
State the aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates computed by reference to the price at which the common equity was last sold, or the average bid and asked price of such common equity, as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter.
Common Stock, $.01 par value—$19,253,215,827 as of June 30, 2018.
Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.
Common Stock, $.01 par value—1,017,718,703 shares issued and outstanding as of February 20, 2019.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of the proxy statement for the Annual Meeting to be held on April 24, 2019 are incorporated by reference into Part III.



Table of Contents




REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
FORM 10-K
INDEX
 

 
 
 
 
Page
PART I
 
 
 
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
Item 1.
 
Business
 
Item 1A.
 
Risk Factors
 
Item 1B.
 
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
Item 2.
 
Properties
 
Item 3.
 
Legal Proceedings
 
Item 4.
 
Mine Safety Disclosures
 
 
 
 
 
 
PART II
 
 
 
 
Item 5.
 
Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
Item 6.
 
Selected Financial Data
 
Item 7.
 
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
Item 7A.
 
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
 
Item 8.
 
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
 
Item 9.
 
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
 
Item 9A.
 
Controls and Procedures
 
Item 9B.
 
Other Information
 
 
 
 
PART III
 
 
Item 10.
 
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
 
Item 11.
 
Executive Compensation
 
Item 12.
 
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
 
Item 13.
 
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
 
Item 14.
 
Principal Accounting Fees and Services
 
 
 
 
 
 
PART IV
 
 
Item 15.
 
Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
 
Item 16.
 
Form 10-K Summary
 
SIGNATURES
 

2

Table of Contents




Glossary of Defined Terms
Agencies - collectively, FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA.
ALCO - Asset/Liability Management Committee.
AOCI - Accumulated other comprehensive income.
ASC - Accounting Standards Codification.
ASU - Accounting Standards Update.
ATM - Automated teller machine.
Bank - Regions Bank.
Basel I - Basel Committee's 1988 Regulatory Capital Framework (First Accord).
Basel III - Basel Committee's 2010 Regulatory Capital Framework (Third Accord).
Basel III Rules - Final capital rules adopting the Basel III capital framework approved by U.S. federal
regulators in 2013.
Basel IV - Basel Committee's revised Regulatory Capital Framework proposal released in December 2017.
Basel Committee - Basel Committee on Banking Supervision.
BHC - Bank Holding Company.
BHC Act - Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended.
BITS - Technology arm of the Financial Services Roundtable.
Board - The Company’s Board of Directors.
CAP - Customer Assistance Program.
CCAR - Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review.
CCB - Capital Conservation Buffer.
CECL - Current Expected Credit Loss Approach.
CEO - Chief Executive Officer.
CET1 - Common Equity Tier 1.
CFO - Chief Financial Officer.
CFPB - Consumer Financial Protection Bureau.
CFTC - Commodity Futures Trading Commission.
Company - Regions Financial Corporation and its subsidiaries.
COSO - Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.
CPR - Constant (or Conditional) Prepayment Rate.
CRA - Community Reinvestment Act of 1977.
DIF - Deposit Insurance Fund.
Dodd-Frank Act - The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010.
DPD - Days Past Due.
DUS - Fannie Mae Delegated Underwriting & Servicing.
EAD - Exposure at Default.
EGRRCPA - The Economic Growth, Regulatory Relief, and Consumer Protection Act.
ERI - Eligible retained income.
FASB - Financial Accounting Standards Board.
FDIA - Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended.

3

Table of Contents




FDIC - The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
Federal Reserve - The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.
FFIEC - Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council.
FHA - Federal Housing Administration.
FHC - Financial Holding Company.
FHLB - Federal Home Loan Bank.
FHLMC - Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation, known as Freddie Mac.
FICO - The Financing Corporation, established by the Competitive Equality Banking Act of
1987.
FICO scores - Personal credit scores based on the model introduced by the Fair Isaac Corporation.
FinCEN - the Financial Crimes Enforcement Network.
FINRA - Financial Industry Regulatory Authority.
FNMA - Federal National Mortgage Association, known as Fannie Mae.
FOMC - Federal Open Market Committee.
FRB - Federal Reserve Bank.
FS-ISAC - Financial Services - Information Sharing & Analysis Center.
FSOC - Federal Stability Oversight Council.
FTP - Funds Transfer Pricing.
GAAP - Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States.
GDP - Gross Domestic Product.
GDPR - EU General Data Protection Regulation.
GNMA - Government National Mortgage Association.
HUD - U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development.
IPO - Initial public offering.
IRA - Individual Retirement Account.
IRS - Internal Revenue Service.
LCR - Liquidity coverage ratio.
LGD - Loss given default.
LIBOR - London InterBank Offered Rates.
LLC - Limited Liability Company.
LTIP - Long-term incentive plan.
LTV - Loan to value.
MD&A - Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.
Morgan Keegan - Morgan Keegan & Company, Inc.
MSAs - Metropolitan Statistical Areas.
MSR - Mortgage servicing right.
MSRB - Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board.
NAV - Net Asset Value.
NM - Not meaningful.
NPR - Notice of Public Ruling.

4

Table of Contents




NSFR - Net stable funding ratio.
NYSE - New York Stock Exchange.
OAS - Option-Adjusted Spread.
OCC - Office of the Comptroller of the Currency.
OCI - Other comprehensive income.
OFAC - U.S. Treasury Department - Office of Foreign Assets Control.
OIS - Overnight Indexed Swap.
OLA - Orderly Liquidation Authority.
OTTI - Other-than-temporary impairment.
PD - Probability of default.
Raymond James - Raymond James Financial, Inc.
Regions Securities - Regions Securities LLC.
SBIC - Small Business Investment Companies.
SCB - Stress capital buffer.
SEC - U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.
SERP - Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan.
SLB - Stress leverage buffer.
SOFR - Secured Overnight Funding Rate.
Tax Reform - H.R.1, An Act to Provide for Reconciliation Pursuant to Titles II and V of the Concurrent
Resolution on the Budget for Fiscal Year 2018.
TBA - To Be Announced.
TDR - Troubled debt restructuring.
TRACE - Trade Reporting and Compliance Engine.
U.S. - United States.
USA PATRIOT Act - Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept
and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001.
U.S. Treasury - The United States Department of the Treasury.
UTB - Unrecognized tax benefits.
VIE - Variable interest entity.
Visa - The Visa, U.S.A. Inc. card association or its affiliates, collectively.
Volcker Rule - Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act and regulations promulgated thereunder, as applicable.



5

Table of Contents




PART I
Forward-Looking Statements
This Annual Report on Form 10-K, other periodic reports filed by Regions Financial Corporation under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and any other written or oral statements made by us or on our behalf to analysts, investors, the media and others, may include forward-looking statements as defined in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. The terms “Regions,” the “Company,” “we,” “us” and “our” as used herein mean collectively Regions Financial Corporation, a Delaware corporation, together with its subsidiaries when or where appropriate. The words “future,” “anticipates,” “assumes,” “intends,” “plans,” “seeks,” “believes,” “predicts,” “potential,” “objectives,” “estimates,” “expects,” “targets,” “projects,” “outlook,” “forecast,” “would,” “will,” “may,” “might,” “could,” “should,” “can,” and similar terms and expressions often signify forward-looking statements . Forward-looking statements are not based on historical information, but rather are related to future operations, strategies, financial results or other developments. Forward-looking statements are based on management’s current expectations as well as certain assumptions and estimates made by, and information available to, management at the time the statements are made. Those statements are based on general assumptions and are subject to various risks, and because they also relate to the future they are likewise subject to inherent uncertainties and other factors that may cause actual results to differ materially from the views, beliefs and projections expressed in such statements. Therefore, we caution you against relying on any of these forward-looking statements. These risks, uncertainties and other factors include, but are not limited to, the risks identified in Item 1A. “Risk Factors” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and those described below:
Current and future economic and market conditions in the United States generally or in the communities we serve, including the effects of possible declines in property values, increases in unemployment rates and potential reductions of economic growth, which may adversely affect our lending and other businesses and our financial results and conditions.
Possible changes in trade, monetary and fiscal policies of, and other activities undertaken by, governments, agencies, central banks and similar organizations, which could have a material adverse effect on our earnings.
Possible changes in market interest rates or capital markets could adversely affect our revenue and expense, the value of assets and obligations, and the availability and cost of capital and liquidity.
Any impairment of our goodwill or other intangibles, any repricing of assets, or any adjustment of valuation allowances on our deferred tax assets due to changes in law, adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations of the reporting unit or other factors.
The effect of changes in tax laws, including the effect of Tax Reform and any future interpretations of or amendments to Tax Reform, which may impact our earnings, capital ratios and our ability to return capital to stockholders.
Possible changes in the creditworthiness of customers and the possible impairment of the collectability of loans and leases, including operating leases.
Changes in the speed of loan prepayments, loan origination and sale volumes, charge-offs, loan loss provisions or actual loan losses where our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover our eventual losses.
Possible acceleration of prepayments on mortgage-backed securities due to low interest rates, and the related acceleration of premium amortization on those securities.
Loss of customer checking and savings account deposits as customers pursue other, higher-yield investments, which could increase our funding costs.
Possible changes in consumer and business spending and saving habits and the related effect on our ability to increase assets and to attract deposits, which could adversely affect our net income.
Our ability to effectively compete with other traditional and non-traditional financial services companies, some of whom possess greater financial resources than we do or are subject to different regulatory standards than we are.
Our inability to develop and gain acceptance from current and prospective customers for new products and services and the enhancement of existing products and services to meet customers’ needs and respond to emerging technological trends in a timely manner could have a negative impact on our revenue.
Our inability to keep pace with technological changes could result in losing business to competitors.
Changes in laws and regulations affecting our businesses, including legislation and regulations relating to bank products and services, as well as changes in the enforcement and interpretation of such laws and regulations by applicable governmental and self-regulatory agencies, which could require us to change certain business practices, increase compliance risk, reduce our revenue, impose additional costs on us, or otherwise negatively affect our businesses.
Our ability to obtain a regulatory non-objection (as part of the CCAR process or otherwise) to take certain capital actions, including paying dividends and any plans to increase common stock dividends, repurchase common stock under current or future programs, or redeem preferred stock or other regulatory capital instruments, may impact our ability to return capital to stockholders and market perceptions of us.

6

Table of Contents




Our ability to comply with stress testing and capital planning requirements (as part of the CCAR process or otherwise) may continue to require a significant investment of our managerial resources due to the importance and intensity of such tests and requirements.
Our ability to comply with applicable capital and liquidity requirements (including, among other things, the Basel III capital standards and the LCR rule), including our ability to generate capital internally or raise capital on favorable terms, and if we fail to meet requirements, our financial condition could be negatively impacted.
The effects of any developments, changes or actions relating to any litigation or regulatory proceedings brought against us or any of our subsidiaries.
The costs, including possibly incurring fines, penalties, or other negative effects (including reputational harm) of any adverse judicial, administrative, or arbitral rulings or proceedings, regulatory enforcement actions, or other legal actions to which we or any of our subsidiaries are a party, and which may adversely affect our results.
Our ability to manage fluctuations in the value of assets and liabilities and off-balance sheet exposure so as to maintain sufficient capital and liquidity to support our business.
Our ability to execute on our strategic and operational plans, including our ability to fully realize the financial and non-financial benefits relating to our strategic initiatives.
The risks and uncertainties related to our acquisition or divestiture of businesses.
The success of our marketing efforts in attracting and retaining customers.
Our ability to recruit and retain talented and experienced personnel to assist in the development, management and operation of our products and services may be affected by changes in laws and regulations in effect from time to time.
Fraud or misconduct by our customers, employees or business partners.
Any inaccurate or incomplete information provided to us by our customers or counterparties.
Inability of our framework to manage risks associated with our business such as credit risk and operational risk, including third-party vendors and other service providers, which could, among other things, result in a breach of operating or security systems as a result of a cyber attack or similar act or failure to deliver our services effectively.
Dependence on key suppliers or vendors to obtain equipment and other supplies for our business on acceptable terms.
The inability of our internal controls and procedures to prevent, detect or mitigate any material errors or fraudulent acts.
The effects of geopolitical instability, including wars, conflicts and terrorist attacks and the potential impact, directly or indirectly, on our businesses.
The effects of man-made and natural disasters, including fires, floods, droughts, tornadoes, hurricanes, and environmental damage, which may negatively affect our operations and/or our loan portfolios and increase our cost of conducting business. The severity and impact of future earthquakes, fires, hurricanes, tornadoes, droughts, floods and other weather-related events are difficult to predict and may be exacerbated by global climate change.
Changes in commodity market prices and conditions could adversely affect the cash flows of our borrowers operating in industries that are impacted by changes in commodity prices (including businesses indirectly impacted by commodities prices such as businesses that transport commodities or manufacture equipment used in the production of commodities), which could impair their ability to service any loans outstanding to them and/or reduce demand for loans in those industries.
Our ability to identify and address cyber-security risks such as data security breaches, malware, “denial of service” attacks, “hacking” and identity theft, a failure of which could disrupt our business and result in the disclosure of and/or misuse or misappropriation of confidential or proprietary information, disruption or damage to our systems, increased costs, losses, or adverse effects to our reputation.
Our ability to realize our adjusted efficiency ratio target as part of our expense management initiatives.
Possible cessation or market replacement of LIBOR and the related effect on our LIBOR-based financial products and contracts, including, but not limited to, hedging products, debt obligations, investments, and loans.
Possible downgrades in our credit ratings or outlook could increase the costs of funding from capital markets.
The effects of a possible downgrade in the U.S. government’s sovereign credit rating or outlook, which could result in risks to us and general economic conditions that we are not able to predict.
The effects of problems encountered by other financial institutions that adversely affect us or the banking industry generally could require us to change certain business practices, reduce our revenue, impose additional costs on us, or otherwise negatively affect our businesses.

7

Table of Contents




The effects of the failure of any component of our business infrastructure provided by a third party could disrupt our businesses, result in the disclosure of and/or misuse of confidential information or proprietary information, increase our costs, negatively affect our reputation, and cause losses.
Our ability to receive dividends from our subsidiaries could affect our liquidity and ability to pay dividends to stockholders.
Changes in accounting policies or procedures as may be required by the FASB or other regulatory agencies could materially affect our financial statements and how we report those results, and expectations and preliminary analyses relating to how such changes will affect our financial results could prove incorrect.
Other risks identified from time to time in reports that we file with the SEC.
Fluctuations in the price of our common stock and inability to complete stock repurchases in the time frame and/or on the terms anticipated.
The effects of any damage to our reputation resulting from developments related to any of the items identified above.
You should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date made. Factors or events that could cause our actual results to differ may emerge from time to time, and it is not possible to predict all of them. We assume no obligation and do not intend to update or revise any forward-looking statements that are made from time to time, either as a result of future developments, new information or otherwise, except as may be required by law.




8

Table of Contents




Item 1. Business
Regions Financial Corporation is a FHC headquartered in Birmingham, Alabama that operates in the South, Midwest and Texas. The terms "Regions," "the Company," "we," "us" and "our" mean Regions Financial Corporation, a Delaware corporation and its subsidiaries, when appropriate. Regions provides traditional commercial, retail and mortgage banking services, as well as other financial services in the fields of asset management, wealth management, securities brokerage, trust services, merger and acquisition advisory services, and other specialty financing. At December 31, 2018 , Regions had total consolidated assets of approximately $125.7 billion , total consolidated deposits of approximately $94.5 billion and total consolidated stockholders’ equity of approximately $15.1 billion .
Regions is a Delaware corporation and on July 1, 2004, became the successor by merger to Union Planters Corporation and the former Regions Financial Corporation. Its principal executive offices are located at 1900 Fifth Avenue North, Birmingham, Alabama 35203, and its telephone number at that address is (800) 734-4667.
Banking Operations
Regions conducts its banking operations through Regions Bank, an Alabama state-chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System. At December 31, 2018 , Regions operated 1,952 ATMs and 1,454 total branch outlets across the South, Midwest and Texas.
The following chart depicts the distribution of branch locations in each of the states in which Regions conducts its banking operations.
 
Branches
Florida
307

Tennessee
220

Alabama
211

Mississippi
126

Georgia
116

Louisiana
99

Arkansas
82

Texas
80

Missouri
64

Indiana
52

Illinois
48

South Carolina
23

Kentucky
11

Iowa
8

North Carolina
7

Total
1,454


Other Financial Services Operations
In addition to its banking operations, Regions provides additional financial services through the following subsidiaries:
Regions Equipment Finance Corporation and Regions Commercial Equipment Finance, LLC, each a wholly-owned subsidiary of Regions Bank, provide equipment financing products focusing on commercial clients.
Regions Investment Services, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Regions Bank, offers investments and insurance products to Regions Bank customers, provided by licensed insurance agents. In addition, Regions Bank and Regions Investment Services, Inc. also maintain an agreement with Cetera Investment Services, LLC to offer securities, insurance and advisory services to Regions Bank customers through dually-employed financial advisors.
Regions Securities LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Regions headquartered in Atlanta, Georgia, serves as a broker-dealer to commercial clients and acts in an advisory capacity to merger and acquisition transactions. Additionally, BlackArch Partners LLC is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Regions and is headquartered in Charlotte, North Carolina. BlackArch Partners LLC and its subsidiaries offer merger and acquisition services to its institutional clients and commercial entities.
Regions Affordable Housing LLC is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Regions Bank headquartered in Great Neck, New York, and engages in low income housing tax credit corporate fund syndication and asset management.

9

Table of Contents




Supervision and Regulation
We are subject to the extensive regulatory framework applicable to BHCs and their subsidiaries. This framework is intended primarily for the protection of depositors, the FDIC's DIF and the banking system as a whole, and generally is not intended for the protection of stockholders or other investors. Described below are the material elements of selected laws and regulations applicable to us and our subsidiaries. These descriptions are not intended to be complete and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the full text of the statutes and regulations described. Changes in applicable law or regulation, and in their interpretation and application by regulatory agencies and other governmental authorities, cannot be predicted, but may have a material effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Overview
We are registered with the Federal Reserve as a BHC and have elected to be treated as an FHC under the BHC Act. As such, we and our subsidiaries are subject to the supervision, examination and reporting requirements of the BHC Act and the regulations of the Federal Reserve. Generally, the BHC Act provides for “umbrella” regulation of FHCs by the Federal Reserve and functional regulation of holding company subsidiaries by applicable regulatory agencies. The BHC Act also requires the Federal Reserve to examine any subsidiary of a BHC, other than a depository institution, engaged in activities permissible for a depository institution. The Federal Reserve is also granted the authority, in certain circumstances, to require reports of, examine and adopt rules applicable to any holding company subsidiary.
Regions Bank is a member of the FDIC, and, as such, its deposits are insured by the FDIC to the extent provided by law. Regions Bank is an Alabama state-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System. Its operations are generally subject to supervision and examination by both the Federal Reserve and the Alabama State Banking Department and the bank regulators are given authority to approve or disapprove mergers, acquisitions, consolidations, the establishment of branches and similar corporate actions. The federal and state banking regulators also have the power to prevent the continuance or development of unsafe or unsound banking practices or other violations of law. State and federal laws and regulations govern the activities in which Regions Bank engages, including the investments it makes and the aggregate amount of loans that may be granted to one borrower. Various consumer and compliance laws and regulations also affect its operations. Regions Bank is also affected by the actions of the Federal Reserve as it implements monetary policy. As a Federal Reserve System member bank, Regions Bank is required to hold stock in the Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta in an amount equal to 6 percent of its capital stock and surplus. Member banks with total assets in excess of $10 billion, including Regions Bank, receive a floating dividend rate tied to 10-year U.S. Treasuries, with the maximum dividend rate capped at 6 percent.
Regions Bank and its affiliates are also subject to supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the CFPB with respect to consumer protection laws and regulations. Some of Regions’ non-bank subsidiaries are also subject to regulation by various federal and state agencies, such as the SEC and FINRA in the case of our broker-dealer subsidiaries, Regions Securities LLC and BlackArch Securities LLC.
We are also subject to the disclosure and regulatory requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as administered by the SEC. Our common stock and depository shares representing our outstanding preferred stock are each listed on the NYSE. Consequently, we are also subject to the NYSE’s rules for listed companies.
 Under Section 165 of the Dodd-Frank Act, as amended by EGRRCPA, which was signed into law on May 24, 2018, U.S. BHCs with total consolidated assets of $100 billion or more but less than $250 billion, including Regions, are currently subject to enhanced prudential standards. The enhanced prudential standards include risk-based capital and leverage requirements, liquidity standards, risk management and risk committee requirements, stress test requirements and a debt-to-equity limit for companies that the FSOC has determined would pose a grave threat to systemic financial stability were they to fail such limits. In general, EGRRCPA increased the statutory asset threshold above which the Federal Reserve is required to apply these enhanced prudential standards from $50 billion to $250 billion. Although EGRRCPA’s increased asset threshold took effect immediately for BHCs with total consolidated assets less than $100 billion, the increased asset threshold for BHCs with total consolidated assets of $100 billion or more but less than $250 billion, including Regions, generally will become effective 18 months after the date of enactment (that is, November 2019). The Federal Reserve is authorized, however, during that 18-month period to exempt, by order, any BHC with assets between $100 billion and $250 billion from any enhanced prudential standard requirement. The Federal Reserve is also authorized to apply any enhanced prudential standard requirement to any BHC with between $100 billion and $250 billion in total consolidated assets that would otherwise be exempt under EGRRCPA, if the Federal Reserve determines that such action is appropriate to address risks to financial stability and promote safety and soundness, taking into consideration certain factors including the BHC’s capital structure, riskiness, complexity, financial activities (including financial activities of subsidiaries), size, and any other risk-related factors that the Federal Reserve deems appropriate. BHCs with $250 billion or more in total consolidated assets remain fully subject to the Dodd-Frank Act’s enhanced prudential standards requirements.
In October 2018, pursuant to the discretion afforded them with respect to BHCs with assets between $100 billion and $250 billion, the Federal Reserve and the other Federal bank regulators proposed rules that would tailor the application of the enhanced prudential standards to BHCs and depository institutions per the EGRRCPA amendments (the “Tailoring NPRs”). The Tailoring NPRs would assign each U.S. BHC with $100 billion or more in total consolidated assets, as well as its bank subsidiaries, to one

10

Table of Contents




of four categories based on its size and five risk-based indicators: (1) cross-jurisdictional activity, (2) weighted short-term wholesale funding, (3) non-bank assets, (4) off-balance sheet exposure, and (5) status as a U.S. global systemically important BHC (“G-SIB”). Under the Tailoring NPRs, Category IV standards would apply to banking organizations with at least $100 billion in total consolidated assets that do not meet any of the thresholds specified for Categories I through III.
The Federal Reserve staff indicated in connection with the Tailoring NPRs the firms that would fall into each of the four Categories based on data for the second quarter of 2018. According to the Federal Reserve’s projections, Regions (and, pursuant to the proposed rules, its depository institution subsidiary, Regions Bank) would be a “Category IV” firm under each of the Tailoring NPRs, although the thresholds for each of the four categories could change in the final rules. Firms that would be subject to Category IV standards, such as Regions and Regions Bank, would generally be subject to the same capital and liquidity requirements as firms with less than $100 billion in total consolidated assets, but would also be required to monitor and report certain risk-based indicators. Accordingly, under the Tailoring NPRs, Category IV firms would, among other things, (1) no longer be subject to any LCR or proposed NSFR requirement, (2) no longer be subject to company-run capital stress testing requirements and (3) become subject to supervisory capital stress testing on a biennial instead of annual basis. The Tailoring NPRs are subject to modification through the federal rulemaking process in accordance with the Administrative Procedures Act. A chart summarizing key elements of the capital, liquidity and enhanced prudential standards requirements applicable to Regions should the Tailoring NPRs be adopted is included immediately below, and elements of the Tailoring NPRs are discussed in further detail throughout this section.
Application under Tailoring NPRs of Certain Enhanced Prudential Standards, Capital and Liquidity Requirements to Regions
 
Current
Assuming Adoption of Tailoring NPR and Assignment to Category IV
CAPITAL
Stress Testing: Company-Run (DFAST)
ü
(Annual)
û
Stress Testing: Supervisory
ü
(Annual)
ü
(Two-Year Cycle)
CCAR: Quantitative
ü
(Annual)
ü
(Two-Year Cycle)
Annual Capital Plan Submission
ü
ü
Opt-Out of AOCI Capital Impact
ü
ü
Generally Applicable Leverage Ratio
ü
ü
LIQUIDITY
LCR
ü
(Modified)
û
NSFR (Proposed)
ü
(Modified)
û
Liquidity Stress Tests
ü
(Monthly)
ü
(Quarterly)
Liquidity Risk Management
ü
ü
Liquidity Buffer
ü
ü
FR 2052a Reporting
ü
(Monthly)
ü
(Monthly)
CERTAIN OTHER ENHANCED PRUDENTIAL STANDARDS
Risk Committee
ü
ü
Risk Management
ü
ü
    The Tailoring NPR does not amend the Federal Reserve’s capital plan rule, but the Federal Reserve indicated that it expects to release a future proposal to do so, consistent with the changes to its stress testing rules.
Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, as amended by EGRRCPA, BHCs with total consolidated assets of $100 billion or more, such as Regions, are required to submit resolution plans to the Federal Reserve and FDIC providing for the company’s strategy for rapid and orderly resolution in the event of its material financial distress or failure. Regions submitted its most recent resolution plan to these agencies in December 2017 and Regions Bank submitted its most recent resolution plan in June 2018. If the Federal Reserve and the FDIC determine that these plans are not credible and we do not cure the deficiencies, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC may jointly impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements or restrictions on growth, activities or operations

11

Table of Contents




of the Company or Regions Bank or may jointly order the Company or Regions Bank to divest assets or operations to facilitate an orderly resolution in the event of failure. Currently, Regions is required to submit a resolution plan by December 31, 2019, and Regions Bank will not be required to submit a resolution plan before July 1, 2020; however, in connection with the release of the Tailoring NPRs, the Federal Reserve noted that it expects to release a separate proposal to amend, with the FDIC, their joint resolution plan rule to address the applicability of resolution plan requirements for U.S. BHCs with between $100 billion and $250 billion in total consolidated assets, including Regions, and to adjust the scope and applicability of resolution plan requirements for firms that remain subject to them.
The ultimate benefits or consequences of EGRRCPA and the Tailoring NPRs on Regions, Regions Bank and their respective subsidiaries and activities will be subject to the final form of the Tailoring NPRs and additional rulemakings issued by the Federal Reserve and other federal regulators. Regions cannot predict future changes in the applicable laws, regulations and regulatory agency policies, yet such changes may have a material impact on Regions’ business, financial condition or results of operations. We will continue to evaluate the impact of any changes in law and any new regulations promulgated, including changes in regulatory costs and fees, modifications to consumer products or disclosures required by the CFPB and the requirements of the enhanced supervision provisions, among others.
On February 5, 2019 the Federal Reserve provided relief to BHCs with assets between $100 billion and $250 billion, including Regions, in the form of a one-year extension to the requirement to submit a capital plan to the Federal Reserve. Thus, Regions must submit a capital plan to the Federal Reserve by April 5, 2020, rather than April 5, 2019. In addition, Regions is not subject to the supervisory capital stress testing or the company-run capital stress testing requirements for 2019. However, Regions is still required to maintain a capital plan that is reviewed and approved by Regions’ Board of Directors. Furthermore, while Regions is not required to submit a full capital plan to the Federal Reserve in 2019, the Company is required to submit its planned capital actions for the period between July 1, 2019 and June 30, 2020. The Federal Reserve has announced that for the period from July 1, 2019 through June 30, 2020, Regions, like other firms granted an extension, is approved to make capital distributions up to the amount that would have allowed the firm to remain above all minimum capital requirements in CCAR 2018, adjusted for any changes in Regions’ regulatory capital ratios since the Federal Reserve acted on Regions’ 2018 capital plan.
Permissible Activities under the BHC Act
In general, the BHC Act limits the activities permissible for BHCs to the business of banking, managing or controlling banks and such other activities as the Federal Reserve has determined to be so closely related to banking as to be properly incidental thereto. A BHC electing to be treated as a FHC, like Regions, may also engage in a range of activities that are (i) financial in nature or incidental to such financial activity or (ii) complementary to a financial activity and that do not pose a substantial risk to the safety and soundness of a depository institution or to the financial system generally. These activities include securities dealing, underwriting and market making, insurance underwriting and agency activities, merchant banking and insurance company portfolio investments.
For a BHC to be eligible to elect FHC status, all of its subsidiary insured depository institutions must be well-capitalized and well-managed as described below under “-Regulatory Remedies under the FDIA” and must have received at least a satisfactory rating on such institution’s most recent examination under the CRA. The BHC itself must also be well-capitalized and well-managed in order to be eligible to elect FHC status. If an FHC fails to continue to be well-capitalized or well-managed after engaging in activities not permissible for BHCs that have not elected to be treated as financial holding companies, the company must enter into an agreement with the Federal Reserve to comply with all applicable capital and management requirements. If the company does not return to compliance within 180 days, the Federal Reserve may order the company to divest its subsidiary banks or the company may be required to discontinue or divest investments in companies engaged in activities permissible only for a BHC electing to be treated as an FHC. Furthermore, if the Federal Reserve determines that an FHC has not maintained a CRA rating of at least "satisfactory," the FHC would not be able to commence any new financial activities or acquire a company that engages in such activities, although the FHC would still be allowed to engage in activities closely related to banking and make investments in the ordinary course of conducting banking activities.
The BHC Act does not place territorial restrictions on permissible non-banking activities of BHCs. The Federal Reserve has the power to order any BHC or its subsidiaries to terminate any activity or to terminate its ownership or control of any subsidiary when the Federal Reserve has reasonable grounds to believe that continuation of such activity or such ownership or control constitutes a serious risk to the financial soundness, safety or stability of any bank subsidiary of the BHC.
Capital Requirements
Regions and Regions Bank are each required to comply with applicable capital adequacy standards established by the Federal Reserve, which are based on the Basel III framework.
The Basel III-based U.S. capital rules, among other things, impose a capital measure called Common Equity Tier 1 Capital, or CET1 capital, to which most deductions/adjustments to regulatory capital measures must be made. In addition, the Basel III-based U.S. capital rules specify that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting certain specified requirements.
Under the U.S. Basel III-based capital rules, the minimum capital ratios are:

12

Table of Contents




4.5% CET1 capital to risk-weighted assets;
6.0% tier 1 capital (that is, CET1 capital plus additional tier 1 capital) to risk-weighted assets;
8.0% total capital (that is, tier 1 capital plus tier 2 capital) to risk-weighted assets; and
4.0% tier 1 capital to total average consolidated assets as defined under U.S. Basel III Standardized approach (known as the “leverage ratio”).
The U.S. capital rules also impose a capital conservation buffer (“CCB”) on top of the three minimum risk-weighted asset ratios listed above. As of January 1, 2019, the CCB has been fully phased-in and is 2.5%. Banking institutions that fail to meet the effective minimum ratios once the CCB is taken into account (that is, 7.0% for CET1 capital to risk-weighted assets, 8.5% for tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets and 10.5% for total capital to risk-weighted assets) will be subject to constraints on capital distributions, including dividends and share repurchases, and certain discretionary executive compensation. The severity of the constraints depends on the amount of the shortfall and the institution’s “eligible retained income” (that is, four quarter trailing net income, net of distributions and tax effects not reflected in net income). On April 10, 2018, the Federal Reserve issued a proposal designed to create a single, integrated capital requirement by combining the quantitative assessment of firms’ capital plans with the CCB requirement. Details of this proposal are discussed under “- Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review and Stress Testing” below. Although the proposal, if adopted, would change the way in which the minimum ratios are calculated, firms would continue to be subject to progressively more stringent constraints on capital actions as they approach the minimum ratios.
For more information, see the “Regulatory Requirements” section of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Leverage Requirements
BHCs and banks are also required to comply with minimum leverage capital requirements. These requirements provide for a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to total consolidated average tangible assets (as defined for regulatory purposes), called the “leverage ratio,” of 4.0% for all BHCs.
Liquidity Requirements
Liquidity risk management and supervision have become increasingly important since the financial crisis. In addition to the liquidity buffer requirement, Regions is currently subject to the federal banking agencies’ rules implementing Basel III’s LCR, which is designed to ensure that a covered bank or BHC maintains an adequate level of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets under an acute 30-day liquidity stress scenario. The LCR rule, following the threshold amendments under EGRRCPA, currently applies in a modified, less stringent, form to BHCs, such as Regions, having $100 billion or more but less than $250 billion in total consolidated assets and less than $10 billion in total on-balance sheet foreign exposure. Since January 1, 2017, the rule has been fully phased-in. Regions is required to calculate its LCR on a monthly basis. If a covered company fails to meet the required LCR, it must promptly notify its primary federal banking regulator and may be required to take remedial actions. In December 2016, the Federal Reserve issued a final rule that requires BHCs currently subject to the LCR rule, such as Regions, to disclose publicly, on a quarterly basis, quantitative and qualitative information about certain components of its LCR beginning with the fourth quarter of 2018 for modified LCR BHCs such as Regions. At December 31, 2018, Regions’ LCR was above the minimum requirement. As noted above, under the Tailoring NPRs, Category IV firms, including Regions, would no longer be subject to any LCR requirement.
In addition to LCR, the Basel III framework also included a second standard, referred to as the NSFR, which is designed to promote more medium- and long-term funding of the assets and activities of banks over a one-year time horizon. In May 2016, the U.S. banking regulators issued a proposed rule to implement the NSFR for large U.S. banking organizations. Under the 2016 proposal, BHCs with less than $250 billion, but more than $50 billion, in total consolidated assets and less than $10 billion in on-balance sheet foreign exposure, such as Regions, would have been subject to a less stringent modified NSFR requirement. As proposed, the NSFR rule would have taken effect on January 1, 2018; however, the U.S. banking regulators have not issued the final rule. As noted above, under the Tailoring NPRs, Category IV firms, including Regions, would no longer be subject to any NSFR requirement.
Under the Tailoring NPRs, Category IV firms, including Regions, would remain subject to liquidity risk management requirements, but these requirements would be tailored such that these firms would be required to: (i) calculate collateral positions monthly, as opposed to weekly as is currently required; (ii) establish a more limited set of liquidity risk limits than are currently required; and (iii) monitor fewer elements of intraday liquidity risk exposures than are currently monitored. These firms would also be subject to liquidity stress testing quarterly, rather than monthly, and would be required to report liquidity data on the FR 2052a on a monthly basis. The liquidity buffer requirements for these firms would not change.

13

Table of Contents




Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review and Stress Testing
The Federal Reserve currently conducts annual analyses of BHCs with at least $100 billion in total consolidated assets to determine whether the companies have sufficient capital on a consolidated basis necessary to absorb losses in baseline, adverse and severely adverse economic conditions (although, in light of EGRRCPA’s eliminating the statutory requirement for the adverse scenario, on January 8, 2019, the Federal Reserve proposed amendments to its stress testing rules that would, among other things, eliminate the adverse scenario). Regions is also currently required to conduct its own semi-annual stress analysis to assess the potential impact on Regions of the economic and financial conditions used as part of the Federal Reserve’s annual stress analysis. Under the Tailoring NPRs, Category IV firms, including Regions, would be subject to supervisory stress testing every other year, rather than annually, and would no longer be subject to company-run stress testing requirements, but would remain subject to the quantitative review of their capital plans under CCAR, to required capital plan submissions, and to the FR Y-14 reporting requirements.
U.S. BHCs with total consolidated assets of $100 billion or more, such as Regions, must develop and maintain a capital plan, and must submit the capital plan to the Federal Reserve as part of the Federal Reserve’s CCAR process. The CCAR process is intended to help ensure that these BHCs have robust, forward-looking capital planning processes that account for each company’s unique risks and that permit continued operations during times of economic and financial stress. In connection with the release of the Tailoring NPRs, the Federal Reserve noted that it expects to revise its guidance relating to capital planning to align with the proposed categories of standards set forth in the Tailoring NPRs, and the impact of the future proposal on Regions and its capital planning process will depend on the final form of the Federal Reserve’s revised guidance.
As noted above, on April 10, 2018, the Federal Reserve issued a proposal designed to create a single, integrated capital requirement by combining the quantitative assessment of CCAR with the CCB requirement. If adopted, the proposal would replace the current static 2.5% CCB with a SCB requirement. The SCB, subject to a minimum of 2.5%, would reflect stressed losses in the supervisory severely adverse scenario of the Federal Reserve’s supervisory stress tests and would also include four quarters of planned common stock dividends. The proposal would also introduce a SLB requirement, similar to the SCB, which would apply to the Tier 1 leverage ratio. In addition, the proposal would eliminate the quantitative objection provisions of CCAR but would require a BHC to reduce its planned capital distributions if those distributions would not be consistent with the applicable capital buffer constraints based on the BHC’s own baseline scenario projections. The Federal Reserve has stated that it intends to propose revisions to the stress buffer requirements that would be applicable to Category IV BHCs to align with the proposed two-year supervisory stress testing cycle for Category IV BHCs.
In addition to other limitations, our ability to make any capital distributions (including dividends and share repurchases) is contingent on the Federal Reserve's non-objection to our capital plan. Should the Federal Reserve object to a capital plan, a BHC may not make any capital distribution other than those capital distributions to which the Federal Reserve has indicated its non-objection in writing. As a result of a final rule adopted by the Federal Reserve in January 2017, beginning with the 2017 CCAR cycle, the Federal Reserve may no longer object on the basis of qualitative criteria to capital plans submitted by BHCs that have total consolidated assets of at least $50 billion but less than $250 billion, non-bank assets of less than $75 billion, and that are not U.S. global-systemically important banks, such as Regions. Our annual capital planning submission is currently due by April 5th and the Federal Reserve will publish the results of its supervisory CCAR review of our capital plan by June 30th of each year. As noted above, the Tailoring NPR, which would change the supervisory stress testing cycle from annual to biennial, would not similarly amend the Federal Reserve’s capital plan rule, but the Federal Reserve indicated that it expects to release a future proposal to do so.
Safety and Soundness Standards
The FDIA requires the federal banking agencies to take prompt corrective action in respect of depository institutions that do not meet specified capital requirements. The FDIA establishes five capital categories (“well-capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized”), and the federal banking agencies must take certain mandatory supervisory actions, and are authorized to take other discretionary actions, with respect to institutions that are undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized. The severity of these mandatory and discretionary supervisory actions depends upon the capital category in which the institution is placed. Generally, subject to a narrow exception, the FDIA requires the banking regulator to appoint a receiver or conservator for an institution that is critically undercapitalized. As of December 31, 2018, both Regions and Regions Bank were well-capitalized.
An institution that is classified as well-capitalized based on its capital levels may be treated as adequately capitalized, and an institution that is adequately capitalized or undercapitalized based upon its capital levels may be treated as though it were undercapitalized or significantly undercapitalized, respectively, if the appropriate federal banking agency, after notice and opportunity for hearing, determines that an unsafe or unsound condition or an unsafe or unsound practice warrants such treatment.
An institution that is categorized as undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized is required to submit an acceptable capital restoration plan to its appropriate federal banking regulator. Under the FDIA, in order for the capital restoration plan to be accepted by the appropriate federal banking agency, a BHC must guarantee that a subsidiary depository

14

Table of Contents




institution will comply with its capital restoration plan, subject to certain limitations. The BHC must also provide appropriate assurances of performance.
The FDIA requires the various regulatory agencies to prescribe certain non-capital standards for safety and soundness relating generally to operations and management, asset quality, and executive compensation and permits regulatory action against a financial institution that does not meet such standards. Regulators also must take into consideration: (i) concentrations of credit risk; (ii) interest rate risk (when the interest rate sensitivity of an institution’s assets does not match the sensitivity of its liabilities or its off-balance sheet position); and (iii) risks from non-traditional activities, as well as an institution’s ability to manage those risks, when determining the adequacy of an institution’s capital. Regulators make this evaluation as a part of their regular examination of the institution’s safety and soundness. Additionally, regulators may choose to examine other factors in order to evaluate the safety and soundness of financial institutions.
Payment of Dividends
We are a legal entity separate and distinct from our banking and other subsidiaries. The principal source of cash flow to us, including cash flow to pay dividends to our stockholders and principal and interest on any of our outstanding debt, is dividends from Regions Bank. There are statutory and regulatory limitations on the payment of dividends by Regions Bank to us, as well as by us to our stockholders.
If, in the opinion of a federal bank regulatory agency, an institution under its jurisdiction is engaged in or is about to engage in an unsafe or unsound practice, such agency may require, after notice and hearing, that such institution cease and desist from such practice. The federal bank regulatory agencies have indicated that paying dividends that deplete an institution’s capital base to an inadequate level would be an unsafe and unsound banking practice. Under the FDIA, an insured institution may not pay a dividend if payment would cause it to become undercapitalized or if it already is undercapitalized. See “-Safety and Soundness Standards” above. Moreover, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC have issued policy statements stating that BHCs and insured banks should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings.
Payment of Dividends by Regions Bank . Under the Federal Reserve’s Regulation H, Regions Bank may not, without approval of the Federal Reserve, declare or pay a dividend to us if the total of all dividends declared in a calendar year exceeds the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net income for that year and (b) its retained net income for the preceding two calendar years, less any required transfers to additional paid-in capital or to a fund for the retirement of preferred stock.
Under Alabama law, Regions Bank may not pay a dividend in excess of 90% of its net earnings unless its surplus is equal to at least 20% of capital. Regions Bank is also required by Alabama law to seek the approval of the Alabama Superintendent of Banking prior to the payment of dividends if the total of all dividends declared by Regions Bank in any calendar year will exceed the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net earnings for that year, plus (b) its retained net earnings for the preceding two years, less any required transfers to surplus. The statute defines net earnings as the remainder of all earnings from current operations plus actual recoveries on loans and investments and other assets, after deducting from the total thereof all current operating expenses, actual losses, accrued dividends on preferred stock, if any, and all federal, state and local taxes. Regions Bank cannot, without approval from the Federal Reserve and the Alabama Superintendent of Banking, declare or pay a dividend to Regions unless Regions Bank is able to satisfy the criteria discussed above.
Payment of Dividends by Regions . Our payment of dividends to our stockholders is subject to the oversight of the Federal Reserve. In particular, the dividend policies and share repurchases of a large BHC, such as Regions, are reviewed by the Federal Reserve based on capital plans submitted as part of the CCAR process and stress tests as submitted by the BHC, and will be assessed against, among other things, the BHC’s ability to achieve the required capital ratios under the Basel III Rules as they are phased in by U.S. regulators. See “-Capital Requirements” and “-Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review and Stress Testing” above.
Support of Subsidiary Banks
Under longstanding Federal Reserve policy, which has been codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, Regions is expected to act as a source of financial strength to, and to commit resources to support, its subsidiary bank. This support may be required at times when Regions may not be inclined to provide it. In addition, any capital loans by a BHC to its subsidiary bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of such subsidiary bank. In the event of a BHC’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the BHC to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to a priority of payment.
Transactions with Affiliates
Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and the Federal Reserve’s Regulation W restrict transactions between a bank and its affiliates, including a parent BHC. Regions Bank is subject to these restrictions, which include quantitative and qualitative limits on the amounts and types of transactions that may take place, including extensions of credit to affiliates, investments in the stock or securities of affiliates, purchases of assets from affiliates and certain other transactions with affiliates. These restrictions also require that credit transactions with affiliates be collateralized and that transactions with affiliates be on market

15

Table of Contents




terms or better for the bank. Generally, a bank’s covered transactions with any affiliate are limited to 10% of the bank’s capital stock and surplus and covered transactions with all affiliates are limited to 20% of the bank’s capital stock and surplus.
Deposit Insurance
Regions Bank accepts deposits, and those deposits have the benefit of FDIC insurance up to the applicable limits. Under the FDIA, insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that the insured depository institution has engaged in unsafe and unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by a bank’s federal regulatory agency.
Deposit Insurance Assessments. Regions Bank pays deposit insurance premiums to the FDIC based on an assessment rate established by the FDIC. FDIC assessment rates for large institutions that have more than $10 billion in assets, such as Regions Bank, are calculated based on a “scorecard” methodology that seeks to capture both the probability that an individual large institution will fail and the magnitude of the impact on the deposit insurance fund if such a failure occurs, based primarily on the difference between the institution’s average of total assets and average tangible equity. The FDIC has the ability to make discretionary adjustments to the total score, up or down, based upon significant risk factors that are not adequately captured in the scorecard. For large institutions, including Regions Bank, after accounting for potential base-rate adjustments, the total base assessment rate could range from 1.5 to 40 basis points on an annualized basis.
The FDIA established a minimum ratio of the DIF to estimated insured deposits of 1.15% prior to September 2020 and 1.35% thereafter. Beginning July 1, 2016, the FDIC imposed a surcharge on the quarterly assessments of insured depository institutions with total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more, such as Regions Bank, that continued through September 30, 2018, when the reserve ratio of the DIF first reached 1.36%, exceeding the future statutorily required minimum of 1.35%. Because the statutory minimum was reached, the surcharge no longer applies. The surcharge was enacted to continue through the earlier of the quarter that the DIF first reaches or exceeds 1.35% or December 31, 2018. During 2018, the DIF reached the 1.35% minimum and the surcharge was discontinued beginning with the fourth quarter of 2018 assessment. During 2018, Regions Bank’s total FDIC insurance assessments and surcharge were $85 million, a $23 million decrease from 2017. We cannot predict whether, as a result of an adverse change in economic conditions or other reasons, the FDIC will increase deposit insurance assessment levels in the future.
For more information, see the “FDIC Insurance Assessments” section of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Acquisitions
The BHC Act requires every BHC to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before: (i) it may acquire direct or indirect ownership or control of any voting shares of any bank or savings and loan association, if after such acquisition, the BHC will directly or indirectly own or control 5% or more of the voting shares of the institution; (ii) it or any of its subsidiaries, other than a bank, may acquire all or substantially all of the assets of any bank or savings and loan association; or (iii) it may merge or consolidate with any other BHC. FHCs with consolidated assets exceeding $50 billion must obtain prior approval from the Federal Reserve before acquiring certain non-bank financial companies with assets exceeding $10 billion. FHCs seeking approval to complete an acquisition must be well-capitalized and well-managed. Currently, BHCs with consolidated assets exceeding $50 billion must also provide prior written notice to the Federal Reserve before acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of any voting shares of any company having consolidated assets of $10 billion or more. EGRRCPA amended this requirement to apply only to BHCs with consolidated assets exceeding $250 billion, effective November 24, 2019.
The BHC Act further provides that the Federal Reserve may not approve any transaction that would result in a monopoly or would be in furtherance of any combination or conspiracy to monopolize or attempt to monopolize the business of banking in any section of the U.S., or the effect of which may be substantially to lessen competition or to tend to create a monopoly in any section of the country, or that in any other manner would be in restraint of trade, unless the anticompetitive effects of the proposed transaction are clearly outweighed by the public interest in meeting the convenience and needs of the community to be served. The Federal Reserve is also required to consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the BHCs and banks impacted and the convenience and needs of the community to be served. Consideration of financial resources generally focuses on capital adequacy, and the consideration of convenience and needs of the community to be served includes the parties’ performance under the CRA. The Federal Reserve must also take into account the institutions’ effectiveness in combating money laundering. In addition, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the BHC Act was amended to require the Federal Reserve to, when evaluating a proposed transaction, consider the extent to which the transaction would result in greater or more concentrated risks to the stability of the U.S. banking or financial system.
Depositor Preference
Under federal law, claims of depositors and certain claims for both administrative expenses and employee compensation against an insured depository institution would be afforded a priority over other general unsecured claims against such an institution in the “liquidation or other resolution” of such an institution by any receiver.

16

Table of Contents




Volcker Rule
The Dodd-Frank Act prohibits banks and their affiliates from engaging in proprietary trading and investing in, sponsoring and having certain relationships with private funds such as hedge funds or private equity funds that would be considered an investment company for purposes of the Volcker Rule. The final rules implementing the Volcker Rule also require that large BHCs, such as Regions, design and implement compliance programs to ensure adherence to the Volcker Rule’s prohibitions. Development and monitoring of the required compliance program may require the expenditure of resources and management attention. In July 2018, the Federal Reserve, OCC, FDIC, CFTC and SEC issued a notice of proposed rulemaking intended to tailor the application of the Volcker Rule based on the size and scope of a banking entity’s trading activities and to clarify and amend certain definitions, requirements and exemptions. The ultimate impact of any amendments to the Volcker Rule will depend on, among other things, further rulemaking and implementation guidance from the relevant U.S. federal regulatory agencies and the development of market practices and standards.
Consumer Protection Laws
We are subject to a number of federal and state consumer protection laws, including laws designed to protect customers and promote lending to various sectors of the economy and population. These laws include, but are not limited to, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the Truth in Lending Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act, the Truth in Savings Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, and their respective state law counterparts.
The CFPB has broad rulemaking, supervisory and enforcement powers under various federal consumer financial protection laws, including the laws referenced above, fair lending laws and certain other statutes. The CFPB has finalized a number of significant rules, including rules that impact nearly every aspect of the lifecycle of a residential mortgage loan. The CFPB also has examination and primary enforcement authority with respect to depository institutions with $10 billion or more in assets, including the authority to prevent unfair, deceptive or abusive practices in connection with the offering of consumer financial products.
Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and standards that are more stringent than those adopted at the federal level and, in certain circumstances, permits state attorneys general to enforce compliance with both the state and federal laws and regulations.
Financial Privacy and Cybersecurity
The federal banking regulators have adopted rules that limit the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose non-public information about consumers to non-affiliated third parties. These limitations require disclosure of privacy policies to consumers and, in some circumstances, allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to a non-affiliated third party. These regulations affect how consumer information is used in diversified financial companies and conveyed to outside vendors. In addition, consumers may also prevent disclosure of certain information among affiliated companies that is assembled or used to determine eligibility for a product or service, such as that shown on consumer credit reports and application information. Consumers also have the option to direct banks and other financial institutions not to share information about transactions and experiences with affiliated companies for the purpose of marketing products or services.
The federal banking regulators regularly issue guidance regarding cybersecurity intended to enhance cyber risk management standards among financial institutions. A financial institution is expected to establish multiple lines of defense and to ensure their risk management processes address the risk posed by potential threats to the institution. A financial institution’s management is expected to maintain sufficient processes to effectively respond and recover the institution’s operations after a cyber-attack. A financial institution is also expected to develop appropriate processes to enable recovery of data and business operations if a critical service provider of the institution falls victim to this type of cyber-attack. The Regions Information Security Program reflects the requirements of this guidance.
State regulators have also been increasingly active in implementing privacy and cybersecurity standards and regulations. Recently, several states have adopted regulations requiring certain financial institutions to implement cybersecurity programs and providing detailed requirements with respect to these programs, including data encryption requirements. Many states have also recently implemented or modified their data breach notification and data privacy requirements. We expect this trend of state-level activity in those areas to continue, and are continually monitoring developments in the states in which our customers are located.
Community Reinvestment Act
Regions Bank is subject to the provisions of the CRA. Under the terms of the CRA, Regions Bank has a continuing and affirmative obligation, consistent with safe and sound operation, to help meet the credit needs of its communities, including providing credit to individuals residing in low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. The CRA requires each appropriate federal bank regulatory agency, in connection with its examination of a depository institution, to assess such institution’s record in assessing and meeting the credit needs of the community served by that institution, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. The regulatory agency’s assessment is part of the Federal Reserve’s consideration of applications by a bank or BHC to acquire, merge or consolidate with another banking institution or its holding company, to establish a new branch office that will accept deposits or to relocate an office. In the case of a BHC applicant, the Federal Reserve will assess the records of each subsidiary

17

Table of Contents




depository institution of the applicant BHC, and such records may be the basis for denying the application. In April 2018, the U.S. Department of Treasury issued a memorandum to the Federal banking regulators with recommended changes to the CRA’s implementing regulations to reduce their complexity and associated burden on banks. We will continue to evaluate the impact of any changes to the regulations implementing the CRA.
Compensation Practices
Our compensation practices are subject to oversight by the Federal Reserve. The federal banking regulators have provided guidance designed to ensure that incentive compensation arrangements at banking organizations take into account risk and are consistent with safe and sound practices. The guidance sets forth the following three key principles with respect to incentive compensation arrangements: (i) the arrangements should provide employees with incentives that appropriately balance risk and financial results in a manner that does not encourage employees to expose their organizations to imprudent risk; (ii) the arrangements should be compatible with effective controls and risk management; and (iii) the arrangements should be supported by strong corporate governance. The guidance provides that supervisory findings with respect to incentive compensation will be incorporated, as appropriate, into the organization’s supervisory ratings, which can affect its ability to make acquisitions or perform other actions. The guidance also provides that enforcement actions may be taken against a banking organization if its incentive compensation arrangements or related risk management, control or governance processes pose a risk to the organization’s safety and soundness.
Anti-Money Laundering
A continued focus of governmental policy relating to financial institutions in recent years has been combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA PATRIOT Act broadened the application of anti-money laundering regulations to apply to additional types of financial institutions such as broker-dealers, investment advisors and insurance companies, and strengthened the ability of the U.S. Government to help prevent, detect and prosecute international money laundering and the financing of terrorism. The principal provisions of Title III of the USA PATRIOT Act require that regulated financial institutions, including state member banks: (i) establish an anti-money laundering program that includes training and audit components; (ii) comply with regulations regarding the verification of the identity of any person seeking to open an account; (iii) take additional required precautions with non-U.S. owned accounts; and (iv) perform certain verification and certification of money laundering risk for their foreign correspondent banking relationships. Failure of a financial institution to comply with the USA PATRIOT Act’s requirements could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution. Regions’ banking subsidiary has augmented its systems and procedures to meet the requirements of these regulations and will continue to revise and update their policies, procedures and controls to reflect changes required by the USA PATRIOT Act and implementing regulations. The USA PATRIOT Act also requires federal banking regulators to evaluate the effectiveness of an applicant in combating money laundering in determining whether to approve a proposed bank acquisition.
In May 2016, FinCEN, which drafts regulations implementing the USA PATRIOT Act and other anti-money laundering and Bank Secrecy Act legislation, issued final rules that require financial institutions to obtain beneficial ownership information with respect to legal entities with which such institutions conduct business, subject to certain exclusions and exemptions, and financial institutions that are subject to these final rules, including Regions, were required to comply by May 2018. Bank regulators are focusing their examinations on anti-money laundering compliance, and we continue to monitor and augment, where necessary, our anti-money laundering compliance programs.
Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation
The U.S. has imposed economic sanctions that affect transactions with designated foreign countries, nationals and others. These are typically known as the “OFAC” rules based on their administration by the U.S. Treasury Department Office of Foreign Assets Control. The OFAC-administered sanctions targeting countries take many different forms. Generally, however, they contain one or more of the following elements: (i) restrictions on trade with or investment in a sanctioned country, including prohibitions against direct or indirect imports from and exports to a sanctioned country and prohibitions on U.S. persons engaging in financial transactions relating to, making investments in, or providing investment-related advice or assistance to, a sanctioned country; and (ii) a blocking of assets in which the government or specially designated nationals of the sanctioned country have an interest, by prohibiting transfers of property subject to U.S. jurisdiction (including property in the possession or control of U.S. persons). Blocked assets (e.g., property and bank deposits) cannot be paid out, withdrawn, set off or transferred in any manner without a license from OFAC. Failure to comply with these sanctions could have serious legal and reputational consequences.
Regulation of Broker Dealers
Our subsidiaries, Regions Securities LLC and BlackArch Securities LLC, are registered broker-dealers with the SEC and, as a result, are subject to regulation and examination by the SEC, FINRA and other self-regulatory organizations. These regulations cover a broad range of issues, including capital requirements; sales and trading practices; use of client funds and securities; the conduct of directors, officers and employees; record-keeping and recording; supervisory procedures to prevent improper trading on material non-public information; qualification and licensing of sales personnel; and limitations on the extension of credit in securities transactions. In addition to federal registration, state securities commissions require the registration of certain broker-dealers.

18

Table of Contents




Competition
All aspects of our business are highly competitive. Our subsidiaries compete with other financial institutions located in the states in which they operate and other adjoining states, as well as large banks in major financial centers and other financial intermediaries, such as savings and loan associations, credit unions, Internet banks, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms, mortgage companies and financial service operations of major commercial and retail corporations. We expect competition to remain intense among financial services companies given the relatively low interest rate and slower economic environment relative to past economic cycles. Also, future changes in monetary policy , coupled with post-crisis regulatory requirements, may increase competition for certain deposit products.     
Customers for banking services and other financial services offered by our subsidiaries are generally influenced by convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, price of services and availability of products. Although our position varies in different markets, we believe that our affiliates effectively compete with other financial services companies in their relevant market areas.
Employees
As of December 31, 2018, Regions and its subsidiaries had 19,969 full-time equivalent employees.
Available Information
We maintain a website at www.regions.com . We make available on our website, free of charge, our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K, including exhibits, and amendments to those reports that are filed with or furnished to the SEC pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. These documents are made available on our website as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. These documents are also available, free of charge, on the SEC's website at www.sec.gov. Also available on our website are our (i) Corporate Governance Principles, (ii) Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, (iii) Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers, (iv) Fair Disclosure Policy Summary, and (v) the charters of our Audit Committee, Compensation and Human Resources Committee, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, and Risk Committee.


19

Table of Contents




Item 1A. Risk Factors
An investment in the Company involves risk, some of which, including market, liquidity, credit, operational, legal, compliance, reputational and strategic risks, could be substantial and is inherent in our business. This risk also includes the possibility that the value of the investment could decrease considerably, and dividends or other distributions concerning the investment could be reduced or eliminated. Discussed below are risk factors that could adversely affect our financial results and condition, as well as the value of, and return on investment in the Company.
Risks Related to the Operation of Our Business
Our businesses have been, and may continue to be, adversely affected by conditions in the financial markets and economic conditions generally.
We provide traditional commercial, retail and mortgage banking services, as well as other financial services including asset management, wealth management, securities brokerage, merger-and-acquisition advisory services and other specialty financing. All of our businesses are materially affected by conditions in the financial markets and economic conditions generally or specifically in the Southeastern U.S., the principal markets in which we conduct business. A worsening of business and economic conditions generally or specifically in the principal markets in which we conduct business could have adverse effects on our business, including the following:
A decrease in the demand for, or the availability of, loans and other products and services offered by us;
A decrease in the value of our loans held for sale or other assets secured by consumer or commercial real estate;
An impairment of certain intangible assets, such as goodwill;
A decrease in interest income from variable rate loans, due to declines in interest rates; and
An increase in the number of clients and counterparties who become delinquent, file for protection under bankruptcy laws or default on their loans or other obligations to us, which could result in a higher level of nonperforming assets, net charge-offs, provisions for loan losses, and valuation adjustments on loans held for sale.
In the event of severely adverse business and economic conditions generally or specifically in the principal markets in which we conduct business, there can be no assurance that the federal government and the Federal Reserve would intervene. If economic conditions worsen or volatility increases, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.
Ineffective liquidity management could adversely affect our financial results and condition.
Effective liquidity management is essential for the operation of our business. We require sufficient liquidity to meet customer loan requests, customer deposit maturities/withdrawals, payments on our debt obligations as they come due and other cash commitments under both normal operating conditions and unpredictable circumstances causing industry or general financial market stress. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance our activities on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us specifically or the financial services industry or economy generally. Factors that could detrimentally impact our access to liquidity sources include a downturn in the geographic markets in which our loans and operations are concentrated or difficult credit markets. Our access to deposits may also be affected by the liquidity needs of our depositors. In particular, a majority of our liabilities during 2018 were checking accounts and other liquid deposits, which are payable on demand or upon several days’ notice, while by comparison, a substantial majority of our assets were loans, which cannot be called or sold in the same time frame. Although we have historically been able to replace maturing deposits and advances as necessary, we might not be able to replace such funds in the future, especially if a large number of our depositors seek to withdraw their accounts, regardless of the reason. A failure to maintain adequate liquidity could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.
Our operations are concentrated in the Southeastern U.S., and adverse changes in the economic conditions in this region can adversely affect our financial results and condition.
Our operations are concentrated in the Southeastern U.S., particularly in the states of Alabama, Florida, Georgia, Louisiana, Mississippi and Tennessee. As a result, local economic conditions in the Southeastern U.S. significantly affect the demand for the loans and other products we offer to our customers (including real estate, commercial and construction loans), the ability of borrowers to repay these loans and the value of the collateral securing these loans. Following the financial crisis, the national real estate market experienced a significant decline in value, and the value of real estate in Florida in particular declined significantly more than real estate values in the U.S. as a whole. This decline has had an adverse impact on some of our borrowers and on the value of the collateral securing many of our loans. Although real estate in many geographies has improved, any further declines in the future may affect borrowers and collateral values, which could adversely affect our currently performing loans, leading to future delinquencies or defaults and increases in our provision for loan losses. Further or continued adverse changes in these economic conditions could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.

20

Table of Contents




Weather-related events and other natural disasters, as well as man-made disasters, could cause a disruption in our operations or other consequences that could have an adverse impact on financial results and condition.
A significant portion of our operations is located in the areas bordering the Gulf of Mexico and the Atlantic Ocean, regions that are susceptible to hurricanes, or in areas of the Southeastern U.S. that are susceptible to tornadoes and other severe weather events. In particular, in recent years, a number of severe Atlantic Ocean hurricanes impacted areas in our footprint. Many areas in the Southeastern U.S. have also experienced severe droughts and floods in recent years. Any of these, or any other severe weather event, could cause disruption to our operations and could have a material adverse effect on our overall business, results of operations or financial condition. While we maintain insurance covering many of these weather-related events, including coverage for lost profits and extra expense, there is no insurance against the disruption that a catastrophic earthquake, fire, hurricane, tornado or other severe weather event could produce to the markets that we serve and the resulting adverse impact on our borrowers to timely repay their loans and the value of any collateral held by us. The severity and impact of future earthquakes, fires, hurricanes, tornadoes, droughts, floods and other weather-related events are difficult to predict and may be exacerbated by global climate change. Man-made disasters and other events connected with the Gulf of Mexico or Atlantic Ocean, such as oil spills, could have similar effects.
If we experience greater credit losses in our loan portfolios than anticipated, our earnings may be materially adversely affected.
As a lender, we are exposed to the risk that our customers will be unable to repay their loans and leases according to their terms and that any collateral securing the payment of their loans and leases may not be sufficient to assure repayment. Credit losses are inherent in the business of making loans and could have a material adverse effect on our operating results.
We make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan portfolio and provide an allowance for loan losses based on a number of factors. Our management periodically determines the allowance for loan losses based on available information, including the quality of the loan portfolio, economic conditions, the value of the underlying collateral and the level of non-accrual loans. Increases in the allowance will result in an expense for the period, thereby reducing our reported net income. If, as a result of general economic conditions, there is a decrease in asset quality or growth in the loan portfolio, management determines that additional increases in the allowance for loan losses are necessary, we may incur additional expenses which will reduce our net income, and our business, results of operations or financial condition may be materially adversely affected.
Although our management will establish an allowance for loan losses it believes is appropriate to absorb probable and reasonably estimable losses in our loan portfolio, this allowance may not be adequate. For example, if a hurricane or other natural disaster were to occur in one of our principal markets or if economic conditions in those markets were to deteriorate unexpectedly, additional loan losses not incorporated in the existing allowance for loan losses may occur. Losses in excess of the existing allowance for loan losses will reduce our net income and could adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition, perhaps materially.
In addition, bank regulatory agencies will periodically review our allowance for loan losses and the value attributed to non-accrual loans and to real estate acquired through foreclosure. Such regulatory agencies may require us to adjust our determination of the value for these items. These adjustments could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.
As discussed in greater detail below, Accounting Standards Update 2016-13, Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments , is effective January 1, 2020, and will substantially change the accounting for credit losses on loans and other financial assets. The standard removes the existing “probable” threshold in GAAP for recognizing credit losses and instead requires companies to reflect their estimate of credit losses over the life of the financial assets. The adoption of the standard may result in an overall material increase in the allowance for credit losses. However, the impact at adoption will be influenced by the portfolios' composition and quality at the adoption date as well as economic conditions and forecasts at that time.
Weakness in the residential real estate markets could adversely affect our performance.
As of December 31, 2018 , consumer residential real estate loans represented approximately 28.3% of our total loan portfolio. Declines in home values would adversely affect the value of collateral securing the residential real estate that we hold, as well as the volume of loan originations and the amount we realize on the sale of real estate loans. These factors could result in higher delinquencies and greater charge-offs in future periods, which could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Weakness in the commercial real estate markets could adversely affect our performance.
As of December 31, 2018 , approximately 7.7% of our loan portfolio consisted of investor real estate loans. The properties securing income-producing investor real estate loans are typically not fully leased at the origination of the loan. The borrower’s ability to repay the loan is instead dependent upon additional leasing through the life of the loan or the borrower’s successful operation of a business. Weak economic conditions may impair a borrower’s business operations and typically slow the execution of new leases. Such economic conditions may also lead to existing lease turnover. As a result of these factors, vacancy rates for retail, office and industrial space may increase. High vacancy rates could also result in rents falling. The combination of these factors could result in deterioration in the fundamentals underlying the commercial real estate market and the deterioration in value

21

Table of Contents




of some of our loans. Any such deterioration could adversely affect the ability of our borrowers to repay the amounts due under their loans. As a result, our business, results of operations or financial condition may be materially adversely affected.
Risks associated with home equity products where we are in a second lien position could materially adversely affect our performance.
Home equity products, particularly those where we are in a second lien position, and particularly those in certain geographic areas, may carry a higher risk of non-collection than other loans. Home equity lending includes both home equity loans and lines of credit. Of our $9.3 billion home equity portfolio at December 31, 2018 , approximately $5.9 billion were home equity lines of credit and $3.4 billion were closed-end home equity loans (primarily originated as amortizing loans). This type of lending, which is secured by a first or second mortgage on the borrower’s residence, allows customers to borrow against the equity in their home. Real estate market values at the time of origination directly affect the amount of credit extended, and, in addition, past and future changes in these values impact the depth of potential losses. Second lien position lending carries higher credit risk because any decrease in real estate pricing may result in the value of the collateral being insufficient to cover the second lien after the first lien position has been satisfied. As of December 31, 2018 , approximately $3.1 billion of our home equity lines and loans were in a second lien position.
Weakness in commodity businesses could adversely affect our performance.
Many of our borrowers operate in industries that are directly or indirectly impacted by changes in commodity prices. This includes agriculture, livestock, metals, timber, textiles and energy businesses (including oil, gas and petrochemical), as well as businesses indirectly impacted by commodities prices such as businesses that transport commodities or manufacture equipment used in production of commodities. Changes in commodity products prices depend on local, regional and global events or conditions that affect supply and demand for the relevant commodity. These industries have been, and may in the future be, subject to significant volatility. In addition, legislative changes such as the elimination of certain tax incentives could have significant impacts on this portfolio.
Industry competition may adversely affect our degree of success.
Our profitability depends on our ability to compete successfully. We operate in a highly competitive environment, and we expect competition to remain intense among financial services companies given the relatively low interest rate and slower economic environment relative to past economic cycles. In our market areas, we face competition from other commercial banks, savings and loan associations, credit unions, Internet banks, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms, mortgage companies, and other financial intermediaries that offer similar services. Some of our non-bank competitors are not subject to the same extensive regulations we are and, therefore, may have greater flexibility in competing for business. In particular, the activity and prominence of marketplace lenders and other technological financial services companies have grown significantly over recent years and is expected to continue growing, including further entry into offering traditional banking products and the possibility of obtaining bank or bank-like charters, such as the OCC’s fintech charter.
Our ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including customer convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, pricing and range of products. If we are unable to successfully compete for new customers and to retain our current customers, our business, financial condition or results of operations may be adversely affected, perhaps materially. In particular, if we experience an outflow of deposits as a result of our customers seeking investments with higher yields or greater financial stability, we may be forced to rely more heavily on borrowings and other sources of funding to operate our business and meet withdrawal demands, thereby adversely affecting our net interest margin and financial performance.
Fluctuations in market interest rates may adversely affect our performance.
Our profitability depends to a large extent on our net interest income and other financing income, which is the difference between the interest income received on interest-earning assets (primarily loans and investment securities) and the interest expense incurred in connection with interest-bearing liabilities (primarily deposits and borrowings). Net interest income and other financing income also includes rental income and depreciation expense associated with operating leases for which Regions is the lessor. The level of net interest income and other financing income is primarily a function of the average balance of interest-earning assets, the average balance of interest-bearing liabilities and the spread between the yield on such assets and the cost of such liabilities. These factors are influenced by both the pricing and mix of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities which, in turn, are impacted by external factors such as the local economy, competition for loans and deposits, the monetary policy of the FOMC and interest rates markets.
The cost of our deposits and short-term wholesale borrowings is largely based on short-term interest rates, the level of which is influenced heavily by the FOMC’s actions. However, the yields generated by our loans and securities are typically driven by both short-term and longer-term interest rates. Longer-term rates are affected by multiple factors including the actions of the FOMC through actions such as quantitative easing or tightening, and the market's expectations for future inflation, growth and other economic considerations. The level of net interest income and other financing income is, therefore, influenced by the overall level of interest rates along with the shape of the yield curve. Interest rate volatility can reduce unrealized gains or create unrealized losses in our portfolios. If the interest rates on our interest-bearing liabilities increase at a faster pace than the interest rates on our interest-earning assets, our net interest income and other financing income may decline.

22

Table of Contents




Our net interest income and other financing income would be similarly affected if the interest rates on our interest-earning assets declined at a faster pace than the interest rates on our interest-bearing liabilities. Interest rates remain low by historical standards; however, while still low relative to historical standards, increases in short term and long term interest rates since December 2015 have contributed to growth in net interest income and other financing income and the net interest margin.
Our current one-year interest rate sensitivity position is asset sensitive. As a result, an immediate or gradual decrease in rates over a twelve-month period would likely have a negative impact on twelve-month net interest income and other financing income. Conversely, an increasing rate environment would likely have a positive impact on twelve-month net interest income and other financing income. However, increasing rates would also increase debt service requirements for some of our borrowers and may adversely affect those borrowers’ ability to pay as contractually obligated and could result in additional delinquencies or charge-offs. Our results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected as a result.
For a more detailed discussion of these risks and our management strategies for these risks, see the “Net Interest Income and Other Financing Income, Margin and Interest Rate Risk,” “Net Interest Income and Other Financing Income and Margin,” “Market Risk-Interest Rate Risk” and “Securities” sections of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Changes in the method pursuant to which the LIBOR and other benchmark rates are determined could adversely impact our business and results of operations.
Our floating-rate funding, certain hedging transactions and certain of the products that we offer, such as floating-rate loans and mortgages, determine their applicable interest rate or payment amount by reference to a benchmark rate, such as LIBOR, or to an index, currency, basket or other financial metric. LIBOR and certain other benchmark rates are the subject of recent national, international, and other regulatory guidance and proposals for reform. In July 2017, the Chief Executive of the FCA announced that the FCA intends to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit rates for the calculation of LIBOR after 2021. This announcement indicates that the continuation of LIBOR on the current basis cannot and will not be guaranteed after 2021. Consequently, at this time, it is not possible to predict whether and to what extent banks will continue to provide submissions for the calculation of LIBOR. Similarly, it is not possible to predict whether LIBOR will continue to be viewed as an acceptable market benchmark, what rate or rates may become accepted alternatives to LIBOR, or what the effect of any such changes in views or alternatives may be on the markets for LIBOR-linked financial instruments.
Certain of our LIBOR-based financial products and contracts, including, but not limited to, hedging products, debt obligations, investments, and loans, extend beyond 2021. We are in the process of assessing the impact that a cessation or market replacement of LIBOR would have on these various products and contracts.
Any future reductions in our credit ratings may increase our funding costs and place limitations on business activities related to providing credit support to customers.
The major ratings agencies regularly evaluate us, and their ratings are based on a number of factors, including our financial strength and conditions affecting the financial services industry generally. In general, ratings agencies base their ratings on many quantitative and qualitative factors, including capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix and level and quality of earnings, and we may not be able to maintain our current credit ratings. The ratings assigned to Regions and Regions Bank remain subject to change at any time, and it is possible that any ratings agency will take action to downgrade Regions, Regions Bank or both in the future. Additionally, ratings agencies may also make substantial changes to their ratings policies and practices, which may affect our credit ratings. In the future, changes to existing ratings guidelines and new ratings guidelines may, among other things, adversely affect the ratings of our securities or other securities in which we have an economic interest.
Regions’ credit ratings can have negative consequences that can impact our ability to access the debt and capital markets, as well as reduce our profitability through increased costs on future debt issuances. In addition, certain customers could be prohibited from placing deposits with Regions Bank. If Regions were to be downgraded below investment grade, we may not be able to reliably access the short-term unsecured funding markets, and certain customers could be prohibited from placing deposits with Regions Bank, which could cause us to hold more cash and liquid investments to meet our ongoing liquidity needs. Such actions could reduce our profitability as these liquid investments earn a lower return than other assets, such as loans. Regions’ liquidity policy requires that the holding company maintain cash sufficient to cover the greater of (i) 18 months of debt service and other cash needs or (ii) a minimum cash balance of $500 million. Although this policy helps protect us against the costs of unexpected adverse funding environments, we cannot guarantee that this policy will be sufficient.
Additionally, if Regions were to be downgraded to below investment grade, certain counterparty contracts may be required to be renegotiated or require the posting of additional collateral. Refer to Note 21 “Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities - Contingent Features” to the consolidated financial statements of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fair value of contracts subject to contingent credit features and the collateral postings associated with such contracts. Although the exact amount of additional collateral is unknown, it is reasonable to conclude that Regions may be required to post additional collateral related to existing contracts with contingent credit features.

23

Table of Contents




The value of our goodwill and other intangible assets may decline in the future.
As of December 31, 2018 , we had $4.8 billion of goodwill and $115 million of other intangible assets. A significant decline in our expected future cash flows, a significant adverse change in the business climate, slower economic growth or a significant and sustained decline in the price of our common stock, any or all of which could be materially impacted by many of the risk factors discussed herein, may necessitate our taking charges in the future related to the impairment of our goodwill. Future regulatory actions could also have a material impact on assessments of goodwill for impairment. If we were to conclude that a future write-down of our goodwill is necessary, we would record the appropriate charge, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
Identifiable intangible assets other than goodwill consist of core deposit intangibles, purchased credit card relationship assets, and the DUS license. Adverse events or circumstances could impact the recoverability of these intangible assets including loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card accounts and/or balances, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent these intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, a non-cash impairment charge would be recorded, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
The value of our deferred tax assets could adversely affect our operating results and regulatory capital ratios.
As of December 31, 2018 , Regions had approximately $20 million in net deferred tax assets (net of valuation allowance of $30 million ). Our deferred tax assets are subject to an evaluation of whether it is more likely than not that they will be realized for financial statement purposes. In making this determination, we consider all positive and negative evidence available, including the impact of recent operating results, future reversals of taxable temporary differences, future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards and tax planning strategies. We have determined that the deferred tax assets are more likely than not to be realized at December 31, 2018 (except for $30 million related to state deferred tax assets for which we have established a valuation allowance). If we were to conclude that a significant portion of our deferred tax assets were not more likely than not to be realized, the required valuation allowance could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations and regulatory capital ratios. In addition, the value of our deferred tax assets could be adversely affected by a change in statutory tax rates.
Changes in the soundness of other financial institutions could adversely affect us.
Financial services companies are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and we routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment banks, mutual and hedge funds, and other institutional clients. As a result, defaults by, or even mere speculation about, one or more financial services companies, or the financial services industry generally, may lead to market-wide liquidity problems and could lead to losses or defaults by us or by other institutions. Many of these transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of default of our counterparty or client. In addition, our credit risk may be exacerbated if the collateral held by us cannot be realized or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan or lease or derivative exposure due us. Any such losses may materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Our businesses may be adversely affected if we are unable to hire and retain qualified employees.
Our success depends, in part, on our executive officers and other key personnel. The market for qualified individuals is highly competitive, and we may not be able to attract and retain qualified personnel or candidates to replace or succeed members of our senior management team or other key personnel. Our compensation practices are subject to review and oversight by the Federal Reserve, the FDIC and other regulators. As a large financial and banking institution, we may be subject to limitations on compensation practices, which may or may not affect our competitors, by the Federal Reserve, the FDIC or other regulators. These limitations could further affect our ability to attract and retain our executive officers and other key personnel, in particular as we are more often competing for personnel with financial technology providers and other less regulated entities who may not have the same limitations on compensation as we do. For a discussion of proposed rules that may impact our compensation practices, see the “Supervision and Regulation-Compensation Practices” section of Item 1. “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Maintaining or increasing market share may depend on market acceptance and regulatory approval of new products and services.
Our success depends, in part, on the ability to adapt products and services to evolving industry standards. There is increasing pressure to provide products and services at lower prices. This can reduce net interest income and other financing income and non-interest income from fee-based products and services. In addition, the widespread adoption of new technologies could require us to make substantial capital expenditures to modify or adapt existing products and services or develop new products and services. We may not be successful in introducing new products and services in response to industry trends or developments in technology, or those new products may not achieve market acceptance. As a result, we could lose business, be forced to price products and services on less advantageous terms to retain or attract clients, or be subject to cost increases, and our business, financial condition or results of operations may be adversely affected.

24

Table of Contents




We need to stay current on technological changes in order to compete and meet customer demands.
The financial services market, including banking services, is undergoing rapid changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. In addition to better serving customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and may enable us to reduce costs. Our future success may depend, in part, on our ability to use technology to provide products and services that provide convenience to customers and to create additional efficiencies in our operations. Some of our competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements than we currently have. Further, financial technology providers, who invest substantial resources in developing and designing new technology (in particular digital and mobile technology), are beginning to offer more traditional banking products (either directly or through bank partnerships) and may in the future be able to provide additional services by obtaining a bank-like charter, such as the OCC’s fintech charter. We may not be able to effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services to our customers. As a result, our ability to effectively compete to retain or acquire new business may be impaired, and our business, financial condition or results of operations, may be adversely affected.
We are subject to a variety of operational risks, including the risk of fraud or theft by employees, which may adversely affect our business and results of operations.
We are exposed to many types of operational risks, including business continuity, process, third party, information technology, human resource, model, and fraud risks. Regions’ fraud risks include fraud committed by external parties against the Company or its customers and fraud committed internally by our associates. Certain fraud risks, including identity theft and account takeover may increase as a result of customers’ account or personally identifiable information being obtained through breaches of retailers’ or other third parties’ networks. We have established processes and procedures intended to identify, measure, monitor, mitigate, report and analyze these risks; however, there are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies as there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated, monitored or identified. If our risk management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses, we may have to expend resources detecting and correcting the failure in our systems and we may be subject to potential claims from third parties and government agencies. We may also suffer severe reputational damage. Any of these consequences could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. In particular, the unauthorized disclosure, misappropriation, mishandling or misuse of personal, non-public, confidential or proprietary information of customers could result in significant regulatory consequences, reputational damage and financial loss.
Damage to our reputation could significantly harm our businesses.
Our ability to attract and retain customers and highly-skilled management and employees is impacted by our reputation. A negative public opinion of us and our business can result from any number of activities, including our lending practices, corporate governance and regulatory compliance, acquisitions and actions taken by our regulators or by community organizations in response to these activities. Significant harm to our reputation could also arise as a result of regulatory or governmental actions, litigation, employee misconduct or the activities of our customers, other participants in the financial services industry or our contractual counterparties, such as our service providers and vendors. In particular, a cybersecurity event impacting us or our customers' data could have a negative impact on our reputation and customer confidence in Regions and its cybersecurity. Damage to our reputation could also adversely affect our credit ratings and access to the capital markets.
We are subject to a variety of systems failure and cybersecurity risks that could adversely affect our business and financial performance.
Failure in or breach of our systems or infrastructure, or those of our third-party service providers (or providers to such third-party service providers), including as a result of cyber-attacks, could disrupt our businesses or the businesses of our customers. This could result in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, damage our reputation, increase our costs and financial losses. As a large financial institution, we depend on our ability to process, record and monitor a large number of customer transactions on a continuous basis. As public and regulatory expectations, as well as our customers' expectations have increased regarding operational performance and information security, our systems and infrastructure must continue to be safeguarded and monitored for potential failures, disruptions and breakdowns. Our business, financial, accounting, data processing systems or other operating systems and facilities may stop operating properly or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors, including events that are wholly or partially beyond our control. For example, there could be electrical or telecommunications outages; natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornadoes and hurricanes; pandemics; events arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts; and, as described below, cyber-attacks. Although we have business continuity plans and other safeguards in place, our business operations may be adversely affected by significant and widespread disruption to our physical infrastructure or operating systems that support our businesses and customers. For a discussion of the guidance that federal banking regulators have released regarding cybersecurity and cyber risk management standards, see the “Supervision and Regulation-Financial Privacy and Cybersecurity” section of Item 1. “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Information security risks for large financial institutions, such as Regions, have increased significantly in recent years in part because of the proliferation of Internet and mobile banking and the increased sophistication and activities of organized crime, hackers, terrorists, nation-states, activists and other external parties. This increase is expected to continue and further intensify.

25

Table of Contents




Third parties with whom we or our customers do business also present operational and information security risks to us, including security breaches or failures of their own systems. As noted above, our operations rely on the secure processing, transmission and storage of confidential information in our computer systems and networks. In addition, to access our products and services, our customers may use personal computers, smartphones, tablets, and other mobile devices that are beyond our control environment. Although we believe that we have appropriate information security procedures and controls designed to prevent or limit the effects of a cyber-attack or information security breach, our technologies, systems, networks and our customers’ devices may be the target of cyber-attacks or information security breaches that could result in the unauthorized release, gathering, monitoring, misuse, loss or destruction of Regions’ or our customers’ confidential, proprietary and other information. We also have insurance coverage that may, subject to policy terms and conditions, cover certain losses associated with cyber-attacks or information security breaches, but it may be insufficient to cover all losses from any such attack or breach. Additionally, cyber-attacks, such as denial of service attacks, hacking or terrorist activities, could disrupt Regions’ or our customers’ or other third parties’ business operations. For example, denial of service attacks have been launched against a number of large financial services institutions, including Regions. Although these past events have not resulted in a breach of Regions’ client data or account information, such attacks have adversely affected the performance of Regions Bank’s website, www.regions.com , and, in some instances, prevented customers from accessing Regions Bank’s secure websites for consumer and commercial applications. In all cases, the attacks primarily resulted in inconvenience; however, future cyber-attacks could be more disruptive and damaging, and Regions may not be able to anticipate or prevent all such attacks. As cyber threats continue to evolve, we may be required to expend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our layers of defense or to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities. We may also be required to incur significant costs in connection with any regulatory investigation or civil litigation resulting from a cyber-attack or information security breach that impacts us. In addition, our third-party service providers may be unable to identify vulnerabilities in their systems or, once identified, be unable to promptly provide required patches. Further, even if provided, such patches may not fully remediate any vulnerability or may be difficult for Regions to implement. The techniques used by cyber criminals change frequently, may not be recognized until launched and can be initiated from a variety of sources, including terrorist organizations and hostile foreign governments. These criminals may attempt to fraudulently induce employees, customers or other users of our systems to disclose sensitive information in order to gain access to data or our systems.
Disruptions or failures in the physical infrastructure or operating systems that support our businesses and customers, or cyber-attacks or security breaches of the networks, systems or devices that our customers use to access our products and services, could result in customer attrition, regulatory fines, civil litigation, penalties or intervention, reputational damage, reimbursement or other compensation costs, remediation costs, additional cybersecurity protection costs, increased insurance premiums and/or additional compliance costs, any of which could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition. We could also be adversely affected if we lost access to information or services from a third-party service provider as a result of a security breach, system or operational failure or disruption affecting the third-party service provider. For a more detailed discussion of these risks and specific occurrences, see the “Information Security Risk” section of Item 7. "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
We are also subject to laws and regulations relating to the privacy of the information of clients, employees or others, and any failure to comply with these laws and regulations could expose us to liability and/or reputational damage. As new privacy-related laws and regulations, such as those modeled after GDPR, are implemented, the time and resources needed for us to comply with such laws and regulations, as well as our potential liability for non-compliance and reporting obligations in the case of data breaches, may significantly increase. In addition, our businesses are increasingly subject to laws and regulations relating to privacy, surveillance, encryption and data use in the jurisdictions in which we operate. Compliance with these laws and regulations may require us to change our policies, procedures and technology for information security and segregation of data, which could, among other things, make us more vulnerable to operational failures, and to monetary penalties for breach of such laws and regulations.
We rely on other companies to provide key components of our business infrastructure.
Third parties provide key components of our business operations such as data processing, recording and monitoring transactions, online banking interfaces and services, Internet connections and network access. While we have selected these third-party vendors carefully, performing upfront due diligence and ongoing monitoring activities, we do not control their actions. Any problems caused by these third parties, including those resulting from disruptions in services provided by a vendor (including as a result of a cyber-attack, other information security event or a natural disaster), financial or operational difficulties for the vendor, or resulting from issues at third-party vendors to the vendors, failure of a vendor to handle current or higher volumes, failure of a vendor to provide services for any reason, poor performance of services, failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations, or fraud or misconduct on the part of employees of any of our vendors, could adversely affect our ability to deliver products and services to our customers, our reputation and our ability to conduct our business. In certain situation, replacing these third-party vendors could also create significant delay and expense. Accordingly, use of such third parties creates an unavoidable, inherent risk to our business operations.
We depend on the accuracy and completeness of information about clients and counterparties.
In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions with clients and counterparties, we may rely on information furnished by or on behalf of clients and counterparties, including financial statements and other financial information. We also

26

Table of Contents




may rely on representations of clients and counterparties as to the accuracy and completeness of that information and, with respect to financial statements, on reports of independent auditors if made available. If this information is inaccurate, we may be subject to regulatory action, reputational harm or other adverse effects with respect to the operation of our business, our financial condition and our results of operations.
We are exposed to risk of environmental liability when we take title to property.
In the course of our business, we may foreclose on and take title to real estate. As a result, we could be subject to environmental liabilities with respect to these properties. We may be held liable to a governmental entity or to third parties for property damage, personal injury, investigation and clean-up costs incurred by these parties in connection with environmental contamination or may be required to investigate or clean up hazardous or toxic substances or chemical releases at a property. The costs associated with investigation or remediation activities could be substantial. In addition, if we are the owner or former owner of a contaminated site, we may be subject to common law claims by third parties based on damages and costs resulting from environmental contamination emanating from the property. If we become subject to significant environmental liabilities, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected.
We rely on the mortgage secondary market for some of our liquidity.
In 2018, we sold 45.6% of the mortgage loans we originated to the Agencies. We rely on the Agencies to purchase loans that meet their conforming loan requirements in order to reduce our credit risk and provide funding for additional loans we desire to originate. We cannot provide assurance that the Agencies will not materially limit their purchases of conforming loans due to capital constraints, a change in the criteria for conforming loans or other factors. Additionally, various proposals have been made to reform the U.S. residential mortgage finance market, including the role of the Agencies. The exact effects of any such reforms are not yet known, but they may limit our ability to sell conforming loans to the Agencies. If we are unable to continue to sell conforming loans to the Agencies, our ability to fund, and thus originate, additional mortgage loans may be adversely affected, which would adversely affect our results of operations.
We are subject to a variety of risks in connection with any sale of loans we may conduct.
In connection with our sale of one or more loan portfolios, we may make certain representations and warranties to the purchaser concerning the loans sold and the procedures under which those loans have been originated and serviced. If any of these representations and warranties are incorrect, we may be required to indemnify the purchaser for any related losses, or we may be required to repurchase part or all of the effected loans. We may also be required to repurchase loans as a result of borrower fraud or in the event of early payment default by the borrower on a loan we have sold. If we are required to make any indemnity payments or repurchases and do not have a remedy available to us against a solvent counterparty, we may not be able to recover our losses resulting from these indemnity payments and repurchases. Consequently, our results of operations may be adversely affected.
In addition, we must report as held for sale any loans that we have undertaken to sell, whether or not a purchase agreement for the loans has been executed. We may, therefore, be unable to ultimately complete a sale for part or all of the loans we classify as held for sale. Management must exercise its judgment in determining when loans must be reclassified from held for investment status to held for sale status under applicable accounting guidelines. Any failure to accurately report loans as held for sale could result in regulatory investigations and monetary penalties. Any of these actions could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. Reclassifying loans from held for investment to held for sale also requires that the affected loans be marked to the lower of cost or fair value. As a result, any loans classified as held for sale may be adversely affected by changes in interest rates and by changes in the borrower’s creditworthiness. We may be required to reduce the value of any loans we mark held for sale, which could adversely affect our results of operations.
A downgrade or potential downgrade of the U.S. Government’s sovereign credit rating by one or more credit ratings agencies, and developments in international trade, could adversely affect our business.
Future uncertainty over U.S. fiscal policy could result in a downgrade or a reduction in the outlook of the U.S. long-term sovereign credit rating by one or more credit ratings agencies. Any downgrade, or perceived future downgrade, in the U.S. sovereign credit rating or outlook could adversely affect global financial markets and economic conditions and may result in, among other things, increased volatility and illiquidity in the capital markets, declines in consumer confidence, increased unemployment levels and declines in the value of U.S. Treasury securities and securities guaranteed by the U.S. government. As a result, our business, liquidity, results of operations and financial conditions may be adversely affected. Additionally, the economic conditions resulting from any such downgrade or perceived future downgrade may significantly exacerbate the other risks we face. In addition, unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by the imposition of tariffs or other limitations on international trade and travel, which can result in market volatility, negatively impact client activity, and adversely affect our businesses.
Our reported financial results depend on management’s selection of accounting methods and certain assumptions and estimates.
Our accounting policies and assumptions are fundamental to our reported financial condition and results of operations. Our management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying many of these accounting policies and methods so they comply with GAAP and reflect management’s judgment of the most appropriate manner to report our financial condition and results. In

27

Table of Contents




some cases, management must select the accounting policy or method to apply from two or more alternatives, any of which may be reasonable under the circumstances, yet may result in us reporting materially different results than would have been reported under a different alternative.
Certain accounting policies are critical to presenting our reported financial condition and results of operations. They require management to make difficult, subjective or complex judgments about matters that are uncertain. Materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions or estimates. The Company’s critical accounting estimates include: the allowance for credit losses; fair value measurements; intangible assets; residential MSRs; and income taxes. Because of the uncertainty of estimates involved in these matters, we may be required to do one or more of the following: significantly increase the allowance for credit losses and/or sustain credit losses that are significantly higher than the reserve provided; recognize significant impairment on our goodwill, other intangible assets or deferred tax asset balances; or significantly increase our accrued income taxes. Any of these actions could adversely affect our reported financial condition and results of operations.
If the models that we use in our business perform poorly or provide inadequate information, our business or results of operations may be adversely affected.
We utilize quantitative models to assist in measuring risks and estimating or predicting certain financial values. Models may be used in processes such as determining the pricing of various products, grading loans and extending credit, measuring interest rate and other market risks, forecasting financial performance, predicting losses, improving customer services, maintaining adherence to laws and regulations, assessing capital adequacy, and calculating regulatory capital levels, as well as to estimate the value of financial instruments and balance sheet items. Poorly designed, implemented, or managed models present the risk that our business decisions that consider information based on such models will be adversely affected due to the inadequacy or inaccuracy of that information. Also, information we provide to the public or to our regulators based on poorly designed, implemented, or managed models could be inaccurate or misleading. Some of the decisions that our regulators make, including those related to capital distributions to our stockholders, could be affected adversely due to the perception that the quality of the models used to generate the relevant information is insufficient.
Changes in our accounting policies or in accounting standards could materially affect how we report our financial results and condition.
From time to time, the FASB and SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements. These changes can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. For example, in June 2016, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update 2016-13, Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments , that will, effective January 1, 2020, substantially change the accounting for credit losses on loans and other financial assets held by banks, financial institutions and other organizations. The standard removes the existing “probable” threshold in GAAP for recognizing credit losses and instead requires companies to reflect their estimate of credit losses over the life of the financial assets. Companies must consider all relevant information when estimating expected credit losses, including details about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. In December 2018, the Federal Reserve, OCC and FDIC released a final rule to revise their regulatory capital rules to address this upcoming change to the allowance measurement and subsequent concerns related to the impact on capital and capital planning. The rule provides an optional three-year phase-in period for the day-one adverse regulatory capital impact upon adoption of the standard. The impact of this final rule on Regions and Regions Bank will depend on whether we elect to phase in the impact of the standard over a three-year period. The adoption of the standard may result in an overall material increase in the allowance for credit losses. However, the impact at adoption will be influenced by the portfolios' composition and quality at the adoption date as well as economic conditions and forecasts at that time. It is also possible that Regions’ ongoing reported earnings and lending activity will be negatively impacted in periods following adoption.
Risks Arising From the Legal and Regulatory Framework in which Our Business Operates
We are, and may in the future be, subject to litigation, investigations and governmental proceedings that may result in liabilities adversely affecting our financial condition, business or results of operations or in reputational harm.
We and our subsidiaries are, and may in the future be, named as defendants in various class actions and other litigation, and may be the subject of subpoenas, reviews, requests for information, investigations, and formal and informal proceedings by government and self-regulatory agencies regarding our and their businesses and activities (including subpoenas, requests for information and investigations related to the activities of our customers). Any such matters may result in material adverse consequences to our results of operations, financial condition or ability to conduct our business, including adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties (including civil money penalties under applicable banking laws), injunctions, restrictions on our business activities or other relief. Our involvement in any such matters, even if the matters are ultimately determined in our favor, could also cause significant harm to our reputation and divert management attention from the operation of our business. Further, any settlement, consent order or adverse judgment in connection with any formal or informal proceeding or investigation by government or self-regulatory agencies may result in additional litigation, investigations or proceedings as other litigants and government or self-regulatory agencies (including the inquiries mentioned above) begin independent reviews of the same businesses or activities. In general, the amounts paid by financial institutions in settlement of proceedings or investigations, including those

28

Table of Contents




relating to anti-money laundering matters or sales practices, have increased substantially and are likely to remain elevated. In some cases, governmental authorities have required criminal pleas or other extraordinary terms as part of such settlements, which could have significant collateral consequences for a financial institution, including loss of customers, restrictions on the ability to access the capital markets, and the inability to operate certain businesses or offer certain products for a period of time. In addition, enforcement matters could impact our supervisory and CRA ratings, which may in turn restrict or limit our activities.
In recent years, a number of judicial decisions have upheld the right of borrowers to sue lending institutions on the basis of various evolving legal theories, collectively termed “lender liability.” Generally, lender liability is founded on the premise that a lender has either violated a duty, whether implied or contractual, of good faith and fair dealing owed to the borrower or has assumed a degree of control over the borrower resulting in the creation of a fiduciary duty owed to the borrower or its other creditors or stockholders. In the future, Regions could become subject to claims based on this or other evolving legal theories.
Additional information relating to our litigation, investigations and other proceedings is discussed in Note 24 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
We may face significant claims for indemnification in connection with our sale of Morgan Keegan in 2012.
In April 2012, Regions closed the sale of Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James. In connection with the sale, Regions agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all litigation and certain other matters related to pre-closing activities of Morgan Keegan. Indemnifiable losses under the indemnification provision include legal and other expenses, such as costs for defense, judgments, settlements and awards associated with the resolution of litigation related to pre-closing activities. As of December 31, 2018, the carrying value of the indemnification obligation is immaterial and reflects an estimate of liability; however, actual liabilities can potentially be higher than amounts reserved. The amount of liability that we may ultimately incur from indemnification claims may have an adverse impact, perhaps materially, on our financial condition or results of operations.
We are subject to extensive governmental regulation, which could have an adverse impact on our operations.
We are subject to extensive state and federal regulation, supervision and examination governing almost all aspects of our operations, which limits the businesses in which we may permissibly engage. The laws and regulations governing our business are intended primarily for the protection of our depositors, our customers, the financial system and the FDIC insurance fund, not our stockholders or other creditors. These laws and regulations govern a variety of matters, including certain debt obligations, changes in control, maintenance of adequate capital, and general business operations and financial condition (including permissible types, amounts and terms of loans and investments, the amount of reserves against deposits, restrictions on dividends, establishment of branch offices, and the maximum interest rate that may be charged by law). Further, we must obtain approval from our regulators before engaging in many activities, and our regulators have the ability to compel us to, or restrict us from, taking certain actions entirely. There can be no assurance that any regulatory approvals we may require or otherwise seek will be obtained.
Regulations affecting banks and other financial institutions are undergoing continuous review and frequently change, and the ultimate effect of such changes cannot be predicted. Changes to the legal and regulatory framework governing our operations, including the passage and continued implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act and EGRRCPA, have significantly revised the laws and regulations under which we operate. Although EGRRCPA contained limited amendments to the Dodd-Frank Act and certain other post-financial crisis regulatory requirements, rules to implement the changes have yet to be finalized, and the final timing, scope and impact of these changes to the regulatory framework applicable to financial institutions remain uncertain. Regulations and laws may be modified or repealed at any time, and new legislation may be enacted that will affect us, Regions Bank and our subsidiaries.
Any changes in any federal and state law, as well as regulations and governmental policies, income tax laws and accounting principles, could affect us in substantial and unpredictable ways, including ways that may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. Failure to appropriately comply with any such laws, regulations or principles could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil money penalties or damage to our reputation, all of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. Our regulatory position is discussed in greater detail in Note 14 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
We may be subject to more stringent capital and liquidity requirements.
Regions and Regions Bank are each subject to capital adequacy and liquidity guidelines and other regulatory requirements specifying minimum amounts and types of capital that must be maintained. From time to time, the regulators implement changes to these regulatory capital adequacy and liquidity guidelines. If we fail to meet these minimum capital adequacy and liquidity guidelines and other regulatory requirements, we or our subsidiaries may be restricted in the types of activities we may conduct and may be prohibited from taking certain capital actions, such as paying dividends and repurchasing or redeeming capital securities.
In particular, the capital adequacy and liquidity guidelines applicable to Regions and Regions Bank under the currently applicable Basel III Rules require Regions to satisfy additional, more stringent capital adequacy and liquidity standards than in the past. In addition, these requirements could have a negative impact on our ability to lend, grow deposit balances, make acquisitions and make capital distributions in the form of increased dividends or share repurchases. Higher capital levels could also lower our

29

Table of Contents




return on equity. In addition, Basel IV significantly revises the Basel capital framework, and the impact on us will depend on the manner in which the revisions are implemented in the U.S. with respect to firms such as Regions and Regions Bank.
For more information concerning our compliance with capital and liquidity requirements, see Note 14 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Rulemaking changes implemented by the CFPB will result in higher regulatory and compliance costs that may adversely affect our results of operations.
Since its formation, the CFPB has finalized a number of significant rules that could have a significant impact on our business and the financial services industry more generally. In particular, the CFPB has adopted rules impacting nearly every aspect of the lifecycle of a residential mortgage loan as discussed in the “Supervision and Regulation” section of Item 1. “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K above. We may also be required to add additional compliance personnel or incur other significant compliance-related expenses. Our business, results of operations or competitive position may be adversely affected as a result.
We may not be able to complete future acquisitions, may not be successful in realizing the benefits of any future acquisitions that are completed, or may choose not to pursue acquisition opportunities we might find beneficial.
We may, from time to time, evaluate and engage in the acquisition or divestiture of businesses (including their assets or liabilities, such as loans or deposits). We must generally satisfy a number of meaningful conditions prior to completing any such transaction, including in certain cases, federal and state bank regulatory approvals.
The process for obtaining required regulatory approvals, particularly for large financial institutions, like Regions, can be difficult, time-consuming and unpredictable. We may fail to pursue, evaluate or complete strategic and competitively significant business opportunities as a result of our inability, or our perceived inability, to obtain required regulatory approvals in a timely manner or at all.
Assuming we are able to successfully complete one or more transactions, we may not be able to successfully integrate and realize the expected synergies from any completed transaction in a timely manner or at all. In particular, we may be held responsible by federal and state regulators for regulatory and compliance failures at an acquired business prior to the date of the acquisition, and these failures by the acquired company may have negative consequences for us, including the imposition of formal or informal enforcement actions. Completion and integration of any transaction may also divert management attention from other matters, result in additional costs and expenses, or adversely affect our relationships with our customers and employees, any of which may adversely affect our business or results of operations. Future acquisitions may also result in dilution of our current stockholders’ ownership interests or may require we incur additional indebtedness or use a substantial amount of our available cash and other liquid assets. As a result, our financial condition may be affected, and we may become more susceptible to economic conditions and competitive pressures.
Increases in FDIC insurance assessments may adversely affect our earnings.
Our deposits are insured by the FDIC up to legal limits and, accordingly, we are subject to FDIC deposit insurance assessments. We generally cannot control the amount of assessments we will be required to pay for FDIC insurance. The FDIC may require us to pay higher FDIC assessments than we currently do or may charge additional special assessments or future prepayments if, for example, there are financial institution failures in the future. Any increase in deposit assessments or special assessments may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. See the “Supervision and Regulation-Deposit Insurance” discussion within Item 1. “Business” and the “Non-Interest Expense” discussion within Item 7. “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for additional information related to the FDIC’s deposit insurance assessments applicable to Regions Bank.
Unfavorable results from ongoing stress analyses may adversely affect our ability to retain customers or compete for new business opportunities.
The Federal Reserve conducts an annual stress analysis of Regions to evaluate our ability to absorb losses in three economic and financial scenarios generated by the Federal Reserve, including base, adverse and severely adverse economic and financial scenarios (although, in light of EGRRCPA’s eliminating the statutory requirement for the adverse scenario, on January 8, 2019, the Federal Reserve proposed amendments to its stress testing rules that would, among other things, eliminate the adverse scenario). The rules also require us to conduct our own semi-annual stress analysis to assess the potential impact on Regions of the scenarios used as part of the Federal Reserve’s annual stress analysis. A summary of the results of certain aspects of the Federal Reserve’s annual stress analysis is released publicly and contains information and results specific to BHCs. The rules also currently require us to disclose publicly a summary of the results of our semi-annual stress analyses, and Regions Bank’s annual stress analyses, under the severely adverse scenario.
Although the stress tests are not meant to assess our current condition or outlook, our customers may misinterpret and adversely react to the results of these stress tests despite the strength of our financial condition. Any potential misinterpretations and adverse reactions could limit our ability to attract and retain customers or to effectively compete for new business opportunities.

30

Table of Contents




The inability to attract and retain customers or effectively compete for new business may have a material and adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Our regulators may also require us to raise additional capital or take other actions, or may impose restrictions on our business, based on the results of the stress tests, including rejecting, or requiring revisions to, our annual capital plan submitted in connection with the CCAR. The failure of our capital plan to pass the CCAR could adversely affect our ability to pay dividends and repurchase stock. In addition, we may not be able to raise additional capital if required to do so, or may not be able to do so on terms that we believe are advantageous to Regions or its current stockholders. Any such capital raises, if required, may also be dilutive to our existing stockholders.
Certain elements of these stress testing and capital planning requirements may be eased in the future consistent with recently issued and anticipated proposals by the Federal banking agencies following the enactment of EGRRCPA. However, the ultimate timing and implementation of such relief is unclear and therefore we expect to remain subject to these standards in the near term.
If an orderly liquidation of a systemically important BHC or non-bank financial company were triggered, we could face assessments for the Orderly Liquidation Fund.
The Dodd-Frank Act created a new mechanism, the OLA, for liquidation of systemically important BHCs and non-bank financial companies. The OLA is administered by the FDIC and is based on the FDIC’s bank resolution model. The Secretary of the U.S. Treasury may trigger a liquidation under this authority only after consultation with the President of the U.S. and after receiving a recommendation from the boards of the FDIC and the Federal Reserve upon a two-thirds vote. Liquidation proceedings will be funded by the Orderly Liquidation Fund, which will borrow from the U.S. Treasury and impose risk-based assessments on covered financial companies. Risk-based assessments would be made, first, on entities that received more in the resolution than they would have received in the liquidation to the extent of such excess, and second, if necessary, on, among others, BHCs with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, such as Regions. Any such assessments may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Risks Related to Our Capital Stock
The market price of shares of our capital stock will fluctuate.
The market price of our capital stock could be subject to significant fluctuations due to a change in sentiment in the market regarding our operations or business prospects. Such risks may be affected by:
Our operating performance, financial condition and prospects, or the operating performance, financial condition and prospects of our competitors;
Operating results that vary from the expectations of management, securities analysts and investors;
Our creditworthiness;
Developments in our business or in the financial sector generally;
Regulatory changes affecting our industry generally or our business and operations;
The operating and securities price performance of companies that investors consider to be comparable to us;
Announcements of strategic developments, divestitures and other material events by us or our competitors;
Expectations of or actual equity dilution;
Whether we declare or fail to declare dividends on our capital stock from time to time;
The ratings assigned to our securities by credit-rating agencies;
Changes in the credit, mortgage and real estate markets, including the markets for mortgage-related securities; and
Changes in global financial markets, global economies and general market conditions, such as interest or foreign exchange rates, stock, commodity, credit or asset valuations or volatility; and
Executive management changes.
The market price of our capital stock, including our common stock and depositary shares representing fractional interests in our preferred stock, may be subject to fluctuations unrelated to our operating performance or prospects. Increased volatility could result in a decline in the market price of our capital stock.
Our capital stock is subordinate to our existing and future indebtedness.
Our capital stock, including our common stock and depositary shares representing fractional interests in our preferred stock, ranks junior to all of Regions’ existing and future indebtedness and Regions’ other non-equity claims with respect to assets available to satisfy claims against us, including claims in the event of our liquidation. As of December 31, 2018 , Regions’ total liabilities were approximately $110.6 billion , and we may incur additional indebtedness in the future to increase our capital resources. Additionally, if our total capital ratio or the total capital ratio of Regions Bank falls below the required minimums, we or Regions

31

Table of Contents




Bank could be forced to raise additional capital by making additional offerings of debt securities, including medium-term notes, senior or subordinated notes or other applicable securities.
We are a holding company and depend on our subsidiaries for dividends, distributions and other payments.
We are a legal entity separate and distinct from our banking and other subsidiaries. Our principal source of cash flow, including cash flow to pay dividends to our stockholders and principal and interest on our outstanding debt, is dividends from Regions Bank. There are statutory and regulatory limitations on the payment of dividends by Regions Bank to us, as well as by us to our stockholders. Regulations of both the Federal Reserve and the State of Alabama affect the ability of Regions Bank to pay dividends and other distributions to us and to make loans to us. If Regions Bank is unable to make dividend payments to us and sufficient cash or liquidity is not otherwise available, we may not be able to make dividend payments to our common and preferred stockholders or principal and interest payments on our outstanding debt. See the “Stockholders’ Equity” section of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. In addition, our right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of creditors of that subsidiary, except to the extent that any of our claims as a creditor of such subsidiary may be recognized. As a result, shares of our capital stock are effectively subordinated to all existing and future liabilities and obligations of our subsidiaries. At December 31, 2018 , our subsidiaries’ total deposits and borrowings were approximately $107.3 billion.
We may not pay dividends on shares of our capital stock.
Holders of shares of our capital stock are only entitled to receive such dividends as our Board may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Although we have historically declared cash dividends on our common stock, we are not required to do so and may reduce or eliminate our common stock dividend in the future. This could adversely affect the market price of our common stock. Furthermore, the terms of our outstanding preferred stock prohibit us from declaring or paying any dividends on any junior series of our capital stock, including our common stock, or from repurchasing, redeeming or acquiring such junior stock, unless we have declared and paid full dividends on our outstanding preferred stock for the most recently completed dividend period.
We are also subject to statutory and regulatory limitations on our ability to pay dividends on our capital stock. For example, it is the policy of the Federal Reserve that BHCs should generally pay dividends on common stock only out of earnings, and only if prospective earnings retention is consistent with the organization’s expected future needs, asset quality and financial condition. Moreover, the Federal Reserve may closely scrutinize any dividend payout ratios exceeding 30% of after-tax net income. Additionally, we are currently required to submit annual capital plans to the Federal Reserve for review before we can take certain capital actions, including declaring and paying dividends and repurchasing or redeeming capital securities. If our capital plan or any amendment to our capital plan is objected to for any reason, our ability to declare and pay dividends on our capital stock may be limited. Further, if we are unable to satisfy the capital requirements applicable to us for any reason, we may be limited in our ability to declare and pay dividends on our capital stock. Certain elements of these capital planning requirements may be eased in the future consistent with recently issued and anticipated proposals by the Federal banking agencies following the enactment of EGRRCPA and the proposed Stress Capital Buffer framework. However, the ultimate timing and implementation of such relief is unclear and therefore we expect to remain subject to these standards in the near term.
Anti-takeover and banking laws and certain agreements and charter provisions may adversely affect share value.
Certain provisions of state and federal law and our certificate of incorporation may make it more difficult for someone to acquire control of us without our Board's approval. Under federal law, subject to certain exemptions, a person, entity or group must notify the federal banking agencies before acquiring control of a BHC. Acquisition of 10% or more of any class of voting stock of a BHC or state member bank, including shares of our common stock, creates a rebuttable presumption that the acquirer “controls” the BHC or state member bank. Also, as noted under the “Supervision and Regulation” section of Item 1. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, a BHC must obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before, among other things, acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any bank, including Regions Bank. One factor the federal banking agencies must consider in certain acquisitions is the systemic impact of the transaction. This may make it more difficult for large institutions to acquire other large institutions and may otherwise delay the regulatory approval process, possibly by requiring public hearings. There also are provisions in our certificate of incorporation that may be used to delay or block a takeover attempt. For example, holders of our preferred stock have certain voting rights that could adversely affect share value. If and when dividends on the preferred stock have not been declared and paid for at least six quarterly dividend periods or their equivalent (whether or not consecutive), the authorized number of directors then constituting our Board will automatically be increased by two, and the preferred stockholders will be entitled to elect the two additional directors. Also, the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of at least two-thirds of all of the then-outstanding shares of the preferred stock is required to consummate a binding share-exchange or reclassification involving the preferred stock, or a merger or consolidation of Regions with or into another entity, unless certain requirements are met. These statutory provisions and provisions in our certificate of incorporation, including the rights of the holders of our preferred stock, could result in Regions being less attractive to a potential acquirer.

32

Table of Contents




We may need to raise additional debt or equity capital in the future, but may be unable to do so.
We may need to raise additional capital in the future to provide us with sufficient capital resources and liquidity to meet our commitments and other business purposes. Our ability to raise additional capital, if needed, will depend on, among other things, prevailing conditions in the capital markets, which are outside of our control, and our financial performance. An economic slowdown or loss of confidence in financial institutions could increase our cost of funding and limit our access to some of our customary sources of capital, including inter-bank borrowings, repurchase agreements and borrowings from the discount window of the Federal Reserve. We cannot be assured that capital will be available to us on acceptable terms or at all. Any occurrence that may limit our access to the capital markets, such as a decline in the confidence of debt purchasers, depositors of Regions Bank or counterparties participating in the capital markets, or a downgrade of our debt ratings, may adversely affect our capital costs and our ability to raise capital and, in turn, our liquidity. An inability to raise additional capital on acceptable terms when needed could have a materially adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Future issuances of additional equity securities could result in dilution of existing stockholders’ equity ownership.
We may determine from time to time to issue additional equity securities to raise additional capital, support growth, or to make acquisitions. Further, we may issue stock options or other stock grants to retain and motivate our employees. These issuances of our securities could dilute the voting and economic interests of our existing stockholders.


33

Table of Contents




Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
None.
Item 2. Properties
Regions’ corporate headquarters occupy the main banking facility of Regions Bank, located at 1900 Fifth Avenue North, Birmingham, Alabama 35203.
At December 31, 2018 , Regions Bank, Regions’ banking subsidiary, operated 1,454 banking offices. At December 31, 2018 , there were no significant encumbrances on the offices, equipment and other operational facilities owned by Regions and its subsidiaries.
See Item 1. “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for a list of the states in which Regions Bank’s branches are located.
Item 3. Legal Proceedings
Information required by this item is set forth in Note 24 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, which are included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures.
Not applicable.
Executive Officers of the Registrant
Information concerning the Executive Officers of Regions is set forth under Item 10. “Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.


34

Table of Contents




PART II
Item 5. Market For Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Regions common stock, par value $.01 per share, is listed for trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol RF. Information relating to compensation plans under which Regions' equity securities are authorized for issuance is presented in Part III, Item 12. As of February 20, 2019 , there were 41,998 holders of record of Regions common stock (including participants in the Computershare Investment Plan for Regions Financial Corporation).
Restrictions on the ability of Regions Bank to transfer funds to Regions at December 31, 2018 , are set forth in Note 14 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” to the consolidated financial statements, which are included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. A discussion of certain limitations on the ability of Regions Bank to pay dividends to Regions and the ability of Regions to pay dividends on its common stock is set forth in Item 1. “Business” under the heading “Supervision and Regulation—Payment of Dividends” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
In connection with Regions' acquisition of BlackArch Partners LLC ("BlackArch") on October 20, 2015, Regions issued 831,766 shares of Regions common stock to the former owners of BlackArch as partial consideration for the acquisition. The shares issued in the transaction are exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, pursuant to Section 4(a)(2). Pursuant to contingent payment provisions in the purchase agreement, if certain conditions are met, Regions will issue up to 1,528,234 additional shares of Regions common stock to the former owners of BlackArch over the four-year period following the acquisition. During 2018 and 2017, an additional 98,951 shares and 134,837 shares were issued, respectively, leaving 1,097,455 additional shares to be potentially issued. Each of the former owners of BlackArch are accredited investors and no underwriters or placement agents were involved in connection with issuance of Regions common stock.
The following table presents information regarding issuer purchases of equity securities during the fourth quarter of 2018 .
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Period
Total Number of  Shares Purchased
 
Average Price Paid
 per Share
 
Total Number of Shares
Purchased as Part of
Publicly Announced
Plans or Programs
 
Maximum Approximate Dollar Value of
Shares that May
Yet Be Purchased Under Publicly Announced Plans or Programs
October 1—31, 2018
11,599,010

 
$
16.32

 
11,599,010

 
$
560,149,190

November 1—30, 2018
10,400,170

 
$
17.33

 
10,400,170

 
$
379,800,363

December 1—31, 2018

 
$

 

 
$

Total 4th Quarter
21,999,180

 
$
16.80

 
21,999,180

 
$
379,800,363

Regions' Board authorized, effective June 28, 2018, a new $2.031 billion common stock repurchase plan, permitting repurchases from the beginning of the third quarter of 2018 through the end of the second quarter of 2019. As of December 31, 2018, Regions has repurchased approximately 90.4 million shares of common stock at a total cost of $1.7 billion under this plan. The Company also continued to repurchase shares on the open market under its capital plan in the first quarter of 2019. As of February 21, 2019, Regions had repurchased approximately 7.4 million additional shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $114.0 million. All of these shares were immediately retired upon repurchase and, therefore, will not be included in treasury stock.

35

Table of Contents




PERFORMANCE GRAPH
Set forth below is a graph comparing the yearly percentage change in the cumulative total return of Regions common stock against the cumulative total return of the S&P 500 Index and the S&P 500 Banks Index for the past five years. This presentation assumes that the value of the investment in Regions’ common stock and in each index was $100 and that all dividends were reinvested.

CHART-F0E0B02F50535B7CA89.JPG  
 
Cumulative Total Return
 
12/31/2013
 
12/31/2014
 
12/31/2015
 
12/31/2016
 
12/31/2017
 
12/31/2018
Regions
$
100.00

 
$
108.63

 
$
101.11

 
$
155.10

 
$
190.70

 
$
151.47

S&P 500 Index
100.00

 
113.68

 
115.24

 
129.02

 
157.17

 
150.27

S&P 500 Banks Index
100.00

 
115.51

 
116.49

 
144.81

 
177.47

 
148.30


Item 6. Selected Financial Data
The information required by Item 6. is set forth in Table 1 “Financial Highlights” of “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”, which is included in Item 7. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

36

Table of Contents




Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
EXECUTIVE OVERVIEW
Management believes the following sections provide an overview of several of the most relevant matters necessary for an understanding of the financial aspects of Regions Financial Corporation’s (“Regions” or “the Company”) business, particularly regarding its 2018 results. Cross references to more detailed information regarding each topic within MD&A and the consolidated financial statements are included. This summary is intended to assist in understanding the information provided, but should be read in conjunction with the entire MD&A and consolidated financial statements, as well as the other sections of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
2018 Results
Regions reported net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders of $1.5 billion , or $1.36 per diluted share, in 2018 compared to net income available to common shareholders from continuing operations of $1.2 billion , or $0.98 per diluted share, in 2017 .
Net interest income and other financing income (taxable-equivalent basis) totaled $3.8 billion in 2018 compared to $3.6 billion in 2017 . The net interest margin (taxable-equivalent basis) was 3.50 percent in 2018 , reflecting an 18 basis point increase from 2017 primarily due to increases in yields on earning assets, particularly loans, exceeding the increase in total funding costs.
The provision for loan losses totaled $229 million in 2018 compared to $150 million in 2017 . This increase was primarily a result of increased loan balances and slowing credit improvement as compared to 2017. The increase was partially offset by the release of the Company's $40 million hurricane-specific loan loss allowance associated with certain 2017 hurricanes, as well as a $16 million net reduction to the provision for loan losses in the first quarter of 2018 associated with the sale of $254 million in residential first mortgage loans consisting primarily of performing troubled debt restructured loans. The provision for loan losses was less than net charge-offs by $94 million in 2018, which also included the impact of broad-based improvements in non-performing and criticized loans. Net charge-offs were 0.40 percent of average loans in 2018 , compared to 0.38 percent in 2017 .
Non-interest income from continuing operations was $2.0 billion in both 2018 and 2017 . While total non-interest income from continuing operations was consistent between years, there were increases in service charges on deposit accounts, card and ATM fees, capital markets income, investment services fee income, and other miscellaneous income. These increases were partially offset by decreases in mortgage income and income from bank-owned life insurance, lower net securities gains, and losses from market value adjustments on employee benefit assets. See Table 5 "Non-Interest Income from Continuing Operations" for further details.
Non-interest expense from continuing operations was $3.6 billion in 2018 and $3.5 billion in 2017 . The increase was driven primarily by increases in salaries and employee benefits, outside services, professional, legal and regulatory expenses, as well as a reduction in the credit for unfunded credit losses. These increases were partially offset by decreases in FDIC insurance assessments, branch consolidation, property and equipment charges, and Visa class B shares expense. See Table 6 "Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations" for further details.
On December 22, 2017, Tax Reform was enacted. Effective January 1, 2018, Tax Reform reduced the maximum corporate statutory federal income tax rate from 35 percent to 21 percent. This was the primary contributor to reducing Regions' effective tax rate from 33.3 percent in 2017 to 19.8 percent in 2018.
On April 4, 2018, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates to BB&T Insurance Holdings, Inc. The transaction closed on July 2, 2018, and generated an after-tax gain of $196 million. A discussion of activity within discontinued operations is included at the end of "Operating Results" in the MD&A section of this report.
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:
"Operating Results" section of MD&A
“Net Interest Income and Other Financing Income and Net Interest Margin” discussion within the “Operating Results” section of MD&A
“Interest Rate Risk” discussion within “Risk Management” section of MD&A
Capital
Capital Actions
As part of its 2018 CCAR submission, Regions' proposed capital plan included increasing its quarterly common stock dividend from $0.09 per share to $0.14 per share beginning in the third quarter of 2018 and the execution of up to $2.031 billion in common share repurchases. The 2018 capital plan covers the period from the third quarter of 2018 through the second quarter of 2019. As of December 31, 2018 , Regions had repurchased approximately 90.4 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately

37

Table of Contents




$1.7 billion under this plan. The Federal Reserve did not object to the capital plan. The Company continued to repurchase shares under this plan into the first quarter of 2019.
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:
“Stockholders’ Equity” discussion in MD&A
Note 15 “Stockholders’ Equity and Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)” to the consolidated financial statements
Regulatory Capital
Regions and Regions Bank are required to comply with regulatory capital requirements established by Federal and State banking agencies. Under the Basel III Rules, Regions is designated as a standardized approach bank and, as such, began transitioning to the Basel III Rules in January 2015 subject to a phase-in period through January 2019, which has been extended. When fully phased in, the Basel III Rules will increase capital requirements through higher minimum capital levels as well as through increases in risk-weights for certain exposures. Proposals from the federal banking agencies may revise the capital treatment of certain assets and may extend the current transitional treatment. The Basel III Rules maintained the minimum guidelines for Regions to be considered well-capitalized for Tier 1 capital and Total capital at 6.0% and 10.0%, respectively. At December 31, 2018 , Regions’ Basel III Tier 1 capital and Total capital ratios were estimated to be 10.68% and 12.46% , respectively.
The Basel III Rules also officially defined CET1. Regions' Basel III CET1 ratio at December 31, 2018 was estimated to be 9.90 %. Regions estimates its fully phased-in CET1 ratio (non-GAAP) at December 31, 2018 to be 9.83% .
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:
“Supervision and Regulation” discussion within Item 1. Business
Table 2 - “GAAP to Non-GAAP reconciliation” in MD&A
"Regulatory Requirements" section of MD&A
Note 14 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” to the consolidated financial statements
Loan Portfolio and Credit
During 2018, total loans increased by $3.2 billion or 4.0 percent compared to 2017 . Loan balances increased year-over-year in all three portfolio segments. The commercial portfolio segment increase was driven primarily by a $3.2 billion increase in the commercial and industrial loan portfolio class. The growth in the commercial portfolio was broad-based, with the energy and financial services portfolio classes experiencing the largest increases compared to 2017. The investor real estate portfolio segment increase was driven by a $588 million increase in commercial investor real estate mortgage loans. This increase was the result of growth in term real estate lending, as well as a reclassification in December 2018 of approximately $345 million of senior housing loans into the investor real estate portfolio from the owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage portfolio. The $28 million increase in the consumer portfolio segment was due primarily to increases in indirect-other consumer loans due to continued growth in point-of-sale initiatives, as well as growth in residential first mortgage loans. These increases were partially offset by decreases in home equity loans as a result of continued payoffs and paydowns and indirect-vehicle loans reflecting the termination of a third-party arrangement in 2016.
The economy has been and will continue to be the primary factor which influences Regions’ loan portfolio. Improvement in overall economic conditions continued in 2018, with demand for bank lending increasing during the second half of the year. The economic growth trends resulted in higher market interest rates during the year. These factors contributed to balance sheet growth for Regions, and provided Regions’ customers with the ability to optimize liquidity through the use of cash for higher earning investment opportunities. Labor market and housing market conditions continued to progress at a steady pace over the course of 2018. Overall, current economic momentum is expected to slow modestly in 2019. Management’s expectation for 2019 adjusted average loan growth is in the low single digits consistent with the GDP forecast.
Net charge-offs totaled $323 million, or 0.40 percent of average loans, in 2018 , compared to $307 million, or 0.38 percent in 2017 , reflecting some large-dollar commercial loan charge-offs within the energy, healthcare and restaurant, accommodation and lodging sectors, as well as an increase associated with growth in indirect-other consumer loans. Total non-accrual loans, past due loans, troubled debt restructurings, and criticized commercial and investor real estate loans decreased year-over-year. The decrease was driven primarily by payoffs and paydowns of criticized commercial loans, as well as improved risk ratings in the commercial loan portfolio. The allowance for loan losses was 1.01 percent of total loans, net of unearned income at December 31, 2018 , a decrease from 1.17 percent at December 31, 2017 . The coverage ratio of allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans was 169% at December 31, 2018 , compared to 144% at December 31, 2017 .
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:
Adjusted Average Balances of Loans within the "Table 2 - GAAP-to-Non-GAAP Reconciliation"
"Portfolio Characteristics" section of MD&A

38

Table of Contents




“Allowance for Credit Losses” discussion within the “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” section of MD&A
“Provision for Loan Losses” discussion within the “Operating Results” section of MD&A
“Loans,” “Allowance for Credit Losses,” “Troubled Debt Restructurings” and “Non-performing Assets” discussions within the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section of MD&A
Note 1 "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies" to the consolidated financial statements
Note 5 "Loans" to the consolidated financial statements
Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements
Liquidity
At the end of 2018 , Regions Bank had $1.5 billion in cash on deposit with the Federal Reserve and the loan-to-deposit ratio was 88 percent. Cash and cash equivalents at the parent company totaled $1.9 billion . Regions' liquidity policy related to minimum holding company cash requires the holding company to maintain cash sufficient to cover the greater of (1) 18 months of debt service and other cash needs or (2) a minimum cash balance of $500 million.
At December 31, 2018 , the Company’s borrowing capacity with the Federal Reserve was $19.0 billion based on available collateral. Borrowing availability with the FHLB was $8.7 billion based on available collateral at the same date. The Company has approximately $16.6 billion of unencumbered liquid securities available for pledging. Regions also maintains a shelf registration statement with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission that can be utilized by the Company to issue various debt and/or equity securities. Additionally, Regions' Board has authorized Regions Bank to issue up to $5 billion in aggregate principal amount of bank notes outstanding at any one time.
A minimum LCR requirement exists for certain large BHCs, savings and loan holding companies and depository institutions, and a less stringent LCR requirement (the "modified LCR") exists for other banking organizations, such as Regions, with $50 billion or more in total consolidated assets. The regulatory agencies finalized a rule that requires quarterly public disclosures of certain LCR measures beginning with results from the fourth quarter of 2018. At December 31, 2018, the Company was fully compliant with the LCR requirements.
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:
“Supervision and Regulation” discussion within Item 1. Business
“Short-Term Borrowings” discussion within the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section of MD&A
“Long-Term Borrowings” discussion within the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section of MD&A
“Regulatory Requirements” section of MD&A
“Liquidity Risk” discussion within the “Risk Management” section of MD&A
Note 12 “Short-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements
Note 13 “Long-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements
2019 Expectations
Selected management expectations for 2019 are noted below:
Full year adjusted average loan growth in the low single digits, compared to 2018 adjusted average balances, consistent with GDP forecast (non-GAAP)
Adjusted non-interest expenses relatively stable (non-GAAP)
Effective income tax rate of 20 to 22 percent
Full year net charge-offs of 40 to 50 basis points of average loans
The reconciliation with respect to these forward-looking non-GAAP measures is expected to be consistent with the actual non-GAAP reconciliations within Management's Discussion and Analysis of this Form 10-K. For more information related to the Company's 2019 expectations, refer to the related sub-sections discussed in more detail within Management's Discussion and Analysis of this Form 10-K.
GENERAL
The following discussion and financial information is presented to aid in understanding Regions’ financial position and results of operations. The emphasis of this discussion will be on continuing operations for the years 2018 , 2017 and 2016 ; in addition, financial information for prior years will also be presented when appropriate.
Regions’ profitability, like that of many other financial institutions, is dependent on its ability to generate revenue from net interest income and other financing income as well as non-interest income sources. Net interest income and other financing income

39

Table of Contents




is primarily the difference between the interest income Regions receives on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and the interest expense Regions pays on interest-bearing liabilities, principally deposits and borrowings. Regions’ net interest income and other financing income is impacted by the size and mix of its balance sheet components and the interest rate spread between interest earned on its assets and interest paid on its liabilities. Net interest income and other financing income also includes rental income and depreciation expense associated with operating leases for which Regions is the lessor. Non-interest income includes fees from service charges on deposit accounts, card and ATM fees, mortgage servicing and secondary marketing, investment management and trust activities, capital markets and other customer services which Regions provides. Results of operations are also affected by the provision for loan losses and non-interest expenses such as salaries and employee benefits, occupancy, professional, legal and regulatory expenses, FDIC insurance assessments and other operating expenses, as well as income taxes.
Economic conditions, competition, new legislation and related rules impacting regulation of the financial services industry and the monetary and fiscal policies of the Federal government significantly affect most, if not all, financial institutions, including Regions. Lending and deposit activities and fee income generation are influenced by levels of business spending and investment, consumer income, consumer spending and savings, capital market activities, and competition among financial institutions, as well as customer preferences, interest rate conditions and prevailing market rates on competing products in Regions’ market areas.
Regions’ business strategy has been and continues to be focused on providing a competitive mix of products and services, delivering quality customer service and maintaining a branch distribution network with offices in convenient locations.
Recent Acquisitions
On October 17, 2016, Regions announced the acquisition of the low income housing tax credit corporate fund syndication and asset management businesses of First Sterling Financial, Inc., which is one of the leading national syndicators of investment funds benefiting from low income housing tax credits. The acquisition complements Regions' existing low income housing tax credit origination business and further expands the Company's capabilities to serve more clients and communities.
Dispositions
On April 4, 2018, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates to BB&T Insurance Holdings, Inc. The transaction closed on July 2, 2018. The gain associated with the transaction amounted to $281 million ($196 million after-tax).
On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James. The sale closed on April 2, 2012. Regions Investment Management, Inc. and Regions Trust were not included in the sale; they are included in the Wealth Management segment.
Results of operations for the entities sold are presented separately as discontinued operations for all periods presented on the consolidated statements of income. Other expenses related to the transaction are also included in discontinued operations. Refer to Note 3 “Discontinued Operations” and Note 24 “Commitments, Contingencies, and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements for further details.
Business Segments
Regions provides traditional commercial, retail and mortgage banking services, as well as other financial services in the fields of asset management, wealth management, securities brokerage, and other specialty financing. Regions carries out its strategies and derives its profitability from three reportable segments: Corporate Bank, Consumer Bank, and Wealth Management, with the remainder split between Discontinued Operations and Other.
See Note 23 “Business Segment Information” to the consolidated financial statements for further information on Regions’ business segments.

40

Table of Contents




Table 1—Financial Highlights
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(In millions, except per share data)
EARNINGS SUMMARY
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income, including other financing income
$
4,393

 
$
3,987

 
$
3,814

 
$
3,601

 
$
3,588

Interest expense and depreciation expense on operating lease assets
658

 
448

 
416

 
296

 
309

Net interest income and other financing income
3,735

 
3,539

 
3,398

 
3,305

 
3,279

Provision for loan losses
229

 
150

 
262

 
241

 
69

Net interest income and other financing income after provision for loan losses
3,506

 
3,389

 
3,136

 
3,064

 
3,210

Non-interest income
2,019

 
1,962

 
2,011

 
1,937

 
1,785

Non-interest expense
3,570

 
3,491

 
3,483

 
3,478

 
3,318

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
1,955

 
1,860

 
1,664

 
1,523

 
1,677

Income tax expense
387

 
619

 
510

 
452

 
546

Income from continuing operations
1,568

 
1,241

 
1,154

 
1,071

 
1,131

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes
271

 
19

 
16

 
(15
)
 
26

Income tax expense (benefit)
80

 
(3
)
 
7

 
(6
)
 
10

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
191

 
22

 
9

 
(9
)
 
16

Net income
$
1,759

 
$
1,263

 
$
1,163

 
$
1,062

 
$
1,147

Net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders
$
1,504

 
$
1,177

 
$
1,090

 
$
1,007

 
$
1,079

Net income available to common shareholders
$
1,695

 
$
1,199

 
$
1,099

 
$
998

 
$
1,095

Earnings per common share from continuing operations – basic
$
1.38

 
$
0.99

 
$
0.87

 
$
0.76

 
$
0.79

Earnings per common share from continuing operations – diluted
1.36

 
0.98

 
0.86

 
0.75

 
0.78

Earnings per common share – basic
1.55

 
1.01

 
0.87

 
0.75

 
0.80

Earnings per common share – diluted
1.54

 
1.00

 
0.87

 
0.75

 
0.79

Return on average common stockholders' equity - continuing operations (1)(3)
10.33
%
 
7.42
%
 
6.69
%
 
6.27
%
 
6.80
%
Return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP) - continuing operations (1)(2)(3)
15.59

 
10.80

 
9.61

 
9.04

 
9.86

Return on average assets - continuing operations (1)(3)
1.27

 
1.00

 
0.92

 
0.88

 
0.96

BALANCE SHEET SUMMARY
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As of December 31
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, net of unearned income
$
83,152

 
$
79,947

 
$
80,095

 
$
81,162

 
$
77,307

Allowance for loan losses
(840
)
 
(934
)
 
(1,091
)
 
(1,106
)
 
(1,103
)
Assets
125,688

 
124,294

 
125,968

 
125,050

 
119,563

Deposits
94,491

 
96,889

 
99,035

 
98,430

 
94,200

Long-term debt
12,424

 
8,132

 
7,763

 
8,349

 
3,462

Stockholders’ equity
15,090

 
16,192

 
16,664

 
16,844

 
16,873

Average balances
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, net of unearned income
$
80,692

 
$
79,846

 
$
81,333

 
$
79,634

 
$
76,253

Assets
123,380

 
123,976

 
125,506

 
122,265

 
118,352

Deposits
94,438

 
97,341

 
97,921

 
96,890

 
93,481

Long-term debt
9,977

 
7,076

 
8,159

 
5,046

 
4,057

Stockholders’ equity
15,381

 
16,665

 
17,126

 
16,916

 
16,620

SELECTED RATIOS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basel I Tier 1 common regulatory capital (non-GAAP) (4)
N/A%

 
N/A%

 
N/A%

 
N/A%

 
11.65
%
Basel III common equity Tier 1 ratio (5)
9.90

 
11.05

 
11.21

 
10.93

 
N/A

Basel III common equity Tier 1 ratio—Fully Phased-In Pro-Forma (non-GAAP) (2)(4)(5)
9.83

 
10.95

 
11.05

 
10.69

 
11.00

Tier 1 capital (4)(5)(6)
10.68

 
11.86

 
11.98

 
11.65

 
12.54

Total capital (4)(5)(6)
12.46

 
13.78

 
14.15

 
13.88

 
15.26

Leverage capital (4)(5)(6)
9.32

 
10.01

 
10.20

 
10.25

 
10.86

Tangible common stockholders’ equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP) (2)
7.80

 
8.71

 
8.99

 
9.13

 
9.66

Efficiency ratio
61.50

 
62.44

 
63.42

 
65.42

 
64.72

Adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP) (2)
59.26

 
61.35

 
62.46

 
64.08

 
63.72


41

Table of Contents




 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(In millions, except per share data)
COMMON STOCK DATA
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common equity book value per share
$
13.92

 
$
13.55

 
$
13.04

 
$
12.35

 
$
11.81

Tangible common book value per share (non-GAAP) (2)
9.19

 
9.16

 
8.95

 
8.52

 
8.18

Market value at year-end
13.38

 
17.28

 
14.36

 
9.60

 
10.56

Total trading volume (shares)
3,044

 
3,704

 
5,241

 
4,243

 
3,689

Dividend payout ratio
29.90
%
 
31.48
%
 
29.25
%
 
30.76
%
 
22.8
%
Stockholders of record at year-end (actual)
42,087

 
46,143

 
48,958

 
51,270

 
57,529

Weighted-average number of common shares outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
1,092

 
1,186

 
1,255

 
1,325

 
1,375

Diluted
1,102

 
1,198

 
1,261

 
1,334

 
1,387

________
N/A - not applicable.
(1) Due to the immaterial impact of the discontinued operations, the balance sheet has not been presented on a continuing operations basis.
(2) See Table 2 for GAAP to non-GAAP reconciliations.
(3) The 2018 return on average common stockholders' equity, return on average tangible stockholders' equity and return on average assets were 11.64%, 17.57%, and 1.43%, respectively, including discontinued operations.
(4) Regions' regulatory capital ratios for years prior to 2015 have not been revised to reflect the retrospective application of new accounting guidance related to investments in qualified affordable housing projects.
(5) Current year Basel III common equity Tier 1, Tier 1 capital, Total capital, and Leverage capital ratios are estimated.
(6) Beginning in 2015, Regions' regulatory capital ratios are calculated pursuant to the phase-in provisions of the Basel III Rules. All prior period ratios were calculated pursuant to the Basel I capital rules.
NON-GAAP MEASURES
The table below presents computations of earnings and certain other financial measures, which exclude certain significant items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP. These non-GAAP financial measures include “adjusted average total loans”, “adjusted net interest margin”, “adjusted efficiency ratio”, “adjusted fee income ratio”, “return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity”, on a consolidated and continuing operations basis, and end of period “tangible common stockholders’ equity”, and “Basel III CET1, on a fully phased-in basis” and related ratios. Regions believes that expressing earnings and certain other financial measures excluding these significant items provides a meaningful base for period-to-period comparisons, which management believes will assist investors in analyzing the operating results of the Company and predicting future performance. These non-GAAP financial measures are also used by management to assess the performance of Regions’ business because management does not consider the activities related to the adjustments to be indications of ongoing operations. Regions believes that presentation of these non-GAAP financial measures will permit investors to assess the performance of the Company on the same basis as that applied by management. Management and the Board utilize these non-GAAP financial measures as follows:
Preparation of Regions’ operating budgets
Monthly financial performance reporting
Monthly close-out reporting of consolidated results (management only)
Presentations to investors of Company performance
Total average loans is presented excluding the impact of the first quarter 2018 residential first mortgage loan sale and the indirect vehicles third-party exit portfolio to arrive at adjusted average total loans (non-GAAP). Regions believes adjusting average total loans provides a meaningful calculation of loan growth rates and presents them on the same basis as that applied by management.
The adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP), which is a measure of productivity, is generally calculated as adjusted non-interest expense divided by adjusted total revenue on a taxable-equivalent basis. The adjusted fee income ratio (non-GAAP) is generally calculated as adjusted non-interest income divided by adjusted total revenue on a taxable-equivalent basis. Management uses these ratios to monitor performance and believes these measures provide meaningful information to investors. Non-interest expense (GAAP) is presented excluding adjustments to arrive at adjusted non-interest expense (non-GAAP), which is the numerator for the adjusted efficiency ratio. Non-interest income (GAAP) is presented excluding adjustments to arrive at adjusted non-interest income (non-GAAP), which is the numerator for the adjusted fee income ratio. Net interest income and other financing income on a taxable-equivalent basis (GAAP) is presented excluding certain adjustments related to Tax Reform to arrive at adjusted net interest income and other financing income on a taxable-equivalent basis (non-GAAP). Net interest income and other financing income on a taxable-equivalent basis and non-interest income are added together to arrive at total revenue on a taxable-equivalent basis. Adjustments are made to arrive at adjusted total revenue on a taxable-equivalent basis (non-GAAP), which is the denominator for the adjusted efficiency and adjusted fee income ratios.

42

Table of Contents




Tangible common stockholders’ equity ratios have become a focus of some investors in analyzing the capital position of the Company absent the effects of intangible assets and preferred stock. Traditionally, the Federal Reserve and other banking regulatory bodies have assessed a bank’s capital adequacy based on Tier 1 capital, the calculation of which is codified in federal banking regulations. Analysts and banking regulators have assessed Regions’ capital adequacy using the tangible common stockholders’ equity measure. Because tangible common stockholders’ equity is not formally defined by GAAP, this measure is considered to be a non-GAAP financial measure and other entities may calculate it differently than Regions’ disclosed calculations. Since analysts and banking regulators may assess Regions’ capital adequacy using tangible common stockholders’ equity, Regions believes that it is useful to provide investors the ability to assess Regions’ capital adequacy on this same basis.
The Basel Committee's Basel III framework will strengthen international capital and liquidity regulations. When fully phased in, Basel III will increase capital requirements through higher minimum capital levels as well as through increases in risk-weights for certain exposures. Additionally, the Basel III Rules place greater emphasis on common equity. The Federal Reserve released its final Basel III Rules detailing the U.S. implementation of Basel III in 2013. Regions, as a standardized approach bank, began transitioning to the Basel III framework in January 2015 subject to a phase-in period extending through January 2019. Because the Basel III implementation regulations will not be fully phased in until 2019 and, are not formally defined by GAAP, these measures are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures. Since analysts and banking regulators may assess Regions’ capital adequacy using the fully phased-in Basel III framework, Regions believes that it is useful to provide investors information enabling them to assess Regions’ capital adequacy on the same basis.
Non-GAAP financial measures have inherent limitations, are not required to be uniformly applied and are not audited. Although these non-GAAP financial measures are frequently used by stakeholders in the evaluation of a company, they have limitations as analytical tools, and should not be considered in isolation, or as a substitute for analyses of results as reported under GAAP. In particular, a measure of earnings that excludes selected items does not represent the amount that effectively accrues directly to stockholders.
The following tables provide: 1) a reconciliation of average total loans to adjusted average total loans (non-GAAP), 2) a reconciliation of net income (GAAP) to net income available to common shareholders (GAAP), 3) a reconciliation of net income available to common shareholders (GAAP) to net income available to common shareholders from continuing operations (GAAP) 4) a reconciliation of non-interest expense from continuing operations (GAAP) to adjusted non-interest expense from continuing operations (non-GAAP), 5) a reconciliation of net interest income and other financing income/margin, taxable equivalent basis (GAAP) to adjusted net interest income and other financing income/margin, taxable equivalent basis (non-GAAP), 6) a reconciliation of non-interest income from continuing operations (GAAP) to adjusted non-interest income from continuing operations (non-GAAP), 7) a computation of adjusted total revenue (non-GAAP), 8) a computation of the adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP), 9) a computation of the adjusted fee income ratio (non-GAAP), 10) a reconciliation of average and ending stockholders’ equity (GAAP) to average and ending tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP) and calculations of related ratios (non-GAAP), 11) a reconciliation of stockholders’ equity (GAAP) to Basel III CET1, on a fully phased-in basis (non-GAAP), and 12) calculation of the related ratio based on Regions’ current understanding of the Basel III requirements (non-GAAP).
Table 2—GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliation
 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
ADJUSTED AVERAGE BALANCES OF LOANS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average total loans
 
$
80,692

 
$
79,846

 
$
81,333

 
$
79,634

 
$
76,253

Less: Balances of residential first mortgage loans sold  (1)
 
40

 
254

 
254

 
254

 
254

Less: Indirect—vehicles third-party
 
850

 
1,517

 
2,025

 
1,930

 
1,706

Adjusted average total loans (non-GAAP)
 
$
79,802

 
$
78,075

 
$
79,054

 
$
77,450

 
$
74,293










43

Table of Contents




 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
 
(Dollars in millions, except per share data)
INCOME CONSOLIDATED
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income (GAAP)
 
$
1,759

 
$
1,263

 
$
1,163

 
$
1,062

 
$
1,147

Preferred dividends (GAAP)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(52
)
Net income available to common shareholders (GAAP)
A
$
1,695

 
$
1,199

 
$
1,099

 
$
998

 
$
1,095

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
 
191

 
22

 
9

 
(9
)
 
16

Net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders (GAAP)
B
$
1,504

 
$
1,177

 
$
1,090

 
$
1,007

 
$
1,079

ADJUSTED EFFICIENCY AND FEE INCOME RATIOS CONTINUING OPERATIONS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest expense (GAAP)
C
$
3,570

 
$
3,491

 
$
3,483

 
$
3,478

 
$
3,318

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contribution to Regions Financial Corporation foundation
 
(60
)
 
(40
)
 

 

 

Professional, legal and regulatory expenses (2)(3)
 

 

 
(3
)
 
(48
)
 
(93
)
Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges
 
(11
)
 
(22
)
 
(58
)
 
(56
)
 
(16
)
Expenses associated with residential mortgage loan sale
 
(4
)
 

 

 

 

Gain on sale of TDRs held for sale, net
 

 

 

 

 
35

Loss on early extinguishment of debt
 

 

 
(14
)
 
(43
)
 

Salary and employee benefits—severance charges
 
(61
)
 
(10
)
 
(21
)
 
(6
)
 

Adjusted non-interest expense (non-GAAP)
D
$
3,434

 
$
3,419

 
$
3,387

 
$
3,325

 
$
3,244

Net interest income and other financing income (GAAP)
E
$
3,735

 
$
3,539

 
$
3,398

 
$
3,305

 
$
3,279

Reduction in leveraged lease interest income resulting from tax reform
 

 
6

 

 

 

Adjusted net interest income and other financing income (non-GAAP)
F
$
3,735

 
$
3,545

 
$
3,398

 
$
3,305

 
$
3,279

Net interest income and other financing income (GAAP)
 
$
3,735

 
$
3,539

 
$
3,398

 
$
3,305

 
$
3,279

Taxable-equivalent adjustment
 
51

 
90

 
84

 
75

 
63

Net interest income and other financing income, taxable-equivalent basis - continuing operations
G
3,786

 
3,629

 
3,482

 
3,380

 
3,342

Reduction in leveraged lease interest income resulting from Tax Reform
 

 
6

 

 

 

Adjusted net interest income and other financing income, taxable equivalent basis (non-GAAP)
H
$
3,786

 
$
3,635

 
$
3,482

 
$
3,380

 
$
3,342

Net interest margin (GAAP) (4)
 
3.50
%
 
3.32
%
 
3.14
%
 
3.13
%
 
3.21
%
Reduction in leveraged lease interest income resulting from Tax Reform
 

 
0.01

 

 

 

Adjusted net interest margin (non-GAAP)
 
3.50
%
 
3.33
%
 
3.14
%
 
3.13
%
 
3.21
%
Non-interest income (GAAP)
I
2,019

 
1,962

 
2,011

 
1,937

 
1,785

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities (gains) losses, net
 
(1
)
 
(19
)
 
(6
)
 
(29
)
 
(27
)
Insurance proceeds (5)
 

 

 
(50
)
 
(91
)
 

Leveraged lease termination gains
 
(8
)
 
(1
)
 
(8
)
 
(8
)
 
(10
)
Gain on sale of affordable housing residential mortgage loans (6)
 

 
(5
)
 
(5
)
 

 

Adjusted non-interest income (non-GAAP)
J
2,010

 
1,937

 
1,942

 
1,809

 
1,748

Total revenue
E+I=K
$
5,754

 
$
5,501

 
$
5,409

 
$
5,242

 
$
5,064

Adjusted total revenue (non-GAAP)
F+J=L
$
5,745

 
$
5,482

 
$
5,340

 
$
5,114

 
$
5,027

Total revenue, taxable-equivalent basis
G+I=M
$
5,805

 
$
5,591

 
$
5,493


$
5,317


$
5,127

Adjusted total revenue, taxable-equivalent basis (non-GAAP)
H+J=N
$
5,796

 
$
5,572

 
$
5,424

 
$
5,189

 
$
5,090

Efficiency ratio (GAAP)
C/M
61.50
%
 
62.44
%
 
63.42
%
 
65.42
%
 
64.72
%
Adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP)
D/N
59.26
%
 
61.35
%
 
62.46
%
 
64.08
%
 
63.72
%
Fee income ratio (GAAP)
I/M
34.78
%
 
35.09
%
 
36.62
%
 
36.42
%
 
34.82
%
Adjusted fee income ratio (non-GAAP)
J/N
34.68
%
 
34.80
%
 
35.82
%
 
34.87
%
 
34.34
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

44

Table of Contents




 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
 
(Dollars in millions, except share data)
RETURN ON AVERAGE TANGIBLE COMMON STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY — CONSOLIDATED
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,381

 
$
16,665

 
$
17,126

 
$
16,916

 
$
16,620

Less:  Average intangible assets (GAAP)
 
5,010

 
5,103

 
5,125

 
5,099

 
5,103

Average deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP)
 
(97
)
 
(148
)
 
(162
)
 
(170
)
 
(182
)
Average preferred stock (GAAP)
 
820

 
820

 
820

 
848

 
754

Average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
O
$
9,648

 
$
10,890

 
$
11,343

 
$
11,139

 
$
10,945

Return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
A/O
17.57
%
 
11.01
%
 
9.69
%
 
8.96
%
 
10.00
%
RETURN ON AVERAGE TANGIBLE COMMON STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY — CONTINUING OPERATIONS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average stockholders’ equity (GAAP) (7)
 
$
15,381

 
$
16,665

 
$
17,126

 
$
16,916

 
$
16,620

Less:  Average intangible assets (GAAP) (7)
 
5,010

 
5,103

 
5,125

 
5,099

 
5,103

Average deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP) (7)
 
(97
)
 
(148
)
 
(162
)
 
(170
)
 
(182
)
Average preferred stock (GAAP) (7)
 
820

 
820

 
820

 
848

 
754

Average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP) (7)
P
$
9,648

 
$
10,890

 
$
11,343

 
$
11,139

 
$
10,945

Return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
B/P
15.59
%
 
10.80
%
 
9.61
%
 
9.04
%
 
9.86
%
TANGIBLE COMMON RATIOS — CONSOLIDATED
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ending stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,090

 
$
16,192

 
$
16,664

 
$
16,844

 
$
16,873

Less: Ending intangible assets (GAAP)
 
4,944

 
5,081

 
5,125

 
5,137

 
5,091

  Ending deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP)
 
(94
)
 
(99
)
 
(155
)
 
(165
)
 
(172
)
  Ending preferred stock (GAAP)
 
820

 
820

 
820

 
820

 
884

Ending tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
Q
$
9,420

 
$
10,390

 
$
10,874

 
$
11,052

 
$
11,070

Ending total assets (GAAP)
 
$
125,688

 
$
124,294

 
$
125,968

 
$
126,050

 
$
119,563

Less: Ending intangible assets (GAAP)
 
4,944

 
5,081

 
5,125

 
5,137

 
5,091

  Ending deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP)
 
(94
)
 
(99
)
 
(155
)
 
(165
)
 
(172
)
Ending tangible assets (non-GAAP)
R
$
120,838

 
$
119,312

 
$
120,998

 
$
121,078

 
$
114,644

End of period shares outstanding
S
1,025

 
1,134

 
1,215

 
1,297

 
1,354

Tangible common stockholders’ equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP)
Q/R
7.80
%
 
8.71
%
 
8.99
%
 
9.13
%
 
9.66
%
Tangible common book value per share (non-GAAP)
Q/S
$
9.19

 
$
9.16

 
$
8.95

 
$
8.52

 
$
8.18

BASEL III COMMON EQUITY TIER 1 RATIO—FULLY PHASED-IN PRO-FORMA  (8)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,090

 
$
16,192

 
$
16,664

 
$
16,844

 
 
Non-qualifying goodwill and intangibles
 
(4,839
)
 
(4,972
)
 
(4,955
)
 
(4,958
)
 
 
Adjustments, including all components of accumulated other comprehensive income, disallowed deferred tax assets, threshold deductions and other adjustments
 
940

 
712

 
489

 
286

 
 
Preferred stock (GAAP)
 
(820
)
 
(820
)
 
(820
)
 
(820
)
 
 
Basel III common equity Tier 1 Fully Phased-In Pro-Forma
(non-GAAP)
T
$
10,371

 
$
11,112

 
$
11,378

 
$
11,352

 
 
Basel III risk-weighted assets Fully Phased-In Pro-Forma
(non-GAAP)
(9)
U
$
105,475

 
$
101,498

 
$
102,975

 
$
106,188

 
 
Basel III common equity Tier 1 ratio Fully Phased-In Pro-Forma (non-GAAP)
T/U
9.83
%
 
10.95
%
 
11.05
%
 
10.69
%
 
 


45

Table of Contents




 _________
(1)
Adjustments to average loan balances assume a simple day-weighted average impact for the year ended December 31, 2018, and are equal to the ending balance of the residential first mortgage loans sold for the prior periods.
(2)
Regions recorded $3 million, $50 million and $100 million of contingent legal and regulatory accruals during the second quarter of 2016, the second quarter of 2015 and the fourth quarter of 2014, respectively, related to previously disclosed matters. The fourth quarter of 2014 accruals were settled in the second quarter of 2015 for $2 million less than originally estimated and a corresponding recovery was recognized.
(3)
A recovery of $7 million was recognized in the second quarter of 2014 related to a non-tax deductible charge of $58 million recorded in the fourth quarter of 2013 related to previously disclosed inquires from government authorities concerning matters from 2009.
(4)
Refer to Table 3 for computation of net interest margin.
(5)
Insurance proceeds recognized in the third quarter of 2016 are related to the previously disclosed settlement with the Department of Housing and Urban Development. Insurance proceeds recognized in 2015 are related to the settlement of the previously disclosed 2010 class-action lawsuit.
(6)
In the fourth quarter of 2016, the Company sold affordable housing residential mortgage loans to FHLMC for a $5 million gain. Approximately $91 million were sold with recourse, resulting in a deferred gain of $5 million, which was recognized during the second quarter of 2017.
(7)
Due to the immaterial impact of the discontinued operations, the balance sheet has not been presented on a continuing operations basis.
(8)
The amounts and the resulting ratios are estimated. Regulatory capital measures for periods prior to 2015 were not revised to reflect the retrospective application of new accounting guidance related to investments in qualified affordable housing projects. As a result, those calculations are not included in the table.
(9)
Regions has systems and internal controls in place to calculate risk-weighted assets as required by Basel III on a fully phased-in basis. The amounts included above are a reasonable approximation, based on our understanding of the requirements.
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND RELATED POLICIES
In preparing financial information, management is required to make significant estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses for the periods shown. The accounting principles followed by Regions and the methods of applying these principles conform with GAAP, regulatory guidances, where applicable, and general banking practices. Estimates and assumptions most significant to Regions are related primarily to the allowance for credit losses, fair value measurements, intangible assets (goodwill and other identifiable intangible assets), residential MSRs and income taxes, and are summarized in the following discussion and in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.
Allowance for Credit Losses
The allowance for credit losses (“allowance”) consists of two components: the allowance for loan losses and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments. Unfunded credit commitments include items such as letters of credit, financial guarantees and binding unfunded loan commitments. The allowance represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan and credit commitment portfolios as of period end. Regions determines its allowance in accordance with GAAP and applicable regulatory guidance.
For non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans equal to or greater than $2.5 million, the allowance for loan losses is based on note-level evaluation considering the facts and circumstances specific to each borrower. For all other commercial and investor real estate loans, the allowance for loan losses is based on statistical models using a PD and an LGD. Historical default information for similar loans is used as an input for the statistical model.
For residential first mortgages, home equity lending and other consumer-related loans, individual products are reviewed on a group basis (e.g., residential first mortgage pools). Historical loss information for similar loans is used as an input for the models.
Factors considered by management in determining the adequacy of the allowance include, but are not limited to: 1) detailed reviews of individual loans; 2) historical and current trends in gross and net loan charge-offs for the various classes of loans evaluated; 3) the Company’s policies relating to delinquent loans and charge-offs; 4) the level of the allowance in relation to total loans and to historical loss levels; 5) levels and trends in non-performing, criticized, classified and past due loans; 6) collateral values of properties securing loans; 7) the composition of the loan portfolio, including unfunded credit commitments; 8) management’s analysis of current economic conditions; and 9) migration of loans between risk rating categories.
In support of collateral values, Regions obtains updated valuations for large commercial and investor real estate non-performing loans on at least an annual basis. For loans that are individually identified for impairment, those valuations are currently discounted as appropriate from the most recent appraisal to consider continued declines in values. The discounted valuations are utilized in the measurement of the level of impairment in the allowance calculation. For loans that are not individually identified for impairment and secured by collateral, Regions considers the impact of declines in valuations in the loss given default estimates within the allowance calculation.
The allowance is sensitive to a variety of internal factors, such as modifications in the mix and level of loan balances outstanding, portfolio performance and assigned risk ratings. As a matter of business practice, Regions may require some form of credit support, such as a guarantee. Guarantees are legally binding and entered into simultaneously with the primary loan agreements. Evaluation of guarantors’ ability and willingness to pay is considered as part of the risk rating process, which provides the basis for the allowance for loan losses for the commercial and investor real estate portfolios. In concluding that the risk rating is

46

Table of Contents




appropriate, Regions considers a number of factors including whether underlying cash flow is adequate to service the debt, payment history, and whether there is appropriate guarantor support. Accordingly, Regions has concluded that the impact of credit support provided by guarantors has been appropriately considered in the calculation and assessment of the allowance for loan losses.
The allowance is also sensitive to a variety of external factors, such as the general health of the economy, as evidenced by volatility in commodity prices, changes in real estate demand and values, interest rates, unemployment rates, bankruptcy filings, fluctuations in the GDP, and the effects of weather and natural disasters such as droughts, floods and hurricanes.
Management considers these variables and all other available information when establishing the final level of the allowance. These variables and others have the ability to result in actual loan losses that differ from the originally estimated amounts.
Management considers the current level of the allowance appropriate to absorb losses inherent in the loan and credit commitment portfolios. Management’s determination of the appropriateness of the allowance requires the use of judgments and estimations that may change in the future. Changes in the factors used by management to determine the appropriateness of the allowance or the availability of new information could cause the allowance to be increased or decreased in future periods. In addition, bank regulatory agencies, as part of their examination process, may require changes in the level of the allowance based on their judgments and estimates. Volatility in certain credit metrics is to be expected. Additionally, changes in circumstances related to individually large credits or certain portfolios may result in volatility.
Management’s estimate of the allowance for the commercial and investor real estate portfolio segments could be affected by estimates of losses inherent in various product types as a result of fluctuations in the internal and external factors mentioned above. For pooled commercial and investor real estate accounts, a 5 percent increase in the PD for non-defaulted accounts and a 5 percent increase in the LGD for all accounts would result in an increase to estimated inherent losses of approximately $35 million.
Losses on residential real estate mortgages, home equity lending and other consumer-related loans can be affected by such factors as collateral value, loss severity, and other internal and external factors mentioned above. A 5 percent increase or decrease in the estimated loss rates on these loans would change estimated inherent losses by approximately $11 million.
These pro forma analyses demonstrate the sensitivity of the allowance to key assumptions; however, they do not reflect an expected outcome.
For further discussion of the allowance for credit losses, see Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.
Fair Value Measurements
A portion of the Company’s assets and liabilities is carried at fair value, with changes in fair value recorded either in earnings or accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). These include debt securities available for sale, mortgage loans held for sale, equity investments (with and without readily determinable market values), residential MSRs and derivative assets and liabilities. From time to time, the estimation of fair value also affects other loans held for sale, which are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. Fair value determination is also relevant for certain other assets such as foreclosed property and other real estate, which are recorded at the lower of the recorded investment in the loan/property or fair value, less estimated costs to sell the property. For example, the fair value of other real estate is determined based on recent appraisals by third parties and other market information, less estimated selling costs. Adjustments to the appraised value are made if management becomes aware of changes in the fair value of specific properties or property types. The determination of fair value also impacts certain other assets that are periodically evaluated for impairment using fair value estimates, including goodwill and other identifiable intangible assets.
Fair value is generally defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) as opposed to the price that would be paid to acquire the asset or received to assume the liability (an entry price), in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. While management uses judgment when determining the price at which willing market participants would transact when there has been a significant decrease in the volume or level of activity for the asset or liability in relation to “normal” market activity, management’s objective is to determine the point within the range of fair value estimates that is most representative of a sale to a third-party investor under current market conditions. The value to the Company if the asset or liability were held to maturity is not included in the fair value estimates.
A fair value measure should reflect the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including the assumptions about the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique, the effect of a restriction on the sale or use of an asset and the risk of nonperformance. Fair value is measured based on a variety of inputs the Company utilizes. Fair value may be based on quoted market prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets (Level 1 valuations). If market prices are not available, quoted market prices for similar instruments traded in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market are used (Level 2 valuations). Where observable market data is not available, the valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market, but observable based on Company-specific data (Level 3 valuations). These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates for assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques typically include option pricing models, discounted cash flow

47

Table of Contents




models and similar techniques, but may also include the use of market prices of assets or liabilities that are not directly comparable to the subject asset or liability.
See Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statements for a detailed discussion of determining fair value, including pricing validation processes.
Intangible Assets
Regions’ intangible assets consist primarily of the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets of acquired businesses (“goodwill”) and other identifiable intangible assets (primarily core deposit intangibles and purchased credit card relationships). Goodwill totaled $4.8 billion and $4.9 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Goodwill is allocated to each of Regions’ reportable segments (each a reporting unit: Corporate Bank, Consumer Bank, and Wealth Management). The decline in the goodwill balance in 2018 is due to the sale of Regions Insurance Group within the Wealth Management reportable segment. Goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis as of October 1 or more often if events and circumstances indicate impairment may exist (refer to Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion).
Accounting guidance permits the Company to first assess qualitative factors to determine if it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying value. If, based on the weight of the evidence, the Company determines it is more likely than not that the fair value exceeds book value, then an impairment test is not necessary. If the Company elects to bypass the qualitative assessment, or concludes that it is more likely than not that the fair value is less than the carrying value, a two-step goodwill impairment test is performed. In Step One, the fair value of the reporting unit is compared to its carrying amount, including goodwill. To the extent that the estimated fair value of the reporting unit exceeds the carrying value, impairment is not indicated and no further testing is required. Conversely, if the estimated fair value of the reporting unit is below its carrying amount, Step Two must be performed. Step Two consists of determining the implied estimated fair value of goodwill, which is the net difference between the valuation adjustments of assets and liabilities excluding goodwill and the valuation adjustment to equity (from Step One) of the reporting unit. The carrying value of equity for each reporting unit is determined from an allocation based upon risk weighted assets. Adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations of the reporting unit, or other factors could result in a decline in the estimated implied fair value of goodwill. If the estimated implied fair value of goodwill is less than the carrying amount, a loss (which could be material) would be recognized to reduce the carrying amount to the estimated implied fair value.
The Company completed its annual goodwill impairment test as of October 1, 2018, by performing a qualitative assessment of goodwill at the reporting unit level to determine whether any indicators of impairment existed. In performing the qualitative assessment, the Company evaluated events and circumstances since the last impairment analysis, recent operating performance including reporting unit performance, changes in market capitalization, regulatory actions and assessments, changes in the business climate, company-specific factors, and trends in the banking industry. After assessing the totality of the events and circumstances, the Company determined that it is more likely than not that the fair value of the Corporate Bank, Consumer Bank, and Wealth Management reporting units exceed their respective carrying values. Therefore, Step One and Step Two of the goodwill impairment test were deemed unnecessary. Refer to Note 10 “Intangible Assets” to the consolidated financial statements for additional discussion of goodwill.
Specific factors as of the date of filing the financial statements that could negatively impact the assumptions used in assessing goodwill for impairment include: a protracted decline in the Company’s market capitalization; adverse business trends resulting from litigation and/or regulatory actions; higher loan losses; forecasts of high unemployment levels; future increased minimum regulatory capital requirements above current thresholds (refer to Note 14 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” to the consolidated financial statements for a discussion of current minimum regulatory requirements); future federal rules and regulations (e.g., such as those resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act); and/or a significant protraction in the current level of interest rates.
Other material identifiable intangible assets, primarily core deposit intangibles and purchased credit card relationships, are reviewed at least annually (usually in the fourth quarter) for events or circumstances which could impact the recoverability of the intangible asset. These events could include loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card accounts and/or balances, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent an other identifiable intangible asset is deemed unrecoverable, an impairment loss would be recorded to reduce the carrying amount. These events or circumstances, if they occur, could be material to Regions’ operating results for any particular reporting period but the potential impact cannot be reasonably estimated.
Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights
Regions has elected to measure and report its residential MSRs using the fair value method. Although sales of residential MSRs do occur, residential MSRs do not trade in an active market with readily observable market prices and the exact terms and conditions of sales may not be readily available, and are therefore Level 3 valuations in the fair value hierarchy previously discussed in the “Fair Value Measurements” section. Specific characteristics of the underlying loans greatly impact the estimated value of the related residential MSRs. As a result, Regions stratifies its residential mortgage servicing portfolio on the basis of certain risk

48

Table of Contents




characteristics, including loan type and contractual note rate, and values its residential MSRs using discounted cash flow modeling techniques. These techniques require management to make estimates regarding future net servicing cash flows, taking into consideration historical and forecasted residential mortgage loan prepayment rates, discount rates, escrow balances and servicing costs. Changes in interest rates, prepayment speeds or other factors impact the fair value of residential MSRs which impacts earnings. The carrying value of residential MSRs was $418 million at December 31, 2018 . Based on a hypothetical sensitivity analysis, Regions estimates that a reduction in primary mortgage market rates of 25 basis points and 50 basis points would reduce the December 31, 2018 fair value of residential MSRs by approximately 4 percent ($17 million) and 8 percent ($35 million), respectively. Conversely, 25 basis point and 50 basis point increases in these rates would increase the December 31, 2018 fair value of residential MSRs by approximately 4 percent ($15 million) and 7 percent ($29 million), respectively. Regions also estimates that an increase in servicing costs of approximately $10 per loan, or 12 percent, would result in a decline in the value of the residential MSRs by approximately $12 million.
The pro forma fair value analysis presented above demonstrates the sensitivity of fair values to hypothetical changes in primary mortgage rates. This sensitivity analysis does not reflect an expected outcome. Refer to the “Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights” discussion in the “Balance Sheet” analysis section found later in this report.
Income Taxes
Accrued income taxes are reported as a component of either other assets or other liabilities, as appropriate, in the consolidated balance sheets and reflect management’s estimate of income taxes to be paid or received.
Deferred income taxes represent the amount of future income taxes to be paid or received and are accounted for using the asset and liability method. The net balance is reported as a component of either other assets or other liabilities, as appropriate, in the consolidated balance sheets. The Company determines the realization of deferred tax assets by considering all positive and negative evidence available, including the impact of recent operating results, future reversals of taxable temporary differences, future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards and tax planning strategies. In projecting future taxable income, the Company utilizes forecasted pre-tax earnings, adjusts for the estimated book-tax differences and incorporates assumptions, including the amounts of income allocable to taxing jurisdictions. These assumptions require significant judgment and are consistent with the plans and estimates the Company uses to manage the underlying businesses. The realization of the deferred tax assets could be reduced in the future if these estimates are significantly different than forecasted. For a detailed discussion of realization of deferred tax assets, refer to the “Income Taxes” section found later in this report.
The Company is subject to income tax in the U.S. and multiple state and local jurisdictions. The tax laws and regulations in each jurisdiction may be interpreted differently in certain situations, which could result in a range of outcomes. Thus, the Company is required to exercise judgment regarding the application of these tax laws and regulations. The Company will evaluate and recognize tax liabilities related to any tax uncertainties. Due to the complexity of some of these uncertainties, the ultimate resolution may result in a payment that is different from the current estimate of the tax liabilities.
The Company’s estimate of accrued income taxes, deferred income taxes and income tax expense can also change in any period as a result of new legislative or judicial guidance impacting tax positions, as well as changes in income tax rates. Any changes, if they occur, can be significant to the Company’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows. On December 22, 2017, Tax Reform was enacted. Effective January 1, 2018, Tax Reform reduced the maximum corporate statutory federal income tax rate from 35 percent to 21 percent. See Note 20 "Income Taxes" to the consolidated financial statements for further details.
OPERATING RESULTS
NET INTEREST INCOME AND OTHER FINANCING INCOME AND NET INTEREST MARGIN
Net interest income and other financing income is Regions’ principal source of income and is one of the most important elements of Regions’ ability to meet its overall performance goals. Net interest income and other financing income (taxable-equivalent basis) increased approximately $157 million, or 4 percent in 2018 compared to 2017 , due to the increases in yields on earning assets, particularly loans, exceeding the increase in total funding costs. In 2018, net interest income and other financing income (taxable-equivalent basis) was reduced by the passage of Tax Reform from the resulting impact on the yield adjustment for tax advantaged assets.
The net interest margin increased to 3.50 percent in 2018 from 3.32 percent in 2017 , due to an increase in yields on earning assets exceeding an increase in total funding costs during 2018 . Comparing 2018 to 2017 , average earning asset yields were 39 basis points higher. Also, interest-bearing liability rates were higher, increasing by 32 basis points. As a result, the net interest rate spread increased 7 basis points to 3.18 percent in 2018 compared to 3.11 percent in 2017 .
The Federal Reserve continued its gradual reduction in the amount of policy accommodation throughout 2018. This, coupled with improving global economic growth trends, resulted in increases in both short-term and long-term interest rates in 2018 . Long-term interest rates are generally represented by the yield on the benchmark 10-year U.S. Treasury note. The average yield on the benchmark rate increased to 2.91 percent in 2018 , as compared to 2.33 percent in 2017 . The taxable investment securities portfolio, which contains significant residential fixed-rate exposure, increased in yield to 2.58 percent in 2018 from 2.39 percent in 2017 ,

49

Table of Contents




largely attributable to higher interest rates and their positive impact on both security reinvestment yields and reduced premium amortization. Similarly, higher long-term rates have benefited the yield on fixed rate loans through reinvestment under normal business activity. Fixed rate loan and security reinvestment were both accretive to yields at year-end market rate levels, as the 10-year U.S. Treasury yield ended 2018 at 2.68 percent. The Company's loan pricing is also influenced by short-term interest rates such as 30-day LIBOR. As the Federal Reserve increased short-term interest rates in 2017 , as well as in March, June, September and December 2018 , 30-day LIBOR averaged 2.02 percent in 2018 , compared to 1.11 percent in 2017 , leading to higher loan yields.
The composition of Regions’ funding base and prudent management resulted in funding costs increasing at a slower pace than earning asset yields as the Fed Funds rate increased throughout 2018. Deposit costs increased to 26 basis points for 2018 compared to 16 basis points for 2017 . Average long-term borrowing balances increased to $10.0 billion in 2018 as compared to $7.1 billion in 2017. The cost on these borrowings increased 21 basis points, as the majority of Regions' long-term debt is effectively converted to floating rate debt through the execution of interest rate swaps. Shorter-term FHLB advances also repriced higher in 2018 as the majority of the these borrowings are floating rate debt as well. See the "Long-Term Borrowings" section in Management's Discussion and Analysis and Note 13 "Long-Term Borrowings" to the consolidated financial statements for additional information.
See also the "Market Risk-Interest Rate Risk" section in Management's Discussion and Analysis for additional information.

50

Table of Contents




Table 3 “Consolidated Average Daily Balances and Yield/Rate Analysis” presents a detail of net interest income and other financing income (on a taxable-equivalent basis), the net interest margin, and the net interest spread.
Table 3—Consolidated Average Daily Balances and Yield/Rate Analysis
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
Average
Balance
 
Income/
Expense
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Average
Balance
 
Income/
Expense
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Average
Balance
 
Income/
Expense
 
Yield/
Rate
 
(Dollars in millions; yields on taxable-equivalent basis)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earning assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell
$

 
$

 
%
 
$
1

 
$

 
%
 
$
4

 
$

 
%
Debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Taxable
24,263

 
626

 
2.58

 
25,017

 
597

 
2.39

 
24,630

 
563

 
2.29

Tax-exempt

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

 

Loans held for sale
386

 
15

 
3.98

 
474

 
16

 
3.35

 
479

 
16

 
3.33

Loans, net of unearned
 income (1)(2)
80,692

 
3,664

 
4.52

 
79,846

 
3,318

 
4.14

 
81,333

 
3,150

 
3.85

Investment in operating leases, net
426

 
14

 
3.26

 
603

 
19

 
3.11

 
775

 
22

 
2.85

Other earning assets
2,465

 
70

 
2.84

 
3,274

 
53

 
1.60

 
3,790

 
44

 
1.05

Total earning assets
108,232

 
4,389

 
4.04

 
109,215

 
4,003

 
3.65

 
111,012

 
3,795

 
3.41

Allowance for loan losses
(863
)
 
 
 
 
 
(1,062
)
 
 
 
 
 
(1,139
)
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
1,975

 
 
 
 
 
1,899

 
 
 
 
 
1,824

 
 
 
 
Other non-earning assets
14,036

 
 
 
 
 
13,924

 
 
 
 
 
13,809

 
 
 
 
 
$
123,380

 
 
 
 
 
$
123,976

 
 
 
 
 
$
125,506

 
 
 
 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Savings
$
8,838

 
14

 
0.16

 
$
8,284

 
12

 
0.15

 
$
7,719

 
11

 
0.14

Interest-bearing checking
19,167

 
79

 
0.41

 
19,294

 
38

 
0.19

 
20,507

 
20

 
0.10

Money market
24,181

 
86

 
0.35

 
26,498

 
45

 
0.17

 
26,909

 
31

 
0.11

Time deposits
6,788

 
71

 
1.05

 
7,003

 
61

 
0.87

 
7,415

 
55

 
0.75

Total interest-bearing deposits (3)
58,974

 
250

 
0.42

 
61,079

 
156

 
0.26

 
62,550

 
117

 
0.19

Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
135

 
3

 
1.98

 
9

 

 

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings
1,262

 
27

 
2.15

 
439

 
5

 
1.06

 
3

 

 

Long-term borrowings
9,977

 
322

 
3.19

 
7,076

 
212

 
2.98

 
8,159

 
196

 
2.38

Total interest-bearing liabilities
70,348

 
602

 
0.86

 
68,603

 
373

 
0.54

 
70,712

 
313

 
0.44

Non-interest-bearing deposits (3)
35,464

 

 

 
36,262

 

 

 
35,371

 

 

Total funding sources
105,812

 
602

 
0.57

 
104,865

 
373

 
0.35

 
106,083

 
313

 
0.29

Net interest spread
 
 
 
 
3.18

 
 
 
 
 
3.11

 
 
 
 
 
2.97

Other liabilities
2,187

 
 
 
 
 
2,450

 
 
 
 
 
2,297

 
 
 
 
Stockholders’ equity
15,381

 
 
 
 
 
16,661

 
 
 
 
 
17,126

 
 
 
 
 
$
123,380

 
 
 
 
 
$
123,976

 
 
 
 
 
$
125,506

 
 
 
 
Net interest income and other financing income/margin on a taxable-equivalent basis (4)
 
 
$
3,787

 
3.50
%
 
 
 
$
3,630

 
3.32
%
 
 
 
$
3,482

 
3.14
%
_______
(1)
Loans, net of unearned income include non-accrual loans for all periods presented.
(2)
Interest income includes net loan fees of $21 million, $24 million and $33 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(3)
Total deposit costs may be calculated by dividing total interest expense on deposits by the sum of interest-bearing deposits and non-interest-bearing deposits. The rates for total deposit costs equal 0.26%, 0.16% and 0.12% for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(4)
The computation of taxable-equivalent net interest income and other financing income is based on the statutory federal income tax rate of

51

Table of Contents




21% for December 31, 2018 and 35% for both December 31, 2017 and 2016, adjusted for applicable state income taxes net of the related federal tax benefit.
Table 4—Volume and Yield/Rate Variances
Table 4 “Volume and Yield/Rate Variances” provides additional information with which to analyze the changes in net interest income and other financing income.
 
2018 Compared to 2017
 
2017 Compared to 2016
 
Change Due to
 
Change Due to
 
Volume
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Net
 
Volume
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Net
 
(Taxable-equivalent basis—in millions)
Interest income including other financing income on:
 
Debt securities-taxable
$
(18
)
 
$
47

 
$
29

 
$
9

 
$
25

 
$
34

Loans held for sale
(3
)
 
2

 
(1
)
 

 

 

Loans, including fees
36

 
310

 
346

 
(58
)
 
226

 
168

Investment in operating leases, net
(6
)
 
1

 
(5
)
 
(5
)
 
2

 
(3
)
Other earning assets
(16
)
 
33

 
17

 
(7
)
 
16

 
9

Total earning assets
(7
)
 
393

 
386

 
(61
)
 
269

 
208

Interest expense on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Savings
1

 
1

 
2

 
1

 

 
1

Interest-bearing checking

 
41

 
41

 
(1
)
 
19

 
18

Money market
(4
)
 
45

 
41

 
(1
)
 
15

 
14

Time deposits
(2
)
 
12

 
10

 
(3
)
 
9

 
6

Total interest-bearing deposits
(5
)
 
99

 
94

 
(4
)
 
43

 
39

Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 
3

 
3

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings
14

 
8

 
22

 

 
5

 
5

Long-term borrowings
94

 
16

 
110

 
(28
)
 
44

 
16

Total interest-bearing liabilities
103

 
126

 
229

 
(32
)
 
92

 
60

Increase (decrease) in net interest income and other financing income
$
(110
)
 
$
267

 
$
157

 
$
(29
)
 
$
177

 
$
148

______
Notes:
The change in interest not due solely to volume or yield/rate has been allocated to the volume column and yield/rate column in proportion to the relationship of the absolute dollar amounts of the change in each.
The computation of taxable-equivalent net interest income and other financing income is based on the statutory federal income tax rate of 21% for December 31, 2018 and 35% for both December 31, 2017 and 2016, adjusted for applicable state income taxes net of the related federal tax benefit.
The mix of earning assets can affect the interest rate spread. Regions’ primary types of earning assets are loans and investment securities. Certain types of earning assets have historically generated larger spreads; for example, loans typically generate larger spreads than other assets, such as securities, Federal funds sold or securities purchased under agreements to resell. The spread on loans increased in 2018 as compared to 2017, due primarily to the increase in market interest rates. Average earning assets in 2018 totaled $108.2 billion, a decrease of $983 million as compared to the prior year.
Average loans as a percentage of average earning assets was 75 percent and 73 percent in 2018 and 2017 , respectively. The remaining categories of earning assets are shown in Table 3 “Consolidated Average Daily Balances and Yield/Rate Analysis”. The proportion of average earning assets to average total assets, which was 88 percent in both 2018 and 2017 , measures the effectiveness of management’s efforts to invest available funds into the most profitable earning vehicles. Funding for Regions’ earning assets comes from interest-bearing and non-interest-bearing sources. Another significant factor affecting the net interest margin is the percentage of earning assets funded by interest-bearing liabilities. The percentage of average earning assets funded by average interest-bearing liabilities was 65 percent in 2018 and 63 percent in 2017 .

52

Table of Contents




PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES
The provision for loan losses is used to maintain the allowance for loan losses at a level that in management’s judgment is appropriate to absorb probable losses inherent in the portfolio at the balance sheet date. During 2018 , the provision for loan losses totaled $229 million and net charge-offs were $323 million . This compares to a provision for loan losses of $150 million and net charge-offs of $307 million in 2017 . The increase in the provision for loan losses was primarily a result of increased loan balances and slowing credit improvement as compared to 2017. The increase was partially offset by the release of the Company's $40 million hurricane-specific loan loss allowance associated with certain 2017 hurricanes, as well as a $16 million net reduction to the provision for loan losses in the first quarter of 2018 from the sale of $254 million in residential first mortgage loans consisting primarily of performing troubled debt restructured loans.
For further discussion and analysis of the total allowance for credit losses, see the "Allowance for Credit Losses" and “Risk Management” sections found later in this report. See also Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.
NON-INTEREST INCOME
Table 5—Non-Interest Income from Continuing Operations
 
Year Ended December 31
 
Change 2018 vs. 2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
(Dollars in millions)
Service charges on deposit accounts
$
710

 
$
683

 
$
664

 
$
27

 
4.0
 %
Card and ATM fees
438

 
417

 
402

 
21

 
5.0
 %
Investment management and trust fee income
235

 
230

 
213

 
5

 
2.2
 %
Capital markets income
202

 
161

 
152

 
41

 
25.5
 %
Mortgage income
137

 
149

 
173

 
(12
)
 
(8.1
)%
Investment services fee income
71

 
60

 
58

 
11

 
18.3
 %
Commercial credit fee income
71

 
71

 
73

 

 
 %
Bank-owned life insurance
65

 
81

 
95

 
(16
)
 
(19.8
)%
Insurance proceeds

 

 
50

 

 
NM

Securities gains, net
1

 
19

 
6

 
(18
)
 
(94.7
)%
Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - defined benefit
(6
)
 

 

 
(6
)
 
NM

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - other
(5
)
 
16

 
3

 
(21
)
 
(131.3
)%
Other miscellaneous income
100

 
75

 
122

 
25

 
33.3
 %
 
$
2,019

 
$
1,962

 
$
2,011

 
$
57

 
2.9
 %
_______
NM- Not Meaningful

Service Charges on Deposit Accounts
Service charges on deposit accounts include non-sufficient fund fees and other service charges. The increase in  2018  compared to 2017 was primarily due to continued customer account growth and increases in non-sufficient fund fee activity.
Card and ATM Fees
Card and ATM fees include the combined amounts of credit card/bank card income and debit card and ATM related revenue. The increase in 2018 compared to 2017 was primarily the result of an increase in commercial and consumer checkcard interchange income associated with new account growth and increases in spend and transactions.
Capital Markets Income
Capital markets income primarily relates to capital raising activities that includes securities underwriting and placement, loan syndication and placement, as well as foreign exchange, derivatives, merger and acquisition and other advisory services. The increase in 2018 compared to 2017 was driven primarily by increases in income from mergers and acquisitions advisory fees, customer interest rate swap income, and loan syndication fees, partially offset by a decrease in fees from the placement of permanent financing for real estate customers.

53

Table of Contents




Mortgage Income
Mortgage income is generated through the origination and servicing of residential mortgage loans for long-term investors and sales of residential mortgage loans in the secondary market. The decrease in mortgage income during 2018 compared to 2017 was due to lower production, tighter margins and a reduction in the valuation of mortgage servicing rights and related hedges. The decreases were partially offset by increases in mortgage servicing income as a result of purchasing the rights to service a total of approximately $6.1 billion in residential mortgage loans during 2018. See Note 7 "Servicing of Financial Assets" to the consolidated financial statements for more information.
Investment Services Fee Income
Investment services fee income represents income earned through investment advisory services, the primary revenue streams of which include sales of annuity and brokerage products. The increase in investment services fees during 2018 compared to 2017 was driven primarily by improved productivity as the result of hiring additional financial advisors.
Bank-owned Life Insurance
Bank-owned life insurance decreased in 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to reduced claims benefits throughout the year, as well as valuation declines in the fourth quarter of 2018 related to market volatility.
Securities Gains, net
Net securities gains primarily result from the Company's asset/liability management process and the sale of certain securities held for employee benefit purposes. See Note 4 "Securities" to the consolidated financial statements for more information.
Market Value Adjustments on Employee Benefit Assets
Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets, both defined benefit and other, are the reflection of market value variations related to assets held for certain employee benefits. The adjustments reported as employee benefit assets - other are offset in salaries and benefits expense.
Other Miscellaneous Income
Other miscellaneous income includes net revenue from affordable housing, valuation adjustments to equity investments, fees from safe deposit boxes, check fees and other miscellaneous income. Net revenue from affordable housing includes actual gains and losses resulting from the sale of affordable housing investments, cash distributions from the investments and any related impairment charges. Other miscellaneous income increased in 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to net gains associated with the sale of certain low income housing tax credit investments, increases in the value of equity investments, and decreases in net impairment charges related to certain operating lease assets.
NON-INTEREST EXPENSE
Table 6—Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations
 
Year Ended December 31
 
Change 2018 vs. 2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
(Dollars in millions)
Salaries and employee benefits
$
1,947

 
$
1,874

 
$
1,842

 
$
73

 
3.9
 %
Net occupancy expense
335

 
339

 
342

 
(4
)
 
(1.2
)%
Furniture and equipment expense
325

 
326

 
312

 
(1
)
 
(0.3
)%
Outside services
187

 
172

 
154

 
15

 
8.7
 %
Professional, legal and regulatory expenses
119

 
93

 
92

 
26

 
28.0
 %
Marketing
92

 
93

 
101

 
(1
)
 
(1.1
)%
FDIC insurance assessments
85

 
108

 
99

 
(23
)
 
(21.3
)%
Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges
11

 
22

 
58

 
(11
)
 
(50.0
)%
Visa class B shares expense
10

 
19

 
15

 
(9
)
 
(47.4
)%
Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(2
)
 
(16
)
 
17

 
14

 
(87.5
)%
Loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
14

 

 
NM

Other miscellaneous expenses
461

 
461

 
437

 

 
 %
 
$
3,570

 
$
3,491

 
$
3,483

 
$
79

 
2.3
 %
_______
NM- Not Meaningful


54

Table of Contents




Salaries and Employee Benefits
Salaries and employee benefits consist of salaries, incentive compensation, long-term incentives, payroll taxes, and other employee benefits such as 401(k), pension, and medical, life and disability insurance, as well as, expenses from liabilities held for employee benefit purposes. Salaries and employee benefits increased during 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to higher severance charges, annual merit increases, and higher production-based incentive expenses, partially offset by staffing reductions and decreased expenses from liabilities held for employee benefit purposes and long-term incentives. Severance charges totaled $61 million for 2018 compared to $10 million for 2017. Full-time equivalent headcount from continuing operations decreased to 19,969 at December 31, 2018 from 21,014 at December 31, 2017, reflecting the impact of the Company's efficiency initiatives implemented as part of its strategic priorities.
Outside Services
Outside services consists of expenses related to routine services provided by third parties, such as contract labor, servicing costs, data processing, loan pricing and research, data license purchases, data subscriptions, and check printing. Outside services increased during 2018 compared 2017 primarily due to increased servicing costs related to point-of-sale lending through third parties and additional expenses recorded related to a new Wealth Management platform.
Professional, Legal and Regulatory Expenses
Professional, legal and regulatory expenses consist of amounts related to legal, consulting, other professional fees and regulatory charges. Professional, legal and regulatory expenses increased during 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to higher consulting fees related to implementation of strategic priorities and litigation-related costs.
FDIC Insurance Assessments
FDIC insurance assessments decreased during 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to the fourth quarter 2018 discontinuation of the FDIC assessment surcharge that was implemented during the third quarter of 2016 and was in place throughout the first nine months of 2018. Other factors that contributed to the decrease included improved operating results, sale of troubled debt restructured loans during the first quarter of 2018, and issuances of unsecured senior bank notes during 2018.
Branch Consolidation, Property and Equipment Charges
Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges include valuation adjustments related to owned branches when the decision to close them is made. Accelerated depreciation and lease write-off charges are recorded for leased branches through and at the actual branch close date. Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges also include costs related to occupancy optimization initiatives.
Visa Class B Shares Expense
Visa class B shares expense is associated with shares sold in a prior year. The Visa class B shares have restrictions tied to finalization of certain covered litigation. Visa class B shares expense decreased during 2018 compared to 2017 as a result of the changes in Visa's stock price and in the status of the covered litigation.
Provision (Credit) for Unfunded Credit Losses
Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses is the adjustment to the reserve for unfunded credit commitments, which can fluctuate based on the amount of outstanding commitments and the level of risk associated with those commitments. A provision for unfunded credit losses is primarily due to increased volume and/or increased levels of estimated risk in commitments, while a (credit) for unfunded credit losses is primarily due to reduced volume and/or levels of estimated risk in commitments.
Other Miscellaneous Expenses
Other miscellaneous expenses include expenses related to communications, postage, supplies, certain credit-related costs, foreclosed property expenses, mortgage repurchase costs and other costs (benefits) related to employee benefit plans. While other miscellaneous expenses were consistent year over year, there were some offsetting changes. The Company contributed $60 million in 2018 and $40 million in 2017 to the Regions Financial Corporation Foundation, resulting in an increase of $20 million in other miscellaneous expenses. Additionally, other net periodic pension costs decreased in 2018 as compared to 2017, which caused a decrease of approximately $24 million in other miscellaneous expenses.
INCOME TAXES
The Company’s income tax expense from continuing operations for the year ended 2018 was $387 million compared to income tax expense of $619 million for the same period in 2017, resulting in effective tax rates of 19.8 percent and 33.3 percent, respectively. The effective tax rate is lower in the current period principally due to Tax Reform enacted in December 2017 that reduced the federal statutory rate from 35 percent to 21 percent effective January 1, 2018.
Many factors impact the effective tax rate including, but not limited to, the level of pre-tax income, the mix of income between various tax jurisdictions with differing tax rates, net tax benefits related to affordable housing investments, bank-owned life

55


insurance, tax-exempt interest and nondeductible expenses. In addition, the effective tax rate is affected by items that may occur in any given period but are not consistent from period-to-period, such as the termination of certain leveraged leases, share-based payments, valuation allowance changes and changes to unrecognized tax benefits. Accordingly, the comparability of the effective tax rate between periods may be impacted.
At December 31, 2018, the Company reported a net deferred tax asset of $20 million compared to a net deferred asset of $163 million at December 31, 2017. The decrease in the deferred tax asset is due principally to increases in deferred tax liabilities related to employee benefits, fixed assets and lease financing which was partially offset by an increase in deferred tax assets related to unrealized losses on securities available for sale and derivative instruments.
The Company continually assesses the realizability of its deferred tax assets based on an evaluative process that considers all available positive and negative evidence. As part of this evaluative process, the Company considers the following sources of taxable income: 1) the future reversals of taxable temporary differences; 2) future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards; and 3) tax-planning strategies. In making a conclusion, the Company has evaluated all available positive and negative evidence impacting these sources of taxable income. The primary sources of evidence impacting the Company's judgment regarding the realization of its deferred tax assets are summarized below.
History of earnings - In 2018, the Company has continued its positive earnings trend with positive earnings from 2012 through 2018. There is no history of significant tax carryforwards expiring unused.
Reversals of taxable temporary differences - The Company anticipates that future reversals of taxable temporary differences, including the accretion of taxable temporary differences related to leveraged leases acquired in a prior business combination, can absorb up to approximately $593 million of deferred tax assets.
Creation of future taxable income - The Company has projected future taxable income that will be sufficient to absorb the remaining deferred tax assets after the reversal of future taxable temporary differences.
Ability to implement tax planning strategies - The Company has the ability to implement tax planning strategies such as asset sales to maximize the realization of deferred tax assets.
Based on this evaluative process, the Company has established a valuation allowance in the amount of $30 million at December 31, 2018 and $34 million at December 31, 2017 because the Company believes that a portion of state net operating loss carryforwards will not be utilized. See Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 20 “Income Taxes” to the consolidated financial statements for additional information about income taxes.
DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS
On April 4, 2018, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates to BB&T Insurance Holdings, Inc. The transaction closed on July 2, 2018. On April 2, 2012, Morgan Keegan was sold. Results from both Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and affiliates and Morgan Keegan are included in discontinued operations.
Regions' results from discontinued operations are presented in Note 3 "Discontinued Operations" to the consolidated financial statements. Income from discontinued operations in 2018 included the gain associated with the sale of Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and affiliates of $281 million ($196 million after tax). Income from discontinued operations in 2017 was primarily the result of recoveries of legal expenses.
BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS
The following sections provide expanded discussion of significant changes in certain line items in asset, liability, and equity categories.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
At December 31, 2018 , cash and cash equivalents totaled $3.5 billion as compared to $4.0 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decrease year-over-year was due primarily to a decrease in cash on deposit with the FRB, as the result of normal day-to-day operating variations.
Debt Securities
Debt securities available for sale, which constitute the majority of the securities portfolio, are an important tool used to manage interest rate sensitivity and provide a primary source of liquidity for the Company.
The “Market Risk-Interest Rate Risk” and "Liquidity Risk" sections, found later in this report, further explain Regions’ interest rate and liquidity risk management practices. The weighted-average yield earned on debt securities was 2.58 percent in 2018 and 2.45 percent in 2017 (see Table 8 “Relative Contractual Maturities and Weighted-Average Yields for Debt Securities”). Table 7 “Debt Securities” details the carrying values of debt securities, including both available for sale and held to maturity.

56

Table of Contents




Table 7—Debt Securities
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
U.S. Treasury securities
$
280

 
$
331

 
$
303

Federal agency securities
43

 
28

 
35

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

 

 
1

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
17,475

 
18,442

 
18,571

Residential non-agency
2

 
3

 
4

Commercial agency
4,466

 
4,361

 
3,625

Commercial non-agency
760

 
788

 
1,129

Corporate and other debt securities
1,185

 
1,108

 
1,274

 
$
24,211

 
$
25,061

 
$
24,942

Regions maintains a highly rated securities portfolio consisting primarily of agency mortgage-backed securities. See Note 4 "Securities" to the consolidated financial statements for additional information.
Maturity Analysis —The average life of the debt securities portfolio at December 31, 2018 was estimated to be 5.7 years, with a duration of approximately 4.2 years. These metrics compare with an estimated average life of 5.9 years, with a duration of approximately 4.3 years for the portfolio at December 31, 2017 . Table 8 “Relative Contractual Maturities and Weighted-Average Yields for Debt Securities” provides additional details.
Table 8—Relative Contractual Maturities and Weighted-Average Yields for Debt Securities
 
Debt Securities Maturing as of December 31, 2018
 
Within One
Year
 
After One But
Within Five
Years
 
After Five But
Within Ten
Years
 
After Ten
Years
 
Total
 
(Dollars in millions)
Debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
119

 
$
157

 
$
1

 
$
3

 
$
280

Federal agency securities

 
14

 

 
29

 
43

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
1

 
217

 
2,023

 
15,234

 
17,475

Residential non-agency

 

 
1

 
1

 
2

Commercial agency
110

 
1,767

 
2,386

 
203

 
4,466

Commercial non-agency

 

 
29

 
731

 
760

Corporate and other debt securities
75

 
718

 
379

 
13

 
1,185

 
$
305

 
$
2,873

 
$
4,819

 
$
16,214

 
$
24,211

Weighted-average yield (1)
2.07
%
 
2.43
%
 
2.56
%
 
2.62
%
 
2.58
%
_________
(1)
The weighted-average yields are calculated on the basis of the yield to maturity based on the book value of each debt security. Weighted-average yields on tax-exempt obligations have been computed on a taxable-equivalent basis using a tax rate of 21%, adjusted for applicable state income taxes net of the related federal tax benefit. Average tax-exempt securities were maintained at such a small balance in 2018 that the taxable-equivalent adjustments for the calculation of yields amounted to zero for the year ended December 31, 2018. Yields on tax-exempt obligations have not been adjusted for the non-deductible portion of interest expense used to finance the purchase of tax-exempt obligations.
Portfolio Quality —Regions’ investment policy emphasizes credit quality and liquidity. Debt securities rated in the highest category by nationally recognized rating agencies and debt securities backed by the U.S. Government and government sponsored agencies, both on a direct and indirect basis, represented approximately 95 percent of the investment portfolio at December 31, 2018 . All other debt securities rated below AAA, not backed by the U.S. Government or government sponsored agencies, or which are not rated represented approximately 5 percent of total debt securities at December 31, 2018 .

57

Table of Contents




Loans Held For Sale
At December 31, 2018 , loans held for sale totaled $304 million , consisting of $256 million of residential real estate mortgage loans, $38 million of commercial mortgage and other loans, and $10 million of non-performing loans. At December 31, 2017 , loans held for sale totaled $348 million , consisting of $325 million of residential real estate mortgage loans, $6 million of commercial mortgage and other loans, and $17 million of non-performing loans. The levels of residential real estate and commercial mortgage loans held for sale that are part of the Company's mortgage originations to be sold fluctuate depending on the timing of origination and sale to third parties.
Loans
GENERAL
Average loans, net of unearned income, represented 75 percent of average interest-earning assets for the year ended December 31, 2018 , compared to 73 percent for the year ended December 31, 2017 . Lending at Regions is generally organized along three portfolio segments: commercial loans (including commercial and industrial, and owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage and construction loans), investor real estate loans (commercial real estate mortgage and construction loans) and consumer loans (residential first mortgage, home equity, indirect-vehicles, indirect-other consumer, consumer credit card and other consumer loans).
Table 9 illustrates a year-over-year comparison of loans, net of unearned income, by portfolio segment and class and Table 10 provides information on selected loan maturities.
Table 9—Loan Portfolio  
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(In millions, net of unearned income)
Commercial and industrial
$
39,282

 
$
36,115

 
$
35,012

 
$
35,821

 
$
32,732

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
5,549

 
6,193

 
6,867

 
7,538

 
8,263

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
384

 
332

 
334

 
423

 
407

Total commercial
45,215

 
42,640

 
42,213

 
43,782

 
41,402

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
4,650

 
4,062

 
4,087

 
4,255

 
4,680

Commercial investor real estate construction
1,786

 
1,772

 
2,387

 
2,692

 
2,133

Total investor real estate
6,436

 
5,834

 
6,474

 
6,947

 
6,813

Residential first mortgage
14,276

 
14,061

 
13,440

 
12,811

 
12,315

Home equity
9,257

 
10,164

 
10,687

 
10,978

 
10,932

Indirect—vehicles
3,053

 
3,326

 
4,040

 
3,984

 
3,642

Indirect—other consumer
2,349

 
1,467

 
920

 
545

 
206

Consumer credit card
1,345

 
1,290

 
1,196

 
1,075

 
1,009

Other consumer
1,221

 
1,165

 
1,125

 
1,040

 
988

Total consumer
31,501

 
31,473

 
31,408

 
30,433

 
29,092

 
$
83,152

 
$
79,947

 
$
80,095

 
$
81,162

 
$
77,307



58

Table of Contents




Table 10—Selected Loan Maturities
 
Loans Maturing as of December 31, 2018 (1)
 
Within
One Year
 
After One
But  Within
Five Years
 
After
Five
Years
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial (2)
$
5,188

 
$
25,137

 
$
8,732

 
$
39,057

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
484

 
2,525

 
2,540

 
5,549

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
12

 
51

 
321

 
384

Total commercial
5,684

 
27,713

 
11,593

 
44,990

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
1,202

 
3,064

 
384

 
4,650

Commercial investor real estate construction
616

 
1,141

 
29

 
1,786

Total investor real estate
1,818

 
4,205

 
413

 
6,436

 
$
7,502

 
$
31,918

 
$
12,006

 
$
51,426

 
Predetermined
Rate
 
Variable
Rate
 
(In millions)
Due after one year but within five years
$
5,109

 
$
26,809

Due after five years
8,165

 
3,841

 
$
13,274

 
$
30,650

_________
(1) Excludes consumer portfolio segment.
(2) Excludes $225 million of small business credit card accounts.
Loans, net of unearned income, totaled $83.2 billion at December 31, 2018 , an increase of $3.2 billion from year-end 2017 levels. Regions manages loan growth with a focus on risk management and risk-adjusted return on capital. Loan balances increased year over year in all 3 portfolio segments. However, within the commercial portfolio segment, the commercial real estate mortgage owner-occupied class declined year over year. In addition, within the consumer portfolio segment, the home equity and indirect-vehicles classes declined year over year.
PORTFOLIO CHARACTERISTICS
The following sections describe the composition of the portfolio segments and classes disclosed in Table 9, explain changes in balances from the 2017 year-end, and highlight the related risk characteristics. Regions believes that its loan portfolio is well diversified by product, client, and geography throughout its footprint. However, the loan portfolio may be exposed to certain concentrations of credit risk which exist in relation to individual borrowers or groups of borrowers, certain types of collateral, certain types of industries, certain loan products, or certain regions of the country. See Note 5 “Loans” and Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements for additional discussion.
Commercial
The commercial portfolio segment includes commercial and industrial loans to commercial customers for use in normal business operations to finance working capital needs, equipment purchases and other expansion projects. Commercial and industrial loans increased $3.2 billion or 9 percent since year-end 2017 driven primarily by new relationships and expansion of existing relationships within the Company's corporate and middle market portfolios aided by growth within specialized lending groups, which offset the impact of large corporate customers utilizing the fixed income market to pay down and pay off bank debt. Also contributing to the increase was a reclassification of approximately $263 million in purchasing card balances previously recognized in other assets. The commercial portfolio also includes owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage loans to operating businesses, which are loans for long-term financing of land and buildings, and are repaid by cash flow generated by business operations. These loans declined $644 million or 10 percent from year-end 2017 , and included a reclassification in December 2018 of approximately $345 million of senior housing loans out of owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage loans and into the investor real estate portfolio. Owner-occupied commercial real estate construction loans are made to commercial businesses for the development of land or construction of a building where the repayment is derived from revenues generated from the business of the borrower.
Over half of the Company’s total loans are included in the commercial portfolio segment. These balances are spread across numerous industries, as noted in the table below. The Company manages the related risks to this portfolio by setting certain lending limits for each significant industry.

59

Table of Contents




The following table provides detail of Regions' commercial portfolio balances in selected industries as of December 31 :
Table 11—Selected Industry Exposure
 
December 31, 2018
 
Loans
 
Unfunded Commitments
 
Total Exposure
 
(In millions)
Administrative, support, waste and repair
$
1,353

 
$
882

 
$
2,235

Agriculture
550

 
235

 
785

Educational services
2,500

 
606

 
3,106

Energy
2,275

 
2,408

 
4,683

Financial services
4,063

 
3,670

 
7,733

Government and public sector
2,826

 
506

 
3,332

Healthcare
3,854

 
1,869

 
5,723

Information
1,446

 
1,002

 
2,448

Manufacturing
4,543

 
4,061

 
8,604

Professional, scientific and technical services
1,730

 
1,434

 
3,164

Real estate
6,696

 
6,567

 
13,263

Religious, leisure, personal and non-profit services
1,735

 
766

 
2,501

Restaurant, accommodation and lodging
2,071

 
590

 
2,661

Retail trade
2,362

 
2,267

 
4,629

Transportation and warehousing
1,869

 
974

 
2,843

Utilities
1,729

 
2,287

 
4,016

Wholesale goods
3,356

 
2,549

 
5,905

Other (1)
257

 
2,458

 
2,715

Total commercial
$
45,215

 
$
35,131

 
$
80,346

 
December 31, 2017 (2)
 
Loans
 
Unfunded Commitments
 
Total Exposure
 
(In millions)
Administrative, support, waste and repair
$
976

 
$
620

 
$
1,596

Agriculture
525

 
247

 
772

Educational services
2,353

 
378

 
2,731

Energy
1,767

 
1,877

 
3,644

Financial services
3,615

 
3,336

 
6,951

Government and public sector
2,785

 
394

 
3,179

Healthcare
4,216

 
1,586

 
5,802

Information
1,294

 
813

 
2,107

Manufacturing
4,181

 
3,785

 
7,966

Professional, scientific and technical services  
1,764

 
1,266

 
3,030

Real estate
6,315

 
5,772

 
12,087

Religious, leisure, personal and non-profit services
1,841

 
726

 
2,567

Restaurant, accommodation and lodging
2,224

 
642

 
2,866

Retail trade
2,336

 
2,294

 
4,630

Transportation and warehousing  
1,815

 
863

 
2,678

Utilities
1,557

 
2,114

 
3,671

Wholesale goods
3,148

 
2,267

 
5,415

Other (1)
(72
)
 
1,604

 
1,532

Total commercial
$
42,640

 
$
30,584

 
$
73,224


60

Table of Contents




_______
(1)
"Other" contains balances related to non-classifiable and invalid business industry codes offset by payments in process and fee accounts that are not available at the loan level.
(2)
As customers' businesses evolve (e.g. up or down the vertical manufacturing chain), Regions may need to change the assigned business industry code used to define the customer relationship. When these changes occur, Regions does not recast the customer history for prior periods into the new classification because the business industry code used in the prior period was deemed appropriate. As a result, year over year changes may be impacted.
Investor Real Estate
Loans for real estate development are repaid through cash flows related to the operation, sale or refinance of the property. This portfolio segment includes extensions of credit to real estate developers or investors where repayment is dependent on the sale of real estate or income generated from the real estate collateral. A portion of Regions’ investor real estate portfolio segment consists of loans secured by residential product types (land, single-family and condominium loans) within Regions’ markets. Additionally, this category includes loans made to finance income-producing properties such as apartment buildings, office and industrial buildings, and retail shopping centers. Total investor real estate loans increased $602 million in comparison to 2017 year-end balances due to growth in term real estate lending, as well as a reclassification in December 2018 of approximately $345 million of senior housing loans into the commercial investor real estate mortgage portfolio class from the owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage portfolio class. Due to the nature of the cash flows typically used to repay investor real estate loans, these loans are particularly vulnerable to weak economic conditions.
Residential First Mortgage
Residential first mortgage loans represent loans to consumers to finance a residence. These loans are typically financed over a 15 to 30 year term and, in most cases, are extended to borrowers to finance their primary residence. These loans increased $215 million in comparison to 2017 year-end balances. This increase was net of the sale of $254 million of primarily performing troubled debt restructured loans and certain non-restructured interest-only loans during the first quarter of 2018. Approximately $2.6 billion in new loan originations were retained on the balance sheet during 2018 .
Home Equity
Home equity lending includes both home equity loans and lines of credit. This type of lending, which is secured by a first or second mortgage on the borrower's residence, allows customers to borrow against the equity in their homes. The home equity portfolio totaled $9.3 billion at December 31, 2018 as compared to $10.2 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decline in the home equity portfolio year-over-year was due to continued payoffs and paydowns. Substantially all of this portfolio was originated through Regions’ branch network.
The following table presents information regarding the future principal payment reset dates for the Company's home equity lines of credit as of December 31, 2018 . The balances presented are based on maturity date for lines with a balloon payment and draw period expiration date for lines that convert to a repayment period.
Table 12—Home Equity Lines of Credit - Future Principal Payment Resets
 
First Lien
 
% of Total
 
Second Lien
 
% of Total
 
Total
 
(Dollars in millions)
2019
$
50

 
0.85
%
 
$
47

 
0.81
%
 
$
97

2020
109

 
1.85

 
81

 
1.37

 
190

2021
128

 
2.18

 
112

 
1.91

 
240

2022
140

 
2.39

 
132

 
2.24

 
272

2023
172

 
2.94

 
161

 
2.74

 
333

2024-2028
2,401

 
40.90

 
2,280

 
38.84

 
4,681

2029-2033
34

 
0.57

 
22

 
0.38

 
56

Thereafter
1

 
0.01

 
1

 
0.02

 
2

Total
$
3,035

 
51.69
%
 
$
2,836

 
48.31
%
 
$
5,871

Of the $9.3 billion home equity portfolio at December 31, 2018 , approximately $5.9 billion were home equity lines of credit and $3.4 billion were closed-end home equity loans (primarily originated as amortizing loans). Beginning in December 2016, new home equity lines of credit have a 10-year draw period and a 20-year repayment term. During the 10-year draw period customers do not have an interest-only payment option, except on a very limited basis. From May 2009 to December 2016, home equity lines of credit had a 10-year draw period and a 10-year repayment term. Prior to May 2009, home equity lines of credit had a 20-year repayment term with a balloon payment upon maturity or a 5-year draw period with a balloon payment upon maturity. The term “balloon payment” means there are no principal payments required until the balloon payment is due for interest-only lines of credit.

61

Table of Contents




Other Consumer Credit Quality Data
The Company calculates an estimate of the current value of property pledged as collateral for both residential first mortgage and home equity lending products (“current LTV”). The estimate is based on home price indices compiled by a third party. The third party data indicates home price trends for MSAs. Regions uses the third party valuation trends from the MSAs in the Company's footprint in its estimate. The trend data is applied to the loan portfolios taking into account the age of the most recent valuation and geographic area.
The following table presents current LTV data for components of the residential first mortgage and home equity classes of the consumer portfolio segment. Current LTV data for some loans in the portfolio is not available due to mergers and systems integrations. The amounts in the table represent the entire loan balance. For purposes of the table below, if the loan balance exceeds the current estimated collateral the entire balance is included in the “Above 100%” category, regardless of the amount of collateral available to partially offset the shortfall.
Table 13—Estimated Current Loan to Value Ranges
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home Equity
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home Equity
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
(In millions)
Estimated current loan to value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Above 100%
$
64

 
$
28

 
$
52

 
$
123

 
$
49

 
$
117

80% - 100%
1,720

 
168

 
346

 
1,711

 
275

 
485

Below 80%
12,117

 
5,852

 
2,627

 
11,639

 
6,257

 
2,766

Data not available
375

 
66

 
118

 
588

 
85

 
130

 
$
14,276

 
$
6,114

 
$
3,143

 
$
14,061

 
$
6,666

 
$
3,498

Indirect—Vehicles
Indirect-vehicles lending, which is lending initiated through third-party business partners, largely consists of loans made through automotive dealerships. This portfolio class decreased $273 million from year-end 2017. The decrease was primarily due to the termination of a third-party arrangement during the fourth quarter of 2016. The balance is expected to continue to decrease.
In January 2019, Regions decided to discontinue its indirect auto lending business due to competition-based margin compression impacting overall returns on the portfolio. Regions will cease originating new indirect auto loans in the first quarter of 2019 and intends to complete any in-process indirect auto loan closings by the end of the second quarter of 2019. The Company will remain in the direct auto lending business.
Indirect—Other Consumer
Indirect-other consumer lending represents other point-of-sale lending through third parties. This portfolio class increased $882 million from year-end 2017 primarily due to continued growth in existing point-of-sale initiatives.
Consumer Credit Card
Consumer credit card lending represents primarily open-ended variable interest rate consumer credit card loans. These balances increased $55 million from year-end 2017 .
Other Consumer
Other consumer loans primarily include direct consumer loans, overdrafts and other revolving loans. Other consumer loans increased $56 million from year-end 2017 .
Regions qualitatively considers factors such as periodic updates of FICO scores, unemployment, home prices, and geography as credit quality indicators for consumer loans. FICO scores are obtained at origination and refreshed FICO scores are obtained by the Company quarterly for all consumer loans. The following tables present estimated current FICO score data for components of classes of the consumer portfolio segment. Current FICO data is not available for the remaining loans in the portfolio for various reasons; for example, if customers do not use sufficient credit, an updated score may not be available. Residential first mortgage and home equity balances with FICO scores below 620 were 5 percent of the combined portfolios for both December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017 .

62

Table of Contents




Table 14—Estimated Current FICO Score Ranges
 
December 31, 2018
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home Equity
 
Indirect-Vehicles
 
Indirect-Other Consumer
 
Consumer
Credit Card
 
Other
Consumer
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Below 620
$
700

 
$
239

 
$
142

 
$
272

 
$
56

 
$
98

 
$
69

620 - 680
747

 
429

 
259

 
332

 
212

 
229

 
148

681 - 720
1,270

 
708

 
376

 
384

 
405

 
288

 
223

Above 720
11,104

 
4,610

 
2,316

 
1,992

 
1,474

 
721

 
704

Data not available
455

 
128

 
50

 
73

 
202

 
9

 
77

 
$
14,276

 
$
6,114

 
$
3,143

 
$
3,053

 
$
2,349

 
$
1,345

 
$
1,221

 
 
December 31, 2017
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home Equity
 
Indirect - Vehicles
 
Indirect-Other Consumer
 
Consumer
Credit Card
 
Other
Consumer
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Below 620
$
741

 
$
261

 
$
161

 
$
328

 
$
43

 
$
85

 
$
72

620 - 680
829

 
492

 
300

 
396

 
153

 
220

 
146

681 - 720
1,353

 
775

 
435

 
419

 
246

 
288

 
227

Above 720
10,344

 
5,000

 
2,546

 
2,088

 
765

 
689

 
656

Data not available
794

 
138

 
56

 
95

 
260

 
8

 
64

 
$
14,061

 
$
6,666

 
$
3,498

 
$
3,326

 
$
1,467

 
$
1,290

 
$
1,165

Allowance for Credit Losses
The allowance for credit losses ("allowance") consists of two components: the allowance for loan losses and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments. The allowance for loan losses totaled $840 million at December 31, 2018 compared to $934 million at December 31, 2017 . The allowance for loan losses as a percentage of net loans decreased from 1.17 percent at December 31, 2017 to 1.01 percent as of December 31, 2018. The decrease in percentage is attributable to reductions in non-performing, criticized and TDR loans.
The provision for loan losses increased from $150 million in 2017 to $229 million in 2018 primarily as a result of increased loan balances and slowing credit improvement compared to 2017. The provision for loan losses was less than net charge-offs for 2018 by approximately $94 million, as a result of broad-based improvements in non-performing and criticized loans. Net charge-offs for 2018 were approximately $16 million higher as compared to 2017, reflecting an increase associated with growth in the indirect - other consumer loans and higher recoveries on commercial investor real estate mortgage loans in 2017. Additionally, lower than anticipated losses associated with certain 2017 hurricanes resulted in the release of the Company's $40 million hurricane-specific loan loss allowance during 2018. Lastly, a $16 million net reduction to the provision for loan losses from the first quarter of 2018 sale of $254 million in residential first mortgage loans consisting primarily of performing troubled debt restructured loans also contributed to the results.
Management expects that net loan charge-offs will be in the 0.40 percent to 0.50 percent range for the 2019 year; based on recent trends and current market conditions. Economic trends such as interest rates, unemployment, volatility in commodity prices and collateral valuations will impact the future levels of net charge-offs and may result in volatility in certain credit metrics. Additionally, changes in circumstances related to individually large credits or certain portfolios may result in volatility.
Details regarding the allowance and net charge-offs, including an analysis of activity from previous years' totals, are included in Table 15 “Allowance for Credit Losses.”
Refer to Note 1 "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies" to the consolidated financial statements for discussion regarding the pending accounting pronouncement that will replace the current incurred loss accounting model for the allowance for credit losses with a current expected credit loss approach (CECL), which will be effective for Regions on January 1, 2020.


63

Table of Contents




The table below summarizes activity in the allowance for credit losses for the years ended December 31 :
Table 15—Allowance for Credit Losses
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in millions)
Allowance for loan losses at January 1
$
934

 
$
1,091

 
$
1,106

 
$
1,103

 
$
1,341

Loans charged-off:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
130

 
159

 
120

 
130

 
114

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
18

 
17

 
22

 
24

 
63

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied

 

 
1

 

 
2

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
9

 
2

 
2

 
15

 
23

Commercial investor real estate construction

 

 

 

 
1

Residential first mortgage
14

 
11

 
15

 
26

 
36

Home equity
31

 
35

 
56

 
68

 
93

Indirect—vehicles
38

 
49

 
51

 
41

 
37

Indirect—other consumer
48

 
32

 
15

 

 

Consumer credit card
61

 
54

 
42

 
37

 
37

Other consumer
84

 
75

 
74

 
62

 
67

 
433

 
434

 
398

 
403

 
473

Recoveries of loans previously charged-off:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
37

 
33

 
32

 
51

 
51

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
8

 
9

 
11

 
16

 
16

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied

 

 

 

 

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
5

 
21

 
10

 
16

 
22

Commercial investor real estate construction
3

 
2

 
3

 
11

 
5

Residential first mortgage
6

 
4

 
3

 
8

 
8

Home equity
17

 
21

 
26

 
28

 
32

Indirect—vehicles
15

 
18

 
18

 
15

 
13

Indirect—other consumer

 
2

 
1

 

 

Consumer credit card
7

 
6

 
6

 
6

 
5

Other consumer
12

 
11

 
11

 
14

 
14

 
110

 
127

 
121

 
165

 
166

Net charge-offs (recoveries):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
93

 
126

 
88

 
79

 
63

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
10

 
8

 
11

 
8

 
47

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied

 

 
1

 

 
2

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
4

 
(19
)
 
(8
)
 
(1
)
 
1

Commercial investor real estate construction
(3
)
 
(2
)
 
(3
)
 
(11
)
 
(4
)
Residential first mortgage
8

 
7

 
12

 
18

 
28

Home equity
14

 
14

 
30

 
40

 
61

Indirect—vehicles
23

 
31

 
33

 
26

 
24

Indirect—other consumer
48

 
30

 
14

 

 

Consumer credit card
54

 
48

 
36

 
31

 
32

Other consumer
72

 
64

 
63

 
48

 
53

 
323

 
307

 
277

 
238

 
307

Provision for loan losses
229

 
150

 
262

 
241

 
69

Allowance for loan losses at December 31
$
840

 
$
934

 
$
1,091

 
$
1,106

 
$
1,103

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments at January 1
$
53

 
$
69

 
$
52

 
$
65

 
$
78

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(2
)
 
(16
)
 
17

 
(13
)
 
(13
)
Reserve for unfunded credit commitments at December 31
$
51

 
$
53

 
$
69

 
$
52

 
$
65

Allowance for credit losses at December 31
$
891

 
$
987

 
$
1,160

 
$
1,158

 
$
1,168

Loans, net of unearned income, outstanding at end of period
$
83,152

 
$
79,947

 
$
80,095

 
$
81,162

 
$
77,307

Average loans, net of unearned income, outstanding for the period
$
80,692

 
$
79,846

 
$
81,333

 
$
79,634

 
$
76,253

Ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses to loans, net of unearned income
1.01
%
 
1.17
%
 
1.36
%
 
1.36
%
 
1.43
%
Allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans, excluding loans held for sale
169
%
 
144
%
 
110
%
 
141
%
 
133
%
Net charge-offs as percentage of average loans, net of unearned income
0.40
%
 
0.38
%
 
0.34
%
 
0.30
%
 
0.40
%


64

Table of Contents




Allocation of the allowance for loan losses by portfolio segment and class is summarized as follows:
Table 16—Allocation of the Allowance for Loan Losses
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
421

 
47.2
%
 
$
455

 
45.2
%
 
$
585

 
43.7
%
 
$
549

 
44.1
%
 
$
428

 
42.4
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
91

 
6.7

 
127

 
7.7

 
161

 
8.6

 
200

 
9.3

 
214

 
10.7

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
8

 
0.5

 
9

 
0.4

 
7

 
0.4

 
9

 
0.5

 
12

 
0.5

Total commercial
520

 
54.4

 
591

 
53.3

 
753

 
52.7

 
758

 
53.9

 
654

 
53.6

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
42

 
5.6

 
42

 
5.1

 
54

 
5.1

 
69

 
5.3

 
122

 
6.0

Commercial investor real estate construction
16

 
2.1

 
22

 
2.2

 
31

 
3.0

 
28

 
3.3

 
28

 
2.8

Total investor real estate
58

 
7.7

 
64

 
7.3

 
85

 
8.1

 
97

 
8.6

 
150

 
8.8

Residential first mortgage
37

 
17.2

 
62

 
17.6

 
68

 
16.8

 
77

 
15.8

 
93

 
15.9

Home equity
29

 
11.1

 
40

 
12.7

 
45

 
13.3

 
67

 
13.5

 
90

 
14.1

Indirect—vehicles
26

 
3.7

 
34

 
4.2

 
39

 
5.0

 
33

 
4.9

 
41

 
4.7

Indirect—other consumer
61

 
2.8

 
34

 
1.8

 
15

 
1.2

 
5

 
0.7

 
3

 
0.3

Consumer credit card
67

 
1.6

 
66

 
1.6

 
45

 
1.5

 
40

 
1.3

 
46

 
1.3

Other consumer
42

 
1.5

 
43

 
1.5

 
41

 
1.4

 
29

 
1.3

 
26

 
1.3

Total consumer
262

 
37.9

 
279

 
39.4

 
253

 
39.2

 
251

 
37.5

 
299

 
37.6

 
$
840

 
100.0
%
 
$
934

 
100.0
%
 
$
1,091

 
100.0
%
 
$
1,106

 
100.0
%
 
$
1,103

 
100.0
%
TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS (TDRs)
TDRs are modified loans in which a concession is provided to a borrower experiencing financial difficulty. Residential first mortgage, home equity, consumer credit card and other consumer TDRs are consumer loans modified under the CAP. Commercial and investor real estate loan modifications are not the result of a formal program, but represent situations where modifications were offered as a workout alternative. Renewals of classified commercial and investor real estate loans are considered to be TDRs, even if no reduction in interest rate is offered, if the existing terms are considered to be below market. More detailed information is included in Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements. The following table summarizes the loan balance and related allowance for accruing and non-accruing TDRs for the periods ending December 31:

65

Table of Contents




Table 17—Troubled Debt Restructurings  
 
2018
 
2017
 
Loan
Balance
 
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
Loan
Balance
 
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
(In millions)
Accruing:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
$
108

 
$
17

 
$
232

 
$
27

Investor real estate
14

 
1

 
90

 
6

Residential first mortgage
170

 
16

 
368

 
36

Home equity
189

 
6

 
245

 
4

Consumer credit card
1

 

 
1

 

Other consumer
6

 

 
9

 

 
488

 
40

 
945

 
73

Non-accrual status or 90 days past due and still accruing:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
183

 
18

 
115

 
30

Investor real estate
5

 

 
1

 

Residential first mortgage
38

 
4

 
69

 
7

Home equity
15

 

 
14

 

 
241

 
22

 
199

 
37

Total TDRs - Loans
$
729

 
$
62

 
$
1,144

 
$
110

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
TDRs- Held For Sale
5

 

 
13

 

Total TDRs
$
734

 
$
62

 
$
1,157

 
$
110

_________
Note: All loans listed in the table above are considered impaired under applicable accounting literature.
The following table provides an analysis of the changes in commercial and investor real estate TDRs. TDRs with subsequent restructurings that meet the definition of a TDR are only reported as TDR inflows in the period they were first modified. Other than resolutions such as charge-offs, foreclosures, payments, sales and transfers to held for sale, Regions may remove loans from TDR classification if the following conditions are met: the borrower's financial condition improves such that the borrower is no longer in financial difficulty, the loan has not had any forgiveness of principal or interest, the loan has not been restructured as an "A" note/"B" note, the loan has been reported as a TDR over one fiscal year-end and the loan is subsequently refinanced or restructured at market terms such that it qualifies as a new loan.
For the consumer portfolio, changes in TDRs are primarily due to inflows from CAP modifications and outflows from payments and charge-offs. Given the types of concessions currently being granted under the CAP, as detailed in Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements, Regions does not expect that the market interest rate condition will be widely achieved. Therefore, Regions expects consumer loans modified through CAP to continue to be identified as TDRs for the remaining term of the loan.
Table 18—Analysis of Changes in Commercial and Investor Real Estate TDRs
 
2018
 
2017
 
Commercial
 
Investor
Real Estate
 
Commercial
 
Investor
Real Estate
 
(In millions)
Balance, beginning of period
$
347

 
$
91

 
$
520

 
$
95

Inflows
360

 
59

 
372

 
93

Outflows
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(46
)
 

 
(30
)
 
(1
)
Foreclosure

 

 
(2
)
 

Payments, sales and other (1)
(370
)
 
(131
)
 
(513
)
 
(96
)
Balance, end of period
$
291

 
$
19

 
$
347

 
$
91


66

Table of Contents




_________
(1)
The majority of this category consists of payments and sales. "Other" outflows include normal amortization/accretion of loan basis adjustments and loans transferred to held for sale. It also includes $31 million of commercial loans and $35 million of investor real estate loans refinanced or restructured as new loans and removed from TDR classification during 2018. During 2017, $63 million of commercial loans and $10 million of investor real estate loans were refinanced or restructured as new loans and removed from TDR classification.
NON-PERFORMING ASSETS
The following table presents non-performing assets as of December 31 :
Table 19—Non-Performing Assets
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in millions)
Non-performing loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
307

 
$
404

 
$
623

 
$
325

 
$
252

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
67

 
118

 
210

 
268

 
238

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
8

 
6

 
3

 
2

 
3

Total commercial
382

 
528

 
836

 
595

 
493

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
11

 
5

 
17

 
31

 
123

Commercial investor real estate construction

 
1

 

 

 
2

Total investor real estate
11

 
6

 
17

 
31

 
125

Residential first mortgage
40

 
47

 
50

 
63

 
109

Home equity
63

 
69

 
92

 
93

 
102

Total consumer
103

 
116

 
142

 
156

 
211

Total non-performing loans, excluding loans held for sale
496

 
650

 
995

 
782

 
829

Non-performing loans held for sale
10

 
17

 
13

 
38

 
38

Total non-performing loans (1)
506

 
667

 
1,008

 
820

 
867

Foreclosed properties
52

 
73

 
90

 
100

 
124

Non-marketable investments received in foreclosure
8

 

 

 

 

Total non-performing assets (1)
$
566

 
$
740

 
$
1,098

 
$
920

 
$
991

Accruing loans 90 days past due:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
8

 
$
4

 
$
6

 
$
9

 
$
7

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied

 
1

 
2

 
3

 
5

Total commercial
8

 
5

 
8

 
12

 
12

Commercial investor real estate mortgage

 
1

 

 
4

 
3

Total investor real estate

 
1

 

 
4

 
3

Residential first mortgage (2)
66

 
92

 
99

 
113

 
122

Home equity
34

 
37

 
33

 
59

 
63

Indirect—vehicles
9

 
9

 
10

 
9

 
7

Indirect—other consumer
1

 

 

 

 

Consumer credit card
20

 
19

 
15

 
12

 
12

Other consumer
5

 
4

 
5

 
4

 
3

Total consumer
135

 
161

 
162

 
197

 
207

 
$
143

 
$
167

 
$
170

 
$
213

 
$
222

Restructured loans not included in the categories above
$
488

 
$
945

 
$
1,010

 
$
1,039

 
$
1,260

Non-performing loans (1)  to loans and non-performing loans held for sale
0.61
%
 
0.83
%
 
1.26
%
 
1.01
%
 
1.12
%
Non-performing assets (1)  to loans, foreclosed properties and non-performing loans held for sale
0.68
%
 
0.92
%
 
1.37
%
 
1.13
%
 
1.28
%
_________
(1)
Excludes accruing loans 90 days past due.
(2)
Excludes residential first mortgage loans that are 100% guaranteed by the FHA and all guaranteed loans sold to the GNMA where Regions has the right but not the obligation to repurchase. Total 90 days or more past due guaranteed loans excluded were $84 million at December 31, 2018 , $124 million at December 31, 2017 , $113 million at December 31, 2016 , $107 million at December 31, 2015 and $125 million at December 31, 2014.

67

Table of Contents




Non-performing loans decreased during 2018 due to continued broad-based improvement in credit quality. Total commercial and investor real estate non-performing loans, excluding loans held for sale, that were paying as agreed (e.g., less than 30 days past due) represented approximately 48% percent of the total balance at December 31, 2018 .
Economic trends such as interest rates, unemployment, volatility in commodity prices, and collateral valuations will impact the future level of non-performing assets. Circumstances related to individually large credits could also result in volatility.
Total loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing, excluding government guaranteed loans, were $143 million at December 31, 2018 , a decrease from $167 million at December 31, 2017 .
At December 31, 2018 , Regions had approximately $75 million to $135 million of potential problem commercial and investor real estate loans that were not included in non-accrual loans, but for which management had concerns as to the ability of such borrowers to comply with their present loan repayment terms. This is a likely estimate of the amount of commercial and investor real estate loans that have the potential to migrate to non-accrual status in the next quarter.
In order to arrive at the estimate of potential problem loans, credit personnel forecast certain larger dollar loans that may potentially be downgraded to non-accrual at a future time, depending on the occurrence of future events. These personnel consider a variety of factors, including the borrower’s capacity and willingness to meet the contractual repayment terms, make principal curtailments or provide additional collateral when necessary, and provide current and complete financial information including global cash flows, contingent liabilities and sources of liquidity. Based upon the consideration of these factors, a probability weighting is assigned to loans to reflect the potential for migration to the pool of potential problem loans during this specific time period. Additionally, for other loans (for example, smaller dollar loans), a trend analysis is incorporated to determine the estimate of potential future downgrades. Because of the inherent uncertainty in forecasting future events, the estimate of potential problem loans ultimately represents the estimated aggregate dollar amounts of loans as opposed to an individual listing of loans.
The majority of the loans on which the potential problem loan estimate is based are considered criticized and classified. Detailed disclosures for substandard accrual loans (as well as other credit quality metrics) are included in Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.
The following table provides an analysis of non-accrual loans (excluding loans held for sale) by portfolio segment:
Table 20—Analysis of Non-Accrual Loans
 
Non-Accrual Loans, Excluding Loans Held for Sale as of December 31, 2018
 
Commercial
 
Investor
Real Estate
 
Consumer (1)
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
$
528

 
$
6

 
$
116

 
$
650

Additions
341

 
26

 

 
367

Net payments/other activity
(266
)
 

 
(10
)
 
(276
)
Return to accrual
(41
)
 
(2
)
 

 
(43
)
Charge-offs on non-accrual loans (2)
(136
)
 
(9
)
 

 
(145
)
Transfers to held for sale (3)
(36
)
 
(1
)
 
(3
)
 
(40
)
Transfers to foreclosed properties
(3
)
 

 

 
(3
)
Sales
(5
)
 
(9
)
 

 
(14
)
Balance at end of year
$
382

 
$
11

 
$
103

 
$
496

 
Non-Accrual Loans, Excluding Loans Held for Sale as of December 31, 2017
 
Commercial
 
Investor
Real Estate
 
Consumer (1)
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
$
836

 
$
17

 
$
142

 
$
995

Additions
528

 
8

 

 
536

Net payments/other activity
(500
)
 
(7
)
 
(26
)
 
(533
)
Return to accrual
(131
)
 
(8
)
 

 
(139
)
Charge-offs on non-accrual loans (2)
(169
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(170
)
Transfers to held for sale (3)
(31
)
 
(2
)
 

 
(33
)
Transfers to foreclosed properties
(4
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(5
)
Sales
(1
)
 

 

 
(1
)
Balance at end of year
$
528

 
$
6

 
$
116

 
$
650


68

Table of Contents




________
(1)
All net activity within the consumer portfolio segment other than sales and transfers to held for sale (including related charge-offs) is included as a single net number within the net payments/other activity line.
(2)
Includes charge-offs on loans on non-accrual status and charge-offs taken upon sale and transfer of non-accrual loans to held for sale.
(3)
Transfers to held for sale are shown net of charge-offs of $12 million and $19 million recorded upon transfer for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
Other Earning Assets
Other earning assets consist primarily of FRB and FHLB stock, marketable equity securities and operating lease assets . The balance at December 31, 2018 totaled $1.7 billion compared to $1.9 billion at December 31, 2017. Refer to Note 8 "Other Earning Assets" to the consolidated financial statements for additional information.
Goodwill
Goodwill totaled $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018 and $4.9 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decline in goodwill is due to the sale of Regions Insurance Group, Inc. within the Wealth Management reportable segment. See Note 3 for more information related to this transaction. Refer to the “Critical Accounting Policies” section earlier in this report for detailed discussions of the Company’s methodology for testing goodwill for impairment. Refer to Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 10 “Intangible Assets” to the consolidated financial statements for the methodologies and assumptions used in the goodwill impairment analysis.
Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights at Fair Value
Residential MSRs increased approximately $82 million from December 31, 2017 to December 31, 2018 . The year-over-year increase is primarily due to purchases of the rights to service approximately $6.1 billion in residential mortgage loans for approximately $77 million, combined with additions resulting from loans sold during the year with Regions retaining the servicing rights. These total additions were partially offset by the economic amortization associated with borrower repayments. An analysis of residential MSRs is presented in Note 7 “Servicing of Financial Assets” to the consolidated financial statements.
Deposits
Regions competes with other banking and financial services companies for a share of the deposit market. Regions’ ability to compete in the deposit market depends heavily on the pricing of its deposits and how effectively the Company meets customers’ needs. Regions employs various means to meet those needs and enhance competitiveness, such as providing a high level of customer service, competitive pricing and convenient branch locations for its customers. Regions also serves customers through providing centralized, high-quality banking services and alternative product delivery channels such as mobile and internet banking.
Deposits are Regions’ primary source of funds, providing funding for 87 percent of average earning assets in 2018 and 89 percent of average earning assets in 2017 . Table 21 “Deposits” details year-over-year deposits on a period-ending basis. Total deposits at December 31, 2018 decreased approximately $2.4 billion compared to year-end 2017 levels. The decrease in deposits was primarily driven by decreases in money market accounts, non-interest-bearing demand accounts, and interest-bearing transaction accounts. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in savings accounts and time deposits.
Deposit costs have increased to 26 basis points for 2018 , compared to 16 basis points for 2017 and 12 basis points for 2016 due to a continuation of interest rate increases, and in particular, increases in the Federal Funds target range in 2018. The rate paid on interest-bearing deposits increased to 0.42 percent in 2018 compared to 0.26 percent for 2017 and 0.19 percent for 2016. Low deposit costs are driven primarily by the composition of the Company's deposit base, which includes a significant amount of low-cost, and relatively small account balance consumer and private wealth deposits. Low-cost deposits are also heavily concentrated in non-interest bearing demand deposits. The deposit base composition is a key component of the Company's franchise value and is expected to be a competitive advantage in a rising rate environment.
The following table summarizes deposits by category as of December 31 :

69

Table of Contents




Table 21—Deposits
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Non-interest-bearing demand
$
35,053

 
$
36,127

 
$
36,046

Savings
8,788

 
8,413

 
7,840

Interest-bearing transaction
19,175

 
20,161

 
20,259

Money market—domestic
24,111

 
25,306

 
27,293

Money market—foreign

 
23

 
186

Low-cost deposits
87,127

 
90,030

 
91,624

Time deposits
7,364

 
6,859

 
7,183

Customer deposits
94,491

 
96,889

 
98,807

Corporate treasury time deposits

 

 
228

 
$
94,491

 
$
96,889

 
$
99,035

Non-interest-bearing demand deposits decreased $1.1 billion to $35.1 billion at year-end 2018 due primarily to commercial customers using liquidity to pay down debt or invest in their businesses. Non-interest-bearing deposits accounted for approximately 37 percent of total deposits at both year-end 2018 and 2017 .
Savings balances increased $375 million to $8.8 billion, generally reflecting continued consumer savings trends.
Interest-bearing transaction accounts decreased $986 million to $19.2 billion primarily as a result of certain trust customer deposits, which require collateralization by securities, continuing to shift out of deposits and into other fee income-producing customer investments.
Domestic money market accounts decreased $1.2 billion to $24.1 billion at year-end 2018 as the result of a decision to reduce higher-cost retail brokered sweep deposits that were no longer a necessary component of the Company's funding strategy. Domestic money market accounts accounted for approximately 26 percent of total deposits at year-end for both 2018 and 2017 .
Included in time deposits are certificates of deposit and individual retirement accounts. The balance of time deposits increased $505 million in 2018 to $7.4 billion compared to $6.9 billion in 2017 due primarily to higher rates offered in 2018 on certificates of deposit accounts resulting in account growth. Time deposits accounted for 8 percent of total deposits in 2018 and 7 percent of total deposits in 2017 . See Table 22 “Maturity of Time Deposits of $100,000 or More” for maturity information.

Table 22—Maturity of Time Deposits of $100,000 or More
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Time deposits of $100,000 or more, maturing in:
 
 
 
3 months or less
$
957

 
$
676

Over 3 through 6 months
387

 
220

Over 6 through 12 months
595

 
492

Over 12 months
1,578

 
1,606

 
$
3,517

 
$
2,994

Short-Term Borrowings
See Note 12 “Short-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements for a summary of these borrowings at December 31, 2018 and 2017 . The levels of these borrowings can fluctuate depending on the Company’s funding needs and the sources utilized.
Short-term secured borrowings, such as securities sold under agreements to repurchase and FHLB advances, are a core portion of Regions' funding strategy.
The securities financing market and specifically short-term FHLB advances continue to provide reliable funding at attractive rates. See the "Liquidity Risk" section for further detail of Regions' borrowing capacity with the FHLB.

70

Table of Contents




Long-Term Borrowings
Total long-term borrowings increased approximately $4.3 billion to $12.4 billion at December 31, 2018 . The increase was primarily due to a $3.2 billion increase in FHLB advances and $2.4 billion in senior notes issuances. These increases were partially offset by maturities and a redemption of notes totaling approximately $1.3 billion during the year.
See Note 13 “Long-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion and detailed listing of outstandings and rates.
Ratings
Table 23 “Credit Ratings” reflects the debt ratings information of Regions Financial Corporation and Regions Bank by Standard and Poor's ("S&P"), Moody’s, Fitch and Dominion Bond Rating Service ("DBRS") as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 .
Table 23—Credit Ratings 
 
As of December 31, 2018
 
S&P
Moody’s
Fitch
DBRS
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
 
 
Senior unsecured debt
BBB+
Baa2
BBB+
AL
Subordinated debt
BBB
Baa2
BBB
BBBH
Regions Bank
 
 
 
 
Short-term
A-2
P-1
F2
R-IL
Long-term bank deposits
N/A
A2
A-
A
Long-term rating
A-
A2
BBB+
N/A
Senior unsecured debt
A-
Baa2
BBB+
A
Subordinated debt
BBB+
Baa2
BBB
AL
Outlook
Stable
Positive
Stable
Stable
 
As of December 31, 2017
 
S&P
Moody’s
Fitch
DBRS
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
 
 
Senior unsecured debt
BBB+
Baa2
BBB+
BBBH
Subordinated debt
BBB
Baa2
BBB
BBB
Regions Bank
 
 
 
 
Short-term
A-2
P-1
F2
R-1L
Long-term bank deposits
N/A
A2
A-
AL
Long-term rating
A-
A2
BBB+
N/A
Senior unsecured debt
A-
Baa2
BBB+
AL
Subordinated debt
BBB+
Baa2
BBB
BBBH
Outlook
Stable
Stable
Stable
Positive
_________
N/A - not applicable.
On December 20, 2018, Moody’s revised the outlook for Regions Financial Corporation, and its subsidiary, Regions Bank to Positive from Stable, indicating a possible one-notch upgrade over the next two years.  The outlook upgrade reflected the Company’s improved risk asset mix, enhanced risk management and the improvements in profitability as well as a solid balance sheet and strong liquidity profile.
On November 8, 2018, DBRS upgraded the ratings of Regions Financial Corporation, including the Company’s senior unsecured debt rating to A (Low) from BBB (High). At the same time, DBRS upgraded the ratings of Regions Bank, including the Company’s long-term bank deposits to A from A (Low), as well as, the senior unsecured debt to A from A (Low). DBRS attributed the upgrade to the progress the Company has made improving credit fundamentals, including stronger financial results, more rigorous risk management and improved asset quality.
In general, ratings agencies base their ratings on many quantitative and qualitative factors, including capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix, probability of government support, and level and quality of earnings. Any downgrade in credit ratings by one or more ratings agencies may impact Regions in several ways, including, but not limited to, Regions’ access to the capital markets or short-term funding, borrowing cost and capacity, collateral requirements, and acceptability of its letters

71





of credit, thereby potentially adversely impacting Regions’ financial condition and liquidity. See the “Risk Factors” section of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for more information.
A security rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities, and the ratings are subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the assigning rating agency. Each rating should be evaluated independently of any other rating.
Stockholders' Equity
Stockholders’ equity was $15.1 billion at December 31, 2018 as compared to $16.2 billion at December 31, 2017. During 2018, net income increased stockholders’ equity by $1.8 billion. Cash dividends on common stock and cash dividends on preferred stock reduced stockholders' equity by $493 million and $64 million, respectively. Common stock repurchased during 2018 reduced stockholders' equity by $2.1 billion. These shares were immediately retired and therefore are not included in treasury stock. Changes in accumulated other comprehensive income reduced stockholders' equity by $215 million, primarily due to the net change in unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale as a result of increases in market interest rates during 2018.
On June 28, 2018, Regions received no objection from the Federal Reserve to its 2018 capital plan that was submitted as part of the CCAR process, which included the repurchase of common shares and a common stock dividend increase.
See Note 15 “Stockholders’ Equity and Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)” to the consolidated financial statements for additional information.
REGULATORY REQUIREMENTS
CAPITAL RULES
Regions and Regions Bank are required to comply with regulatory capital requirements established by Federal and State banking agencies. These regulatory capital requirements involve quantitative measures of the Company's assets, liabilities and selected off-balance sheet items, and also qualitative judgments by the regulators. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can subject the Company to a series of increasingly restrictive regulatory actions. See Note 14 "Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions" to the consolidated financial statements for a tabular presentation of the applicable holding company and bank regulatory capital requirements.
Under the Basel III Rules, Regions is designated as a standardized approach bank and, as such, began transitioning to the Basel III Rules in January 2015 subject to a phase-in period extending to January 2019. The Basel III Rules are now fully phased in, other than with respect to deductions and adjustments as described below, and among other things, (i) impose a capital measure called CET1, (ii) specify that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting specified requirements, (iii) define CET1 narrowly by requiring that most deductions/adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital and (iv) expand the scope of the deductions/adjustments to capital as compared to prior regulations. The Basel III Rules also prescribe a standardized approach for risk-weightings of assets and off-balance sheet exposures to derive the capital ratios.
Additionally, the Basel III Rules impose a capital conservation buffer designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. The capital conservation buffer is on top of minimum risk-weighted asset ratios and is equal to the lowest difference between the three risk-based capital ratios less the applicable minimum required ratio. As of January 1, 2019, the capital conservation buffer is fully phased in and is 2.5% of CET1 to risk-weighted assets. In addition, the Basel III Rules provide for a countercyclical capital buffer applicable only to advanced approach institutions, and therefore not currently applicable to Regions or Regions Bank. Banking institutions with ratios that are above the minimum but below the combined capital conservation buffer and countercyclical capital buffer, when applicable, face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of the shortfall and the institution’s ERI. ERI is compiled using the past four quarter trailing net income, net of distributions and tax effects not reflected in net income.
The Basel III Rules provide for a number of deductions from and adjustments to CET1. For example, goodwill and selected other intangible assets, and disallowed deferred tax assets are deducted. MSRs, certain other deferred tax assets and significant investments in non-consolidated financial entities are also deducted from CET1 to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10% of CET1 or all such categories in the aggregate exceed 15% of CET1. Under the Basel III Rules, the effects of certain accumulated other comprehensive items are included; however, standardized approach banking organizations, including Regions and Regions Bank, were allowed to make a one-time permanent election to exclude these items. Regions and Regions Bank made this election in order to avoid significant variations in the level of capital, including the impact of interest rate fluctuations on the fair value of their securities portfolios.
Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 began on January 1, 2015 and was to be phased in over a 4-year period, beginning at 40% on January 1, 2015 and an additional 20% per year thereafter. In September 2017, the federal banking agencies proposed to revise and simplify the capital treatment of selected categories of deferred tax assets, MSRs, investments in non-consolidated financial entities and minority interests for banking organizations, such as Regions and Regions Bank, that are not subject to the advanced approach. In November 2017, the federal banking agencies revised the Basel III Rules

72





to extend the current transitional treatment of these items for standardized approach banking organizations until the September 2017 proposal is finalized. The September 2017 proposal would also change the capital treatment of high volatility commercial real estate loans under the standardized approach. These changes would have the impact of increasing regulatory capital ratios for some standardized approach banking organizations such as Regions. Regions continues to review the proposal and its impact on the Company’s capital requirements.
In December 2017, the Basel Committee published standards that it described as the finalization of the Basel III post-crisis regulatory reforms (the standards are commonly referred to as “Basel IV”). Among other things, these standards revise the Basel Committee’s standardized approach for credit risk (including by recalibrating risk-weights and introducing new capital requirements for certain “unconditionally cancellable commitments,” such as unused credit card lines of credit) and provide a new standardized approach for operational risk capital. Under the Basel framework, these standards will generally be effective on January 1, 2022, with an aggregate output floor phasing in through January 1, 2027. Under the current U.S. capital rules, operational risk capital requirements and a capital floor apply only to advanced approach institutions, and not to Regions or Regions Bank. The impact of Basel IV on the Company will depend on the manner in which it is implemented by the federal banking regulators.
On April 10, 2018, the federal banking agencies issued a proposal to simplify capital rules for large banks. The proposal introduces a SCB, which would replace the existing capital conservation buffer and incorporate forward-looking stress test results into non-stress capital requirements. The SCB, subject to a minimum of 2.5%, would reflect stressed losses in the supervisory severely adverse scenario of the Federal Reserve’s supervisory stress tests and would also include four quarters of planned common stock dividends. Details of this proposal are discussed under the “Supervision and Regulation—Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review and Stress Testing” section of the “Business” section of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Although the proposal, if adopted, would change the way in which the minimum capital ratios are calculated, firms would continue to be subject to progressively more stringent constraints on capital actions as they approach the minimum ratios.
In December 2018, the federal banking agencies issued a final rule that amends regulatory capital rules to provide banks with the option to phase in the day-one effects on regulatory capital that may result from adoption of the new current expected credit losses accounting standard (see the "Recent Accounting Pronouncements and Accounting Changes" section in Note 1 "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies"). Additionally, the agencies finalized amendments to stress testing regulations which delay incorporation of the new accounting standard in stress testing until the 2020 stress test cycle.
EGRRCPA was enacted on May 24, 2018, and makes limited amendments to the Dodd-Frank Act as well as modifications to certain other post-crisis regulatory requirements. With respect to capital requirements, EGRRCPA would make Regions no longer subject to company-run stress testing requirements and change Regions’ supervisory stress testing cycle from annual to biennial. In October 2018, the federal banking agencies proposed rules that would tailor the application of enhanced prudential standards per the EGRRCPA and would assign each institution with $100 billion or more in total consolidated assets, as well as its bank subsidiaries, to one of four categories based on its size and five risk-based indicators. According to the Federal Reserve’s projections, Regions would be a “Category IV” institution. Broader discussion of the impact of EGRRCPA on Regions and Regions Bank is included under the “Supervision and Regulation” section of the “Business” section of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
On February 5, 2019, the Federal Reserve provided relief to BHCs with assets between $100 billion and $250 billion, including Regions, in the form of a one-year extension to the requirement to submit a capital plan to the Federal Reserve. Thus, Regions must submit a capital plan to the Federal Reserve by April 5, 2020, rather than April 5, 2019. In addition, Regions is not subject to the supervisory capital stress testing or the company-run capital stress testing requirements for 2019. However, Regions is still required to maintain a capital plan that is reviewed and approved by Regions’ Board of Directors. Furthermore, while Regions is not required to submit a full capital plan to the Federal Reserve in 2019, the Company is required to submit its planned capital actions for the period between July 1, 2019 and June 30, 2020. The Federal Reserve has announced that for the period from July 1, 2019 through June 30, 2020, Regions, like other firms granted an extension, is approved to make capital distributions up to the amount that would have allowed the firm to remain above all minimum capital requirements in CCAR 2018, adjusted for any changes in Regions’ regulatory capital ratios since the Federal Reserve acted on Regions’ 2018 capital plan.
Additional discussion of the Basel III Rules and their applicability to Regions is included in Note 14 "Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions" to the consolidated financial statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
LIQUIDITY COVERAGE RATIO
Regions is currently subject to the Basel III-based U.S. LCR rule, which is a quantitative liquidity metric designed to ensure that a covered bank or BHC maintains an adequate level of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets under an acute 30-day liquidity stress scenario. Following the threshold amendments recently made by EGRRCPA, the LCR rule currently applies in a modified, less stringent, form to BHCs, such as Regions, having $100 billion or more but less than $250 billion in total consolidated assets and less than $10 billion in total on-balance sheet foreign exposure. However, on October 31, 2018, the Federal Reserve, the OCC and the FDIC proposed rules that would, among other things, make institutions such as Regions with less than $250 billion in total consolidated assets no longer subject to the LCR requirement. The LCR rule also imposes a monthly calculation requirement. In December 2016, the Federal Reserve issued a final rule on the public disclosure of the LCR calculation that requires BHCs, such

73





as Regions, to disclose publicly, on a quarterly basis, quantitative and qualitative information about certain components of its LCR beginning with results from the fourth quarter of 2018.
At December 31, 2018 , the Company was fully compliant with the LCR requirements. Changes in the mix and size of the Company's balance sheet and investment portfolio are likely to occur in the future, and additional funding may need to be sourced to remain compliant.
See the “Supervision and Regulation—Liquidity Regulation” subsection of the “Business” section and the “Risk Factors” section for more information.
OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS
Regions periodically invests in various limited partnerships that sponsor affordable housing projects, which are funded through a combination of debt and equity. See Note 2 “Variable Interest Entities” to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion.
Regions' off-balance sheet credit risk includes obligations for loans sold with recourse, unfunded loan commitments, and letters of credit. See Note 7 "Servicing of Financial Assets" and Note 24 "Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees" to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion.
EFFECTS OF INFLATION
The majority of assets and liabilities of a financial institution are monetary in nature; therefore, a financial institution differs greatly from most commercial and industrial companies, which have significant investments in fixed assets or inventories that are greatly impacted by inflation. While the implications differ for a bank, inflation does have influence on the growth of total assets in the banking industry and the resulting level of capitalization. Inflation also affects the level of market interest rates, and therefore, the pricing of financial instruments.
Management believes the most significant potential impact of inflation on financial results is a direct result of Regions’ ability to manage the impact of changes in interest rates. The Company maintains an asset sensitive position as of December 31, 2018 . Refer to Table 24 “Interest Rate Sensitivity” for additional details on Regions’ interest rate sensitivity.
EFFECTS OF DEFLATION
A period of deflation would affect all industries, including financial institutions. Potentially, deflation could lead to lower profits, higher unemployment, lower production and deterioration in overall economic conditions. In addition, deflation could depress economic activity and impair bank earnings through reduced balance sheet growth and less favorable product pricing, as well as impairment in the ability of borrowers to repay loans.
Management believes the most significant potential impact of deflation on financial results relates to Regions’ ability to maintain a sufficient amount of capital to cushion against future market and credit related losses. However, the Company can utilize certain risk management tools to help it maintain its balance sheet strength even if a deflationary scenario were to develop.
RISK MANAGEMENT
Regions is exposed to various risks as part of the normal course of operations. The exposure to risk requires sound risk management practices that comprise an integrated and comprehensive set of programs and processes that apply to the entire Company. Accordingly, Regions has established a risk management framework to manage risks and provide reasonable assurance of the achievement of the Company’s strategic objectives.
The primary risk exposures identified and managed through the Company’s risk management framework are market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, operational risk, legal risk, compliance risk, reputational risk and strategic risk.
Market risk is the risk to Regions’ financial condition resulting from adverse movements in market rates or prices, such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates or equity prices.
Liquidity risk is the potential that the Company will be unable to meet its obligations as they come due because of an inability to liquidate assets or obtain adequate funding (referred to as "funding liquidity risk") or the potential that it cannot easily unwind or offset specific exposures without significantly lowering market prices because of inadequate market depth or market disruptions (referred to as "market liquidity risk").
Credit risk is the risk that arises from the potential that a borrower or counterparty will fail to perform on an obligation.
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people, and systems or from external events.
Legal risk is the risk that arises from the potential that unenforceable contracts, lawsuits, or adverse judgments can disrupt or otherwise negatively affect the operations or condition of the Company.

74


Compliance risk is the risk to current or anticipated earnings or capital arising from violations of laws, rules, or regulations, or from non-conformance with prescribed practices, internal policies and procedures, or ethical standards.
Reputational risk is the potential that negative publicity regarding Regions' business practices, whether true or not, will cause a decline in the customer base, costly litigation, or revenue reductions.
Strategic risk is the risk to current or projected financial condition and resilience from adverse business decisions, poor implementation of business decisions, or lack of responsiveness to changes in the banking industry and operating environment.
Several of these primary risk exposures are expanded upon further within the remaining sections of Management's Discussion and Analysis.
Regions’ risk management framework outlines the Company’s approach for managing risk that includes the following four components:
Culture - A strong, collaborative risk culture ensures focus on risk in all activities and encourages the necessary mindset and behavior to enable effective risk management and promote sound risk-taking within the bounds of the Company’s risk appetite. Our risk culture requires that risks be promptly identified, escalated, and challenged; thereby, benefiting the overall performance of the Company.
Appetite - The Company's risk appetite statements define the types and levels of risk the Company is willing to take to achieve its objectives.
Process - Effective risk management requires sustainable processes and tools to effectively identify, measure, mitigate, monitor, and report risk.
Governance - Governance serves as the foundation for comprehensive management of risks facing the Company. It outlines clear responsibility and accountability for managing, monitoring, escalating, and reporting both existing and emerging risks.
Clearly defined roles and responsibilities are critical to the effective management of risk and are central to the four components of the Company’s approach to risk management. Regions utilizes the Three Lines of Defense concept to clearly designate risk management activities within the Company.
1st Line of Defense activities provide for the identification, acceptance and ownership of risks.
2nd Line of Defense activities provide for objective oversight of the Company’s risk-taking activities and assessment of the Company’s aggregate risk levels.
3rd Line of Defense activities provide for independent reviews and assessments of risk management practices across the Company.
The Board provides the highest level of risk management governance. The principal risk management functions of the Board are to oversee processes for evaluating the adequacy of internal controls, risk management, financial reporting and compliance with laws and regulations. The Board has designated an Audit Committee of outside directors to focus on oversight of management's establishment and maintenance of appropriate disclosure controls and procedures over financial reporting. See the "Financial Disclosures and Internal Controls" section of Management's Discussion and Analysis for additional information. The Board has also designated a Risk Committee of outside directors to focus on Regions’ overall risk profile. The Risk Committee annually approves an Enterprise Risk Appetite Statement that reflects core business principles and strategic vision by including quantitative limits and qualitative statements that are organized by risk type. This statement is designed to be a high-level document that sets the tone for the Board’s risk appetite, which is the maximum amount of risk the Company is willing to accept in pursuit of its business objectives. By establishing boundaries around risk taking and business decisions, and by incorporating the needs and goals of its stockholders, regulators, customers and other stakeholders, the Company’s risk appetite is aligned with its strategic priorities and goals.
The Risk Management Group, led by the Company’s Chief Risk Officer, ensures the consistent application of Regions’ risk management approach within the structure of the Company’s operating, capital and strategic plans. The primary activities of the Risk Management Group include:
Interpreting internal and external signals that point to possible risk issues for the Company;
Identifying risks and determining which Company areas and/or products will be affected;
Ensuring there are mechanisms in place to specifically determine how risks will affect the Company as a whole and the individual area and or product;

75


Assisting business groups in analyzing trends and ensuring Company areas have appropriate risk identification and mitigation processes in place; and
Reviewing the limits, parameters, policies, and procedures in place to ensure the continued appropriateness of risk controls.
As part of its ongoing assessment process, the Risk Management Group makes recommendations to management and the Risk Committee of the Board regarding adjustments to these controls as conditions or risk tolerances change. In addition, the Internal Audit division provides an independent assessment of the Company’s internal control structure and related systems and processes.
Management, with the assistance of the Risk Management Group, follows a formal process for identifying, measuring and documenting key risks facing each business group and determining how those risks can be controlled or mitigated, as well as how the controls can be monitored to ensure they are effective. The Risk Committee receives reports from management to ensure operations are within the limits established by the Enterprise Risk Appetite Statement.
Some of the more significant processes used by management to manage and control risks are described in the remainder of this report. External factors beyond management’s control may result in losses despite the Risk Management Group’s efforts.
MARKET RISK—INTEREST RATE RISK
Regions’ primary market risk is interest rate risk. This includes uncertainty with respect to absolute interest rate levels as well as relative interest rate levels, which are impacted by both the shape and the slope of the various yield curves that affect the financial products and services that the Company offers. To quantify this risk, Regions measures the change in its net interest income and other financing income in various interest rate scenarios compared to a base case scenario. Net interest income and other financing income sensitivity to market rate movements is a useful short-term indicator of Regions’ interest rate risk.
Sensitivity Measurement —Financial simulation models are Regions’ primary tools used to measure interest rate exposure. Using a wide range of sophisticated simulation techniques provides management with extensive information on the potential impact to net interest income and other financing income caused by changes in interest rates. Models are structured to simulate cash flows and accrual characteristics of Regions’ balance sheet. Assumptions are made about the direction and volatility of interest rates, the slope of the yield curve, and the changing composition of the balance sheet that results from both strategic plans and from customer behavior. Among the assumptions are expectations of balance sheet growth and composition, the pricing and maturity characteristics of existing business and the characteristics of future business. Interest rate-related risks are expressly considered, such as pricing spreads, the pricing of deposit accounts, prepayments and other option risks. Regions considers these factors, as well as the degree of certainty or uncertainty surrounding their future behavior.
The primary objective of asset/liability management at Regions is to coordinate balance sheet composition with interest rate risk management to sustain reasonable and stable net interest income and other financing income throughout various interest rate cycles. In computing interest rate sensitivity for measurement, Regions compares a set of alternative interest rate scenarios to the results of a base case scenario derived using “market forward rates.” The standard set of interest rate scenarios includes the traditional instantaneous parallel rate shifts of plus 100 and 200 basis points. Given low market rates by historical standards, the Company continues to focus on the minus 100 basis point shock. While not presented, rising and falling rate scenarios of greater magnitude are also analyzed. In addition to parallel curve shifts, multiple curve steepening and flattening scenarios are contemplated. Regions includes simulations of gradual interest rate movements phased in over a six-month period that may more realistically mimic the speed of potential interest rate movements.
Exposure to Interest Rate Movements— As of December 31, 2018 , Regions was asset sensitive to both gradual and instantaneous parallel yield curve shifts as compared to the base case for the measurement horizon ending December 2019 . The estimated exposure associated with the parallel yield curve shift of minus 100 basis points in the table below reflects the combined impacts of movements in short-term and long-term interest rates. The decline in short-term interest rates (such as the Fed Funds rate, the rate of Interest on Excess Reserves and 1 month LIBOR) will lead to a reduction of yield on assets and liabilities contractually tied to such rates. Recent Fed Funds increases have resulted in only modest increases in deposit and other funding costs for Regions. Therefore, it is expected that declines in funding costs will only partially offset the decline in asset yields. A reduction in intermediate and long-term interest rates (such as intermediate to longer-term U.S. Treasuries, swap and mortgage rates) will drive yields lower on certain fixed rate, newly originated or renewed loans, reduce prospective yields on certain investment portfolio purchases, and increase amortization of premium expense on existing securities in the investment portfolio. At current rate levels, the interest income sensitivity afforded by potential further extension of investment securities and the resulting impact on premium amortization is reduced, making intermediate and long-term interest rate sensitivity primarily attributable to changes in the level of reinvestment yields on fixed rate assets.
With respect to sensitivity along the yield curve, the balance sheet is estimated to be asset sensitive to short-term, intermediate-term, and long-term rates individually. Current simulation models estimate that, as compared to the base case, net interest income and other financing income over a 12 month horizon would respond favorably by approximately $78 million if intermediate and

76





longer-term interest rates were to immediately and on a sustained basis exceed the base scenario by 100 basis points. Conversely, if intermediate and longer-term interest rates were to immediately and on a sustained basis underperform the base case by 100 basis points, then net interest income and other financing income, as compared to the base case, would decline by approximately $104 million.
The table below summarizes Regions' positioning in various parallel yield curve shifts (i.e., including both long-term and short-term interest rates). The scenarios are inclusive of all interest rate risk hedging activities. Forward starting hedges that have been transacted are contemplated to the extent they start within the measurement horizon. Forward starting hedging relationships are currently being used to protect net interest income as the macroeconomic cycle continues to evolve.
Table 24—Interest Rate Sensitivity
 
Estimated Annual Change
in Net Interest Income and Other Financing Income
December 31, 2018
 
(In millions)
Gradual Change in Interest Rates
 
+ 200 basis points
$
196

+ 100 basis points
105

- 100 basis points
(119
)
 
 
Instantaneous Change in Interest Rates
 
+ 200 basis points
$
186

+ 100 basis points
110

- 100 basis points
(168
)
As discussed above, the interest rate sensitivity analysis presented in Table 24 is informed by a variety of assumptions and estimates regarding the progression of the balance sheet in both the baseline scenario as well as the scenarios of instantaneous and gradual shifts in the yield curve. Though there are many assumptions which affect the estimates for net interest income and other financing income, those pertaining to deposit pricing, deposit mix and overall balance sheet composition are particularly impactful. Given the uncertainties associated with the prolonged period of low interest rates, management evaluates the impact to its sensitivity analysis of these key assumptions. Sensitivity calculations are hypothetical and should not be considered to be predictive of future results.
The Company’s baseline balance sheet growth assumptions include moderate loan and deposit growth reflecting management's best estimate. The behavior of deposits in response to changes in interest rate levels is largely informed by analyses of prior rate cycles, but with suitable adjustments based on management’s expectations in the current rate environment. In the + 100 basis point gradual interest rate change scenario in Table 24, the interest-bearing deposit re-pricing sensitivity over the 12 month horizon is expected to be between 60 percent and 70 percent of changes in short-term market rates (e.g. Fed Funds). Recently observed market rate movements have yielded higher levels of asset sensitivity than modeled due primarily to outperformance in deposit betas as compared to the model assumption. A 5 percentage point lower sensitivity than the baseline assumption would increase 12 month net interest income and other financing income in the gradual +100 basis points scenario by approximately $29 million. While the estimates should be used as a guide, differences may result driven by the pace of rate changes, and other market and competitive factors.
Similarly, management assumes that the change in the mix of deposits in a rising rate environment versus the baseline balance sheet growth assumptions is informed by analyses of prior rate cycles. Management assumes that in rising rate scenarios, some shift from non-interest bearing to interest-bearing products will occur. As the rate cycle has progressed and a mix shift has become inherent in the baseline forecast, management has reduced the sensitivity impact on the shock scenarios. The magnitude of the shift is rate dependent and equates to approximately $1.5 billion over 12 months in the gradual +100 basis point scenario in Table 24. In the event this shift increased by an additional $1.5 billion over 12 months, the result would be a reduction of 12 month net interest income and other financing income in the gradual +100 basis points scenario by approximately $17 million.
Interest rate movements may also have an impact on the value of Regions’ securities portfolio, which can directly impact the carrying value of stockholders’ equity. Regions from time to time may hedge these price movements with derivatives (as discussed below).
Derivatives —Regions uses financial derivative instruments for management of interest rate sensitivity. ALCO, which consists of members of Regions’ senior management team, in its oversight role for the management of interest rate sensitivity, approves the use of derivatives in balance sheet hedging strategies. Derivatives are also used to offset the risks associated with customer derivatives, which include interest rate, credit and foreign exchange risks. The most common derivatives Regions employs are

77





forward rate contracts, Eurodollar futures contracts, interest rate swaps, options on interest rate swaps, interest rate caps and floors, and forward sale commitments.
Forward rate contracts are commitments to buy or sell financial instruments at a future date at a specified price or yield. A Eurodollar futures contract is a future on a Eurodollar deposit. Eurodollar futures contracts subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates. Because futures contracts are cash settled daily, there is minimal credit risk associated with Eurodollar futures. Interest rate swaps are contractual agreements typically entered into to exchange fixed for variable (or vice versa) streams of interest payments. The notional principal is not exchanged but is used as a reference for the size of interest settlements. Interest rate options are contracts that allow the buyer to purchase or sell a financial instrument at a predetermined price and time. Forward sale commitments are contractual obligations to sell market instruments at a future date for an already agreed-upon price. Foreign currency contracts involve the exchange of one currency for another on a specified date and at a specified rate. These contracts are executed on behalf of the Company's customers and are used by customers to manage fluctuations in foreign exchange rates. The Company is subject to the credit risk that another party will fail to perform.
Regions has made use of interest rate swaps and floors in balance sheet hedging strategies to effectively convert a portion of its fixed-rate funding position and available for sale securities portfolios to a variable-rate position and to effectively convert a portion of its variable-rate loan portfolios to fixed-rate. Regions also uses derivatives to economically manage interest rate and pricing risk associated with its mortgage origination business. In the period of time that elapses between the origination and sale of mortgage loans, changes in interest rates have the potential to cause a decline in the value of the loans in this held-for-sale portfolio. Futures contracts and forward sale commitments are used to protect the value of the loan pipeline and loans held for sale from changes in interest rates and pricing.
The following table presents additional information about hedging interest rate derivatives used by Regions to manage interest rate risk:
Table 25—Hedging Derivatives by Interest Rate Risk Management Strategy
 
December 31, 2018
 
Notional
Amount
 
Weighted-Average
 
 
 
Maturity (Years)
 
Receive Rate (1)
 
Pay Rate (1)
 
Strike Price (1)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Derivatives in fair value hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     Receive fixed/pay variable swaps
$
3,150

 
3.0

 
1.8
%
 
2.5
%
 
%
     Receive variable/pay fixed swaps
81

 
4.8

 
2.5

 
2.4

 

Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     Receive fixed/pay variable swaps
8,750

 
5.8

 
2.1

 
2.4

 

     Interest rate floors
3,250

 
6.0

 

 

 
2.2

     Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments
$
15,231

 
5.3

 
2.0
%
 
2.4
%
 
2.2
%
_________
(1) Variable rate indexes on swap and floor contracts reference a combination of short-term LIBOR benchmarks, primarily 1 month LIBOR.
A portion of the cash flow hedging relationships designated above in Table 25 are forward starting, and therefore do not impact, or have limited impact to the estimated annual change in net interest income and other financing income discussed in Table 24. As of December 31, 2018, $3.75 billion notional of the outstanding cash flow swaps were forward starting. All interest rate floors were forward starting. Forward starting swaps and floors have maturities of approximately five years after their respective start dates. Subsequent to December 31, 2018, the Company executed $1.0 billion notional of forward starting cash flow swaps and $1.0 billion notional of forward starting floors with similar characteristics, start dates and maturities, to the forward starting hedges already transacted. Inclusive of these contracts, the total receive rate and strike price on all forward starting cash flow swaps and floors was 2.8 percent and 2.1 percent, respectively.
Regions manages the credit risk of these instruments in much the same way as it manages credit risk of the loan portfolios by establishing credit limits for each counterparty and through collateral agreements for dealer transactions. For non-dealer transactions, the need for collateral is evaluated on an individual transaction basis and is primarily dependent on the financial strength of the counterparty. Credit risk is also reduced significantly by entering into legally enforceable master netting agreements. When there is more than one transaction with a counterparty and there is a legally enforceable master netting agreement in place, the exposure represents the net of the gain and loss positions with and collateral received from and/or posted to that counterparty. All interest rate swap derivatives traded by Regions are subject to mandatory clearing. The counterparty risk for cleared trades effectively moves from the executing broker to the clearinghouse allowing Regions to benefit from the risk mitigation controls in place at the respective clearinghouse. The “Credit Risk” section in this report contains more information on the management of credit risk.

78





Regions also uses derivatives to meet the needs of its customers. Interest rate swaps, interest rate options and foreign exchange forwards are the most common derivatives sold to customers. Other derivative instruments with similar characteristics are used to hedge market risk and minimize volatility associated with this portfolio. Instruments used to service customers are held in the trading account, with changes in value recorded in the consolidated statements of income.
The primary objective of Regions’ hedging strategies is to mitigate the impact of interest rate changes, from an economic perspective, on net interest income and other financing income and the net present value of its balance sheet. The overall effectiveness of these hedging strategies is subject to market conditions, the quality of Regions’ execution, the accuracy of its valuation assumptions, counterparty credit risk and changes in interest rates. See Note 21 “Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities” to the consolidated financial statements for a tabular summary of Regions’ year-end derivatives positions and further discussion.
Regions accounts for residential MSRs at fair market value with any changes to fair value being recorded within mortgage income. Regions enters into derivative and balance sheet transactions to economically mitigate the impact of market value fluctuations related to residential MSRs. Derivative instruments entered into in the future could be materially different from the current risk profile of Regions’ current portfolio.
MARKET RISK—PREPAYMENT RISK
Regions, like most financial institutions, is subject to changing prepayment speeds on mortgage-related assets under different interest rate environments. Prepayment risk is a significant risk to earnings and specifically to net interest income and other financing income. For example, mortgage loans and other financial assets may be prepaid by a debtor, so that the debtor may refinance its obligations at lower rates. As loans and other financial assets prepay in a falling rate environment, Regions must reinvest these funds in lower-yielding assets. Prepayments of assets carrying higher rates reduce Regions’ interest income and overall asset yields. Conversely, in a rising rate environment, these assets will prepay at a slower rate, resulting in opportunity cost by not having the cash flow to reinvest at higher rates. Prepayment risk can also impact the value of securities and the carrying value of equity. Regions’ greatest exposures to prepayment risks primarily rest in its mortgage-backed securities portfolio, the mortgage fixed-rate loan portfolio and the residential MSR, all of which tend to be sensitive to interest rate movements. Each of these assets is also exposed to prepayment risk due to factors which are not necessarily the result of interest rates, but rather due to changes in policies or programs related, either directly or indirectly, to the U.S. Government's governance over certain lending and financing within the mortgage market. Such policies can work to either encourage or discourage financing dynamics and represent a risk that is extremely difficult to forecast and may be the result of non-economic factors. The Company attempts to monitor and manage such exposures within reasonable expectations while acknowledging all such risks cannot be foreseen or avoided. Further, Regions has prepayment risk that would be reflected in non-interest income in the form of servicing income on the residential MSR. Regions actively monitors prepayment exposure as part of its overall net interest income and other financing income forecasting and interest rate risk management.
LIQUIDITY RISK
Liquidity is an important factor in the financial condition of Regions and affects Regions’ ability to meet the borrowing needs and deposit withdrawal requirements of its customers. The liquidity coverage ratio rule is designed to ensure that financial institutions have the necessary assets on hand to withstand short-term liquidity disruptions. See the "Liquidity Coverage Ratio" discussion included in the "Regulatory Requirements" section of Management's Discussion and Analysis for additional information.
Regions intends to fund its obligations primarily through cash generated from normal operations. Regions also has obligations related to potential litigation contingencies. See Note 24 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements for additional discussion of the Company’s funding requirements.
Assets, consisting principally of loans and securities, are funded by customer deposits, borrowed funds and stockholders’ equity. Regions’ goal in liquidity management is to satisfy the cash flow requirements of depositors and borrowers, while at the same time meeting the Company’s cash flow needs. Having and using various sources of liquidity to satisfy the Company’s funding requirements is important.
In order to ensure an appropriate level of liquidity is maintained, Regions performs specific procedures including scenario analyses and stress testing at the bank, holding company, and affiliate levels. Regions' liquidity policy requires the holding company to maintain cash sufficient to cover the greater of (1) 18 months of debt service and other cash needs or (2) a minimum cash balance of $500 million. Cash and cash equivalents at the holding company totaled $1.9 billion at December 31, 2018 . Compliance with the holding company cash requirements is reported to the Risk Committee of the Board on a quarterly basis. Regions also has minimum liquidity requirements for the Bank and subsidiaries. The Bank's funding and contingency planning does not currently include any reliance on short-term unsecured sources. Risk limits are established within the Company's Liquidity Risk Oversight Committee and ALCO, which regularly reviews compliance with the established limits.
The securities portfolio is one of Regions’ primary sources of liquidity. Proceeds from maturities and principal and interest payments of securities provide a constant flow of funds available for cash needs (see Note 4 “Debt Securities” to the consolidated

79





financial statements). The agency guaranteed mortgage-backed securities portfolio is another source of liquidity in various secured borrowing capacities.
Maturities in the loan portfolio also provide a steady flow of funds. Additional funds are provided from payments on consumer loans and one-to-four family residential first mortgage loans. Regions’ liquidity is further enhanced by its relatively stable customer deposit base. Liquidity needs can also be met by borrowing funds in state and national money markets, although Regions does not currently rely on short-term unsecured wholesale market funding.
The balance with the FRB is the primary component of the balance sheet line item, “interest-bearing deposits in other banks.” At December 31, 2018 , Regions had approximately $1.5 billion in cash on deposit with the FRB, a decrease from approximately $1.9 billion at December 31, 2017. The average balance held with the FRB was approximately $730 million and $2.0 billion during 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Refer to the "Cash and Cash Equivalents" section for more information.
Regions’ borrowing availability with the FRB as of December 31, 2018 , based on assets pledged as collateral on that date, was $19.0 billion.
Regions’ financing arrangement with the FHLB adds additional flexibility in managing the Company's liquidity position. As of December 31, 2018 , Regions’ outstanding balance of FHLB borrowings was $8.5 billion and its total borrowing capacity from the FHLB totaled approximately $17.2 billion. FHLB borrowing capacity is contingent on the amount of collateral pledged to the FHLB. Regions Bank pledged certain securities, commercial and real estate mortgage loans, residential first mortgage loans on one-to-four family dwellings and home equity lines of credit as collateral for the FHLB advances outstanding. Additionally, investment in FHLB stock is required in relation to the level of outstanding borrowings. Refer to Note 8 "Other Earning Assets" to the consolidated financial statements for additional information. The FHLB has been and is expected to continue to be a reliable and economical source of funding.
Regions maintains a shelf registration statement with the SEC that can be utilized by Regions to issue various debt and/or equity securities. Additionally, Regions' Board had authorized Regions Bank to issue up to $5 billion in aggregate principal amount of bank notes outstanding at any one time.  Subsequent to December 31, 2018, the Board authorized Regions Bank to increase the aggregate principal amount of bank notes outstanding at any one time to $10 billion. Refer to Note 13 "Long-Term Borrowings" to the consolidated financial statements for additional information.
Regions may, from time to time, consider opportunistically retiring outstanding issued securities, including subordinated debt in privately negotiated or open market transactions for cash or common shares. Regulatory approval would be required for retirement of some instruments.
Table 26—Contractual Obligations
Regions' contractual obligations and expected payment dates are presented in the following table:
   
Payments Due By Period (1)
   
Less than 1
Year
 
1-3 Years
 
4-5 Years
 
More than 5
Years
 
Indeterminable
Maturity
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Deposits (2)
$
3,781

 
$
2,605

 
$
933

 
$
45

 
$
87,127

 
$
94,491

Short-term borrowings
1,600

 

 

 

 

 
1,600

Long-term borrowings
4,454

 
5,441

 
1,478

 
1,051

 

 
12,424

Lease obligations
125

 
205

 
132

 
251

 

 
713

Purchase obligations
30

 
48

 
44

 
10

 

 
132

Benefit obligations (3)
11

 
37

 
33

 
62

 

 
143

Commitments to fund low income housing partnerships (4)
784

 

 

 

 

 
784

Unrecognized tax benefits

 

 

 

 
13

 
13

 
$
10,785

 
$
8,336

 
$
2,620

 
$
1,419

 
$
87,140

 
$
110,300

_________
(1)
See Note 24 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements for the Company’s commercial commitments at December 31, 2018 .
(2)
Deposits with indeterminable maturity include non-interest bearing demand, savings, interest-bearing transaction accounts and money market accounts.
(3)
Amounts only include obligations related to the unfunded non-qualified pension plan and postretirement health care plan.
(4)
Commitments to fund low income housing partnerships includes commitments to make future investments, short-term construction loans and letters of credit, as well as the funded portions of these loans and letters of credit. All of these items are short-term in nature and the majority do not have defined maturity dates. Therefore, they have all been considered due on demand, maturing one year or less. See Note 2 "Variable Interest Entities" to the consolidated financial statements for additional information.

80





CREDIT RISK
Regions’ objective regarding credit risk is to maintain a credit portfolio that provides for stable credit costs with acceptable volatility through an economic cycle. Regions has various processes to manage credit risk as described below. In order to assess the risk profile of the loan portfolio, Regions considers risk factors within the loan portfolio segments and classes, the current U.S. economic environment and that of its primary banking markets, as well as counterparty risk. See the "Portfolio Characteristics" section found earlier in this report for further information regarding the loan portfolio. See further discussion of the current U.S. economic environment and counterparty risk below.
Management Process
Credit risk is managed by maintaining a sound credit risk culture, throughout all lines of defense, which ensures that the levels and types of risk taken are aligned with Regions' credit risk appetite. The credit quality of borrowers and counterparties has a significant impact on Regions' earnings; however, the nature of the risk differs by each of the defined businesses which engage in multiple forms of commercial, investor real estate and consumer lending. Regions categorizes the credit risks it faces by asset quality, counterparty exposure, and diversification levels which provides a structure to assess credit risk and guides credit decision-making. Credit policies, another key component of Regions' culture, are designed and adjusted, as needed, to promote sound credit risk management. These policies guide lending activities in a manner consistent with Regions' strategy and provide a framework for achieving asset quality and earnings objectives.
Effective credit risk management requires coordinated identification, measurement, mitigation, monitoring and reporting of credit risk exposure, credit quality, and emerging risk trends. Accordingly, Regions has implemented a credit risk governance structure that provides oversight from the Board to the organizational units in order to maintain open channels of communication.
Occasionally, borrowers and counterparties do not fulfill their obligations and Regions must take steps to mitigate and manage losses. Teams are in place to appropriately identify and manage nonperforming loans, collections, loan modifications, and loss mitigation efforts. Regions maintains an allowance for credit losses that management considers adequate to absorb losses inherent in the portfolio.
For a discussion of the process and methodology used to calculate the allowance for credit losses refer to the “Critical Accounting Estimates and Related Policies” section found earlier in this report, and Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements. Details regarding the allowance for credit losses, including an analysis of activity from the previous year’s total, are included in Table 15 “Allowance for Credit Losses.” Also, refer to Table 16 “Allocation of the Allowance for Loan Losses” for details pertaining to management’s allocation of the allowance for loan losses to each loan category.
Responsibility and accountability for effectively managing all risks, including credit risk, in the various business units lies with the first line of defense. Credit Risk Management, in the second line of defense, oversees, assesses and effectively challenges the risk-taking activities of the first line of defense. Finally, Credit Risk Review provides ongoing oversight, as a third line of defense function, of the credit portfolios to ensure Regions’ activities, and controls, are appropriate for the size, complexity and risk profile of the Company.
Economic Environment in Regions’ Banking Markets
One of the primary factors influencing the credit performance of Regions’ loan portfolio is the overall economic environment in the U.S. and the primary markets in which it operates. Regions forecasts real GDP growth of approximately 2.6 percent in 2019, with consumer spending, business investment spending, and government spending the main drivers.
Household balance sheets continue to improve and sustained house price appreciation has cushioned the effects of recent declines in equity prices on household net worth. While the rate of growth of household debt has accelerated, growth nonetheless remains below average growth rates seen over past cycles and household debt-to-income ratios are significantly lower than was the case prior to the 2007-09 recession. While recent increases in market interest rates will have pushed debt service burdens higher, any increases in debt service burdens follow a sustained period in which household debt service burdens remained near historical lows. As such, household debt service burdens remain manageable. Moreover, a higher share of fixed rate debt relative to past cycles means consumers are more insulated from the effects of rising interest rates than in past cycles. Ongoing improvement in labor market conditions in 2019 should lead to faster wage growth, which in turn will sustain growth in disposable personal income. As a result, consumer spending will remain a primary driver of economic growth in 2019.
While business investment spending softened over the latter stages of 2018, that followed what had been notably rapid growth in business spending on equipment and machinery from the beginning of 2017 through the second quarter of 2018. Two main factors weighing on business investment spending in late-2018 were declines in energy prices and, more broadly, growing uncertainty over trade policy. Nonetheless, Regions believes there is further upside room for business investment spending in 2019. First, the capital stock is rather old relative to historical norms, which should facilitate spending on upgrading/replacing dated facilities and machinery. Second, with labor becoming more scarce and more expensive, firms have added incentive to invest in capital to make existing workforces more productive. Incentives for business investment from Tax Reform remain in place, which should also help sustain growth in capital spending in 2019.

81





The housing market is a key question mark for 2019. While it is Regions’ view that supply issues are the primary drag on housing market activity, the cumulative effect of higher mortgage interest rates and rapid house price appreciation over the course of 2018 began to erode affordability. By year-end 2018, however, mortgage rates had turned lower and builders were seeing some relief on input prices, particularly lumber, while inventories of existing homes for sale had begun to rise, albeit from an exceptionally low base. Within Regions' footprint, housing market activity continues to grow at a moderate pace, and a more moderate pace of house price appreciation is expected in 2019. These factors, along with continued job and income growth, mean that demand for home purchases should also continue at a moderate pace in 2019.
As expected, inflation did pick up in 2018, but a significant late-year decline in energy prices led to a deceleration in headline inflation at year-end. Core inflation, however, continued to gently accelerate through 2018, and further acceleration is likely in 2019. Services prices will be more vulnerable to pass-through effects of labor costs rising at a faster rate, and core goods (i.e., consumer goods excluding food and energy) prices began to firm up by year-end 2018. Still, any acceleration in core inflation in 2019 is likely to be gradual and, as such, is unlikely to prompt the FOMC to move at a faster pace in raising the Fed funds rate.
The “dot plot” released in conjunction with the December 2018 FOMC meeting implied a total of two 25 basis point increases in the Fed funds rate target range in 2019, though many participants expect no more increases. At the same time, market participants became less positive in their outlooks for economic growth, which led to a flatter yield curve over the latter phases of 2018. The FOMC is looking to move away from forward guidance, towards a more “data dependent” approach to setting monetary policy.
For the Regions footprint as a whole, rates of job, income, and overall economic growth have been and are expected to remain broadly consistent with those seen nationally. There are, however, differences in rates of growth among the individual states and metropolitan areas across the footprint. Those markets which are larger and more economically diverse and boast more favorable demographic trends have been and are expected to remain among the better performing markets within Regions' footprint. The pace of job growth within Regions’ footprint accelerated in 2018, and job growth remained notably broad based across the major industry groups. Manufacturing has been a support for overall economic activity across the Regions footprint, but this is one sector, along with agriculture, that is most vulnerable to intensifying trade disputes between the U.S. and China. Still, steady job growth over the course of 2019 is expected to keep downward pressure on unemployment rates across the footprint.
In summation, real GDP growth is expected to be approximately 2.6 percent in 2019, with consumer spending, business investment, and government spending the main drivers of growth. Global economic growth is expected to moderate in 2019, but exports should still be additive to U.S. economic growth in 2019. Gradual acceleration in core inflation is expected. However, if inflation accelerates more rapidly than anticipated, and in turn prompts the FOMC to become more aggressive in raising the Fed funds rate, there would be downside risk to the Company's baseline outlook, as this would have an adverse impact on asset prices and likely have an adverse impact on the broader economy. Other downside risks include elevated uncertainty over trade policy and geopolitical tensions, including growing political unrest across much of Europe. Upside potential includes elevated consumer confidence and solid growth in disposable income lead to a faster than anticipated pace of growth in consumer spending, and the possibility that productivity growth responds faster and more favorably to an increase in business investment than anticipated.
Counterparty Risk
Counterparty risk is the risk that the counterparty to a transaction or contract could be unable or unwilling to fulfill its contractual or legal obligations. Exposure may be to a financial institution (such as commercial banks, insurance companies, broker dealers, etc.) or a corporate client.
Regions has a centralized approach to approval, management, and monitoring of counterparty exposure. The Counterparty Risk Management Group is responsible for the independent credit risk management of financial institution counterparties and their affiliates. Market Risk Management is responsible for the measurement and stress testing of counterparty exposures. The Corporate and Commercial Credit groups are responsible for the independent credit risk management of client side counterparties.
Financial institution exposure may result from a variety of transaction types generated in one or more departments of the Company. Exposure limits are established to manage the exposure generated by various areas of the Company. Counterparty client credit risk arises when Regions sells a risk management product to hedge risks in the client’s business. Exposures to counterparties are aggregated across departments and regularly reported to senior management.
INFORMATION SECURITY RISK
Regions faces a variety of operational risks, including information security risks. Information security risks, such as evolving and adaptive cyber attacks that are conducted regularly against Regions and other large financial institutions to compromise or disable information systems, have generally increased in recent years. This trend is expected to continue for a number of reasons, including the proliferation of new technologies, including technology-based products and services used by us and our customers, the increasing use of mobile devices and cloud technologies, the ability to conduct more financial transactions online, and the increasing sophistication and activities of organized crime, hackers, terrorists, nation-states, activists and other external parties or fraud on the part of employees.

82





Regions devotes significant financial and non-financial resources to identify and mitigate threats to the confidentiality, availability and integrity of its information systems. Regions regularly assesses the threats and vulnerabilities to its environment so it can update and maintain its systems and controls to effectively mitigate these risks. Layered security controls are designed to complement each other to protect customer information and transactions. Regions regularly tests its control environment utilizing practices such as penetration testing and more targeted assessments to ensure its controls are working as expected. Regions will continue to commit the resources necessary to mitigate these growing cyber risks, as well as continue to develop and enhance controls, processes and technology to protect its systems from attacks or unauthorized access. In addition, Regions maintains a strong commitment to a comprehensive risk management program that includes due diligence and oversight of third-party relationships with vendors.
Regions’ system of internal controls also incorporates an organization-wide protocol for the appropriate reporting and escalation of information security matters to management and the Board, to ensure effective and efficient resolution and, if necessary, disclosure of any matters. The Board is actively engaged in the oversight of Regions’ continuous efforts to reinforce and enhance its operational resilience. The Board monitors Regions’ information management risk policies and practices primarily through its Risk Committee, which oversees areas of operational risk such as information technology activities; risks associated with development, infrastructure, and cybersecurity; approval and oversight of information security risk assessments, strategies, policies and programs; and disaster recovery, business continuity, and incident response plans. Additionally, the Board’s Audit Committee regularly reviews Regions’ cybersecurity practices, mainly by receiving reports on the cybersecurity management program prepared by the Chief Information Security Officer, risk management, and Internal Audit. The Board, through its various committees, is briefed at least quarterly on information security matters.
Regions participates in information sharing organizations such as FS-ISAC, to gather and share information with peer banks and other financial institutions to better prepare and protect its information systems from attack. FS-ISAC is a nonprofit organization whose objective is to protect the financial services sector against cyber and physical threats and risk. It acts as a trusted third party that provides anonymity to allow members to submit threat, vulnerability and incident information in a non-attributable and trusted manner so information that would normally not be shared is instead made available to other members for the greater good of the membership. In addition to FS-ISAC, Regions is a member of BITS. BITS serves the financial community and its members by providing industry best practices on a variety of security and fraud topics.
Regions has contracts with vendors to provide denial of service mitigation. These vendors have also committed the necessary resources to support Regions in the event of a cyber event. Even though Regions devotes significant resources to combat cyber security risks, there is no guarantee that these measures will provide absolute security. As an additional security measure, Regions has engaged a computer forensics firm and an industry-leading consulting firm on retainer in case of a cyber event. Regions has also developed and maintains robust business continuity and disaster recovery plans that it could implement in the event of a cyber event so as to mitigate the effects of any such event. Some of Regions' exposure with respect to data breaches may be offset by applicable insurance.
Even if Regions successfully prevents cyber attacks to its own network, the Company may still incur losses that result from customers' account information obtained through breaches of retailers' networks where customers have transacted business. The fraud losses, as well as the costs of investigations and re-issuing new customer cards, may impact Regions' financial results. In addition, Regions also relies on some vendors to provide certain components of its business infrastructure, and although Regions actively assesses and monitors the information security capabilities of these vendors, Regions' reliance on them may also increase exposure to information security risk.
In the event of a cyber-attack or other data breach, Regions may be required to incur significant expenses, including with respect to remediation costs, costs of implementing additional preventative measures, addressing any reputational harm and addressing any related regulatory inquiries or civil litigation arising from the event.
FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE AND INTERNAL CONTROLS
Regions maintains internal controls over financial reporting, which generally include those controls relating to the preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP. Regions’ process for evaluating internal controls over financial reporting starts with understanding the risks facing each of its functions and areas, how those risks are controlled or mitigated, and how management monitors those controls to ensure that they are in place and effective. These risks, control procedures and monitoring tools are documented in a standard format. This format not only documents the internal control structures over all significant accounts, but also places responsibility on management for establishing feedback mechanisms to ensure that controls are effective.
Regions also has processes to ensure appropriate disclosure controls and procedures are maintained. These controls and procedures as defined by the SEC are generally designed to ensure that financial and non-financial information required to be disclosed in reports filed with the SEC is reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that such information is communicated to management, including the CEO and CFO, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

83





Regions’ Disclosure Review Committee, which includes representatives from the legal, tax, finance, risk management, accounting, investor relations, and treasury departments, meets quarterly to review recent internal and external events to determine whether all appropriate disclosures have been made in reports filed with the SEC. In addition, the CEO and CFO meet quarterly with the SEC Filings Review Committee, which includes senior representatives from accounting, legal, risk management, treasury, and the business groups. The SEC Filings Review Committee provides a forum in which senior executives disclose to the CEO and CFO any known significant deficiencies or material weaknesses in Regions’ internal controls over financial reporting, and provide reasonable assurance that the financial statements and other contents of the Company’s Form 10-K and 10-Q filings are accurate, complete and timely. As part of this process, certifications of internal control effectiveness are obtained from Regions’ associates who are responsible for maintaining and monitoring effective internal controls over financial reporting. These certifications are reviewed and presented to the CEO and CFO as support of the Company’s assessment of internal controls over financial reporting. The Form 10-K is presented to the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors for approval, and the Forms 10-Q are reviewed by the Audit Committee. Financial results and other financial information are also reviewed with the Audit Committee on a quarterly basis.
As required by Sections 302 and 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the CEO and the CFO review and make certifications regarding the accuracy of Regions’ periodic public reports filed with the SEC, as well as the effectiveness of disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting. With the assistance of the financial review committees noted in the previous paragraph, Regions continually assesses and monitors disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting, and makes refinements as necessary.
COMPARISON OF 2017 WITH 2016 —CONTINUING OPERATIONS
Regions reported net income available to common shareholders of $1.2 billion, or $1.00 per diluted common share, in 2017 compared to $1.1 billion, or $0.87 per diluted share in 2016. Regions also reported net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders of $1.2 billion, or $1.00 per diluted common share, in 2017 compared to $1.1 billion, or $0.87 per diluted share, in 2016.
Net interest income and other financing income from continuing operations was $3.5 billion and $3.4 billion in 2017 and 2016, respectively, reflecting a decrease in average earning assets to $109.2 billion from $111.0 billion at December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The net interest margin from continuing operations (taxable-equivalent basis) was 3.32 percent in 2017 , compared to 3.14 percent during 2016, reflecting increases in yields on earning assets, particularly loans, exceeding the slight increase in total funding costs.
Non-interest income from continuing operations decreased $49 million to $2.0 billion in 2017 compared to 2016. The decrease was due to insurance proceeds received in 2016, as well as decreases in BOLI, other miscellaneous income, and mortgage income. These decreases more than offset increases in service charges on deposit accounts, card and ATM fees, and investment management and trust fee income. See Table 5 "Non-Interest Income from Continuing Operations" for additional information.
Insurance proceeds recognized in 2016 were related to the settlement of the previously disclosed and accrued 2010 class-action lawsuit.
Bank-owned life insurance decreased in 2017 compared to 2016 primarily due to a gain on exchange of policies that was recognized in the first quarter of 2016 and reduced claim benefits in 2017.
Other miscellaneous income decreased $47 million in 2017 compared to 2016. The decrease was primarily due to operating lease impairment charges of $22 million recorded in 2017, declines in net revenue from affordable housing, and a recovery of approximately $10 million related to the 2010 Gulf of Mexico oil spill recorded in 2016.
Mortgage income decreased $24 million in 2017 compared to 2016. The decrease was due to lower production, spread compression, and a reduction in the valuation of mortgage servicing rights and related hedges. The decreases were partially offset by increase in mortgage servicing income as a result of purchasing the rights to service a total of approximately $2.7 billion in residential mortgage loans during 2017. See Note 7 "Servicing of Financial Assets" to the consolidated financial statements for more information.
Service charges on deposit accounts increased $19 million in 2017 compared to 2016. The increase was primarily due to overall account growth resulting in increases in non-sufficient fund fees.
Card and ATM fees increased $15 million in 2017 compared to 2016. The increase was primarily the result of checking account and active credit card growth resulting in higher interchange income.
Investment management and trust fee income increased $17 million in 2017 compared to 2016. The increase was driven primarily from the increase in assets under administration and growth in the equity markets.
Non-interest expense from continuing operations increased $8 million in 2017 compared to 2016. Increases in salaries and employee benefits, furniture and equipment expense, outside services, FDIC insurance assessments, and professional, legal, and regulatory expenses occurred in 2017. These increases were offset by decreases in branch consolidation, property and equipment

84





charges, provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses and loss on early extinguishment of debt. See Table 6 “Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations” for additional information.
Total salaries and employee benefits increased $32 million in 2017 as compared to 2016. The increase was primarily due to merit increases, increased expenses from liabilities held for employee benefit purposes and $12 million in pension settlement charges in 2017. The expenses from liabilities held for employee benefit purposes are offset in non-interest income. Full-time equivalent headcount decreased to 21,014 at December 31, 2017 from 21,402 at December 31, 2016, reflecting the Company's efficiency initiatives implemented as part of its three-year strategic plan and serving to partially offset the aforementioned increases.
Furniture and equipment expense increased $14 million in 2017 as compared to 2016. The increase was primarily driven by increased depreciation related to the completion of certain capital investment projects.
Outside services increased $18 million in 2017 as compared to 2016. The increase was primarily due to increased servicing costs related to point-of-sale lending through third parties and additional expenses recorded related to a new Wealth Management platform.
FDIC insurance assessments increased during 2017 compared to 2016 primarily due to the implementation of the FDIC assessment surcharge that went into effect during the third quarter of 2016, and was in place throughout 2017, as well as the impact of a $6 million refund recognized in the second quarter of 2016.
Professional, legal, and regulatory expenses consist of amounts related to legal, consulting, other professional fees and regulatory charges. Professional, legal and regulatory expenses increased during 2017 compared to 2016 due primarily to a legal recovery of $7 million that was recognized in 2016.
Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges include valuation adjustments related to owned branches when the decision to close them is made. Accelerated depreciation and lease write-off charges are recorded for leased branches through and at the actual branch close date. Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges also include costs related to occupancy optimization initiatives.
Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses decreased $33 million in 2017 compared to 2016. The (credit) for unfunded credit losses in 2017 was primarily due to a reduction in the level of risk estimated for the unfunded credit commitments in the commercial and industrial portfolio. The provision for unfunded credit losses during 2016 was attributable to increases in the commercial and industrial reserve rates for unfunded commitments and letters of credit and a large specific reserve on an unfunded energy credit.
In 2016, the Company purchased approximately $649 million of its 2.00% senior notes due May 2018. The pre-tax loss on the early extinguishment related to this tender offer was approximately $14 million.
The Company’s income tax expense from continuing operations for 2017 was $619 million compared to $510 million in 2016, resulting in an effective tax rate of 33.3 percent and 30.6 percent, respectively.
At December 31, 2017, the allowance for loan losses totaled $934 million or 1.17 percent of total loans, net of unearned income compared to $1.1 billion or 1.36 percent at December 31, 2016. Net charge-offs totaled $307 million, or 0.38 percent of average loans in 2017 compared to $277 million, or 0.34 percent of average loans in 2016, reflecting some large-dollar commercial loan charge-offs within the energy, healthcare and education sectors. During 2017, the provision for loan losses was $150 million as compared to $262 million in 2016. The decrease in the provision for loan losses in 2017 compared to 2016 was the result of improving economic conditions driving broad-based improvements in credit metrics, particularly in the latter half of 2017. Non-performing assets decreased from $1.1 billion at December 31, 2016, to $740 million at December 31, 2017.

85





Table 27—Quarterly Results of Operations
 
2018
 
2017
 
Fourth
Quarter
 
Third
Quarter
 
Second
Quarter
 
First
Quarter
 
Fourth
Quarter
 
Third
Quarter
 
Second
Quarter
 
First
Quarter
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Total interest income, including other financing income
$
1,158

 
$
1,112

 
$
1,076

 
$
1,047

 
$
1,020

 
$
1,012

 
$
989

 
$
966

Total interest expense and depreciation expense on operating lease assets
200

 
170

 
150

 
138

 
119

 
115

 
107

 
107

Net interest income and other financing income
958

 
942

 
926

 
909

 
901

 
897

 
882

 
859

Provision (credit) for loan losses
95

 
84

 
60

 
(10
)
 
(44
)
 
76

 
48

 
70

Net interest income and other financing income after provision (credit) for loan losses
863

 
858

 
866

 
919

 
945

 
821

 
834

 
789

Total non-interest income, excluding securities gains (losses), net
481

 
519

 
511

 
507

 
506

 
474

 
489

 
474

Securities gains (losses), net

 

 
1

 

 
10

 
8

 
1

 

Total non-interest expense
853

 
922

 
911

 
884

 
920

 
853

 
875

 
843

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
491

 
455

 
467

 
542

 
541

 
450


449

 
420

Income tax expense
85

 
85

 
89

 
128

 
221

 
138

 
133

 
127

Income from continuing operations
406

 
370

 
378

 
414

 
320

 
312

 
316

 
293

Discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

 
274

 
(3
)
 

 
6

 

 

 
13

Income tax expense (benefit)

 
80

 

 

 
(9
)
 
1

 

 
5

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

 
194

 
(3
)
 

 
15

 
(1
)
 

 
8

Net income
$
406

 
$
564

 
$
375

 
$
414

 
$
335

 
$
311

 
$
316

 
$
301

Net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders
$
390

 
$
354

 
$
362

 
$
398

 
$
304

 
$
296

 
$
300

 
$
277

Net income available to common shareholders
$
390

 
$
548

 
$
359

 
$
398

 
$
319

 
$
295

 
$
300

 
$
285

Earnings per common share from continuing operations: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.38

 
$
0.33

 
$
0.32

 
$
0.35

 
$
0.26

 
$
0.25

 
$
0.25

 
$
0.23

Diluted
0.37

 
0.32

 
0.32

 
0.35

 
0.26

 
0.25

 
0.25

 
0.23

Earnings per common share: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.38

 
$
0.50

 
$
0.32

 
$
0.35

 
$
0.28

 
$
0.25

 
$
0.25

 
$
0.24

Diluted
0.37

 
0.50

 
0.32

 
0.35

 
0.27

 
0.25

 
0.25

 
0.23

________
(1)
Quarterly amounts may not add to year-to-date amounts due to rounding.



86


Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
REPORT OF MANAGEMENT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
We, as members of the Management of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries (the “Company”), are responsible for establishing and maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting. Regions’ internal control system was designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and Board of Directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of the Company’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Internal control over financial reporting includes self-monitoring mechanisms, and actions are taken to correct deficiencies as they are identified.
All internal controls systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations and may not prevent or detect misstatements in the Company’s financial statements, including the possibility of circumvention or overriding of controls. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Regions’ management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 . In making this assessment, we used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) in its 2013 Internal Control—Integrated Framework. Based on our assessment, we believe and assert that, as of December 31, 2018 , the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective based on those criteria.
Regions’ independent registered public accounting firm has issued an audit report on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. This report appears on the following page.
 
 
 
 
 
 
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
 
 
 
by
/ S /    J OHN  M. T URNER , J R .
 
 
John M. Turner, Jr.
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
 
 
by
/ S /    D AVID  J. T URNER , J R .        
 
 
David J. Turner, Jr.
Chief Financial Officer

87

Table of Contents




REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of Regions Financial Corporation

Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 framework) (the COSO criteria). In our opinion, Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries (the Company) maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on the COSO criteria.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated balance sheets of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, and the related notes of the Company and our report dated February 22, 2019 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Basis for Opinion
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.
Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


     EYLLPSIGNATURE201510KA47.JPG                         
Birmingham, Alabama
February 22, 2019

88





REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of Regions Financial Corporation

Opinion on the Financial Statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 framework) and our report dated February 22, 2019 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Basis for Opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.


 
EYLLPSIGNATURE201510KA47.JPG     
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 1971.

Birmingham, Alabama
February 22, 2019




89





REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions, except share data)
Assets
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
2,018

 
$
2,012

Interest-bearing deposits in other banks
1,520

 
1,899

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

 
70

Debt securities held to maturity (estimated fair value of $1,460 and $1,667, respectively)
1,482

 
1,658

Debt securities available for sale
22,729

 
23,403

Loans held for sale (includes $251 and $325 measured at fair value, respectively)
304

 
348

Loans, net of unearned income
83,152

 
79,947

Allowance for loan losses
(840
)
 
(934
)
Net loans
82,312

 
79,013

Other earning assets
1,719

 
1,891

Premises and equipment, net
2,045

 
2,064

Interest receivable
375

 
337

Goodwill
4,829

 
4,904

Residential mortgage servicing rights at fair value
418

 
336

Other identifiable intangible assets, net
115

 
177

Other assets
5,822

 
6,182

Total assets
$
125,688

 
$
124,294

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
 
Deposits:
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing
$
35,053

 
$
36,127

Interest-bearing
59,438

 
60,762

Total deposits
94,491

 
96,889

Borrowed funds:
 
 
 
Short-term borrowings:
 
 
 
Other short-term borrowings
1,600

 
500

Total short-term borrowings
1,600

 
500

Long-term borrowings
12,424

 
8,132

Total borrowed funds
14,024

 
8,632

Other liabilities
2,083

 
2,581

Total liabilities
110,598

 
108,102

Stockholders’ equity:
 
 
 
Preferred stock, authorized 10 million shares, par value $1.00 per share:
 
 
 
Non-cumulative perpetual, liquidation preference $1,000.00 per share, including related surplus, net of issuance costs; issued—1,000,000 shares
820

 
820

Common stock, authorized 3 billion shares, par value $.01 per share:
 
 
 
Issued including treasury stock—1,065,858,925 and 1,175,327,565 shares, respectively
11

 
12

Additional paid-in capital
13,766

 
15,858

Retained earnings
2,828

 
1,628

Treasury stock, at cost—41,032,676 and 41,259,320 shares, respectively
(1,371
)
 
(1,377
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net
(964
)
 
(749
)
Total stockholders’ equity
15,090

 
16,192

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
125,688

 
$
124,294


See notes to consolidated financial statements.

90

Table of Contents




REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Interest income, including other financing income on:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, including fees
$
3,613

 
$
3,228

 
$
3,066

Debt securities - taxable
625

 
596

 
563

Loans held for sale
15

 
16

 
16

Other earning assets
70

 
53

 
44

Operating lease assets
70

 
94

 
125

Total interest income, including other financing income
4,393

 
3,987

 
3,814

Interest expense on:
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
250

 
156

 
117

Short-term borrowings
30

 
5

 

Long-term borrowings
322

 
212

 
196

Total interest expense
602

 
373

 
313

Depreciation expense on operating lease assets
56

 
75

 
103

Total interest expense and depreciation expense on operating lease assets
658

 
448

 
416

Net interest income and other financing income
3,735

 
3,539

 
3,398

Provision for loan losses
229

 
150

 
262

Net interest income and other financing income after provision for loan losses
3,506

 
3,389

 
3,136

Non-interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
710

 
683

 
664

Card and ATM fees
438

 
417

 
402

Investment management and trust fee income
235

 
230

 
213

Capital markets income
202

 
161

 
152

Mortgage income
137

 
149

 
173

Securities gains, net
1

 
19

 
6

Other
296

 
303

 
401

Total non-interest income
2,019

 
1,962

 
2,011

Non-interest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and employee benefits
1,947

 
1,874

 
1,842

Net occupancy expense
335

 
339

 
342

Furniture and equipment expense
325

 
326

 
312

Other
963

 
952

 
987

Total non-interest expense
3,570

 
3,491

 
3,483

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
1,955

 
1,860

 
1,664

Income tax expense
387

 
619

 
510

Income from continuing operations
1,568

 
1,241

 
1,154

Discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes
271

 
19

 
16

Income tax expense (benefit)
80

 
(3
)
 
7

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax
191

 
22

 
9

Net income
$
1,759

 
$
1,263

 
$
1,163

Net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders
$
1,504

 
$
1,177

 
$
1,090

Net income available to common shareholders
$
1,695

 
$
1,199

 
$
1,099

Weighted-average number of shares outstanding:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
1,092

 
1,186

 
1,255

Diluted
1,102

 
1,198

 
1,261

Earnings per common share from continuing operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
1.38

 
$
0.99

 
$
0.87

Diluted
1.36

 
0.98

 
0.86

Earnings per common share:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
1.55

 
$
1.01

 
$
0.87

Diluted
1.54

 
1.00

 
0.87

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

91

Table of Contents




REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Net income
$
1,759

 
$
1,263

 
$
1,163

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity during the period (net of zero, zero and zero tax effect, respectively)

 

 

Less: reclassification adjustments for amortization of unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity (net of ($3), ($4) and ($8) tax effect, respectively)
(6
)
 
(6
)
 
(14
)
Net change in unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity, net of tax
6

 
6

 
14

Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period (net of ($83), ($14) and ($57) tax effect, respectively)
(244
)
 

 
(92
)
Less: reclassification adjustments for securities gains (losses) realized in net income (net of zero, $7 and $2 tax effect, respectively)

 
12

 
4

Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale, net of tax
(244
)
 
(12
)
 
(96
)
Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized holding gains (losses) on derivatives arising during the period (net of ($1), ($2) and $15 tax effect, respectively)
(3
)
 
2

 
25

Less: reclassification adjustments for gains (losses) on derivative instruments realized in net income (net of $3, $33 and $54 tax effect, respectively)
9

 
53

 
89

Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments, net of tax
(12
)
 
(51
)
 
(64
)
Defined benefit pension plans and other post employment benefits:
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial gains (losses) arising during the period (net of $4, ($13) and ($27) tax effect, respectively)
7

 
(40
)
 
(46
)
Less: reclassification adjustments for amortization of actuarial loss and settlements realized in net income (net of ($8), ($17) and ($12) tax effect, respectively)
(28
)
 
(31
)
 
(22
)
Net change from defined benefit pension plans and other post employment benefits, net of tax
35

 
(9
)
 
(24
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
(215
)
 
(66
)
 
(170
)
Comprehensive income
$
1,544

 
$
1,197

 
$
993

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

92

Table of Contents





REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 
Preferred Stock
 
Common Stock
 
Additional
Paid-In
Capital
 
Retained
Earnings
(Deficit)
 
Treasury
Stock,
At Cost
 
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss), Net
 
Total
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions, except per share data)
BALANCE AT JANUARY 1, 2016
1

 
$
820

 
1,297

 
$
13

 
$
17,883

 
$
(115
)
 
$
(1,377
)
 
$
(380
)
 
$
16,844

Net income

 

 

 

 

 
1,163

 

 

 
1,163

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(170
)
 
(170
)
Cash dividends declared

 

 

 

 

 
(318
)
 

 

 
(318
)
Preferred stock dividends

 

 

 

 

 
(64
)
 

 

 
(64
)
Common stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impact of share repurchase

 

 
(89
)
 

 
(839
)
 

 

 

 
(839
)
Impact of stock transactions under compensation plans, net and other

 

 
6

 

 
48

 

 

 

 
48

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2016
1

 
$
820

 
1,214

 
$
13

 
$
17,092

 
$
666

 
$
(1,377
)
 
$
(550
)
 
$
16,664

Net income

 

 

 

 

 
1,263

 

 

 
1,263

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(66
)
 
(66
)
Reclassification of the Tax Reform related revaluation of deferred tax items within AOCI

 

 

 

 

 
133

 

 
(133
)
 

Cash dividends declared

 

 

 

 

 
(370
)
 

 

 
(370
)
Preferred stock dividends

 

 

 

 

 
(64
)
 

 

 
(64
)
Common stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impact of share repurchase

 

 
(85
)
 
(1
)
 
(1,274
)
 

 

 

 
(1,275
)
Impact of stock transactions under compensation plans, net and other

 

 
4

 

 
40

 

 

 

 
40

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2017
1

 
$
820

 
1,133

 
$
12

 
$
15,858

 
$
1,628

 
$
(1,377
)
 
$
(749
)
 
$
16,192

Cumulative effect from change in accounting guidance

 

 

 

 

 
(2
)
 

 

 
(2
)
Net income

 

 

 

 

 
1,759

 

 

 
1,759

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(215
)
 
(215
)
Cash dividends declared

 

 

 

 

 
(493
)
 

 

 
(493
)
Preferred stock dividends

 

 

 

 

 
(64
)
 

 

 
(64
)
Common stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impact of share repurchase

 

 
(115
)
 
(1
)
 
(2,121
)
 

 

 

 
(2,122
)
Impact of stock transactions under compensation plans, net and other

 

 
7

 

 
29

 

 
6

 

 
35

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2018
1

 
$
820

 
1,025

 
$
11

 
$
13,766

 
$
2,828

 
$
(1,371
)
 
$
(964
)
 
$
15,090

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

93

Table of Contents




REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
1,759

 
$
1,263

 
$
1,163

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for loan losses
229

 
150

 
262

Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
462

 
537

 
574

Securities (gains) losses, net
(1
)
 
(22
)
 
(6
)
(Gain) on sale of business
(281
)
 

 

Deferred income tax expense
226

 
209

 
67

Originations and purchases of loans held for sale
(3,351
)
 
(3,571
)
 
(3,756
)
Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale
3,451

 
4,053

 
3,700

(Gain) loss on sale of loans, net
(73
)
 
(118
)
 
(124
)
(Gain) loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
14

Net change in operating assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
Other earning assets
116

 
48

 
2

Interest receivable and other assets
171

 
(410
)
 
(228
)
Other liabilities
(470
)
 
110

 
189

Other
37

 
48

 
180

Net cash from operating activities
2,275

 
2,297

 
2,037

Investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from maturities of debt securities held to maturity
174

 
196

 
591

Proceeds from sales of debt securities available for sale
254

 
815

 
1,924

Proceeds from maturities of debt securities available for sale
3,383

 
3,575

 
4,072

Net proceeds from (payments for) bank-owned life insurance
(4
)
 
(1
)
 
9

Purchases of debt securities available for sale
(3,410
)
 
(4,404
)
 
(7,563
)
Purchases of debt securities held to maturity

 
(494
)
 

Proceeds from sales of loans
307

 
25

 
182

Purchases of loans
(503
)
 
(238
)
 
(985
)
Purchases of mortgage servicing rights
(71
)
 
(41
)
 
(64
)
Net change in loans
(3,381
)
 
(84
)
 
1,339

Net purchases of other assets
(151
)
 
(150
)
 
(205
)
Proceeds from disposition of business, net of cash transferred
357

 

 

Net cash from investing activities
(3,045
)
 
(801
)
 
(700
)
Financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deposits
(2,398
)
 
(2,146
)
 
605

Net change in short-term borrowings
1,100

 
500

 
(10
)
Proceeds from long-term borrowings
21,750

 
6,649

 
3,357

Payments on long-term borrowings
(17,451
)
 
(6,255
)
 
(3,916
)
Cash dividends on common stock
(452
)
 
(346
)
 
(317
)
Cash dividends on preferred stock
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
Repurchases of common stock
(2,122
)
 
(1,275
)
 
(839
)
Taxes paid related to net share settlement of equity awards
(35
)
 
(22
)
 
(14
)
Other
(1
)
 
(7
)
 
(2
)
Net cash from financing activities
327

 
(2,966
)
 
(1,200
)
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
(443
)
 
(1,470
)
 
137

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
3,981

 
5,451

 
5,314

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$
3,538

 
$
3,981

 
$
5,451

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

94

Table of Contents




REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTE 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Regions Financial Corporation (“Regions” or the “Company”) provides a full range of banking and bank-related services to individual and corporate customers through its subsidiaries and branch offices located across the South, Midwest and Texas. The Company competes with other financial institutions located in the states in which it operates, as well as other adjoining states. Regions is subject to the regulations of certain government agencies and undergoes periodic examinations by certain of those regulatory authorities.
The accounting and reporting policies of Regions and the methods of applying those policies that materially affect the consolidated financial statements conform with GAAP and with general financial services industry practices. In preparing the financial statements, management is required to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities as of the balance sheet dates and revenues and expenses for the periods presented. Actual results could differ from the estimates and assumptions used in the consolidated financial statements including, but not limited to, the estimates and assumptions related to the allowance for credit losses, fair value measurements, intangibles, residential MSRs and income taxes.
Regions has evaluated all subsequent events for potential recognition and disclosure through the filing date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Effective January 1, 2018, the Company adopted new guidance related to several accounting topics. The cumulative effect of the retrospective application was a total reduction to retained earnings of $2 million , of which the individual components were immaterial. All prior period amounts impacted by guidance that required retrospective application have been revised.
Certain amounts in prior period financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the current period presentation, except as otherwise noted. These reclassifications are immaterial and have no effect on net income, comprehensive income (loss), total assets or total stockholders’ equity as previously reported.
BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Regions, its subsidiaries and certain VIEs. Significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated. Regions considers a voting rights entity to be a subsidiary and consolidates it if Regions has a controlling financial interest in the entity. VIEs are consolidated if Regions has the power to direct the activities of the VIE that significantly impact financial performance and has the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE (i.e., Regions is the primary beneficiary). The determination of whether Regions is the primary beneficiary of a VIE is reassessed on an ongoing basis. Investments in companies which are not VIEs but in which Regions has significant influence over the operating and financing decisions, are accounted for using the equity method of accounting. Investments in VIEs, where Regions is not the primary beneficiary of a VIE, are accounted for using either the proportional amortization method or the equity method of accounting. These investments are included in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets. The maximum potential exposure to losses relative to investments in VIEs is generally limited to the sum of the outstanding balance, future funding commitments and any related loans to the entity. Loans to these entities are underwritten in substantially the same manner as are other loans and are generally secured. Refer to Note 2 for additional disclosures regarding Regions’ significant VIEs.
Unconsolidated equity investments that do not meet the criteria to be accounted for under the equity method and do not have a readily determinable fair value are accounted for at cost under the measurement alternative with adjustments for impairment and observable price changes as applicable. Cost method investments are included in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets. Dividends received or receivable and observable price changes from these investments are included as a component of other non-interest income in the consolidated statements of income.
DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS
On April 4, 2018, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates to BB&T Insurance Holdings, Inc. The transaction closed on July 2, 2018. On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into an agreement to sell Morgan Keegan and related affiliates. The transaction closed on April 2, 2012. Results of operations for the entities sold are presented separately as discontinued operations for all periods presented on the consolidated statements of income. Other expenses related to the transaction are also included in discontinued operations. See Note 3 and Note 24 for further discussion.
CASH EQUIVALENTS AND CASH FLOWS
Cash equivalents represent assets that can be converted into cash immediately. At Regions, these assets include cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits in other banks, and federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell. Cash flows from loans, either originated or acquired, are classified at that time according to management’s intent to either sell or hold the loan for the foreseeable future. When management’s intent is to sell the loan, the cash flows of that loan are presented

95





as operating cash flows. When management’s intent is to hold the loan for the foreseeable future, the cash flows of that loan are presented as investing cash flows.
The following table summarizes supplemental cash flow information for the years ended December 31 :  
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Cash paid during the period for:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest on deposits and borrowings
$
581

 
$
363

 
$
299

Income taxes, net
57

 
181

 
314

Non-cash transfers:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held for sale and loans transferred to other real estate
54

 
80

 
100

Loans transferred to loans held for sale
313

 
41

 
247

Loans held for sale transferred to loans
14

 
8

 
5

Properties transferred to held for sale
21

 
33

 
53

Loans settled with other earning assets

 
33

 

Operating lease assets settled with other earning assets

 
15

 


SECURITIES PURCHASED UNDER AGREEMENTS TO RESELL AND SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE
Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as collateralized financing transactions. It is Regions’ policy to take possession of securities purchased under resell agreements either through direct delivery or a tri-party agreement.
DEBT SECURITIES
Management determines the appropriate accounting classification of debt securities at the time of purchase, based on intent, and periodically re-evaluates such designations. Debt securities are classified as held to maturity when the Company has the intent and ability to hold the securities to maturity. Debt securities held to maturity are presented at amortized cost. Debt securities not classified as held to maturity are classified as available for sale. Debt securities available for sale are presented at estimated fair value with changes in unrealized gains and losses, net of taxes, reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for discussion of determining fair value.
The amortized cost of debt securities classified as held to maturity and available for sale is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts to maturity, or in the case of mortgage-backed securities, over the estimated life of the security, using the interest method. Such amortization or accretion is included in interest income on securities. Realized gains and losses are included in net securities gains (losses). The cost of securities sold is based on the specific identification method.
The Company reviews its securities portfolio on a regular basis to determine if there are any conditions indicating that a security has other-than-temporary impairment. For debt securities, factors include the credit standing of the issuer, whether the Company expects to receive all scheduled principal and interest payments, Regions’ intent to sell and whether it is more likely than not that the Company will have to sell the security before its market value recovers. For debt securities, activity related to the credit loss component of other-than-temporary impairment is recognized in earnings as part of net securities gains (losses). Refer to Note 4 for further detail and information on securities.
LOANS HELD FOR SALE
Regions’ loans held for sale include commercial loans, investor real estate loans and residential real estate mortgage loans. Loans held for sale are recorded at either estimated fair value, if the fair value option is elected, or the lower of cost or estimated fair value. Regions has elected to account for residential real estate mortgages originated with the intent to sell at fair value. Intent is established for these conforming residential real estate mortgage loans when Regions enters into an interest rate lock commitment. Gains and losses on these residential mortgage loans held for sale for which the fair value option has been elected are included in mortgage income. Certain commercial mortgage loans held for sale where management has elected the fair value option are recorded at fair value. Gains and losses on commercial mortgage loans held for sale for which the fair value option has been elected are included in capital markets income. Regions also transfers certain commercial, investor real estate, and residential real estate mortgage portfolio loans to held for sale when management has the intent to sell in the near term. These held for sale loans are recorded at the lower of cost or estimated fair value. At the time of transfer, write-downs on the loans are recorded as charge-offs and a new cost basis is established. Any subsequent lower of cost or market adjustment is determined on an individual loan basis and is recognized in other non-interest expense. Gains and losses on the sale of non-performing commercial and investor real estate loans are included in other non-interest expense when realized as such amounts are viewed as credit costs.  Gains and losses on

96





sales of performing loans are included in non-interest income. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for discussion of determining estimated fair value.
LOANS
Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are considered loans held for investment (or portfolio loans). Loans held for investment are carried at the principal amount outstanding, net of premiums, discounts, unearned income and deferred loan fees and costs. Regions' loans balance is comprised of commercial, investor real estate and consumer loans. Interest income on all types of loans is accrued based on the contractual interest rate and the principal amount outstanding using methods that approximate the interest method, except for those loans classified as non-accrual. Premiums and discounts on purchased loans and non-refundable loan origination and commitment fees, net of direct costs of originating or acquiring loans, are deferred and recognized over the estimated lives of the related loans as an adjustment to the loans’ constant effective yield, which is included in interest income on loans. See Note 5 for further detail and information on loans.
Regions engages in both direct and leveraged lease financing. The net investment in direct financing leases is the sum of all minimum lease payments and estimated residual values, less unearned income. Unearned income is recognized over the terms of the leases to produce a constant effective yield. The net investment in leveraged leases is the sum of all lease payments (less non-recourse debt payments) and estimated residual values, less unearned income. Income from leveraged leases is recognized over the term of the leases based on the unrecovered equity investment.
Regions determines past due or delinquency status of a loan based on contractual payment terms.
Commercial and investor real estate loans are placed on non-accrual if any of the following conditions occur: 1) collection in full of contractual principal and interest is no longer reasonably assured (even if current as to payment status), 2) a partial charge-off has occurred, unless the loan has been brought current under its contractual terms (original or restructured terms) and the full originally contracted principal and interest is considered to be fully collectible, or 3) the loan is delinquent on any principal or interest for 90 days or more unless the obligation is secured by collateral having a net realizable value (estimated fair value less costs to sell) sufficient to fully discharge the obligation and the loan is in the legal process of collection. Factors considered regarding full collection include assessment of changes in borrower’s cash flow, valuation of underlying collateral, ability and willingness of guarantors to provide credit support, and other conditions. Charge-offs on commercial and investor real estate loans are primarily based on the facts and circumstances of the individual loan and occur when available information confirms the loan is not or will not be fully collectible. Factors considered in making these determinations are the borrower’s and any guarantor’s ability and willingness to pay, the status of the account in bankruptcy court (if applicable), and collateral value. Commercial and investor real estate loan relationships of $250,000 or less are subject to charge-off or charge down to estimated fair value at 180 days past due, based on collateral value.
Non-accrual and charge-off decisions for consumer loans are dictated by the FFIEC's Uniform Retail Credit Classification and Account Management Policy which establishes standards for the classification and treatment of consumer loans. The charge-off process drives consumer non-accrual status as follows. If a consumer loan secured by real estate in a first lien position (residential first mortgage or home equity) becomes 180 days past due, Regions evaluates the loan for non-accrual status and potential charge-off based on net loan to value exposure. For home equity loans and lines of credit in a second lien position, the evaluation is performed at 120 days past due. If a loan is secured by collateral having a net realizable value sufficient to fully discharge the obligation, then a partial write-down is not necessary and the loan remains on accrual status, provided it is in the process of legal collection. If a partial charge-off is necessary as a result of the evaluation, then the remaining balance is placed on non-accrual. Consumer loans not secured by real estate are generally charged-off at either 120 days past due for closed-end loans, 180 days past due for open-end loans other than credit cards or the end of the month in which the loan becomes 180 days past due for credit cards.
When loans are placed on non-accrual status, the accrual of interest, amortization of loan premium, accretion of loan discount and amortization/accretion of deferred net loan fees/costs are discontinued. When a commercial or investor real estate loan is placed on non-accrual status, uncollected interest accrued in the current year is reversed and charged to interest income. Uncollected interest accrued from prior years on commercial and investor real estate loans placed on non-accrual status in the current year is charged against the allowance for loan losses. When a consumer loan is placed on non-accrual status, all uncollected interest accrued is reversed and charged to interest income due to immateriality. Interest collections on commercial and investor real estate non-accrual loans are applied as principal reductions. Interest collections on consumer loans are recorded using the cash basis, due to immateriality.
All loans on non-accrual status may be returned to accrual status and interest accrual resumed if all of the following conditions are met: 1) the loan is brought contractually current as to both principal and interest, 2) future payments are reasonably expected to continue being received in accordance with the terms of the loan and repayment ability can be reasonably demonstrated, and 3) the loan has been performing for at least six months.

97





ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
Regions' allowance for credit losses (“allowance”) consists of two components: the allowance for loan losses, which is recorded as a contra-asset to loans, and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments, which is recorded in other liabilities. The allowance is reduced by actual losses (charge-offs) and increased by recoveries, if any. Regions charges losses against the allowance in the period the loss is confirmed. All adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are charged directly to expense through the provision for loan losses. All adjustments to the reserve for unfunded credit commitments are recorded in other non-interest expense.
The allowance is maintained at a level believed appropriate by management to absorb probable credit losses inherent in the loan and unfunded credit commitment portfolios in accordance with GAAP and regulatory guidelines. Management’s determination of the appropriateness of the allowance is a quarterly process and is based on an evaluation and rating of the loan portfolio segments, historical loan loss experience, current economic conditions, collateral values securing loans, levels of problem loans, volume, growth, quality and composition of the loan portfolio, regulatory guidance, and other relevant factors. Changes in any of these, or other factors, or the availability of new information, could require that the allowance be adjusted in future periods. Actual losses could vary from management’s estimates. Management attributes portions of the allowance to loans that it evaluates and determines to be impaired and to groups of loans that it evaluates collectively. However, the entire allowance is available to cover all charge-offs that arise from the loan portfolio.
CALCULATION OF ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
Commercial and Investor Real Estate Components
Impaired Loans
Loans deemed to be impaired include non-accrual loans, excluding consumer loans, and all TDRs. Regions considers the current value of collateral, credit quality of any guarantees, guarantor’s liquidity and willingness to repay, the loan structure, and other factors when evaluating whether an individual loan is impaired. Other factors may include the industry and geographic region of the borrower, size and financial condition of the borrower, cash flow and leverage of the borrower and Regions’ evaluation of the borrower’s management. For non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans (including TDRs) equal to or greater than $2.5 million , the allowance for loan losses is based on a note-level evaluation considering the facts and circumstances specific to each borrower. For these loans, Regions measures the level of impairment based on the present value of the estimated cash flows, the estimated value of the collateral or, if available, the observable market price. Regions generally uses the estimated cash flow method to measure impairment. For commercial and investor real estate accruing TDRs and all non-accruing loans less than $2.5 million , the allowance for loan losses is based on a discounted cash flow analysis performed at the note level, where estimated projected cash flows reflect credit losses based on statistical information (including historical default information) derived from loans with similar risk characteristics (e.g., credit quality indicator and product type) using PDs and LGDs as described in the following paragraph.
Non-Impaired Loans
For all other commercial and investor real estate loans, the allowance for loan losses is calculated at a pool level based on credit quality indicators and product type. Statistically determined PDs and LGDs are calculated based on historical default and loss information for similar loans. The historical default and loss information is measured over a relevant period for each loan pool. The pool level allowance is calculated using the PD and LGD estimates and is adjusted as appropriate based on additional analysis of long-term average loss experience compared to previously forecasted losses, external loss data and other risks identified from current economic conditions and credit quality trends. Various one year PD measurements are used in conjunction with life-of-loan LGD measurements to estimate incurred losses. As a result, losses are effectively covered over a two to three year period for loans that are currently in default and those estimated to default within the next twelve months.
Consumer Components
For consumer loans, the classes are segmented into pools of loans with similar risk characteristics. For most consumer loan pools, historical losses are the primary factor in establishing the allowance allocated to each pool. The twelve month loss rate is the basis for the allocation and it may be adjusted based on deteriorating trends, portfolio growth, or other factors determined by management to be relevant.
The allowance for loan losses for the residential first mortgage non-TDR pool is calculated based on a twelve-month historical loss rate segmented based on the following risk characteristics: past due and accrual status and further by geography, property use and amortization type for accruing, non-past due loans. The allowance for loan losses for residential first mortgage TDRs is calculated based on a discounted cash flow analysis on pools of homogeneous loans. Cash flows are projected using the restructured terms and then discounted at the original note rate. The projected cash flows assume a default rate, which is based on historical performance of residential first mortgage TDRs. The allowance for loan losses for the home equity pool is calculated based on a twelve-month historical loss rate segmented based on the following risk characteristics: lien position, TDR status, geography, non-accrual and past due status, and refreshed FICO scores for accruing, non-past due loans.

98





Qualitative Factors
While quantitative allowance methodologies strive to reflect all risk factors, any estimate involves assumptions and uncertainties resulting in some level of imprecision. Imprecision exists in the estimation process due to the inherent time lag of obtaining information and variations between estimates and actual outcomes. Regions adjusts the allowance in consideration of quantitative and qualitative factors which may not be directly measured in the note-level or pooled calculations, including, but not limited to:
Credit quality trends,
Loss experience in particular portfolios,
Macroeconomic factors such as unemployment, real estate prices, or commodity pricing volatility,
Changes in risk selection and underwriting standards,
Shifts in credit quality of consumer customers which is not yet reflected in the historical data,
Volatility associated with large individual credits.
Reserve for Unfunded Credit Commitments
In order to estimate a reserve for unfunded commitments, Regions uses a process consistent with that used in developing the allowance for loan losses. The reserve is based on an EAD multiplied by a PD multiplied by an LGD. The EAD is estimated based on an analysis of historical funding patterns for defaulted loans in various categories. The PD and LGD align with the statistically-calculated parameters used to calculate the allowance for loan losses for various pools, which are based on credit quality indicators and product type. The methodology applies to commercial and investor real estate credit commitments and standby letters of credit that are not unconditionally cancellable.
Refer to Note 6 for further discussion regarding the calculation of the allowance for credit losses.
TDRs
TDRs are loans in which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty at the time of restructuring, and Regions has granted a concession to the borrower. TDRs are undertaken in order to improve the likelihood of recovery on the loan and may take the form of modifications made with the stated interest rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, other modifications to the structure of the loan that fall outside of normal underwriting policies and procedures, or in limited circumstances forgiveness of principal and/or interest. TDRs can involve loans remaining on non-accrual, moving to non-accrual, or continuing on accrual status, depending on the individual facts and circumstances of the borrower. TDRs are subject to policies governing accrual/non-accrual evaluation consistent with all other loans of the same product type as discussed in the “Loans” section above. All loans with the TDR designation are considered to be impaired, even if they are accruing. See the “Calculation of Allowance For Credit Losses” section above for Regions’ allowance for loan losses methodology related to TDRs.
The CAP was designed to evaluate potential consumer loan participants as early as possible in the life cycle of the troubled loan (as described in Note 6). Many of the modifications are finalized without the borrower ever reaching the applicable number of days past due, and therefore the loan may never be placed on non-accrual. Accordingly, given the positive impact of the restructuring on the likelihood of recovery of cash flows due under the modified terms, accrual status continues to be appropriate for these loans.
OTHER EARNING ASSETS
Other earning assets consist primarily of investments in FRB stock, FHLB stock, marketable equity securities and operating lease assets. See Note 8 for additional information.
INVESTMENTS IN FEDERAL RESERVE BANK AND FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK STOCK
Ownership of FRB and FHLB stock is a requirement for all banks seeking membership into and access to the services provided by these banking systems. These shares are accounted for at amortized cost, which approximates fair value.
MARKETABLE EQUITY SECURITIES
Marketable equity securities are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value reported in net income.
INVESTMENTS IN OPERATING LEASES
Investments in operating leases represent the assets underlying the related lease contracts and are reported at cost, less accumulated depreciation and net of origination fees and costs. Depreciation on these assets is generally provided on a straight-line basis over the lease term down to an estimated residual value. Regions periodically evaluates its depreciation rate for leased assets based on projected residual values and adjusts depreciation expense over the remaining life of the lease if deemed appropriate. Regions also evaluates the current value of the operating lease assets and tests for impairment when indicators of impairment are present. Income from operating lease assets includes lease origination fees, net of lease origination costs, and is recognized as

99





operating lease revenue on a straight line basis over the scheduled lease term. The accrual of revenue on operating leases is generally discontinued at the time an account is determined to be uncollectible. Operating lease revenue and the depreciation expense on the related operating lease assets are included as components of net interest income and other financing income on the consolidated statements of income. When a leased asset is returned, its remaining value is reclassified from other earning assets to other assets and recorded at the lower of cost or estimated fair value, less costs to sell, on Regions' consolidated balance sheet. Impairment of the operating lease asset, as well as residual value gains and losses at the end of the lease term are recorded through other non-interest income.
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
Premises and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization, as applicable. Land is carried at cost. Depreciation expense is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the improvements (or the terms of the leases, if shorter). Generally, premises and leasehold improvements are depreciated or amortized over 7 - 40 years. Furniture and equipment are generally depreciated or amortized over 3 - 10 years. Premises and equipment are evaluated for impairment at least annually, or more often if events or circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the asset may not be recoverable. Maintenance and repairs are charged to non-interest expense in the consolidated statements of income. Improvements that extend the useful life of the asset are capitalized to the carrying value and depreciated. See Note 9 for detail of premises and equipment.
Regions enters into lease transactions for the right to use assets. These leases vary in term and, from time to time, include incentives and/or rent escalations. Examples of incentives include periods of “free” rent and leasehold improvement incentives. Regions recognizes incentives and escalations on a straight-line basis over the lease term as a reduction of or increase to rent expense, as applicable, within net occupancy expense in the consolidated statements of income.
INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Intangible assets include goodwill, which is the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets of acquired businesses, and other identifiable intangible assets. Other identifiable intangible assets primarily include the following: 1) core deposit intangible assets, which are amounts recorded related to the value of acquired indeterminate maturity deposits, 2) amounts capitalized related to the value of acquired customer relationships, and 3) the DUS license. Core deposit intangibles and certain other identifiable intangibles are amortized on an accelerated basis over their expected useful lives.
The Company’s goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis in the fourth quarter, or more often if events or circumstances indicate that there may be impairment. Regions assesses the following indicators of goodwill impairment for each reporting period:
Recent operating performance,
Changes in market capitalization,
Regulatory actions and assessments,
Changes in the business climate (including legislation, legal factors and competition),
Company-specific factors (including changes in key personnel, asset impairments, and business dispositions), and
Trends in the banking industry.
Adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations, or other factors could result in a decline in the implied estimated fair value of goodwill. Accounting guidance permits the Company to first assess qualitative factors to determine if it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying value. If, based on the weight of the evidence, the Company determines it is more likely than not that the fair value exceeds book value, then an impairment test is not necessary. If the Company elects to bypass the qualitative assessment, or concludes that it is more likely than not that the fair value is less than the carrying value, a two-step goodwill impairment test is performed. Step One compares the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the estimated fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is considered not impaired. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its estimated fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test is performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. Step Two of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied estimated fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If the carrying amount of goodwill for that reporting unit exceeds the implied estimated fair value of that unit’s goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in other non-interest expense in an amount equal to that excess.
For purposes of performing the qualitative assessment, Regions evaluates events and circumstances which may include, but are not limited to, events and circumstances since the last impairment analysis, recent operating performance including reporting unit performance, changes in market capitalization, regulatory actions and assessments, changes in the business climate, company-specific factors, and trends in the banking industry to determine if it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount.

100





For purposes of performing Step One of the goodwill impairment test, if applicable, Regions uses both income and market approaches to value its reporting units. The income approach, which is the primary valuation approach, consists of discounting projected long-term future cash flows, which are derived from internal forecasts and economic expectations for the respective reporting units. The significant inputs to the income approach include expected future cash flows, the long-term target equity ratios, and the discount rate.
For purposes of performing Step Two of the goodwill impairment test, if applicable, Regions compares the implied estimated fair value of the reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. In order to determine the implied estimated fair value, a full purchase price allocation would be performed in the same manner as if a business combination had occurred. As part of the Step Two analysis, Regions estimates the fair value of all of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit, including unrecognized assets and liabilities. The related valuation methodologies for certain material financial assets and liabilities are discussed in the “Fair Value Measurements” section below.
Other identifiable intangible assets, primarily core deposit intangibles, purchased credit card relationships and other acquired customer relationships, are reviewed at least annually (usually in the fourth quarter) for events or circumstances that could impact the recoverability of the intangible asset. These events could include loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card or other types of acquired customer accounts and/or balances, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent other identifiable intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, impairment losses are recorded in other non-interest expense and reduce the carrying amount of the asset.
Refer to Note 10 for further detail and discussion of the results of the goodwill and other identifiable intangibles impairment tests.
ACCOUNTING FOR TRANSFERS AND SERVICING OF FINANCIAL ASSETS
Regions accounts for transfers of financial assets as sales when control over the transferred assets is surrendered. Control is generally considered to have been surrendered when 1) the transferred assets are legally isolated from the Company or its consolidated affiliates, even in bankruptcy or other receivership, 2) the transferee has the right to pledge or exchange the assets with no conditions that constrain the transferee and provide more than a trivial benefit to the Company, and 3) the Company does not maintain the obligation or unilateral ability to reclaim or repurchase the assets. If these sale criteria are met, the transferred assets are removed from the Company’s balance sheet and a gain or loss on sale is recognized. If not met, the transfer is recorded as a secured borrowing, and the assets remain on the Company’s balance sheet, the proceeds from the transaction are recognized as a liability, and gain or loss on sale is deferred until the sale criterion are achieved.
Regions has elected to account for its residential MSRs using the fair value measurement method. Under the fair value measurement method, residential MSRs are measured at estimated fair value each period with changes in fair value recorded as a component of mortgage income. The fair value of residential MSRs is calculated using various assumptions including future cash flows, market discount rates, expected prepayment rates, servicing costs and other factors. A significant change in prepayments of residential mortgages in the servicing portfolio could result in significant valuation adjustments, thus creating potential volatility in the carrying amount of residential MSRs. The valuation method relies on an OAS to consider prepayment risk and equate the asset's discounted cash flows to its market price. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for additional discussion regarding determination of fair value.
Regions is a DUS lender. The DUS program provides liquidity to the multi-family housing market. Regions' related commercial MSRs are recorded in other assets on the consolidated balance sheets at the lower of cost or estimated fair value and are amortized in proportion to, and over the estimated period that net servicing income is expected to be received based on projections of the amount and timing of estimated future net cash flows. The amount and timing of estimated future net cash flows are updated based on actual results and updated projections. Regions periodically evaluates its commercial MSRs for impairment. Regions has a one-third loss share guarantee associated with the majority of the DUS servicing portfolio. The other two-thirds loss share guarantee is retained by Fannie Mae. The estimated fair value of the loss share guarantee is recorded in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets.
Refer to Note 7 for further information on servicing of financial assets.
FORECLOSED PROPERTY AND OTHER REAL ESTATE
Other real estate and certain other assets acquired in satisfaction of indebtedness (“foreclosure”) are carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the loan or estimated fair value less estimated costs to sell the property. At the date of transfer from the loan portfolio, if the recorded investment in the loan exceeds the property’s estimated fair value less estimated costs to sell, a write-down is recorded against the allowance. Regions allows a period of up to 60 days after the date of transfer to record finalized write-downs as charge-offs against the allowance in order to properly accumulate all related invoices and updated valuation information, if necessary. Subsequent to transfer, Regions obtains valuations from professional valuation experts and/or third party appraisers on at least an annual basis. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for additional discussion regarding determination of fair value. Subsequent to transfer and the additional 60 days, any further write-downs are recorded as

101





other non-interest expense. Gain or loss on the sale of foreclosed property and other real estate is included in other non-interest expense. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , the carrying values of foreclosed properties were immaterial.
From time to time, assets classified as premises and equipment are transferred to held for sale for various reasons. These assets are carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the asset or estimated fair value less estimated cost to sell based upon the property’s appraised value at the date of transfer. Any write-downs of property held for sale are recorded as other non-interest expense.
DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING ACTIVITIES
The Company enters into derivative financial instruments to manage interest rate risk, facilitate asset/liability management strategies and manage other exposures. These instruments primarily include interest rate swaps, options on interest rate swaps, options including interest rate caps and floors, Eurodollar futures, forward rate contracts and forward sale commitments. All derivative financial instruments are recognized on the consolidated balance sheets as other assets or other liabilities, as applicable, at estimated fair value. Regions enters into master netting agreements with counterparties and/or requires collateral to cover exposures. In at least some cases, counterparties post collateral at a zero threshold regardless of credit rating. The majority of interest rate derivatives traded by Regions with dealing counterparties are subject to mandatory clearing through a central clearinghouse. The variation margin payments made for derivatives cleared through a central clearinghouse are legally characterized as settlements of the derivatives. As a result, these positions are reflected as settled with no fair value presented for purposes of the balance sheet and related disclosures. The counterparty risk for cleared trades effectively moves from the executing broker to the clearinghouse allowing Regions to benefit from the risk mitigation controls in place at the respective clearinghouse.
Interest rate swaps are agreements to exchange interest payments based upon notional amounts. Interest rate swaps subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates, changes in interest rate volatility as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform. Option contracts involve rights to buy or sell financial instruments on a specified date or over a period at a specified price. These rights do not have to be exercised. Some option contracts such as interest rate floors, involve the exchange of cash based on changes in specified indices. Interest rate floors are contracts to hedge interest rate declines based on a notional amount, generally associated with a principal balance at risk. Interest rate floors subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates, changes in interest rate volatility, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform. Forward rate contracts are commitments to buy or sell financial instruments at a future date at a specified price or yield. Regions primarily enters into forward rate contracts on marketable instruments, which expose Regions to market risk associated with changes in the value of the underlying financial instrument, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform. Eurodollar futures are futures contracts on Eurodollar deposits. Eurodollar futures subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates. Because futures contracts are cash settled daily through a margining process in an exchange, there is minimal credit risk associated with Eurodollar futures. Forward sale commitments are sales of securities at a specified price at a future date. Forward sale commitments subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in market value, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform.
The Company elects to account for certain derivative financial instruments as accounting hedges which, based on the exposure being hedged, are either fair value or cash flow hedges.
Fair value hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the change in fair value of the hedged risk in an asset, liability or firm commitment. Under the fair value hedging model, gains or losses attributable to the change in fair value of the derivative instrument, as well as the gains and losses attributable to the change in fair value of the hedged item, are recognized in interest income or interest expense in the same income statement line item with the hedged item in the period in which the change in fair value occurs. To the extent the changes in fair value of the derivative do not offset the changes in fair value of the hedged item, the difference is recognized. The corresponding adjustment to the hedged asset or liability is included in the basis of the hedged item, while the corresponding change in the fair value of the derivative instrument is recorded as an adjustment to other assets or other liabilities, as applicable.
Cash flow hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the variability of future cash flows or other forecasted transactions. For cash flow hedge relationships, the entire change in the fair value of the hedging instrument would be recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income except for amounts excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness. Amounts recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) are recognized in earnings in the same income statement line item where the earnings effect of the hedged item is presented in the period or periods during which the hedged item impacts earnings.
The Company formally documents all hedging relationships, as well as its risk management objective and strategy for entering into various hedge transactions. The Company performs periodic qualitative and quantitative assessments to determine whether the hedging relationship has been highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of hedged items and whether the relationship is expected to continue to be highly effective in the future.
If a hedge relationship is de-designated or if hedge accounting is discontinued because the hedged item no longer meets the definition of a firm commitment, or because it is probable that the forecasted transaction will not occur, the derivative will continue to be recorded as an other asset or other liability in the consolidated balance sheets at its estimated fair value, with changes in fair value recognized in other non-interest expense. Any asset or liability that was recorded pursuant to recognition of the firm

102





commitment is removed from the consolidated balance sheets and recognized in other non-interest expense. Gains and losses that were unrecognized and aggregated in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) pursuant to the hedge of a forecasted transaction are recognized immediately in other non-interest expense.
Derivative contracts for which the Company has not elected to apply hedge accounting are classified as other assets or liabilities with gains and losses related to the change in fair value recognized in capital markets fee income and other or mortgage income, as applicable, in the statements of income during the period. These positions, as well as non-derivative instruments, are used to mitigate economic and accounting volatility related to customer derivative transactions, the mortgage pipeline and the fair value of residential MSRs.
Regions enters into interest rate lock commitments, which are commitments to originate mortgage loans whereby the interest rate on the loan is determined prior to funding and the customers have locked into that interest rate. Accordingly, such commitments are recorded at estimated fair value with changes in fair value recorded in mortgage income or capital markets fee income and other, as applicable. Regions also has corresponding forward sale commitments related to these interest rate lock commitments, which are recorded at estimated fair value with changes in fair value recorded in mortgage income or capital markets fee income and other, as applicable. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for additional information related to the valuation of interest rate lock commitments.
Regions enters into various derivative agreements with customers desiring protection from possible future market fluctuations. Regions manages the market risk associated with these derivative agreements. The contracts in this portfolio for which the Company has elected not to apply hedge accounting are marked-to-market through earnings and included in other assets and other liabilities.
Concurrent with the election to use fair value measurement for residential MSRs, Regions began using various derivative instruments to mitigate the impact of changes in the fair value of residential MSRs in the statements of income. This effort may involve the use of various derivative instruments, including, but not limited to, forwards, futures, swaps and options. These derivatives are carried at estimated fair value, with changes in fair value reported in mortgage income.
Refer to Note 21 for further discussion and details of derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
INCOME TAXES
The Company accounts for income taxes using the asset and liability method, which requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for expected future tax consequences. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined by applying the federal and state tax rates to the differences between financial statement carrying amounts and the corresponding tax bases of assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets are also recorded for any tax attributes, such as tax credit and net operating loss carryforwards. The net balance of deferred tax assets and liabilities is reported in other assets or other liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets, as appropriate. Any effect of a change in federal and state tax rates on deferred tax assets and liabilities is recognized in income tax expense in the period that includes the enactment date. Excluding the effects of Tax Reform, as discussed in Note 20 and the "Recent Accounting Pronouncements and Accounting Changes" section below, the impact of changes in tax rates related to unrealized gains and losses included in accumulated other comprehensive income is immaterial. The Company reflects the expected amount of income tax to be paid or refunded during the year as current income tax expense or benefit, as applicable.
The Company determines the realization of deferred tax assets by considering all positive and negative evidence available, including the impact of recent operating results, future reversals of taxable temporary differences, future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards and tax planning strategies. A valuation allowance is recorded for any deferred tax assets that are not more-likely-than-not to be realized.
Income tax benefits generated from uncertain tax positions are accounted for using the recognition and cumulative-probability measurement thresholds. Based on the technical merits, if a tax benefit is not more-likely-than-not of being sustained upon examination, the Company records a liability for the recognized income tax benefit. If a tax benefit is more-likely-than-not of being sustained based on the technical merits, the Company utilizes the cumulative probability measurement and records an income tax benefit equivalent to the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50 percent likely to be realized upon ultimate settlement with a taxing authority. The Company recognizes interest expense, interest income and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits within current income tax expense.
The Company applies the proportional amortization method in accounting for its qualified affordable housing investments. This method recognizes the amortized cost of the investment as a component of income tax expense.
The deferral method of accounting is used for investments that generate investment tax credits. Under this method, the investment tax credits are recognized as a reduction of the related asset.
Refer to Note 20 for further discussion regarding income taxes.

103





TREASURY STOCK AND SHARE REPURCHASES
The purchase of the Company’s common stock is recorded at cost. At the date of repurchase, stockholders' equity is reduced by the repurchase price. Upon retirement, or upon purchase for constructive retirement, treasury stock would be reduced by the cost of such stock with the excess of repurchase price over par or stated value recorded in additional paid-in capital. If the Company subsequently reissues treasury shares, treasury stock is reduced by the cost of such stock with differences recorded in additional paid-in capital or retained earnings, as applicable.
Pursuant to recent share repurchase programs, shares repurchased were immediately retired, and therefore were not included in treasury stock. The Company's policy related to these share repurchases is to reduce its common stock based on the par value of the shares repurchased and to reduce its additional paid-in capital for the excess of the repurchase price over the par value.
SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS
Regions sponsors stock plans which most commonly include restricted stock (i.e., unvested common stock) units, restricted stock awards, performance stock units and stock options. The Company accounts for share-based payments under the fair value recognition provisions whereby compensation cost is measured based on the estimated fair value of the award at the grant date and is recognized in the consolidated financial statements on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for service-based awards. The fair value of restricted stock units, restricted stock awards or performance stock units is determined based on the closing price of Regions common stock on the date of grant. Historical data is also used to estimate future employee attrition, which is considered in calculating estimated forfeitures. Estimated forfeitures are adjusted when actual forfeitures differ from estimates, resulting in the recognition of compensation cost only for awards that vest. The effect of a change in estimated forfeitures is recognized through a cumulative catch-up adjustment that is included in compensation cost in the period of the change in estimate. The fair value of stock options where vesting is based on service is estimated at the date of grant using a Black-Scholes option pricing model and related assumptions. As compensation cost is recognized, a deferred tax asset is recorded that represents an estimate of the future tax deduction from exercise or release of restrictions. At the time the share-based awards are exercised, cancelled, have expired, or restrictions are released, the Company may be required to recognize an adjustment to tax expense depending on the market price of the Company’s common stock.
See Note 17 for further discussion and details of share-based payments.
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
Regions uses an expected long-term rate of return applied to the fair market value of assets as of the beginning of the year and the expected cash flows during the year for calculating the expected investment return on all pension plan assets. At a minimum, amortization of the net gain or loss included in accumulated other comprehensive income resulting from experience different from that assumed and from changes in assumptions is included as a component of net periodic benefit cost if, as of the beginning of the year, that net gain or loss exceeds 10 percent of the greater of the projected benefit obligation or the market value of plan assets. If amortization is required, the minimum amortization is that excess divided by the average remaining service period of active participating employees expected to receive benefits under the plans. Regions records the service cost component of net periodic pension and postretirement benefit cost in salaries and employee benefits on the consolidated statements of income. The other components of net periodic pension and postretirement benefit cost are recorded in other non-interest expense on the consolidated statements of income. Regions uses a third-party actuary to compute the remaining service period of active participating employees. This period reflects expected turnover, pre-retirement mortality, and other applicable employee demographics.
REVENUE RECOGNITION
Interest Income
The largest source of revenue for Regions is interest income. Interest income is recognized using the interest method driven by nondiscretionary formulas based on written contracts, such as loan agreements or securities contracts.
Service Charges on Deposit Accounts
Service charges on deposit accounts include non-sufficient fund fees and other service charges. Non-sufficient fund fees are earned when a depositor presents an item for payment in excess of available funds, and Regions, at its discretion, provides the necessary funds to complete the transaction.
Regions generates other service charges by providing depositors proper safeguard and remittance of funds as well as by providing optional services for depositors, such as check imaging or treasury management, that are performed upon the depositor’s request. Charges for the proper safeguard and remittance of funds are recognized monthly, as the customer retains funds in the account. Regions recognizes revenue for other optional services at the point in time the customer uses the selected service to execute a transaction (e.g. execute an ACH wire).
Card and ATM Fees
Card and ATM fees include the combined amounts of credit card, debit card, and ATM related revenue. The majority of the fees are card interchange where Regions earns a fee for remitting cardholder funds (or extends credit) via a third party network to

104





merchants. Regions satisfies performance obligations for each transaction at the point in time the card is used and the funds are remitted. The network establishes interchange fees that the merchant remits to Regions for each transaction, and Regions incurs costs from the network for facilitating the interchange with the merchant. Due to its inability to establish prices and direct activities of the related processing network’s service, Regions is deemed the agent in this arrangement and records interchange revenues net of related costs. Regions also pays consideration to certain commercial card holders based on interchange fees and contractual volume. These costs are recognized as a reduction to interchange income.
Card and ATM fees also include ATM fee income generated from allowing a Regions cardholder to withdraw funds from a non-Regions ATM and from allowing a non-Regions cardholder to withdraw funds from a Regions ATM. Regions satisfies performance obligations for each transaction at the point in time that the withdrawal is processed. Regions does not direct activities of the related processing network’s service and recognizes revenue on a net basis as the agent in each transaction.
Investment Management and Trust Fee Income
Investment management and trust fee income represents revenue generated from asset management services provided to individuals, businesses, and institutions. Regions has a fiduciary responsibility to the beneficiary of the trust to perform agreed upon services which can include investing the assets, periodic reporting to the beneficiaries, and providing tax information regarding the trust. In exchange for these trust and custodial services, Regions collects fee income from beneficiaries as contractually determined via fee schedules. Regions’ performance obligations to customers are primarily satisfied over time as the services are performed and provided to the customer.
Mortgage Income
Mortgage income and related fees are recognized when earned as Regions services mortgage loans for others. Mortgage income also includes gains or losses on Regions’ sales of mortgage loans to other financial institutions or government agencies which are recognized as each sales transaction occurs.
Capital Markets Income
Regions generates capital markets fee revenue through capital raising activities which include revenue streams such as securities underwriting and placement, loan syndication and placement, as well as foreign exchange, derivatives, merger and acquisition and other advisory services. For those revenue streams, revenue is primarily recognized at a point in time which coincides with the satisfaction of a single performance obligation, typically the transaction closing.
Securities underwriting and placement fees involve the issuing and distribution of securities for an underwriting fee from customers. The underwriting fee is a single performance obligation which is satisfied at the time that the transaction is closed, and the amount of the fee is either a fixed or variable percentage based on the deal value which is determinable at the time of deal closing.
Regions generates revenue from affordable housing investments through the syndication of investment funds to third parties. Regions transfers the primary benefits of the investment to the customer and recognizes syndication revenue on the closing date of the transaction.
Bank-Owned Life Insurance
Bank-owned life insurance income primarily represents income earned from the appreciation of cash surrender value of insurance contracts held and the proceeds of insurance benefits. Regions recognizes revenue each period in the amount of the appreciation of the cash surrender value of the insurance policies. Revenue from the proceeds of insurance benefits is recognized at the time a claim is confirmed.
Commercial Credit Fee Income
Commercial credit fee income includes letters of credit fees and unused commercial commitment fees. Regions recognizes revenue for letters of credit fees over time. Regions recognizes revenue for unused commercial commitment fees on the date that the commitment expires.
Investment Services Fee Income
Investment services fee income represents income earned from investment advisory services. Through the use of third party carriers, Regions provides its customers with access to investment products that meet customers’ financial needs and investment objectives. Upon selection of an investment product, the customer enters into a policy with the carrier. Regions’ performance obligation is satisfied by fulfilling its responsibility to place customers in investment vehicles for which Regions earns commissions from the carrier based on agreed-upon fee percentages. In addition, Regions has a contractual relationship with a third party broker dealer to provide full service brokerage and investment advisory activities. As the principal in the arrangement, Regions recognizes the investment services commissions on a gross basis.
Insurance Proceeds
Insurance proceeds represent settlements from previously disclosed lawsuits. Revenue from insurance proceeds is recognized when the settlement proceeds are received.

105





Securities Gains (Losses), Net
Net securities gains or losses result from Regions’ asset/liability management process. Gains or losses on the sale of securities are recognized as each sales transaction occurs with the cost of securities sold based on the specific identification method.
Market Value Adjustments on Employee Benefit Assets
Regions holds assets for certain employee benefit assets, both defined and other. Those assets are recorded at estimated fair value and the market value variations are recognized each period.
Other Miscellaneous Income
Other miscellaneous income represents a variety of revenue streams, including check order fees, wire transfer fees and other unusual gains, if any. For check order fees, Regions generates revenue by serving as the agent in connecting the customer to a third party check provider. For wire transfer fees, Regions generates revenue by providing wire transfer services to its depositors. In both instances Regions recognizes revenue at the time the service is provided.
PER SHARE AMOUNTS
Earnings per common share is calculated by dividing net income available to common shareholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per common share is calculated by dividing net income available to common shareholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period, plus the effect of outstanding stock options, restricted and performance stock awards if dilutive. Refer to Note 16 for additional information.
FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
Fair value guidance establishes a framework for using fair value to measure assets and liabilities and defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) as opposed to the price that would be paid to acquire the asset or received to assume the liability (an entry price). A fair value measure should reflect the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including the assumptions about the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique, the effect of a restriction on the sale or use of an asset and the risk of nonperformance. Required disclosures include stratification of balance sheet amounts measured at fair value based on inputs the Company uses to derive fair value measurements. These strata include:
Level 1 valuations, where the valuation is based on quoted market prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets (which include exchanges and over-the-counter markets with sufficient volume),
Level 2 valuations, where the valuation is based on quoted market prices for similar instruments traded in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market, and
Level 3 valuations, where the valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market, but observable based on Company-specific data. These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates for assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques typically include option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques, but may also include the use of market prices of assets or liabilities that are not directly comparable to the subject asset or liability.
ITEMS MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE ON A RECURRING BASIS
Debt securities available for sale, certain mortgage loans held for sale, marketable equity securities, residential MSRs, derivative assets and derivative liabilities are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Below is a description of valuation methodologies for these assets and liabilities.
Debt securities available for sale consist of U.S. Treasuries, obligations of states and political subdivisions, mortgage-backed securities (including agency securities), and other debt securities.
U.S. Treasuries are valued based on quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges. Pricing received for U.S. Treasuries from third-party services is based on a market approach using dealer quotes from multiple active market makers and real-time trading systems. These valuations are Level 1 measurements.
Mortgage-backed securities are valued primarily using data from third-party pricing services for similar securities as applicable. Pricing from these third-party services is generally based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, benchmark securities, TBA prices, issuer spreads, bids and offers, monthly payment information, and collateral performance, as applicable. These valuations are Level 2 measurements. Where such comparable data is not available, the Company develops valuations based on assumptions that are not readily observable in the market place; these valuations are Level 3 measurements.
Obligations of states and political subdivisions are generally based on data from third-party pricing services. The valuations are based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, MSRB reported trades, material event notices and new issue data. These valuations are Level 2 measurements. Where such comparable data is not available,

106





the Company develops valuations based on assumptions that are not readily observable in the market place; these valuations are Level 3 measurements.
Other debt securities are valued based on Level 1, 2 and 3 measurements, depending on pricing methodology selected and are valued primarily using data from third-party pricing services. Pricing from these third-party services is generally based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, bids and offers, and TRACE reported trades.
The majority of Regions' debt securities available for sale are valued using third-party pricing services. To validate pricing related to liquid investment securities, which represent the vast majority of the available for sale portfolio (e.g., mortgage-backed securities), Regions compares price changes received from the third-party pricing service to overall changes in market factors in order to validate the pricing received. To validate pricing received on less liquid investment securities in the available for sale portfolio, Regions receives pricing from third-party brokers/dealers on a sample of securities that are then compared to the pricing received. The pricing service uses standard observable inputs when available, for example: benchmark yields, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, and bids and offers, among others. For certain security types, additional inputs may be used, or some inputs may not be applicable. It is not customary for Regions to adjust the pricing received for the available for sale portfolio. In the event that prices are adjusted, Regions classifies the measurement as a Level 3 measurement.
Mortgage loans held for sale consist of residential first mortgage loans and commercial mortgages held for sale. Regions has elected to measure certain residential and commercial mortgage loans held for sale at fair value by applying the fair value option (see additional discussion under the “Fair Value Option” section in Note 22). The residential first mortgage loans held for sale are valued based on traded market prices of similar assets where available and/or discounted cash flows at market interest rates, adjusted for securitization activities that include servicing value and market conditions, a Level 2 measurement. The commercial mortgage loans held for sale are valued based on traded market prices for comparable commercial mortgage-backed securitizations, into which the loans will be placed, adjusted for movements of interest rates and credit spreads, a Level 3 measurement due to the unobservable inputs included in the credit spreads for bonds in commercial mortgage-backed securitizations.
Marketable equity securities, which primarily consist of assets held for certain employee benefits and money market funds, are valued based on quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges; these valuations are Level 1 measurements.
Residential mortgage servicing rights are valued using an option-adjusted spread valuation approach, a Level 3 measurement. The underlying assumptions and estimated values are corroborated at least quarterly by values received from independent third parties. See Note 7 for information regarding the servicing of financial assets and additional details regarding the assumptions relevant to this valuation.
Derivative assets and liabilities, which primarily consist of interest rate, foreign exchange, and commodity contracts that include forwards, futures, options and swaps, are included in other assets and other liabilities (as applicable) on the consolidated balance sheets. Interest rate swaps are predominantly traded in over-the-counter markets and, as such, values are determined using widely accepted discounted cash flow models, which are Level 2 measurements. These discounted cash flow models use projections of future cash payments/receipts that are discounted at an appropriate index rate. Regions utilizes OIS curves as fair value measurement inputs for the valuation of interest rate and commodity derivatives. The projected future cash flows are sourced from an assumed yield curve, which is consistent with industry standards and conventions. These valuations are adjusted for the unsecured credit risk at the reporting date, which considers collateral posted and the impact of master netting agreements. For options and futures contracts traded in over-the-counter markets, values are determined using discounted cash flow analyses and option pricing models based on market rates and volatilities, which are Level 2 measurements. Interest rate lock commitments on loans intended for sale and risk participations categorized as credit derivatives are valued using option pricing models that incorporate significant unobservable inputs, and therefore are Level 3 measurements.
ITEMS MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE ON A NON-RECURRING BASIS
From time to time, certain assets may be recorded at fair value on a non-recurring basis. These non-recurring fair value adjustments typically are a result of the application of lower of cost or fair value accounting or a write-down occurring during the period. For example, if the fair value of an asset in these categories falls below its cost basis, it is considered to be at fair value at the end of the period of the adjustment. In periods where there is no adjustment, the asset is generally not considered to be at fair value. The following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis.
Foreclosed property and other real estate is carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the loan or fair value less estimated costs to sell the property. The fair value for foreclosed property that is based on either observable transactions of similar instruments or formally committed sale prices is classified as a Level 2 measurement. If no formally committed sale price is available, Regions also obtains valuations from professional valuation experts and/or third party appraisers. Updated valuations are obtained on at least an annual basis. Foreclosed property exceeding established dollar thresholds is valued based on appraisals. Appraisals are performed by third-parties with appropriate professional certifications and conform to generally accepted appraisal standards as evidenced by the Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice. Regions’ policies related to appraisals conform to regulations established by the Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery and Enforcement Act of 1989 and

107





other regulatory guidance. Professional valuations are considered Level 2 measurements because they are based largely on observable inputs. Regions has a centralized appraisal review function that is responsible for reviewing appraisals for compliance with banking regulations and guidelines as well as appraisal standards. Based on these reviews, Regions may make adjustments to the market value conclusions determined in the appraisals of real estate (either as other real estate or loans held for sale) when the appraisal review function determines that the valuation is based on inappropriate assumptions or where the conclusion is not sufficiently supported by the market data presented in the appraisal. Adjustments to the market value conclusions are discussed with the professional valuation experts and/or third-party appraisers; the magnitude of the adjustments that are not mutually agreed upon is insignificant. In either event, adjustments, if made, must be based on sufficient information available to support an alternate opinion of market value. An estimated standard discount factor, which is updated at least annually, is applied to the appraisal amount for certain commercial and investor real estate properties when the recorded investment in the loan is transferred into foreclosed property. Internally adjusted valuations are considered Level 3 measurements as management uses assumptions that may not be observable in the market. These non-recurring fair value measurements are typically recorded on the date an updated offered quote, appraisal, or third-party valuation is received.
Equity investments without a readily determinable fair value are adjusted prospectively to estimated fair value when an observable price transaction for a same or similar investment with the same issuer occurs; these valuations are Level 3 measurements.
Loans held for sale for which the fair value option has not been elected are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value and therefore may be reported at fair value on a non-recurring basis. The fair values for commercial loans held for sale that are based on formally committed loan sale prices or valuations performed using observable inputs are classified as a Level 2 measurement. If no formally committed sales price is available, a professional valuation is obtained, consistent with the process described above for foreclosed property and other real estate.
FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating fair values of financial instruments that are not disclosed above:
Cash and cash equivalents : The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets and cash flows approximate the estimated fair values. Because these amounts generally relate to either currency or highly liquid assets, these are considered Level 1 valuations.
Debt securities held to maturity : The fair values of debt securities held to maturity are estimated in the same manner as the corresponding debt securities available for sale, which are measured at fair value on a recurring basis.
Loans, (excluding capital leases), net of unearned income and allowance for loan losses : A discounted cash flow method under the income approach is utilized to estimate the fair value of the loan portfolio. The discounted cash flow method relies upon assumptions about the amount and timing of scheduled principal and interest payments, principal prepayments, and current market rates. The loan portfolio is aggregated into categories based on loan type and credit quality. For each loan category, weighted average statistics, such as coupon rate, age, and remaining term are calculated. These are Level 3 valuations.
Other earning assets (excluding equity investments and operating leases) : The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets approximate the estimated fair values. While these instruments are not actively traded in the market, the majority of the inputs required to value them are actively quoted and can be validated through external sources. Accordingly, these are Level 2 valuations.
Deposits : The fair value of non-interest-bearing demand accounts, interest-bearing transaction accounts, savings accounts, money market accounts and certain other time deposit accounts is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (i.e., the carrying amount). Fair values for certificates of deposit are estimated by using discounted cash flow analyses, based on market spreads to benchmark rates. These are Level 2 valuations.
Short-term and long-term borrowings : The carrying amounts of short-term borrowings reported in the consolidated balance sheets approximate the estimated fair values, and are considered Level 2 measurements as similar instruments are traded in active markets. The fair values of certain long-term borrowings are estimated using quoted market prices of identical instruments in active markets and are considered Level 1 measurements. The fair values of certain long term borrowings are estimated using quoted market prices of identical instruments in non-active markets and are considered Level 2 valuations. Otherwise, valuations are based on non-binding broker quotes and are considered Level 3 valuations.
Loan commitments and letters of credit : The estimated fair values for these off-balance sheet instruments are based on probabilities of funding to project future loan fundings, which are discounted using the loan methodology described above. The premiums/discounts are adjusted for the time value of money over the average remaining life of the commitments and the opportunity cost associated with regulatory requirements. Because the probabilities of funding and loan valuations are not observable in the market and are considered Company specific inputs, these are Level 3 valuations.
See Note 22 for additional information related to fair value measurements.

108





RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS AND ACCOUNTING CHANGES
The following table provides a brief description of accounting standards that could have a material impact to Regions’ consolidated financial statements upon adoption.
Standard
Description
Required Date of Adoption
Effect on Regions' financial statements or other significant matters
Standards Adopted (or partially adopted) in 2018
ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers

ASU 2015-14, Deferral of the Effective Date

ASU 2016-08, Principal versus Agent Considerations

ASU 2016-10, Identifying Performance Obligations and Licensing

ASU 2016-12, Narrow-Scope Improvements and Practical Expedience

ASU 2016-20, Technical Corrections and Improvements to Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers
This ASU supersedes the revenue recognition requirements in ASC Topic 605, Revenue Recognition, and most industry-specific guidance throughout the Industry topics of the Codification. The core principle of the ASU is that an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. The ASU may be adopted either retrospectively or on a modified retrospective basis.
January 1, 2018

Regions adopted the new revenue recognition standard on January 1, 2018 using the modified retrospective method. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact. For the year ended December 31, 2018, approximately $1.7 billion of non-interest income is within the scope of the new revenue recognition standard and includes service charges on deposit accounts, card and ATM fees, investment management and trust fee income, capital markets fee income, investment services fee income and other components within non-interest income. Income streams that are out of scope of the new standard include interest income, mortgage income, securities gains (losses), bank-owned life insurance and certain other components within non-interest income. Regions also developed additional quantitative and qualitative disclosures required by the new revenue recognition standard. See Note 25.

ASU 2016-01, Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Liabilities

ASU 2018-03, Technical Corrections and Improvements to Financial Instruments

ASU 2018-04, Debt Securities and Regulated Operations
This ASU amends ASC Topic 825, Financial Instruments-Overall, and addresses certain aspects of recognition, measurement, presentation, and disclosure of financial instruments. Among other minor amendments applicable to Regions, the main provisions require investments in equity securities to be measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognized through net income unless they qualify for a practicability exception (excludes investments accounted for under the equity method of accounting or those that result in consolidation of the investee). Except for disclosure requirements that have been adopted prospectively, the ASU must be adopted on a modified retrospective basis.
January 1, 2018


The adoption of this guidance resulted in trading account assets and equity securities available for sale being reclassified to other earning assets. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact. See Note 8.

ASU 2016-15, Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments
This ASU amends Topic 230, Statement of Cash Flows, and provides clarification with respect to classification within the statement of cash flows where current guidance is unclear or silent. The ASU must be adopted retrospectively.
January 1, 2018
The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact.

ASU 2017-01, Clarifying the Definition of a Business
This ASU amends Topic 805, Business Combinations, and provides additional accounting guidance to better determine when a set of assets and activities is a business. The ASU must be adopted prospectively.
January 1, 2018

The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact.

ASU 2017-05, Other Income- Gains and Losses from the Derecognition of Nonfinancial Assets
This ASU amends Subtopic 610-20, Other Income - Gains and Losses from the Derecognition of Nonfinancial Assets, to clarify the scope and to add guidance for partial sales of nonfinancial assets. The new standard adds a definition for in-substance nonfinancial assets and clarifies that nonfinancial assets within a legal entity are within the scope of ASC 606. This ASU may be adopted either retrospectively or on a modified retrospective basis.
January 1, 2018

Regions adopted the guidance using the modified retrospective method. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact.



109





Standard
Description
Required Date of Adoption
Effect on Regions' financial statements or other significant matters
Standards Adopted (or partially adopted) in 2018 (continued)
ASU 2017-07, Compensation- Retirement Benefits
This ASU amends Topic 715, Retirement Benefits, and provides more prescriptive guidance around the presentation of net periodic pension and postretirement benefit cost in the income statement. The amendment requires that the service cost component be disaggregated from other components of net periodic benefit cost in the income statement. The ASU must be adopted retrospectively.
January 1, 2018
The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact. See Note 18.
ASU 2017-09, Stock Compensation: Scope of Modification Accounting
This ASU amends Topic 718, Compensation-Stock Compensation, and clarifies when modification accounting should be applied to changes in terms or conditions of share-based payment awards. The amendments narrow the scope of modification accounting by clarifying that modification accounting should be applied to awards if the change affects the fair value, vesting conditions, or classification of the award. The amendments do not impact current disclosure requirements for modifications, regardless of whether modification accounting is required under the new guidance. The ASU must be adopted prospectively to modifications that occur on or after the adoption date.
January 1, 2018

The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact.

ASU 2017-12, Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities
This ASU amends ASC 815, Derivatives and Hedging to (1) improve the transparency and understandability of information conveyed to financial statement users about an entity’s risk management activities by better aligning the entity’s financial reporting for hedging relationships with those risk management activities and (2) reduce the complexity of and simplify the application of hedge accounting by preparers. Except for disclosure requirements that have been adopted prospectively, the ASU must be adopted on a modified retrospective basis.
January 1, 2019

Early adoption is permitted.
Regions elected to adopt this ASU for financial reporting as of January 1, 2018. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact. See Note 21.

ASU 2018-05, Income Taxes
This ASU amends SEC guidance in the Codification related to income taxes to reflect the guidance in SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin 118, which provides guidance for companies that are not able to complete their accounting for the income tax effects of the Tax Reform in the period of enactment. The staff believes that to the extent a company can reasonably estimate the impact of the Tax Reform, such items should be reported in the first reporting period in which the Company is able to determine the reasonable estimate.
Effective upon issuance.
Regions adopted this ASU upon issuance. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact.
ASU 2018-13, Fair Value Measurement


This ASU amends the disclosure requirements of Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement, to remove disclosure of transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy and to include disclosure of the range and weighted average used in Level 3 fair value measurements, among other amendments. The ASU applies to all entities that are required to provide disclosures about recurring or non-recurring fair value measurements. Amendments should be applied retrospectively to all periods presented, except for certain amendments, which should be applied prospectively for only the most recent interim or annual period presented in the initial fiscal year of adoption.
January 1, 2020

Early adoption is permitted.
Regions elected to adopt this ASU for financial reporting as of December 31, 2018. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact.
ASU 2018-14, Compensation - Retirement Benefits
This ASU amends the disclosure requirements in Topic 715, Retirement Benefits. The ASU applies to all employer entities that sponsor defined benefit pension or other post-retirement plans. Applicable disclosure changes include: the removal of amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income expected to be recognized as components of net periodic benefit cost over the next year; the removal of the effects of a one-percentage point change in assumed health care cost trend rates; and the addition of an explanation of reasons for significant gains and losses related to changes in the benefit obligation for the period. The ASU must be adopted on a retrospective basis.

January 1, 2021

Early adoption is permitted.

Regions elected to adopt this ASU for financial reporting as of December 31, 2018. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact. See Note 18.


110





Standard
Description
Required Date of Adoption
Effect on Regions' financial statements or other significant matters
Standards Not Yet Adopted
ASU 2016-02, Leases

ASU 2018-01, Land Easement Practical Expedient for Transition to Topic 842

ASU 2018-10, Narrow Amendments to Topic 842

ASU 2018-11, Targeted Improvements to Topic 842

ASU 2018-20, Narrow-Scope Improvements for Lessors
This ASU creates ASC Topic 842, Leases, and supersedes Topic 840, Leases. The new guidance requires lessees to record a right-of-use asset and a corresponding liability equal to the present value of future rental payments on their balance sheets for all leases with a term greater than one year. There are not significant changes to lessor accounting; however, there were certain improvements made to align lessor accounting with the lessee accounting model and Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers. This guidance expands both quantitative and qualitative required disclosures. This ASU should be adopted on a modified retrospective basis.
January 1, 2019
Regions adopted the standard on January 1, 2019 using the optional transition method, which allowed for a modified retrospective method of adoption with a cumulative effect adjustment to retained earnings without restating comparable periods. Regions also elected the relief package of practical expedients for which there is no requirement to reassess existence of leases, their classification, and initial direct costs as well as an exemption for short-term leases with a term of less than one year, whereby Regions does not recognize a lease liability or right-of-use asset on the balance sheet but instead recognizes lease payments as an expense over the lease term as appropriate. The adoption of this guidance resulted in recognition of a $451 million right of use asset and related liability for future lease obligations. The adoption of the standard is expected to have an immaterial impact to the consolidated statements of income.

ASU 2016-13, Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments

ASU 2018-19 Codification Improvements to Topic 326
This ASU amends Topic 326, Financial Instruments- Credit Losses to replace the current incurred loss accounting model with a current expected credit loss approach (CECL) for financial instruments measured at amortized cost and other commitments to extend credit. The amendments require entities to consider all available relevant information when estimating current expected credit losses, including details about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The resulting allowance for credit losses is to reflect the portion of the amortized cost basis that the entity does not expect to collect. The amendments also eliminate the current accounting model for purchased credit impaired loans and debt securities. Additional quantitative and qualitative disclosures are required upon adoption.

While the CECL model does not apply to available for sale debt securities, the ASU does require entities to record an allowance when recognizing credit losses for available for sale securities, rather than reduce the amortized cost of the securities by direct write-offs.

The ASU should be adopted on a modified retrospective basis. Entities that have loans accounted for under ASC 310-30 at the time of adoption should prospectively apply the guidance in this amendment for purchase credit deteriorated assets.
January 1, 2020
Regions’ cross-functional implementation team, which is co-led by Finance and Risk Management, has developed a project plan that results in running a CECL parallel production during 2019 and the adoption of the standard in the first quarter of 2020. Key project implementation activities for 2018 focused on model enhancements, continued challenge of model outputs, initial development of the qualitative framework, establishing processes and controls, drafting policies and disclosures, data resolution, and documentation. Key project implementation activities for 2019 include finalization of models, the qualitative framework, and the production process; completion of documentation, policies and disclosures; development of supporting analytics; and process and control testing. The project implementation plan also establishes a parallel processing timeline which begins with a limited parallel run in the first quarter of 2019. Parallel runs will be enhanced throughout the year to include the end-to-end production process, governance, controls and disclosures.
 
Regions provides updates to senior leadership and to the Audit Committee and Risk Committee of the Board of Directors. These communications provide an update on the status of the implementation project plan, results of initial modeled impacts, and any identified risks.
 
Adoption of the standard may result in an overall material increase in the allowance for credit losses given the change from accounting for losses inherent in the loan portfolio to accounting for losses over the remaining contractual life of the portfolio. However, the impact at adoption will be influenced by the portfolios’ composition and quality at the adoption date as well as economic conditions and forecasts at that time. Based on initial modeling, the consumer loan portfolios are expected to generate the majority of the increase including longer-dated loans such as residential first mortgages, and home equity lending products and indirect-other products. Additionally, there could be increases or decreases in the allowance in certain other loan portfolios at adoption.
 
Regions expects no material allowance on held to maturity securities because most of this portfolio consists of agency-backed securities that inherently have an immaterial risk of loss. Additionally, Regions expects no material impact to available for sale securities.
ASU 2017-04, Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment
This ASU amends Topic 350, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other, and eliminates Step 2 from the goodwill impairment test.
January 1, 2020

Early adoption is permitted.
Regions believes the adoption of this guidance will not have a material impact. Regions does not plan to early adopt.

111





Standard
Description
Required Date of Adoption
Effect on Regions' financial statements or other significant matters
Standards Not Yet Adopted
ASU 2017-08, Receivables- Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs
This ASU amends Subtopic 310-20, Receivables-Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs, to shorten the amortization period for certain purchased callable debt securities held at a premium to the earliest call date. Current guidance generally requires entities to amortize a premium as a yield adjustment over the contractual life of the instrument. Shortening the amortization period is generally expected to more closely align the recognition of interest income with expectations incorporated into the pricing of the underlying securities. The amendments do not affect the accounting treatment of discounts. This ASU should be adopted on a modified retrospective basis.
January 1, 2019

Early adoption permitted, including in an interim period.
Regions is evaluating the impact upon adoption; however, the impact is not expected to be material.
ASU 2018-07,
Compensation - Stock Compensation

This ASU amends and expands the scope of Topic 718, Compensation-Stock Compensation, to include share-based payment transactions for acquiring goods and services for non-employees. Under this guidance, the accounting for share-based payments to non-employees and employees will be substantially aligned. The measurement of equity-classified non-employee awards will now be fixed at the grant date.
January 1, 2019

Early adoption is permitted.


Regions is evaluating the impact upon adoption; however, the impact is not expected to be material.



ASU 2018-09, Codification Improvements

The FASB issued this ASU to clarify, improve, and correct errors in the Codification. The ASU covers nine amendments, which affect a wide variety of Topics including business combinations, debt, derivatives and hedging, and defined contribution pension plans. Some amendments do not require transition guidance and are effective upon issuance, while others will be applicable for Regions starting in 2019. However, all amendments are expected to have an immaterial impact to Regions.
January 1, 2019

Early adoption is permitted.


Regions believes the adoption of this guidance will not have a material impact.

ASU 2018-15, Customer’s Accounting for Fees Paid in a Cloud Computing Arrangement
This ASU amends Topic 350-40, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other-Internal-Use Software, regarding a customer's accounting for implementation, set-up, and other upfront costs incurred in a cloud computing arrangement that is hosted by the vendor, i.e. a service contract. Customers will apply the same criteria for capitalizing implementation costs as they would for an arrangement that has a software license. The amendments also prescribe the balance sheet, income statement, and cash flow classification of the capitalized implementation costs and related amortization expense, and require additional quantitative and qualitative disclosures.
January 1, 2020

Early adoption is permitted, including in an interim period.
Regions believes the adoption of this guidance will not have a material impact. Regions does not plan to early adopt.
ASU 2018-16, Derivatives and Hedging

This ASU amends Topic 815, Derivatives and Hedging, to expand the list of U.S. benchmark interest rates permitted in applying hedge accounting. The amendments permit all entities that elect to apply hedge accounting to benchmark interest rate hedges under ASC 815, Derivatives and Hedging, to use the OIS rate based on the SOFR as a U.S. benchmark interest rate in addition to the four eligible U.S. benchmark interest rates. The amendments should be applied prospectively for qualifying new or redesignated hedging relationships entered into on or after the date of adoption.
January 1, 2019

Early adoption permitted, including in an interim period.

Regions is evaluating the impact upon adoption; however, the impact is not expected to be material.

ASU 2018-17, Targeted Improvements to Related Party Guidance for Variable Interest Entities

This ASU amends Topic 810, Consolidation, guidance on how all reporting entities evaluate indirect interests held through related parties in common control arrangements when determining whether fees paid to decision makers and service providers are variable interests.
January 1, 2020

Early adoption is permitted.

Regions believes the adoption of this guidance will not have a material impact. Regions does not plan to early adopt.


112


NOTE 2. VARIABLE INTEREST ENTITIES
Regions is involved in various entities that are considered to be VIEs, as defined by authoritative accounting literature. Generally, a VIE is a corporation, partnership, trust or other legal structure that either does not have equity investors with substantive voting rights or has equity investors that do not provide sufficient financial resources for the entity to support its activities. The following discusses the VIEs in which Regions has a significant interest.
AFFORDABLE HOUSING TAX CREDIT INVESTMENTS
Regions periodically invests in various limited partnerships that sponsor affordable housing projects, which are funded through a combination of debt and equity. These partnerships meet the definition of a VIE. Regions uses the proportional amortization method to account for these investments. Due to the nature of the management activities of the general partner, Regions is not the primary beneficiary of these partnerships. See Note 1 for additional details. Additionally, Regions has loans or letters of credit commitments with certain limited partnerships. The funded portion of the loans and letters of credit are classified as commercial and industrial loans or investor real estate loans as applicable in Note 5.
A summary of Regions’ affordable housing tax credit investments and related loans and letters of credit, representing Regions’ maximum exposure to loss as of December 31 is as follows:  
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Affordable housing tax credit investments included in other assets
$
1,021

 
$
1,144

Unfunded affordable housing tax credit commitments included in other liabilities
289

 
348

Loans and letters of credit commitments
329

 
317

Funded portion of loans and letters of credit commitments
166

 
129

 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Tax credits and other tax benefits recognized
$
174

 
$
189

 
$
167

Tax credit amortization expense included in provision for income taxes
137

 
160

 
117

In addition to the investments discussed above, Regions also syndicates affordable housing investments. In these syndication transactions, Regions creates affordable housing funds in which a subsidiary is the general partner or managing member and sells limited partnership interests to third parties. Regions' general partner or managing member interest represents an insignificant interest in the affordable housing fund. The affordable housing funds meet the definition of a VIE. As Regions is not the primary beneficiary and does not have a significant interest, these investments are not consolidated. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the value of Regions’ general partnership interest in affordable housing investments was immaterial.
OTHER INVESTMENTS
Other investments determined to be VIEs include investments in CRA projects, SBICs, and other miscellaneous investments. A summary of Regions' equity method investments representing Regions' maximum exposure to loss as of December 31 is as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Gross equity method investments
$
122

 
$
104

Unfunded equity method commitments
49

 
44

Net funded equity method investments included in other assets
$
73

 
$
60

NOTE 3. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS
On April 4, 2018, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates to BB&T Insurance Holdings, Inc. The transaction closed on July 2, 2018. The gain associated with the transaction amounted to $281 million ($196 million after-tax).
In connection with the agreement, the results of the entities sold are reported in the Company's consolidated statements of income separately as discontinued operations for all periods presented.
On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James. The transaction closed on April 2, 2012. Regions Investment Management, Inc. (formerly known as Morgan Asset Management, Inc.) and Regions Trust were not included in the sale. In connection with the closing of the sale, Regions agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all litigation matters related to pre-closing activities. See Note 24 for related disclosure.

113





Results of operations for the Morgan Keegan entities sold are presented separately as discontinued operations for all periods presented on the consolidated statements of income.
The following table represents the condensed results of operations for the Regions Insurance Group, Inc. entities sold as discontinued operations:
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Interest income
$
1

 
$
1

 
$

Interest expense

 

 

Net interest income
1

 
1

 

Non-interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
Securities gains (losses), net
(1
)
 
3

 

Insurance commissions and fees
69

 
140

 
142

Gain on sale of business
281

 

 

Other

 
3

 
5

Total non-interest income
349

 
146

 
147

Non-interest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and employee benefits
49

 
96

 
102

Net occupancy expense
3

 
6

 
6

Furniture and equipment expense
2

 
4

 
6

Other
16

 
30

 
25

Total non-interest expense
70

 
136

 
139

Income from discontinued operations before income taxes
280

 
11

 
8

Income tax expense (benefit)
84

 
(5
)
 
4

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax
$
196

 
$
16

 
$
4


The following table represents the condensed results of operations for both the Regions Insurance Group, Inc. entities and Morgan Keegan and Company, Inc. and related affiliates as discontinued operations:
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Income from discontinued operations before income taxes
$
271

 
$
19

 
$
16

Income tax expense (benefit)
80

 
(3
)
 
7

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax
$
191

 
$
22


$
9

Earnings per common share from discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.18

 
$
0.02

 
$
0.01

Diluted
$
0.17

 
$
0.02

 
$
0.01

NOTE 4. DEBT SECURITIES
The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses, and estimated fair value of debt securities held to maturity and debt securities available for sale are as follows:

114





 
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
Recognized in OCI (1)
 
 
 
Not recognized in OCI
 
 
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Carrying Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
(In millions)
Debt securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
$
883

 
$

 
$
(32
)
 
$
851

 
$
1

 
$
(10
)
 
$
842

Commercial agency
634

 

 
(3
)
 
631

 

 
(13
)
 
618

 
$
1,517

 
$

 
$
(35
)
 
$
1,482

 
$
1

 
$
(23
)
 
$
1,460

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
284

 
$

 
$
(4
)
 
$
280

 
 
 
 
 
$
280

Federal agency securities
43

 

 

 
43

 
 
 
 
 
43

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
17,064

 
26

 
(466
)
 
16,624

 
 
 
 
 
16,624

Residential non-agency
2

 

 

 
2

 
 
 
 
 
2

Commercial agency
3,891

 
8

 
(64
)
 
3,835

 
 
 
 
 
3,835

Commercial non-agency
768

 
2

 
(10
)
 
760

 
 
 
 
 
760

Corporate and other debt securities
1,206

 
2

 
(23
)
 
1,185

 
 
 
 
 
1,185

 
$
23,258

 
$
38

 
$
(567
)
 
$
22,729

 
 
 
 
 
$
22,729

 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
Recognized in OCI (1)
 
 
 
Not recognized in OCI
 
 
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Carrying Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
(In millions)
Debt securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
$
1,051

 
$

 
$
(40
)
 
$
1,011

 
$
12

 
$
(4
)
 
$
1,019

Commercial agency
651

 

 
(4
)
 
647

 
5

 
(4
)
 
648

 
$
1,702

 
$

 
$
(44
)
 
$
1,658

 
$
17

 
$
(8
)
 
$
1,667

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
333

 
$

 
$
(2
)
 
$
331

 
 
 
 
 
$
331

Federal agency securities
28

 

 

 
28

 
 
 
 
 
28

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
17,622

 
53

 
(244
)
 
17,431

 
 
 
 
 
17,431

Residential non-agency
3

 

 

 
3

 
 
 
 
 
3

Commercial agency
3,739

 
5

 
(30
)
 
3,714

 
 
 
 
 
3,714

Commercial non-agency
787

 
4

 
(3
)
 
788

 
 
 
 
 
788

Corporate and other debt securities
1,093

 
20

 
(5
)
 
1,108

 
 
 
 
 
1,108

 
$
23,605

 
$
82

 
$
(284
)
 
$
23,403

 
 
 
 
 
$
23,403

_________
(1)
The gross unrealized losses recognized in OCI on securities held to maturity resulted from a transfer of securities available for sale to held to maturity in the second quarter of 2013.
Debt securities with carrying values of $7.9 billion and $8.1 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, were pledged to secure public funds, trust deposits and certain borrowing arrangements. Included within total pledged securities is approximately $24 million and $50 million of encumbered U.S. Treasury securities at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
The amortized cost and estimated fair value of debt securities held to maturity and debt securities available for sale at December 31, 2018 , by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

115





 
Amortized
Cost
 
Estimated
Fair Value
 
(In millions)
Debt securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
Residential agency
$
883

 
$
842

Commercial agency
634

 
618

 
$
1,517

 
$
1,460

Debt securities available for sale:
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
$
194

 
$
194

Due after one year through five years
903

 
889

Due after five years through ten years
391

 
380

Due after ten years
45

 
45

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
Residential agency
17,064

 
16,624

Residential non-agency
2

 
2

Commercial agency
3,891

 
3,835

Commercial non-agency
768

 
760

 
$
23,258

 
$
22,729

The following tables present gross unrealized losses and the related estimated fair value of debt securities held to maturity and debt securities available for sale at December 31, 2018 and 2017 . For debt securities transferred to held to maturity from available for sale, the analysis in the tables below is comparing the securities' original amortized cost to its current estimated fair value. These securities are segregated between investments that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than twelve months and for twelve months or more.
 
December 31, 2018
 
Less Than Twelve Months
 
Twelve Months or More
 
Total
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
(In millions)
Debt securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
$

 
$

 
$
842

 
$
(42
)
 
$
842

 
$
(42
)
Commercial agency
486

 
(7
)
 
132

 
(9
)
 
618

 
(16
)
 
$
486

 
$
(7
)
 
$
974

 
$
(51
)
 
$
1,460

 
$
(58
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$

 
$

 
$
261

 
$
(4
)
 
$
261

 
$
(4
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
2,830

 
(37
)
 
11,010

 
(429
)
 
13,840

 
(466
)
Commercial agency
1,073

 
(13
)
 
2,254

 
(51
)
 
3,327

 
(64
)
Commercial non-agency
229

 
(1
)
 
404

 
(9
)
 
633

 
(10
)
Corporate and other debt securities
659

 
(11
)
 
310

 
(12
)
 
969

 
(23
)
 
$
4,791

 
$
(62
)
 
$
14,239

 
$
(505
)
 
$
19,030

 
$
(567
)
 

116





 
December 31, 2017
 
Less Than Twelve Months
 
Twelve Months or More
 
Total
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
(In millions)
Debt securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
$

 
$

 
$
1,019

 
$
(32
)
 
$
1,019

 
$
(32
)
Commercial agency

 

 
150

 
(7
)
 
150

 
(7
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
1,169

 
$
(39
)
 
$
1,169

 
$
(39
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
221

 
$
(1
)
 
$
84

 
$
(1
)
 
$
305

 
$
(2
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
5,157

 
(40
)
 
8,195

 
(204
)
 
13,352

 
(244
)
Commercial agency
1,666

 
(10
)
 
904

 
(20
)
 
2,570

 
(30
)
Commercial non-agency
393

 
(2
)
 
61

 
(1
)
 
454

 
(3
)
Corporate and other debt securities
306

 
(2
)
 
105

 
(3
)
 
411

 
(5
)
 
$
7,743

 
$
(55
)
 
$
9,349

 
$
(229
)
 
$
17,092

 
$
(284
)
The number of individual debt positions in an unrealized loss position in the tables above increased from 1,059 at December 31, 2017 to 1,379 at December 31, 2018 . The increase in the number of securities and the total amount of unrealized losses was primarily due to changes in market interest rates. In instances where an unrealized loss existed, there was no indication of an adverse change in credit on the underlying positions in the tables above. As it relates to these positions, management believes no individual unrealized loss, other than those discussed below, represented an OTTI as of those dates. The Company does not intend to sell, and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell, the positions before the recovery of their amortized cost basis, which may be at maturity.
As part of the Company's normal process for evaluating OTTI, management did identify a limited number of positions where an OTTI was believed to exist during 2018 . For the year ended 2018, such impairments were immaterial.
Gross realized gains and gross realized losses on sales of debt securities available for sale from continuing operations are shown in the table below. The cost of securities sold is based on the specific identification method.
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Gross realized gains
$
4

 
$
22

 
$
36

Gross realized losses
(1
)
 
(5
)
 
(28
)
OTTI
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(2
)
Debt securities available for sale gains (losses), net (1)
$
1

 
$
16

 
$
6

_________
(1) The securities gains (losses), net balances above exclude net trading securities gains of $3 million recognized during 2017.

117





NOTE 5. LOANS
The following table presents the distribution of Regions' loan portfolio by segment and class, net of unearned income as of December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
39,282

 
$
36,115

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
5,549

 
6,193

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
384

 
332

Total commercial
45,215

 
42,640

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
4,650

 
4,062

Commercial investor real estate construction
1,786

 
1,772

Total investor real estate
6,436

 
5,834

Residential first mortgage
14,276

 
14,061

Home equity
9,257

 
10,164

Indirect—vehicles
3,053

 
3,326

Indirect—other consumer
2,349

 
1,467

Consumer credit card
1,345

 
1,290

Other consumer
1,221

 
1,165

Total consumer
31,501

 
31,473

Total loans, net of unearned income (1)
$
83,152

 
$
79,947

_________
(1)
Loans are presented net of unearned income, unamortized discounts and premiums and net deferred loan costs of $(4) million and $43 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
During 2018 and 2017 , Regions purchased approximately $503 million and $238 million in indirect-other consumer loans from third parties, respectively.
In January 2019, Regions decided to discontinue its indirect auto lending business due to competition-based margin compression impacting overall returns on the portfolio.  Regions will cease originating new indirect auto loans in the first quarter of 2019 and intends to complete any in-process indirect auto loan closings by the end of the second quarter of 2019. The Company will remain in the direct auto lending business.
At December 31, 2018 , $22.0 billion in securities and net eligible loans held by Regions were pledged to secure current and potential borrowings from the FHLB. At December 31, 2018 , an additional $25.0 billion in net eligible loans held by Regions were pledged to the FRB for potential borrowings.
The following tables include details regarding Regions’ investment in leveraged leases included within the commercial and industrial loan portfolio class as of and for the years ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Rentals receivable
$
196

 
$
248

Estimated residuals on leveraged leases
160

 
196

Unearned income on leveraged leases
129

 
160

 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Pre-tax income from leveraged leases
$
15

 
$
22

 
$
28

Income tax expense on income from leveraged leases
12

 
24

 
31

The income above does not include leveraged lease termination gains of $8 million , $1 million and $8 million with related income tax expense of $5 million , $1 million and $11 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively. Pre-tax income from leveraged leases was reduced by $6 million during 2017 as a result of Tax Reform.
NOTE 6. ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
Regions determines the appropriate level of the allowance on a quarterly basis. The methodology is described in Note 1.

118





ROLLFORWARD OF ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
The following tables present analyses of the allowance for credit losses by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 . The total allowance for loan losses and the related loan portfolio ending balances are disaggregated to detail the amounts derived through individual evaluation and collective evaluation for impairment. The allowance for loan losses related to individually evaluated loans is attributable to reserves for non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans and all TDRs. The allowance for loan losses and the loan portfolio ending balances related to collectively evaluated loans is attributable to the remainder of the portfolio.
 
2018
 
Commercial
 
Investor Real
Estate
 
Consumer
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Allowance for loan losses, January 1, 2018
$
591

 
$
64

 
$
279

 
$
934

Provision (credit) for loan losses
32

 
(5
)
 
202

 
229

Loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(148
)
 
(9
)
 
(276
)
 
(433
)
Recoveries
45

 
8

 
57

 
110

Net loan losses
(103
)
 
(1
)
 
(219
)
 
(323
)
Allowance for loan losses, December 31, 2018
520

 
58

 
262

 
840

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, January 1, 2018
49

 
4

 

 
53

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(2
)
 

 

 
(2
)
Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, December 31, 2018
47

 
4

 

 
51

Allowance for credit losses, December 31, 2018
$
567

 
$
62

 
$
262

 
$
891

Portion of ending allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
104

 
$
2

 
$
26

 
$
132

Collectively evaluated for impairment
416

 
56

 
236

 
708

Total allowance for loan losses
$
520

 
$
58

 
$
262

 
$
840

Portion of loan portfolio ending balance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
490

 
$
25

 
$
419

 
$
934

Collectively evaluated for impairment
44,725

 
6,411

 
31,082

 
82,218

Total loans evaluated for impairment
$
45,215

 
$
6,436

 
$
31,501

 
$
83,152




119





 
2017
 
Commercial
 
Investor Real
Estate
 
Consumer
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Allowance for loan losses, January 1, 2017
$
753

 
$
85

 
$
253

 
$
1,091

Provision (credit) for loan losses
(28
)
 
(42
)
 
220

 
150

Loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(176
)
 
(2
)
 
(256
)
 
(434
)
Recoveries
42

 
23

 
62

 
127

Net loan losses
(134
)
 
21

 
(194
)
 
(307
)
Allowance for loan losses, December 31, 2017
591

 
64

 
279

 
934

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, January 1, 2017
64

 
5

 

 
69

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(15
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(16
)
Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, December 31, 2017
49

 
4

 

 
53

Allowance for credit losses, December 31, 2017
$
640

 
$
68

 
$
279

 
$
987

Portion of ending allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
171

 
$
8

 
$
47

 
$
226

Collectively evaluated for impairment
420

 
56

 
232

 
708

Total allowance for loan losses
$
591

 
$
64

 
$
279

 
$
934

Portion of loan portfolio ending balance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
756

 
$
96

 
$
706

 
$
1,558

Collectively evaluated for impairment
41,884

 
5,738

 
30,767

 
78,389

Total loans evaluated for impairment
$
42,640

 
$
5,834

 
$
31,473

 
$
79,947


 
2016
 
Commercial
 
Investor Real
Estate
 
Consumer
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Allowance for loan losses, January 1, 2016
$
758

 
$
97

 
$
251

 
$
1,106

Provision (credit) for loan losses
95

 
(23
)
 
190

 
262

Loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(143
)
 
(2
)
 
(253
)
 
(398
)
Recoveries
43

 
13

 
65

 
121

Net loan losses
(100
)
 
11

 
(188
)
 
(277
)
Allowance for loan losses, December 31, 2016
753

 
85

 
253

 
1,091

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, January 1, 2016
47

 
5

 

 
52

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
17

 

 

 
17

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, December 31, 2016
64

 
5

 

 
69

Allowance for credit losses, December 31, 2016
$
817

 
$
90

 
$
253

 
$
1,160

Portion of ending allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
231

 
$
13

 
$
60

 
$
304

Collectively evaluated for impairment
522

 
72

 
193

 
787

Total allowance for loan losses
$
753

 
$
85

 
$
253

 
$
1,091

Portion of loan portfolio ending balance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
$
1,069

 
$
107

 
$
770

 
$
1,946

Collectively evaluated for impairment
41,144

 
6,367

 
30,638

 
78,149

Total loans evaluated for impairment
$
42,213

 
$
6,474

 
$
31,408

 
$
80,095


PORTFOLIO SEGMENT RISK FACTORS
The following describe the risk characteristics relevant to each of the portfolio segments.
Commercial —The commercial portfolio segment includes commercial and industrial loans to commercial customers for use in normal business operations to finance working capital needs, equipment purchases or other expansion projects. Commercial also includes owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage loans to operating businesses, which are loans for long-term

120





financing of land and buildings, and are repaid by cash flow generated by business operations. Owner-occupied construction loans are made to commercial businesses for the development of land or construction of a building where the repayment is derived from revenues generated from the business of the borrower. Collection risk in this portfolio is driven by the creditworthiness of underlying borrowers, particularly cash flow from customers’ business operations, and the sensitivity to market fluctuations in commodity prices.
Investor Real Estate —Loans for real estate development are repaid through cash flow related to the operation, sale or refinance of the property. This portfolio segment includes extensions of credit to real estate developers or investors where repayment is dependent on the sale of real estate or income generated from the real estate collateral. A portion of Regions’ investor real estate portfolio segment consists of loans secured by residential product types (land, single-family and condominium loans) within Regions’ markets. Additionally, these loans are made to finance income-producing properties such as apartment buildings, office and industrial buildings, and retail shopping centers. Loans in this portfolio segment are particularly sensitive to the valuation of real estate.
Consumer —The consumer portfolio segment includes residential first mortgage, home equity, indirect-vehicles, indirect-other consumer, consumer credit card, and other consumer loans. Residential first mortgage loans represent loans to consumers to finance a residence. These loans are typically financed over a 15 to 30 year term and, in most cases, are extended to borrowers to finance their primary residence. Home equity lending includes both home equity loans and lines of credit. This type of lending, which is secured by a first or second mortgage on the borrower’s residence, allows customers to borrow against the equity in their home. Real estate market values as of the time the loan or line is secured directly affect the amount of credit extended and, in addition, changes in these values impact the depth of potential losses. Indirect-vehicles lending, which is lending initiated through third-party business partners, largely consists of loans made through automotive dealerships. Indirect-other consumer lending represents other point of sale lending through third parties. Consumer credit card lending includes Regions branded consumer credit card accounts. Other consumer loans include other revolving consumer accounts, direct consumer loans, and overdrafts. Loans in this portfolio segment are sensitive to unemployment and other key consumer economic measures.
CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS
Commercial and investor real estate portfolio segments are detailed by categories related to underlying credit quality and probability of default. Regions assigns these categories at loan origination and reviews the relationship utilizing a risk-based approach on, at minimum, an annual basis or at any time management becomes aware of information affecting the borrowers' ability to fulfill their obligations. Both quantitative and qualitative factors are considered in this review process. These categories are utilized to develop the associated allowance for credit losses.
Pass—includes obligations where the probability of default is considered low;
Special Mention—includes obligations that have potential weakness that may, if not reversed or corrected, weaken the credit or inadequately protect the Company’s position at some future date. Obligations in this category may also be subject to economic or market conditions that may, in the future, have an adverse effect on debt service ability;
Substandard Accrual—includes obligations that exhibit a well-defined weakness that presently jeopardizes debt repayment, even though they are currently performing. These obligations are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Company may incur a loss in the future if these weaknesses are not corrected;
Non-accrual—includes obligations where management has determined that full payment of principal and interest is in doubt.
Substandard accrual and non-accrual loans are often collectively referred to as “classified.” Special mention, substandard accrual, and non-accrual loans are often collectively referred to as “criticized and classified.” Classes in the consumer portfolio segment are disaggregated by accrual status.


121





The following tables present credit quality indicators for the loan portfolio segments and classes, excluding loans held for sale, as of December 31, 2018 and  2017 .
 
2018
 
Pass
 
Special Mention
 
Substandard
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
37,963

 
$
666

 
$
346

 
$
307

 
$
39,282

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
5,193

 
208

 
81

 
67

 
5,549

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
356

 
7

 
13

 
8

 
384

Total commercial
$
43,512

 
$
881

 
$
440

 
$
382

 
$
45,215

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
$
4,444

 
$
52

 
$
143

 
$
11

 
$
4,650

Commercial investor real estate construction
1,773

 
6

 
7

 

 
1,786

Total investor real estate
$
6,217

 
$
58

 
$
150

 
$
11

 
$
6,436

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Residential first mortgage
 
 
 
 
$
14,236

 
$
40

 
$
14,276

Home equity
 
 
 
 
9,194

 
63

 
9,257

Indirect—vehicles
 
 
 
 
3,053

 

 
3,053

Indirect—other consumer
 
 
 
 
2,349

 

 
2,349

Consumer credit card
 
 
 
 
1,345

 

 
1,345

Other consumer
 
 
 
 
1,221

 

 
1,221

Total consumer
 
 
 
 
$
31,398

 
$
103

 
$
31,501

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
83,152

 
 
2017
 
Pass
 
Special
Mention
 
Substandard
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
34,420

 
$
686

 
$
605

 
$
404

 
$
36,115

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
5,674

 
236

 
165

 
118

 
6,193

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
313

 
3

 
10

 
6

 
332

Total commercial
$
40,407

 
$
925

 
$
780

 
$
528

 
$
42,640

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
$
3,905

 
$
63

 
$
89

 
$
5

 
$
4,062

Commercial investor real estate construction
1,706

 
19

 
46

 
1

 
1,772

Total investor real estate
$
5,611

 
$
82

 
$
135

 
$
6

 
$
5,834

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Residential first mortgage
 
 
 
 
$
14,014

 
$
47

 
$
14,061

Home equity
 
 
 
 
10,095

 
69

 
10,164

Indirect—vehicles
 
 
 
 
3,326

 

 
3,326

Indirect—other consumer
 
 
 
 
1,467

 

 
1,467

Consumer credit card
 
 
 
 
1,290

 

 
1,290

Other consumer
 
 
 
 
1,165

 

 
1,165

Total consumer
 
 
 
 
$
31,357

 
$
116

 
$
31,473

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
79,947



122





AGING ANALYSIS
The following tables include an aging analysis of DPD for each portfolio segment and class as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 :
 
2018
 
Accrual Loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30-59 DPD
 
60-89 DPD
 
90+ DPD
 
Total
30+ DPD
 
Total
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
80

 
$
22

 
$
8

 
$
110

 
$
38,975

 
$
307

 
$
39,282

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
12

 
7

 

 
19

 
5,482

 
67

 
5,549

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied

 

 

 

 
376

 
8

 
384

Total commercial
92

 
29

 
8

 
129

 
44,833

 
382

 
45,215

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
6

 

 

 
6

 
4,639

 
11

 
4,650

Commercial investor real estate construction

 

 

 

 
1,786

 

 
1,786

Total investor real estate
6

 

 

 
6

 
6,425

 
11

 
6,436

Residential first mortgage
85

 
53

 
150

 
288

 
14,236

 
40

 
14,276

Home equity
47

 
26

 
34

 
107

 
9,194

 
63

 
9,257

Indirect—vehicles
40

 
11

 
9

 
60

 
3,053

 

 
3,053

Indirect—other consumer
13

 
7

 
1

 
21

 
2,349

 

 
2,349

Consumer credit card
12

 
9

 
20

 
41

 
1,345

 

 
1,345

Other consumer
15

 
5

 
5

 
25

 
1,221

 

 
1,221

Total consumer
212

 
111

 
219

 
542

 
31,398

 
103

 
31,501

 
$
310

 
$
140

 
$
227

 
$
677

 
$
82,656

 
$
496

 
$
83,152

 
 
2017
 
Accrual Loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30-59 DPD
 
60-89 DPD
 
90+ DPD
 
Total
30+ DPD
 
Total
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
28

 
$
7

 
$
4

 
$
39

 
$
35,711

 
$
404

 
$
36,115

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
18

 
8

 
1

 
27

 
6,075

 
118

 
6,193

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied

 

 

 

 
326

 
6

 
332

Total commercial
46

 
15

 
5

 
66

 
42,112

 
528

 
42,640

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
1

 
1

 
1

 
3

 
4,057

 
5

 
4,062

Commercial investor real estate construction

 

 

 

 
1,771

 
1

 
1,772

Total investor real estate
1

 
1

 
1

 
3

 
5,828

 
6

 
5,834

Residential first mortgage
95

 
85

 
216

 
396

 
14,014

 
47

 
14,061

Home equity
53

 
27

 
37

 
117

 
10,095

 
69

 
10,164

Indirect—vehicles
48

 
13

 
9

 
70

 
3,326

 

 
3,326

Indirect—other consumer
9

 
5

 

 
14

 
1,467

 

 
1,467

Consumer credit card
11

 
7

 
19

 
37

 
1,290

 

 
1,290

Other consumer
13

 
4

 
4

 
21

 
1,165

 

 
1,165

Total consumer
229

 
141

 
285

 
655

 
31,357

 
116

 
31,473

 
$
276

 
$
157

 
$
291

 
$
724

 
$
79,297

 
$
650

 
$
79,947



123





IMPAIRED LOANS
The following tables present details related to the Company’s impaired loans as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 . Loans deemed to be impaired include all TDRs and all non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans, excluding leases. Loans which have been fully charged-off do not appear in the tables below.
 
Non-accrual Impaired Loans 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value (3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
 Principal
    Balance (1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied (2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
No Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance
for Loan
Losses
 
Coverage % (4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
384

 
$
77

 
$
307

 
$
113

 
$
194

 
$
62

 
36.2
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
76

 
9

 
67

 
13

 
54

 
23

 
42.1

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
9

 
1

 
8

 

 
8

 
3

 
44.4

Total commercial
469

 
87

 
382

 
126

 
256

 
88

 
37.3

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
11

 

 
11

 
4

 
7

 
1

 
9.1

Total investor real estate
11

 

 
11

 
4

 
7

 
1

 
9.1

Residential first mortgage
31

 
8

 
23

 

 
23

 
2

 
32.3

Home equity
11

 
2

 
9

 

 
9

 

 
18.2

Total consumer
42

 
10

 
32

 

 
32

 
2

 
28.6

 
$
522

 
$
97

 
$
425

 
$
130

 
$
295

 
$
91

 
36.0
%
 
 
Accruing Impaired Loans 2018
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance (1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied (2)
 
Book Value (3)
 
Related Allowance
 for Loan Losses
 
Coverage % (4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
84

 
$

 
$
84

 
$
14

 
16.7
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
26

 
2

 
24

 
2

 
15.4

Total commercial
110

 
2

 
108

 
16

 
16.4

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
15

 
1

 
14

 
1

 
13.3

Total investor real estate
15

 
1

 
14

 
1

 
13.3

Residential first mortgage
194

 
9

 
185

 
18

 
13.9

Home equity
195

 

 
195

 
6

 
3.1

Consumer credit card
1

 

 
1

 

 

Other consumer
6

 

 
6

 

 

Total consumer
396

 
9

 
387

 
24

 
8.3

 
$
521

 
$
12

 
$
509

 
$
41

 
10.2
%

124





 
Total Impaired Loans 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value (3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance (1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied (2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans
 
Impaired
Loans with No
Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance
for Loan
Losses
 
Coverage % (4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
468

 
$
77

 
$
391

 
$
113

 
$
278

 
$
76

 
32.7
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
102

 
11

 
91

 
13

 
78

 
25

 
35.3

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
9

 
1

 
8

 

 
8

 
3

 
44.4

Total commercial
579

 
89

 
490

 
126

 
364

 
104

 
33.3

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
26

 
1

 
25

 
4

 
21

 
2

 
11.5

Total investor real estate
26

 
1

 
25

 
4

 
21

 
2

 
11.5

Residential first mortgage
225

 
17

 
208

 

 
208

 
20

 
16.4

Home equity
206

 
2

 
204

 

 
204

 
6

 
3.9

Consumer credit card
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Other consumer
6

 

 
6

 

 
6

 

 

Total consumer
438

 
19

 
419

 

 
419

 
26

 
10.3

 
$
1,043

 
$
109

 
$
934

 
$
130

 
$
804

 
$
132

 
23.1
%

 
Non-accrual Impaired Loans 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value (3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance (1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied (2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
No Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance
for Loan
Losses
 
Coverage % (4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
480

 
$
80

 
$
400

 
$
29

 
$
371

 
$
103

 
38.1
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
133

 
15

 
118

 
20

 
98

 
38

 
39.8

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
7

 
1

 
6

 

 
6

 
3

 
57.1

Total commercial
620

 
96

 
524

 
49

 
475

 
144

 
38.7

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
6

 
1

 
5

 

 
5

 
2

 
50.0

Commercial investor real estate construction
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Total investor real estate
7

 
1

 
6

 

 
6

 
2

 
42.9

Residential first mortgage
42

 
11

 
31

 

 
31

 
3

 
33.3

Home equity
10

 
1

 
9

 

 
9

 

 
10.0

Total consumer
52

 
12

 
40

 

 
40

 
3

 
28.8

 
$
679

 
$
109

 
$
570

 
$
49

 
$
521

 
$
149

 
38.0
%
 

125





 
Accruing Impaired Loans 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value (3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance (1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied (2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans on
Accrual
Status
 
Impaired
Loans on
Accrual
Status with 
No Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans on
Accrual
Status with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance 
for Loan Losses
 
Coverage % (4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
154

 
$
8

 
$
146

 
$
1

 
$
145

 
$
19

 
17.5
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
90

 
5

 
85

 

 
85

 
8

 
14.4

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Total commercial
245

 
13

 
232

 
1

 
231

 
27

 
16.3

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
63

 
2

 
61

 

 
61

 
3

 
7.9

Commercial investor real estate construction
29

 

 
29

 

 
29

 
3

 
10.3

Total investor real estate
92

 
2

 
90

 

 
90

 
6

 
8.7

Residential first mortgage
419

 
13

 
406

 

 
406

 
39

 
12.4

Home equity
251

 
1

 
250

 

 
250

 
5

 
2.4

Consumer credit card
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Other consumer
9

 

 
9

 

 
9

 

 

Total consumer
680

 
14

 
666

 

 
666

 
44

 
8.5

 
$
1,017

 
$
29

 
$
988

 
$
1

 
$
987

 
$
77

 
10.4
%

 
Total Impaired Loans 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value (3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance (1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied (2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans
 
Impaired
Loans with No
Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance 
for Loan Losses
 
Coverage % (4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
634

 
$
88

 
$
546

 
$
30

 
$
516

 
$
122

 
33.1
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
223

 
20

 
203

 
20

 
183

 
46

 
29.6

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
8

 
1

 
7

 

 
7

 
3

 
50.0

Total commercial
865

 
109

 
756

 
50

 
706

 
171

 
32.4

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
69

 
3

 
66

 

 
66

 
5

 
11.6

Commercial investor real estate construction
30

 

 
30

 

 
30

 
3

 
10.0

Total investor real estate
99

 
3

 
96

 

 
96

 
8

 
11.1

Residential first mortgage
461

 
24

 
437

 

 
437

 
42

 
14.3

Home equity
261

 
2

 
259

 

 
259

 
5

 
2.7

Consumer credit card
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Other consumer
9

 

 
9

 

 
9

 

 

Total consumer
732

 
26

 
706

 

 
706

 
47

 
10.0

 
$
1,696

 
$
138

 
$
1,558

 
$
50

 
$
1,508

 
$
226

 
21.5
%
_________
(1)
Unpaid principal balance represents the contractual obligation due from the customer and includes the net book value plus charge-offs and payments applied.
(2)
Charge-offs and payments applied represents cumulative partial charge-offs taken, as well as interest payments received that have been applied against the outstanding principal balance.
(3)
Book value represents the unpaid principal balance less charge-offs and payments applied; it is shown before any allowance for loan losses.
(4)
Coverage % represents charge-offs and payments applied plus the related allowance as a percent of the unpaid principal balance.

126





The following table presents the average balances of total impaired loans and interest income for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 . Interest income recognized represents interest on accruing loans modified in a TDR.
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
486

 
$
9

 
$
747

 
$
12

 
$
714

 
$
6

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
131

 
6

 
226

 
5

 
304

 
5

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
7

 

 
5

 

 
3

 

Total commercial
624

 
15

 
978

 
17

 
1,021

 
11

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
61

 
3

 
81

 
4

 
120

 
8

Commercial investor real estate construction
7

 

 
39

 
2

 
30

 
1

Total investor real estate
68

 
3

 
120

 
6

 
150

 
9

Residential first mortgage
230

 
8

 
450

 
15

 
469

 
15

Home equity
230

 
12

 
280

 
14

 
322

 
16

Indirect—vehicles

 

 

 

 
1

 

Consumer credit card
1

 

 
2

 

 
2

 

Other consumer
7

 

 
9

 
1

 
11

 
1

Total consumer
468

 
20

 
741

 
30

 
805

 
32

Total impaired loans
$
1,160

 
$
38

 
$
1,839

 
$
53

 
$
1,976

 
$
52


TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS
Regions regularly modifies commercial and investor real estate loans in order to facilitate a workout strategy. Typical modifications include accommodations, such as renewals and forbearances. The majority of Regions’ commercial and investor real estate TDRs are the result of renewals of classified loans at an interest rate that is not considered to be a market interest rate. For smaller dollar commercial loans, Regions may periodically grant interest rate and other term concessions, similar to those under the consumer program described below.
Regions works to meet the individual needs of consumer borrowers to stem foreclosure through its CAP. Regions designed the program to allow for customer-tailored modifications with the goal of keeping customers in their homes and avoiding foreclosure where possible. Modification may be offered to any borrower experiencing financial hardship regardless of the borrower’s payment status. Consumer TDRs primarily involve an interest rate concession, however under the CAP, Regions may also offer a short-term deferral, a term extension, a new loan product, or a combination of these options. For loans restructured under the CAP, Regions expects to collect the original contractually due principal. The gross original contractual interest may be collectible, depending on the terms modified. All CAP modifications are considered TDRs regardless of the term because they are concessionary in nature and because the customer documents a financial hardship in order to participate.
As noted above, the majority of Regions’ TDRs are results of interest rate concessions and not a forgiveness of principal. Accordingly, the financial impact of the modifications is best illustrated by the impact to the allowance calculation at the loan or pool level, as a result of the loans being considered impaired due to their TDR status. Regions most often does not record a charge-off at the modification date.
The following tables present the end of period balance for loans modified in a TDR during the periods presented by portfolio segment and class, and the financial impact of those modifications. The tables include modifications made to new TDRs, as well as renewals of existing TDRs. Loans first reported as TDRs for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 totaled approximately $374 million and $501 million , respectively.


127





 
2018
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Impact
of Modifications
Considered TDRs
 
Number of
Obligors
 
Recorded
Investment
 
Increase in
Allowance at
Modification
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
113
 
$
353

 
$
5

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
67
 
42

 

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
1
 
2

 

Total commercial
181
 
397

 
5

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
25
 
76

 
3

Total investor real estate
25
 
76

 
3

Residential first mortgage
184
 
31

 
4

Home equity
106
 
7

 

Consumer credit card
54
 
1

 

Indirect—vehicles and other consumer
77
 
1

 

Total consumer
421
 
40

 
4

 
627
 
$
513

 
$
12

 
 
2017
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Impact
of Modifications
Considered TDRs
 
Number of
Obligors
 
Recorded
Investment
 
Increase in
Allowance at
Modification
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
134
 
$
493

 
$
10

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
118
 
110

 
3

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
3
 
2

 

Total commercial
255
 
605

 
13

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
42
 
104

 
3

Commercial investor real estate construction
5
 
70

 
2

Total investor real estate
47
 
174

 
5

Residential first mortgage
209
 
39

 
5

Home equity
116
 
9

 

Consumer credit card
68
 
1

 

Indirect—vehicles and other consumer
155
 
2

 

Total consumer
548
 
51

 
5

 
850
 
$
830

 
$
23

Defaulted TDRs
The following table presents, by portfolio segment and class, TDRs that defaulted during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 , and that were modified in the previous twelve months (i.e., the twelve months prior to the default). For purposes of this disclosure, default is defined as placement on non-accrual status for the commercial and investor real estate portfolio segments, and 90 days past due and still accruing for the consumer portfolio segment. Consideration of defaults in the calculation of the allowance for loan losses is described in detail in Note 1.  

128





 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Defaulted During the Period, Where Modified in a TDR Twelve Months Prior to Default
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
33

 
$
10

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
1

 
1

Total commercial
34

 
11

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
5

 

Total investor real estate
5

 

Residential first mortgage
8

 
9

Home equity

 
1

Total consumer
8

 
10

 
$
47

 
$
21

Commercial and investor real estate loans that were on non-accrual status at the time of the latest modification are not included in the default table above, as they are already considered to be in default at the time of the restructuring. At December 31, 2018 , approximately $42 million of commercial and investor real estate loans modified in a TDR during the year ended December 31, 2018 were on non-accrual status.
At December 31, 2018 , Regions had restructured binding unfunded commitments totaling $8 million where a concession was granted and the borrower was in financial difficulty.
NOTE 7. SERVICING OF FINANCIAL ASSETS
RESIDENTIAL MORTGAGE BANKING ACTIVITIES
The fair value of residential MSRs is calculated using various assumptions including future cash flows, market discount rates, expected prepayment rates, servicing costs and other factors. A significant change in prepayments of mortgages in the servicing portfolio could result in significant changes in the valuation adjustments, thus creating potential volatility in the carrying amount of residential MSRs. The Company compares fair value estimates and assumptions to observable market data where available, and also considers recent market activity and actual portfolio experience.
The table below presents an analysis of residential MSRs under the fair value measurement method for the years ended December 31 :  
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Carrying value, beginning of year
$
336

 
$
324

 
$
252

Additions
111

 
64

 
108

Increase (decrease) in fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
Due to change in valuation inputs or assumptions
18

 
(8
)
 
4

Economic amortization associated with borrower repayments  (1)
(47
)
 
(44
)
 
(40
)
Carrying value, end of year
$
418

 
$
336

 
$
324

_________
(1)
"Economic amortization associated with borrower repayments" includes both total loan payoffs as well as partial paydowns.
In 2016, the Company purchased the rights to service approximately $7.6 billion in residential mortgage loans for approximately $69 million .
In 2017, the Company purchased the rights to service approximately $2.7 billion in residential mortgage loans for approximately $30 million .
In 2018, the Company purchased the rights to service approximately $6.1 billion in residential mortgage loans for approximately $77 million . Approximately $7 million of the purchase price will be paid in 2019.

129





Data and assumptions used in the fair value calculation, as well as the valuation’s sensitivity to rate fluctuations, related to residential MSRs (excluding related derivative instruments) as of December 31 are as follows:  
 
2018
 
2017
 
(Dollars in millions)
Unpaid principal balance
$
36,450

 
$
32,076

Weighted-average CPR (%)
9.0
%
 
9.9
%
Estimated impact on fair value of a 10% increase
$
(24
)
 
$
(22
)
Estimated impact on fair value of a 20% increase
$
(43
)
 
$
(39
)
Option-adjusted spread (basis points)
755

 
861

Estimated impact on fair value of a 10% increase
$
(13
)
 
$
(11
)
Estimated impact on fair value of a 20% increase
$
(26
)
 
$
(22
)
Weighted-average coupon interest rate
4.2
%
 
4.1
%
Weighted-average remaining maturity (months)
281

 
281

Weighted-average servicing fee (basis points)
27.1

 
27.4

The sensitivity calculations above are hypothetical and should not be considered to be predictive of future performance. Changes in fair value based on adverse changes in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumption to the change in fair value may not be linear. Also, the effect of an adverse variation in a particular assumption on the fair value of the residential MSRs is calculated without changing any other assumption, while in reality changes in one factor may result in changes in another, which may either magnify or counteract the effect of the change. The derivative instruments utilized by Regions would serve to reduce the estimated impacts to fair value included in the table above.
The following table presents servicing related fees, which includes contractually specified servicing fees, late fees and other ancillary income resulting from the servicing of residential mortgage loans for the years ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Servicing related fees and other ancillary income
$
95

 
$
96

 
$
86

Residential mortgage loans are sold in the secondary market with standard representations and warranties regarding certain characteristics such as the quality of the loan, the absence of fraud, the eligibility of the loan for sale and the future servicing associated with the loan. Regions may be required to repurchase these loans at par, or make-whole or indemnify the purchasers for losses incurred when representations and warranties are breached.
Regions maintains an immaterial repurchase liability related to residential mortgage loans sold with representations and warranty provisions. This repurchase liability is reported in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets and reflects management’s estimate of losses based on historical repurchase and loss trends, as well as other factors that may result in anticipated losses different from historical loss trends. Adjustments to this reserve are recorded in other non-interest expense on the consolidated statements of income.
COMMERCIAL MORTGAGE BANKING ACTIVITIES
Regions is an approved DUS lender. The DUS program provides liquidity to the multi-family housing market. In connection with the DUS program, Regions services commercial mortgage loans, retains commercial MSRs and intangible assets associated with the DUS license, and assumes a loss share guarantee associated with the loans. See Note 1 for additional information. Also see Note 24 for additional information related to the guarantee.
As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the DUS servicing portfolio was approximately $3.6 billion and $2.9 billion , respectively. The related commercial MSRs were approximately $56 million and $48 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. The estimated fair value of the loss share guarantee was approximately $4 million at both December 31, 2018 and 2017.
NOTE 8. OTHER EARNING ASSETS
Other earning assets consist primarily of investments in FRB stock, FHLB stock, marketable equity securities, and operating lease assets.

130





FRB AND FHLB STOCK
The following table presents the amount of Regions' investments in FRB and FHLB stock as of December 31:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Federal Reserve Bank
$
488

 
$
492

Federal Home Loan Bank
377

 
192

MARKETABLE EQUITY SECURITIES
Effective January 1, 2018, Regions adopted new accounting guidance that requires equity investments to be recorded at fair value with changes in fair value reported in net income. See Note 1 for related disclosure.
Marketable equity securities carried at fair value, which primarily consist of assets held for certain employee benefits and money market funds, are reported in other earning assets in the consolidated balance sheets. Total marketable equity securities were $429 million and $414 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Losses recognized in earnings for marketable equity securities still being held by the Company at December 31, 2018 were $11 million .
OPERATING LEASE ASSETS
The Company's investments in operating leases represent assets such as equipment, vehicles and aircraft. The following table presents investments in operating leases at December 31:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Lease assets
$
591

 
$
685

Accumulated depreciation
(222
)
 
(196
)
Investments in operating leases, net
$
369

 
$
489

The following table presents the minimum future rental payments due from customers for operating leases as of December 31:
 
 
Future rental payments
 
 
(In millions)
2019
 
$
57

2020
 
43

2021
 
30

2022
 
16

2023
 
7

Thereafter
 
13

 
 
$
166

NOTE 9. PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
A summary of premises and equipment, net at December 31 is as follows:  
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Land
$
481

 
$
484

Premises and improvements
1,830

 
1,751

Furniture and equipment
994

 
982

Software
699

 
624

Leasehold improvements
379

 
388

Construction in progress
220

 
249

 
4,603

 
4,478

Accumulated depreciation and amortization
(2,558
)
 
(2,414
)
 
$
2,045

 
$
2,064


131





NOTE 10. INTANGIBLE ASSETS
GOODWILL
Goodwill allocated to each reportable segment (each a reporting unit) at December 31 is presented as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Corporate Bank
$
2,474

 
$
2,474

Consumer Bank
1,978

 
1,978

Wealth Management
377

 
452

 
$
4,829

 
$
4,904

The goodwill allocated to the Wealth Management reportable segment decreased in 2018 due to the sale of Regions Insurance Group, Inc. See Note 3 for more information related to this transaction.
Regions assessed the indicators of goodwill impairment for all three reporting units as part of its annual impairment test, as of October 1, 2018 , and through the date of the filing of this Annual Report, by performing a qualitative assessment of goodwill at the reporting unit level. In performing the qualitative assessment, the Company evaluated events and circumstances since the last impairment analysis, recent operating performance including reporting unit performance, changes in market capitalization, regulatory actions and assessments, changes in the business climate, company-specific factors and trends in the banking industry. The results of the qualitative assessment indicated that it was more likely than not that the estimated fair value of each reporting unit exceeded its carrying amount as of the test date; therefore, the quantitative goodwill impairment tests were deemed unnecessary.

OTHER INTANGIBLES
The following table presents other intangibles and related accumulated amortization as of December 31:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
Gross Carrying Amount
 
Accumulated Amortization
 
Net Carrying Amount
 
(In millions)
Core deposit intangibles
$
1,011

 
$
1,011

 
$
966

 
$
950

 
$
45

 
$
61

Purchased credit card relationship assets
175

 
175

 
129

 
116

 
46

 
59

Customer relationship and employment agreement assets

 
75

 

 
43

 

 
32

Other—amortizing (1)
19

 
19

 
13

 
12

 
6

 
7

DUS license (2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
15

 
15

Other—non-amortizing (3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3

 
3

 
$
1,205

 
$
1,280

 
$
1,108

 
$
1,121

 
$
115

 
$
177

_________
(1) Includes intangible assets related to acquired trust services, trade names and intellectual property.
(2) The DUS license is a non-amortizing intangible asset.
(3) Includes non-amortizing intangible assets related to other acquired trust services.
Core deposit intangible assets are being amortized in other non-interest expense on an accelerated basis over their expected useful lives. Purchased credit card relationship assets are being amortized in other non-interest expense primarily on an accelerated basis over a period ranging from 2 to 8 years.
Customer relationship and employment agreement assets were zero at 2018 due to the sale of Regions Insurance Group, Inc.
Regions purchased a DUS license in 2014. The intangible asset associated with the DUS license is a non-amortizing intangible asset. Refer to Note 7 for additional information related to this license.

132





The aggregate amount of amortization expense for core deposit intangibles, purchased credit card relationship assets, and other intangible assets is estimated as follows:
 
Year Ended December 31
 
(In millions)
2019
$
26

2020
22

2021
18

2022
14

2023
10

Identifiable intangible assets other than goodwill are reviewed at least annually, usually in the fourth quarter, for events or circumstances that could impact the recoverability of the intangible asset. Regions concluded that no impairment for any other identifiable intangible assets occurred during 2018 , 2017 or 2016 .
NOTE 11. DEPOSITS
The following schedule presents a detail of interest-bearing deposits at December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Savings
$
8,788

 
$
8,413

Interest-bearing transaction
19,175

 
20,161

Money market—domestic
24,111

 
25,306

Money market—foreign

 
23

Time deposits
7,364

 
6,859

Interest-bearing customer deposits
$
59,438

 
$
60,762


The aggregate amount of time deposits of $250,000 or more, including certificates of deposit of $250,000 or more, was $1.7 billion and $1.3 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
At December 31, 2018 , the aggregate amounts of maturities of all time deposits (deposits with stated maturities, consisting primarily of certificates of deposit and IRAs) were as follows:
 
December 31, 2018
 
(In millions)
2019
$
3,781

2020
1,455

2021
1,150

2022
505

2023
428

Thereafter
45

 
$
7,364

NOTE 12. SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS
Following is a summary of short-term borrowings at December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Company funding sources:
 
 
 
FHLB advances
$
1,600

 
$
500

 
$
1,600

 
$
500


133





NOTE 13. LONG-TERM BORROWINGS
Long-term borrowings at December 31 consist of the following:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Regions Financial Corporation (Parent):
 
 
 
2.00% senior notes due May 2018
$

 
$
101

3.20% senior notes due February 2021
1,101

 
1,101

2.75% senior notes due August 2022
996

 
995

3.80% senior notes due August 2023
497

 

7.75% subordinated notes due September 2024
100

 
100

6.75% subordinated debentures due November 2025
157

 
158

7.375% subordinated notes due December 2037
298

 
297

Valuation adjustments on hedged long-term debt
(47
)
 
(50
)
 
3,102

 
2,702

Regions Bank:
 
 
 
FHLB advances
6,902

 
3,653

2.25% senior notes due September 2018

 
749

7.50% subordinated notes due May 2018

 
500

2.75% senior notes due April 2021
548

 

3 month LIBOR plus 0.38% of floating rate senior notes due April 2021
349

 

3.374% senior notes converting to 3 month LIBOR plus 0.50%, callable August 2020, due August 2021
499

 

3 month LIBOR plus 0.50% of floating rate senior notes, callable August 2020, due August 2021
499

 

6.45% subordinated notes due June 2037
495

 
495

Other long-term debt
33

 
35

Valuation adjustments on hedged long-term debt
(3
)
 
(2
)
 
9,322

 
5,430

Total consolidated
$
12,424

 
$
8,132


As of December 31, 2018, Regions had three issuances and Regions Bank had one issuance of subordinated notes totaling $555 million and $495 million , respectively, with stated interest rates ranging from 6.45% to 7.75% . All issuances of these notes are, by definition, subordinated and subject in right of payment of both principal and interest to the prior payment in full of all senior indebtedness of the Company, which is generally defined as all indebtedness and other obligations of the Company to its creditors, except subordinated indebtedness. Payment of the principal of the notes may be accelerated only in the case of certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency proceedings or reorganization of the Company. The subordinated notes described above qualify as Tier 2 capital under Federal Reserve guidelines, subject to diminishing credit as the respective maturity dates approach and subject to certain transition provisions. None of the subordinated notes are redeemable prior to maturity, unless there is an occurrence of a qualifying capital event.
During 2018 , Regions issued $500 million of senior notes, and simultaneously entered into an interest rate swap effectively converting the notes to floating rate notes at 1 month LIBOR. Regions also had $100 million of senior notes mature during 2018.
Also in 2018, Regions Bank issued $1.9 billion of senior notes. These senior notes included an issuance of $550 million of 2.75% senior notes, which were effectively converted to floating rate notes at 1 month LIBOR through the simultaneous execution of an interest rate swap. Regions Bank also redeemed $750 million of senior notes and had $500 million of subordinated notes mature during 2018.
FHLB advances at December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 had a weighted-average interest rate of 2.6 percent , 1.4 percent , and 0.8 percent , respectively, with remaining maturities ranging from less than one year to twelve years and a weighted-average of 0.9 years. FHLB borrowing capacity is contingent upon the amount of collateral pledged to the FHLB. Regions has pledged certain loans as collateral for the FHLB advances outstanding. See Note 5 for loans pledged to the FHLB at December 31, 2018 and 2017 . Additionally, membership in the FHLB requires an institution to hold FHLB stock. See Note 8 for the amount of FHLB stock held at December 31, 2018 and 2017 . Regions’ total borrowing capacity with the FHLB (including outstanding advances) as of December 31, 2018 , based on assets available for collateral at that date, was approximately $17.2 billion .

134





Regions uses derivative instruments, primarily interest rate swaps, to manage interest rate risk by converting a portion of its fixed-rate debt to a variable-rate. The effective rate adjustments related to these hedges are included in interest expense on long-term borrowings. The weighted-average interest rate on total long-term debt, including the effect of derivative instruments, was 3.2 percent , 3.0 percent , and 2.4 percent for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively. Further discussion of derivative instruments is included in Note 21.
The aggregate amount of contractual maturities of all long-term debt in each of the next five years and thereafter is as follows:
 
Year Ended December 31
 
Regions
Financial
Corporation
(Parent)
 
Regions
Bank
 
(In millions)
2019
$

 
$
4,454

2020

 
2,479

2021
1,069

 
1,893

2022
973

 

2023
505

 

Thereafter
555

 
496

 
$
3,102

 
$
9,322

In February 2016, Regions filed a shelf registration statement with the SEC. This shelf registration does not have a capacity limit and can be utilized by Regions to issue various debt and/or equity securities. The registration statement will expire in February 2019. Regions expects to file a new shelf registration statement on or about February 22, 2019.
Regions Bank may issue bank notes from time to time, either as part of a bank note program or as stand-alone issuances.  Notes issued by Regions Bank may be senior or subordinated notes.  Notes issued by Regions Bank are not deposits and are not insured or guaranteed by the FDIC.
Regions may, from time to time, consider opportunistically retiring outstanding issued securities, including subordinated debt in privately negotiated or open market transactions. Regulatory approval would be required for retirement of some securities.
On January 28, 2019, through a reopening of its 3.80% senior notes due August 2023, Regions issued $500 million of senior notes, which were effectively converted to floating rate notes at 1 month LIBOR through the simultaneous execution of an interest rate swap.
NOTE 14. REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS AND RESTRICTIONS
Regions and Regions Bank are required to comply with regulatory capital requirements established by Federal and State banking agencies. These regulatory capital requirements involve quantitative measures of the Company’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items, and also qualitative judgments by the regulators. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can subject the Company to a series of increasingly restrictive regulatory actions. Banking regulations identify five capital categories: well-capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , Regions and Regions Bank exceeded all current regulatory requirements, and were classified as "well-capitalized." Management believes that no events or changes have occurred subsequent to December 31, 2018 that would change this designation.
Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require institutions to maintain minimum ratios of common equity Tier 1, Tier 1, and Total capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital to average tangible assets (the "Leverage" ratio).

135





The following tables summarize the applicable holding company and bank regulatory capital requirements:
 
December 31, 2018 (2)
 
Minimum Requirement
 
To Be Well
Capitalized
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Transitional Basis Basel III Regulatory Capital Rules (1)
(Dollars in millions)
Basel III common equity Tier 1 capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
10,371

 
9.90
%
 
4.50
%
 
N/A

Regions Bank
12,109

 
11.59

 
4.50

 
6.50
%
Tier 1 capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
11,190

 
10.68
%
 
6.00
%
 
6.00
%
Regions Bank
12,109

 
11.59

 
6.00

 
8.00

Total capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
13,056

 
12.46
%
 
8.00
%
 
10.00
%
Regions Bank
13,494

 
12.92

 
8.00

 
10.00

Leverage capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
11,190

 
9.32
%
 
4.00
%
 
N/A

Regions Bank
12,109

 
10.12

 
4.00

 
5.00
%

 
December 31, 2017
 
Minimum Requirement
 
To Be Well
Capitalized
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Transitional Basis Basel III Regulatory Capital Rules (1)
(Dollars in millions)
Basel III common equity Tier 1 capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
11,152

 
11.05
%
 
4.50
%
 
N/A

Regions Bank
12,560

 
12.49

 
4.50

 
6.50
%
Tier 1 capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
11,964

 
11.86
%
 
6.00
%
 
6.00
%
Regions Bank
12,560

 
12.49

 
6.00

 
8.00

Total capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
13,903

 
13.78
%
 
8.00
%
 
10.00
%
Regions Bank
14,042

 
13.97

 
8.00

 
10.00

Leverage capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
$
11,964

 
10.01
%
 
4.00
%
 
N/A

Regions Bank
12,560

 
10.54

 
4.00

 
5.00
%
 _________
(1) The 2018 and 2017 capital ratios were calculated at different points of the phase-in period under the Basel III Rules and therefore are not directly comparable.
(2) The 2018 Basel III CET1 capital, Tier 1 capital, Total capital, and Leverage capital ratios are estimated.
Substantially all net assets are owned by subsidiaries. The primary source of operating cash available to Regions is provided by dividends from subsidiaries. Statutory limits are placed on the amount of dividends the subsidiary bank can pay without prior regulatory approval. In addition, regulatory authorities require the maintenance of minimum capital-to-asset ratios at banking subsidiaries. Under the Federal Reserve’s Regulation H, Regions Bank may not, without approval of the Federal Reserve, declare or pay a dividend to Regions if the total of all dividends declared in a calendar year exceeds the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net income for that year and (b) its retained net income for the preceding two calendar years, less any required transfers to additional paid-in capital or to a fund for the retirement of preferred stock. Under Alabama law, Regions Bank may not pay a dividend to Regions in excess of 90 percent of its net earnings until the bank’s surplus is equal to at least 20 percent of capital. Regions Bank is also required by Alabama law to seek the approval of the Alabama Superintendent of Banking prior to paying a dividend to Regions if the total of all dividends declared by Regions Bank in any calendar year will exceed the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net earnings for that year, plus (b) its retained net earnings for the preceding two years, less any required transfers to surplus. The statute defines net earnings as “the remainder of all earnings from current operations plus actual recoveries on loans and investments and other assets, after deducting from the total thereof all current operating expenses, actual losses, accrued dividends on preferred stock, if any, and all federal, state and local taxes.” In addition to dividend restrictions, Federal statutes also prohibit unsecured loans from banking subsidiaries to the parent company.

136





In addition, Regions must adhere to various HUD regulatory guidelines including required minimum capital to maintain their HUD approved status. Failure to comply with the HUD guidelines could result in withdrawal of this certification. As of December 31, 2018 , Regions was in compliance with HUD guidelines. Regions is also subject to various capital requirements by secondary market investors.
NOTE 15. STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
PREFERRED STOCK
The following table presents a summary of the non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock as of December 31:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
Issuance Date
 
Earliest Redemption Date
 
Dividend Rate
 
Liquidation Amount
 
Carrying Amount
 
Carrying Amount
 
(Dollars in millions)
Series A
11/1/2012
 
12/15/2017
 
6.375
%
 
 
$
500

 
$
387

 
$
387

Series B
4/29/2014
 
9/15/2024
 
6.375
%
(1)  
 
500

 
433

 
433

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
1,000

 
$
820

 
$
820

_________
(1) Dividends, if declared, will be paid quarterly at an annual rate equal to (i) for each period beginning prior to September 15, 2024, 6.375% , and (ii) for each period beginning on or after September 15, 2024, three-month LIBOR plus 3.536% .
For each preferred stock issuance listed above, Regions issued depositary shares, each representing a 1/40th ownership interest in a share of the Company's preferred stock, with a liquidation preference of $1,000.00 per share of preferred stock (equivalent to $25.00 per depositary share). Dividends on the preferred stock, if declared, accrue and are payable quarterly in arrears. The preferred stock has no stated maturity and redemption is solely at Regions' option, subject to regulatory approval, in whole, or in part, after the earliest redemption date or in whole, but not in part, within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event for the Series A preferred stock or at any time following a regulatory capital treatment event for the Series B preferred stock.
The Board of Directors declared $64 million in cash dividends on preferred stock, during both 2018 and 2017.
In the event Series A and Series B preferred shares are redeemed at the liquidation amounts, $113 million and $67 million excess of the redemption amount over the carrying amount will be recognized, respectively. Approximately $100 million of Series A preferred dividends that were recorded as a reduction of preferred stock, including related surplus, will be recorded as a reduction to retained earnings, and approximately $13 million of related issuance costs that were recorded as a reduction of preferred stock, including related surplus, will be recorded as a reduction to net income available to common shareholders. Approximately $52 million of Series B preferred dividends that were recorded as a reduction of preferred stock, including related surplus, will be recorded as a reduction to retained earnings, and approximately $15 million of related issuance costs that were recorded as a reduction of preferred stock, including related surplus, will be recorded as a reduction to net income available to common shareholders.
COMMON STOCK
On June 28, 2018, Regions received no objection from the Federal Reserve to its 2018 capital plan that was submitted as part of the CCAR process, which included the repurchase of common shares and a common stock dividend increase. As part of the Company's capital plan, the Board authorized a new $2.031 billion common stock repurchase plan, permitting repurchases from the beginning of the third quarter of 2018 through the second quarter of 2019. This plan is inclusive of the capital generated from the sale of Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates (see Note 3). The capital plan included a proposed increase of the quarterly common stock dividend to $0.14 per common share that began in the third quarter of 2018.
Regions declared $0.46 per share in cash dividends for 2018, $0.315 for 2017, and $0.255 for 2016.
As of December 31, 2018, Regions had repurchased approximately 90.4 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $1.7 billion under this plan. The Company continued to repurchase shares under this plan in the first quarter of 2019, and as of February 21, 2019, Regions had additional repurchases of approximately 7.4 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $114.0 million . All of these shares were immediately retired upon repurchase and, therefore, will not be included in treasury stock.
Prior to the new common stock repurchase plan, Regions had authorization to repurchase $1.47 billion in common shares. As of June 30, 2018, Regions had repurchased approximately 90.6 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $1.47 billion under this plan and concluded the plan during the second quarter of 2018.


137






ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
Activity within the balances in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) is shown in the following tables for the years ended December 31:  
 
2018
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity
 
Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale
 
Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges
 
Defined benefit pension plans and other post
employment
benefits
 
Accumulated
other
comprehensive
income (loss),
net of tax
 
(In millions)
Beginning of year
$
(33
)
 
$
(153
)
 
$
(51
)
 
$
(512
)
 
$
(749
)
Net change
6

 
(244
)
 
(12
)
 
35

 
(215
)
End of year
$
(27
)
 
$
(397
)
 
$
(63
)
 
$
(477
)
 
$
(964
)
 
2017
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity
 
Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale
 
Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges
 
Defined benefit pension plans and other post employment benefits
 
Accumulated other
comprehensive
income (loss),
net of tax
 
(In millions)
Beginning of year
$
(33
)
 
$
(106
)
 
$
11

 
$
(422
)
 
$
(550
)
Net change
6

 
(12
)
 
(51
)
 
(9
)
 
(66
)
Reclassification of the Tax Reform related revaluation of deferred tax items within AOCI
(6
)
 
(35
)
 
(11
)
 
(81
)
 
(133
)
End of year
$
(33
)
 
$
(153
)
 
$
(51
)
 
$
(512
)
 
$
(749
)
 
2016
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity
 
Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale
 
Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges
 
Defined benefit pension plans and other post employment benefits
 
Accumulated other
comprehensive
income (loss),
net of tax
 
(In millions)
Beginning of year
$
(47
)
 
$
(10
)
 
$
75

 
$
(398
)
 
$
(380
)
Net change
14

 
(96
)
 
(64
)
 
(24
)
 
(170
)
End of year
$
(33
)
 
$
(106
)
 
$
11

 
$
(422
)
 
$
(550
)


138





The following table presents amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the years ended December 31:
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
Details about Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) Components
 
Amount Reclassified from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) (1)
 
Amount Reclassified from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) (1)
 
Amount Reclassified from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) (1)
Affected Line Item in the Consolidated Statements of Income
 
 
(In millions)
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
(9
)
 
$
(10
)
 
$
(22
)
Net interest income and other financing income
 
 
3

 
4

 
8

Tax (expense) or benefit
 
 
$
(6
)
 
$
(6
)
 
$
(14
)
Net of tax
Unrealized gains and (losses) on available for sale securities:
 
    
 
    
 
 
 
 
 
$

 
$
19

 
$
6

Securities gains, net
 
 

 
(7
)
 
(2
)
Tax (expense) or benefit
 
 
$

 
$
12

 
$
4

Net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains and (losses) on cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
 
$
12

 
$
86

 
$
143

Net interest income and other financing income
 
 
(3
)
 
(33
)
 
(54
)
Tax (expense) or benefit
 
 
$
9

 
$
53

 
$
89

Net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization of defined benefit pension plans and other post employment benefits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actuarial gains (losses) and settlements
(2)  
$
(36
)
 
$
(48
)
 
$
(34
)
Total before tax
 
 
8

 
17

 
12

Tax (expense) or benefit
 
 
$
(28
)
 
$
(31
)
 
$
(22
)
Net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total reclassifications for the period
 
$
(25
)
 
$
28

 
$
57

Net of tax
_________
(1) Amounts in parentheses indicate reductions to net income.
(2) These accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) components are included in the computation of net periodic pension cost and are included in other non-interest expense on the consolidated statements of income (see Note 18 for additional details).

139





NOTE 16. EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE
The following table sets forth the computation of basic earnings per common share and diluted earnings per common share for the years ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Numerator:
 
 
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations
$
1,568

 
$
1,241

 
$
1,154

Preferred stock dividends
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
Income from continuing operations available to common shareholders
1,504

 
1,177

 
1,090

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax
191

 
22

 
9

Net income available to common shareholders
$
1,695

 
$
1,199

 
$
1,099

Denominator:
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted-average common shares outstanding—basic
1,092

 
1,186

 
1,255

Potential common shares
10

 
12

 
6

Weighted-average common shares outstanding—diluted
1,102

 
1,198

 
1,261

Earnings per common share from continuing operations available to common shareholders (1) :
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
1.38

 
$
0.99

 
$
0.87

Diluted
1.36

 
0.98

 
0.86

Earnings per common share from discontinued operations (1) :
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.18

 
$
0.02

 
$
0.01

Diluted
0.17

 
0.02

 
0.01

Earnings per common share (1) :
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
1.55

 
$
1.01

 
$
0.87

Diluted
1.54

 
1.00

 
0.87

________
(1)
 Certain per share amounts may not appear to reconcile due to rounding.
The effect from the assumed exercise of 6 million , 14 million and 27 million in stock options, restricted stock units and awards and performance stock units for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively, was not included in the above computations of diluted earnings per common share because such amounts would have had an antidilutive effect on earnings per common share.
NOTE 17. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS
Regions administers long-term incentive compensation plans that permit the granting of incentive awards in the form of stock options, restricted stock awards, performance awards and stock appreciation rights. While Regions has the ability to issue stock appreciation rights, none have been issued to date. The terms of all awards issued under these plans are determined by the Compensation Committee of the Board; however, no awards may be granted after the tenth anniversary from the date the plans were initially approved by stockholders. Incentive awards usually vest based on employee service, generally within three years from the date of the grant. The contractual lives of options granted under these plans are typically ten years from the date of the grant.
On April 23, 2015, the stockholders of the Company approved the Regions Financial Corporation 2015 LTIP, which permits the Company to grant to employees and directors various forms of incentive compensation. These forms of incentive compensation are similar to the types of compensation approved in prior plans. The 2015 LTIP authorizes 60 million common share equivalents available for grant, where grants of options and grants of full value awards (e.g., shares of restricted stock, restricted stock units and performance stock units) count as one share equivalent. Unless otherwise determined by the Compensation Committee of the Board, grants of restricted stock, restricted stock units, and performance stock units accrue dividends, or their notional equivalent, as they are declared by the Board, and are paid upon vesting of the award. Upon adoption of the 2015 LTIP, Regions closed the prior long-term incentive plan to new grants, and, accordingly, prospective grants must be made under the 2015 LTIP or a successor plan. All existing grants under prior long-term incentive plans are unaffected by adoption of the 2015 LTIP. The number of remaining share equivalents available for future issuance under the 2015 LTIP was approximately 43 million at December 31, 2018 .
Grants of performance-based restricted stock typically have a three -year performance period, and shares vest within three years after the grant date. Restricted stock units typically have a vesting period of three years. Grantees of restricted stock awards

140





or units must either remain employed with the Company for certain periods from the date of grant in order for shares to be released or issued or retire after meeting the standards of a retiree, at which time shares would be issued and released. The terms of these plans generally stipulate that the exercise price of options may not be less than the fair market value of Regions' common stock at the date the options are granted. Regions issues new shares from authorized reserves upon exercise.
The following table summarizes the elements of compensation cost recognized in the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Compensation cost of share-based compensation awards:
 
 
 
 
 
Restricted and performance stock awards
$
50

 
$
62

 
$
52

Tax benefits related to share-based compensation cost (1)
(13
)
 
(23
)
 
(20
)
Compensation cost of share-based compensation awards, net of tax
$
37

 
$
39

 
$
32

________
(1) The tax benefits rela ted to share-based compensation cost for 2018 exclude (a) excess tax benefits of $16 million related to settled share-based compensation awards and (b) tax expense of $3 million related to expired stock options.
STOCK OPTIONS
The following table summarizes the activity for 2018 , 2017 and 2016 related to stock options:
 
Number of
Options
 
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price
 
Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
(In millions)
 
Weighted-Average Remaining Contractual Term
Outstanding at December 31, 2015
19,350,157

 
$
21.06

 
$
20

 
2.45 yrs
Granted

 

 
 
 
 
Exercised
(1,954,064
)
 
5.80

 
 
 
 
Forfeited or expired
(3,941,046
)
 
34.39

 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2016
13,455,047

 
$
19.37

 
$
34

 
1.83 yrs
Granted

 

 
 
 
 
Exercised
(1,204,138
)
 
6.69

 
 
 
 
Forfeited or expired
(2,843,011
)
 
34.00

 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2017
9,407,898

 
$
16.58

 
$
35

 
1.05 yrs
Granted

 

 
 
 
 
Exercised
(1,619,206
)
 
7.08

 
 
 
 
Forfeited or expired
(6,063,969
)
 
21.88

 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2018
1,724,723

 
$
6.86

 
$
11

 
1.74 yrs
Exercisable at December 31, 2018
1,724,723

 
$
6.86

 
$
11

 
1.74 yrs
The aggregate intrinsic value of exercised options was $10 million for 2018 , $13 million for 2017 , and $17 million for 2016 . Cash received from options exercised was $11 million , $8 million , and $11 million in 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , respectively. The actual tax benefit realized for the tax deductions from options exercised totaled $4 million for 2018 , $3 million for 2017 , and $4 million for 2016 .
RESTRICTED STOCK AWARDS AND PERFORMANCE STOCK AWARDS
During 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , Regions made restricted stock grants that vest upon satisfaction of service conditions and restricted stock award and performance stock award grants that vest based upon service conditions and performance conditions. Incremental shares earned above the performance target associated with previous performance stock awards are included when and if performance targets are achieved. Dividend payments during the vesting period are deferred to the end of the vesting term. The fair value of these restricted shares, restricted stock units and performance stock units was estimated based upon the fair value of the underlying shares on the date of the grant. The valuation was not adjusted for the deferral of dividends.

141





Activity related to restricted stock awards and performance stock awards for 2018 , 2017 and 2016 is summarized as follows:
 
Number of
Shares/Units
 
Weighted-Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
Non-vested at December 31, 2015
16,374,242

 
$
9.51

Granted
6,867,672

 
7.93

Vested
(5,829,974
)
 
8.28

Forfeited
(852,998
)
 
9.07

Non-vested at December 31, 2016
16,558,942

 
$
9.31

Granted
3,993,591

 
14.57

Vested
(4,657,544
)
 
11.06

Forfeited
(631,955
)
 
10.04

Non-vested at December 31, 2017
15,263,034

 
$
10.12

Granted
3,051,090

 
18.17

Vested
(6,038,566
)
 
9.64

Forfeited
(747,021
)
 
13.00

Non-vested at December 31, 2018
11,528,537

 
$
12.32

As of December 31, 2018 , the pre-tax amount of non-vested restricted stock, restricted stock units and performance stock units not yet recognized was $53 million , which will be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.68 years. The total fair value of shares vested during the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , was $112 million , $68 million , and $47 million , respectively. No share-based compensation costs were capitalized during the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 .
NOTE 18. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
PENSION AND OTHER POSTRETIREMENT BENEFITS
Effective January 1, 2016, Regions separated its defined benefit pension plan qualified under the Internal Revenue Code into two plans. The new plan was created primarily for participants who were actively employed on January 1, 2016 and all other participants were retained in the existing plan. Regions' defined benefit pension plans cover only certain employees as the pension plans are closed to new entrants. Benefits under the pension plans are based on years of service and the employee’s highest five consecutive years of compensation during the last ten years of employment. Regions’ funding policy is to contribute annually at least the amount required by IRS minimum funding standards. Contributions are intended to provide not only for benefits attributed to service to date, but also for those expected to be earned in the future.
The Company also sponsors a SERP, which is a non-qualified pension plan that provides certain senior executive officers defined benefits in relation to their compensation. Actuarially determined pension expense is charged to current operations using the projected unit credit method. All defined benefit plans are referred to as “the plans” throughout the remainder of this footnote.

142





The following table sets forth the plans’ change in benefit obligation, plan assets and funded status, using a December 31 measurement date, and amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets at December 31 :
 
Qualified Plans
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
Total
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Change in benefit obligation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Projected benefit obligation, beginning of year
$
2,134

 
$
1,979

 
$
151

 
$
180

 
$
2,285

 
$
2,159

Service cost
35

 
34

 
3

 
4

 
38

 
38

Interest cost
70

 
72

 
5

 
5

 
75

 
77

Actuarial (gains) losses
(211
)
 
202

 
(3
)
 
12

 
(214
)
 
214

Benefit payments
(159
)
 
(150
)
 
(11
)
 
(7
)
 
(170
)
 
(157
)
Administrative expenses
(4
)
 
(3
)
 

 

 
(4
)
 
(3
)
Plan settlements

 

 

 
(43
)
 

 
(43
)
Projected benefit obligation, end of year
$
1,865

 
$
2,134

 
$
145

 
$
151

 
$
2,010

 
$
2,285

Change in plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets, beginning of year
$
2,218

 
$
1,990

 
$

 
$

 
$
2,218

 
$
1,990

Actual return on plan assets
(50
)
 
306

 

 

 
(50
)
 
306

Company contributions
100

 
75

 
11

 
50

 
111

 
125

Benefit payments
(159
)
 
(150
)
 
(11
)
 
(7
)
 
(170
)
 
(157
)
Administrative expenses
(4
)
 
(3
)
 

 

 
(4
)
 
(3
)
Plan settlements

 

 

 
(43
)
 

 
(43
)
Fair value of plan assets, end of year
$
2,105

 
$
2,218

 
$

 
$

 
$
2,105

 
$
2,218

Funded status and accrued benefit (cost) at measurement date
$
240

 
$
84

 
$
(145
)
 
$
(151
)
 
$
95

 
$
(67
)
Amount recognized in the Consolidated Balance Sheets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other assets
$
240

 
$
93

 
$

 
$

 
$
240

 
$
93

Other liabilities

 
(9
)
 
(145
)
 
(151
)
 
(145
)
 
(160
)
 
$
240

 
$
84

 
$
(145
)
 
$
(151
)
 
$
95

 
$
(67
)
Pre-tax amounts recognized in Accumulated Other Comprehensive (Income) Loss:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial loss
$
604

 
$
644

 
$
39

 
$
48

 
$
643

 
$
692

Prior service cost (credit)

 

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
$
604

 
$
644

 
$
40

 
$
49

 
$
644

 
$
693


The accumulated benefit obligation for the qualified plans was $1.8 billion and $2.0 billion as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Total plan assets exceeded the corresponding accumulated benefit obligation for the qualified plans as of both December 31, 2018 and 2017 . The accumulated benefit obligation for the non-qualified plans was $141 million and $143 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, which exceeded all corresponding plan assets for each period. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the actuarial (gains) losses related to the change in the benefit obligation were primarily driven by changes in the discount rate.



143





Net periodic pension cost (benefit) included the following components for the years ended December 31 :
 
Qualified Plans
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
Total
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Service cost
$
35

 
$
34

 
$
35

 
$
3

 
$
4

 
$
4

 
$
38

 
$
38

 
$
39

Interest cost
70

 
72

 
73

 
5

 
5

 
5

 
75

 
77

 
78

Expected return on plan assets
(153
)
 
(143
)
 
(145
)
 

 

 

 
(153
)
 
(143
)
 
(145
)
Amortization of actuarial loss
31

 
32

 
31

 
5

 
4

 
3

 
36

 
36

 
34

Settlement charge

 

 

 

 
12

 

 

 
12

 

Net periodic pension (benefit) cost
$
(17
)
 
$
(5
)
 
$
(6
)
 
$
13

 
$
25

 
$
12

 
$
(4
)
 
$
20

 
$
6

The service cost component of net periodic pension cost is recorded in salaries and employee benefits on the consolidated statements of income. Components other than service cost are recorded in other non-interest expense on the consolidated statements of income.
The settlement charge in 2017 relates to the settlement of liabilities under the SERP for certain plan participants.
The assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at December 31 are as follows:
 
Qualified Plans
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
Discount rate
4.38
%
 
3.71
%
 
4.18
%
 
3.50
%
Rate of annual compensation increase
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
The weighted-average assumptions used to determine net periodic (benefit) cost for the years ended December 31 are as follows:
 
Qualified Plans
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
Discount rate
3.70
%
 
4.34
%
 
4.56
%
 
3.49
%
 
3.93
%
 
4.19
%
Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
6.84
%
 
7.25
%
 
7.75
%
 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

Rate of annual compensation increase
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
Regions utilizes a disaggregated approach in the estimation of the service and interest components of net periodic pension costs by applying the specific spot rates along the yield curve used in the determination of the benefit obligation to the relevant projected cash flows.  This provides a more precise measurement of service and interest costs by improving the correlation between projected benefit cash flows and the corresponding spot yield curve rates. 
The expected long-term rate of return on the qualified plans' assets is based on an estimated reasonable range of probable returns. The assumption is established by considering historical and anticipated return of the asset classes invested in by the qualified plans and the allocation strategy currently in place among those classes. Management chose a point within the range based on the probability of achievement combined with incremental returns attributable to active management. For 2019, the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is 6.84 percent .
The qualified pension plans' investment strategy is continuing to shift from focusing on maximizing asset returns to minimizing funding ratio volatility, with a planned increase in the allocation to bonds. The combined target asset allocation is 51 percent equities, 37 percent fixed income securities and 12 percent in all other types of investments. Equity securities include investments in large and small/mid cap companies primarily located in the U.S., international equities, and private equities. Fixed income securities include investments in corporate and government bonds, asset-backed securities and any other fixed income investments as allowed by respective prospectuses and other offering documents. Other types of investments may include hedge funds and real estate funds that follow several different strategies. The plans' assets are highly diversified with respect to asset class, security and manager. Investment risk is controlled with the plans' assets rebalancing to target allocations on a periodic basis and continual monitoring of investment managers’ performance relative to the investment guidelines established with each investment manager.
Regions’ qualified pension plans have a portion of their investments in Regions' common stock. At December 31, 2018 , the plans held 2,855,618 shares, which represents a total market value of approximately $38 million , or approximately 1.8 percent of the plans' assets.

144





The following table presents the fair value of Regions’ qualified pension plans’ financial assets as of December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Fair Value
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Fair Value
 
(In millions)
Cash and cash equivalents
$
158

 
$

 
$

 
$
158

 
$
48

 
$

 
$

 
$
48

Fixed income securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury and federal agency securities
$

 
$
148

 
$

 
$
148

 
$

 
$
172

 
$

 
$
172

Corporate bonds

 
216

 

 
216

 

 
216

 

 
216

Total fixed income securities
$

 
$
364

 
$

 
$
364

 
$

 
$
388

 
$

 
$
388

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Domestic
$
287

 
$

 
$

 
$
287

 
$
427

 
$

 
$

 
$
427

International
186

 

 

 
186

 
32

 

 

 
32

Total equity securities
$
473

 
$

 
$

 
$
473

 
$
459

 
$

 
$

 
$
459

International mutual funds
$
159

 
$

 
$

 
$
159

 
$
100

 
$

 
$

 
$
100

Total assets in the fair value hierarchy
$
790

 
$
364

 
$

 
$
1,154

 
$
607

 
$
388

 
$

 
$
995

Collective trust funds:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed income fund (1)


 


 


 
$
405

 


 


 


 
$
388

Common stock fund (1)


 


 


 
246

 


 


 


 
265

International fund (1)


 


 


 

 


 


 


 
216

Total collective trust funds


 


 


 
$
651

 


 


 


 
$
869

Hedge funds measured at NAV (1)


 


 


 
$
1

 


 


 


 
$
46

Real estate funds measured at NAV (1)


 


 


 
$
200

 


 


 


 
$
197

Private equity funds measured at NAV (1)


 


 


 
$
99

 


 


 


 
$
111

 


 


 


 
$
2,105

 


 


 


 
$
2,218

__________
(1) In accordance with accounting guidance adopted by Regions in 2016, investments that are measured at fair value using the net asset value per share (or its equivalent) practical expedient are no longer required to be classified in the fair value hierarchy. The fair value amounts presented in this table are intended to permit reconciliation of amounts reported in the fair value hierarchy to amounts reported on the balance sheet.
For all investments, the plans attempt to use quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges, or Level 1 measurements. Where such quoted market prices are not available, the plans typically employ quoted market prices of similar instruments (including matrix pricing) and/or discounted cash flows to estimate a value of these securities, or Level 2 measurements. Level 2 discounted cash flow analyses are typically based on market interest rates, prepayment speeds and/or option adjusted spreads.
Investments held in the plans consist of cash and cash equivalents, fixed income securities , equity securities, collective trust funds, hedge funds, real estate funds, private equity and other assets and are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. See Note 1 for a description of valuation methodologies related to U.S. Treasuries, federal agency securities, and equity securities. The methodology described in Note 1 for other debt securities is applicable to corporate bonds.
Mutual funds are valued based on quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges; these valuations are Level 1 measurements. Collective trust funds, hedge funds, real estate funds, private equity funds and other assets are valued based on net asset value or the valuation of the limited partner’s portion of the equity of the fund. Third party fund managers provide these valuations based primarily on estimated valuations of underlying investments.

145





Information about the expected cash flows for the qualified and non-qualified plans is as follows:
 
Qualified
 
Non-qualified
 
(In millions)
Expected Employer Contributions:
 
 
 
2019
$

 
$
9

Expected Benefit Payments:
 
 
 
2019
$
121

 
$
9

2020
121

 
10

2021
127

 
24

2022
129

 
17

2023
130

 
13

Next five years
668

 
56

OTHER PLANS
Regions has a defined-contribution 401(k) plan that includes a Company match of eligible employee contributions. Eligible employees include those who have been employed for one year and have worked a minimum of 1,000 hours. The Company match is invested based on the employees' allocation elections. In 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , Regions provided an automatic 2 percent cash 401(k) contribution to eligible employees regardless of whether or not they were contributing to the 401(k) plan. To receive this contribution, employees must be employed at the end of the year and not actively accruing a benefit in the Regions’ pension plans. Regions’ cash contribution was approximately $18 million for both 2018 and 2017 and $17 million for 2016 . Eligible employees who are already contributing to the 401(k) plan will continue to receive up to a 4 percent Company match plus the automatic 2 percent cash contribution. Regions’ match to the 401(k) plan on behalf of employees totaled $48 million in both 2018 and 2017 and $45 million in 2016 . Regions’ 401(k) plan held 23 million shares and 26 million shares of Regions' common stock at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. The 401(k) plan received approximately $10 million , $8 million and $9 million in dividends on Regions' common stock for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
Effective January 1, 2019, for eligible employees, the Company match for the 401(k) plan increased from 4 percent to 5 percent .
Regions also sponsors defined benefit postretirement health care plans that cover certain retired employees. For these certain employees retiring before normal retirement age, the Company currently pays a portion of the costs of certain health care benefits until the retired employee becomes eligible for Medicare. Certain retirees, participating in plans of acquired entities, are offered a Medicare supplemental benefit. The plan is contributory and contains other cost-sharing features such as deductibles and co-payments. Retiree health care benefits, as well as similar benefits for active employees, are provided through a self-insured program in which Company and retiree costs are based on the amount of benefits paid. The Company’s policy is to fund the Company’s share of the cost of health care benefits in amounts determined at the discretion of management. Postretirement life insurance is also provided to a grandfathered group of employees and retirees. The assumed health care cost trend rate for postretirement medical benefits was 6.10 percent for 2018 and is assumed to decrease gradually to 4.50 percent by 2038 and remain at that level thereafter. There was no material impact from other postretirement benefits on the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 . The accumulated postretirement benefit obligation for these plans was $17 million and $19 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.

146





NOTE 19. OTHER NON-INTEREST INCOME AND EXPENSE
The following is a detail of other non-interest income from continuing operations for the years ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Investment services fee income
$
71

 
$
60

 
$
58

Commercial credit fee income
71

 
71

 
73

Bank-owned life insurance
65

 
81

 
95

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - defined benefit
(6
)
 

 

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - other
(5
)
 
16

 
3

Insurance proceeds

 

 
50

Other miscellaneous income
100

 
75

 
122

 
$
296

 
$
303

 
$
401

The following is a detail of other non-interest expense from continuing operations for the years ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Outside services
$
187

 
$
172

 
$
154

Professional, legal and regulatory expenses
119

 
93

 
92

Marketing
92

 
93

 
101

FDIC insurance assessments
85

 
108

 
99

Branch consolidation, property and equipment charges
11

 
22

 
58

Visa class B shares expense
10

 
19

 
15

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(2
)
 
(16
)
 
17

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
14

Other miscellaneous expenses
461

 
461

 
437

 
$
963

 
$
952

 
$
987

NOTE 20. INCOME TAXES
The components of income tax expense from continuing operations for the years ended December 31 were as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Current income tax expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Federal
$
175

 
$
373

 
$
442

State
29

 
30

 
21

Total current expense
$
204

 
$
403

 
$
463

Deferred income tax expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Federal
$
130

 
$
180

 
$
1

State
53

 
36

 
46

Total deferred expense
$
183

 
$
216

 
$
47

Total income tax expense
$
387

 
$
619

 
$
510

__________
Note: The table above does not include total income tax expense (benefit) from discontinued operations of $80 million , $(3) million , and $7 million in 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively. The deferred income tax expense (benefit) reflected in discontinued operations was $43 million , $(7) million and $20 million in 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
On December 22, 2017, Tax Reform was enacted. Effective January 1, 2018, Tax Reform reduced the maximum corporate statutory federal income tax rate from 35 percent to 21 percent . With the enactment of Tax Reform, the Company recognized additional income tax expense of approximately $61 million at December 31, 2017. This amount represented an estimate based on information available at December 31, 2017. During 2018, the Company made the determination to and completed administrative filings with the Internal Revenue Service that allowed it to accelerate various deductions into 2017. As a result, the Company recognized during the 2018 measurement period approximately $37 million in tax benefits due to Tax Reform. The measurement period ended in December 2018.

147





Except for the revaluation adjustment recorded in 2017 due to Tax Reform related to unrealized gains and losses included in stockholders' equity, income tax expense does not reflect the tax effects of unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity, unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments and the net change from defined benefit pension plans and other postretirement benefits. Refer to Note 15 for additional information on stockholders' equity and accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).
The Company accounts for investment tax credits using the deferral method. Investment tax credits generated totaled $90 million , $102 million and $54 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Income taxes from continuing operations for financial reporting purposes differs from the amount computed by applying the statutory federal income tax rate of 21 percent for the year ended December 31 , 2018 and 35 percent for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, as shown in the following table:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(Dollars in millions)
Tax on income from continuing operations computed at statutory federal income tax rate
$
410

 
$
651

 
$
582

Increase (decrease) in taxes resulting from:
 
 
 
 
 
State income tax, net of federal tax effect
65

 
43

 
44

Tax-exempt interest
(37
)
 
(54
)
 
(49
)
Affordable housing investment amortization, net of tax benefits (excluding Tax Reform)
(37
)
 
(52
)
 
(50
)
Deferred tax revaluation and other impacts of Tax Reform
(37
)
 
61

 

Non-deductible expenses
28

 
3

 
5

Bank-owned life insurance
(16
)
 
(32
)
 
(37
)
Lease financing
11

 
16

 
28

Other, net

 
(17
)
 
(13
)
Income tax expense
$
387

 
$
619

 
$
510

Effective tax rate
19.8
%
 
33.3
%
 
30.6
%
___ _______
Note: Income tax expense includes amortization of affordable housing investments of $137 million , $160 million (including $23 million due to impact of Tax Reform) and $117 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The additional income tax expense due to Tax Reform of $61 million in 2017 included $133 million of income tax expense related to the revaluation of unrealized gains and losses included in stockholders' equity.

148





Significant components of the Company’s net deferred tax asset at December 31 are listed below:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Deferred tax assets:
 
 
 
Unrealized losses included in stockholders’ equity
$
325

 
$
253

Allowance for loan losses
226

 
249

State net operating loss carryfowards, net of federal tax effect
73

 
82

Accrued expenses
48

 
55

Federal tax credit carryforwards
14

 
13

Fixed assets

 
4

Other
21

 
33

Total deferred tax assets
707

 
689

Less: valuation allowance
(30
)
 
(34
)
Total deferred tax assets less valuation allowance
677

 
655

Deferred tax liabilities:
 
 
 
Lease financing
330

 
292

Goodwill and intangibles
94

 
99

Employee benefits and deferred compensation
82

 
2

Mortgage servicing rights
73

 
63

Fixed assets
41

 

Other
37

 
36

Total deferred tax liabilities
657

 
492

Net deferred tax asset
$
20

 
$
163

The following table provides details of the Company’s tax carryforwards at December 31, 2018 , including the expiration dates, any related valuation allowance and the amount of taxable earnings necessary to fully realize each net deferred tax asset balance:
 
Expiration Dates
 
Deferred Tax
Asset Balance
 
Valuation
Allowance
 
Net Deferred Tax
Asset Balance
 
Pre-Tax
Earnings
Necessary to
Realize (1)
 
(In millions)
General business credits
2038
 
$
14

 
$

 
$
14

 
$ N/A

Net operating losses-states
2019-2023
 
45

 
(9
)
 
36

 
710

Net operating losses-states
2024-2030
 
21

 
(15
)
 
6

 
115

Net operating losses-states
2031-2038
 
7

 
(6
)
 
1

 
13

Other credits-states
2019-2023
 
2

 

 
2

 
N/A

Other credits-states
2024-2030
 
1

 

 
1

 
N/A

________
(1) N/A indicates that credits are not measured on a pre-tax basis.

Of the $20 million net deferred tax asset, $60 million relates to net operating losses and tax credit carryforwards, $45 million of which expires before 2031 (as detailed in the table above).
The Company’s determination of the realization of the net deferred tax asset is based on its assessment of all available positive and negative evidence. At December 31, 2018 , positive evidence supporting the realization of the deferred tax assets includes a history of positive earnings with no history of significant tax credit carryforwards expiring unused. In addition, the reversal of taxable temporary differences, excluding goodwill and the inclusion of the accretion of taxable temporary differences related to leveraged leases acquired in a previous business combination, will offset approximately $593 million of the gross deferred tax assets.
The Company believes that a portion of the state net operating loss carryforwards and state tax credit carryforwards will not be realized due to the length of certain state carryforward periods. Accordingly, a valuation allowance has been established in the amount of $30 million against such benefits at December 31, 2018 compared to $34 million at December 31, 2017 .

149





A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
$
27

 
$
31

 
$
38

Additions based on tax positions related to the current year
11

 

 
3

Reductions based on tax positions taken in a prior period
(13
)
 

 
(6
)
Settlements
(11
)
 

 
(3
)
Expiration of statute of limitations
(1
)
 
(4
)
 
(1
)
Balance at end of year
$
13

 
$
27

 
$
31

The Company files U.S. federal, state, and local income tax returns. In 2015, the Company entered the IRS’s Compliance Assurance Process program and tax years 2017 and 2018 remain open. Other than potential adjustments related to tax attribute carryovers, tax years prior to 2017 are no longer subject to examination by the IRS. Also, with few exceptions, the Company is no longer subject to state and local income tax examinations for tax years before 2014. Currently, there are no material disputed tax positions with federal or state taxing authorities. Accordingly, the Company does not anticipate that any adjustments relating to federal or state tax examinations will result in material changes to its business, financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
As a result of the potential resolution of certain federal and state income tax positions, it is reasonably possible that the UTBs could decrease as much as $2 million during the next twelve months, since resolved items will be removed from the balance whether their resolution results in payment or recognition in earnings.
As of December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , the balance of the Company’s UTBs that would reduce the effective tax rate, if recognized, was $10 million , $21 million and $20 million , respectively. The remainder of the UTB balance has indirect tax benefits in other jurisdictions or is the tax effect of temporary differences.
Income tax expense for 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , includes a total expense (benefit) of $(2) million , $(2) million and $1 million , respectively, for interest expense, interest income and penalties before the impact of any applicable federal and state deductions. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , the Company had a liability of zero and $2 million , respectively, for interest and penalties related to income taxes, before the impact of any applicable federal and state deductions.

150





NOTE 21. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING ACTIVITIES
The following tables present the notional amount and estimated fair value of derivative instruments on a gross basis as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 . Beginning in the first quarter of 2018, variation margin payments made for derivatives cleared through LCH Limited are legally characterized as settlements of the derivatives. Exchange traded derivatives cleared through LCH Limited were not offset prior to January 2018.
 
2018
 
2017
 
Notional
Amount
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
Notional
Amount
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
Gain (1)
 
Loss (1)
 
Gain (1)
 
Loss (1)
 
(In millions)
Derivatives in fair value hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
3,231

 
 
 
 
 
$
3,060

 
$
1

 
$
43

Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
8,750

 
 
 
 
 
6,825

 
5

 
188

Interest rate floors (2)
3,250

 
$
72

 
 
 

 

 

Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments
$
15,231

 
$
72

 
 
 
$
9,885

 
$
6

 
$
231

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
49,737

 
$
193

 
$
237

 
$
40,841

 
$
308

 
$
342

Interest rate options
7,178

 
29

 
20

 
4,598

 
23

 
15

Interest rate futures and forward commitments
7,961

 
4

 
9

 
20,404

 
6

 
5

Other contracts
7,287

 
72

 
74

 
5,721

 
51

 
48

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
$
72,163

 
$
298

 
$
340

 
$
71,564

 
$
388

 
$
410

Total derivatives
$
87,394

 
$
370

 
$
340

 
$
81,449

 
$
394

 
$
641

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total gross derivative instruments, before netting
 
 
$
370

 
$
340

 
 
 
$
394

 
$
641

Less: Legally enforceable master netting agreements
 
 
108

 
108

 
 
 
107

 
107

Less: Cash collateral received/posted
 
 
135

 
71

 
 
 
34

 
131

Total gross derivative instruments, after netting (3)
 
 
$
127

 
$
161

 
 
 
$
253

 
$
403

_________
(1)
Derivatives in a gain position are recorded as other assets and derivatives in a loss position are recorded as other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets. There is no fair value presented for contracts that are characterized as settled daily.
(2)
Estimated fair value includes premium and change in fair value of the interest rate floors.
(3)
As of December 31, 2018, financial instruments posted of $24 million were not offset in the consolidated balance sheets. As of December 31, 2017, cash collateral posted of $ 257 million and financial instruments posted of $50 million were not offset in the consolidated balance sheets.
HEDGING DERIVATIVES
Derivatives entered into to manage interest rate risk and facilitate asset/liability management strategies are designated as hedging derivatives. Derivative financial instruments that qualify in a hedging relationship are classified, based on the exposure being hedged, as either fair value hedges or cash flow hedges. Additional information regarding accounting policies for derivatives is described in Note 1.
FAIR VALUE HEDGES
Fair value hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the change in fair value of an asset, liability or firm commitment.
Regions enters into interest rate swap agreements to manage interest rate exposure on the Company’s fixed-rate borrowings. These agreements involve the receipt of fixed-rate amounts in exchange for floating-rate interest payments over the life of the agreements. Regions enters into interest rate swap agreements to manage interest rate exposure on certain of the Company's fixed-rate available for sale debt securities. These agreements involve the payment of fixed-rate amounts in exchange for floating-rate interest receipts.
CASH FLOW HEDGES
Cash flow hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the variability of future cash flows or other forecasted transactions.
Regions enters into interest rate swap and floor agreements to manage overall cash flow changes related to interest rate risk exposure on LIBOR-based loans. The agreements effectively modify the Company’s exposure to interest rate risk by utilizing receive fixed/pay LIBOR interest rate swaps and interest rate floors.

151





Regions recognized an unrealized after-tax gain of $51 million and $147 million in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, related to discontinued cash flow hedges of loan instruments which will be amortized into earnings in conjunction with the recognition of interest payments through 2025. Regions recognized pre-tax income of $45 million and $68 million during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively related to the amortization of discontinued cash flow hedges of loan instruments.
Regions expects to reclassify into earnings approximately $31 million in pre-tax expense due to the receipt or payment of interest payments on all cash flow hedges and interest rate within the next twelve months. Included in this amount is $14 million in pre-tax net gains related to the amortization of discontinued cash flow hedges. The maximum length of time over which Regions is hedging its exposure to the variability in future cash flows for forecasted transactions is approximately seven years as of December 31, 2018 .
The following tables present the effect of hedging derivative instruments on the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31 :
 
Year Ended December 31, 2018
 
Interest Income
 
Interest Expense
 
Non-interest expense
 
Debt securities-taxable
 
Loans, including fees
 
Deposits
 
Long-term borrowings
 
Other
 
(In millions)
Total amounts presented in the consolidated statements of income
$
625

 
$
3,613

 
$
250

 
$
322

 
$
963

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) on fair value hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
(15
)
 
$

   Recognized on derivatives
4

 

 

 
1

 

   Recognized on hedged items
(4
)
 

 

 
(1
)
 

Net income (expense) recognized on fair value hedges
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
(15
)
 
$

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) on cash flow hedging relationships: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) reclassified from AOCI into net income (2)
$

 
$
12

 
$

 
$

 
$

Net income (expense) recognized on cash flow hedges
$

 
$
12

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
Year Ended December 31, 2017
 
Interest Income
 
Interest Expense
 
Non-interest expense
 
Debt securities-taxable
 
Loans, including fees
 
Deposits
 
Long-term borrowings
 
Other
 
(In millions)
Total amounts presented in the consolidated statements of income
$
596

 
$
3,228

 
$
156

 
$
212

 
$
952

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) on fair value hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives
$
(4
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
2

 
$

   Recognized on derivatives

 

 

 

 
(19
)
   Recognized on hedged items

 

 

 

 
20

Net income (expense) recognized on fair value hedges
$
(4
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
2

 
$
1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) on cash flow hedging relationships: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) reclassified from AOCI into net income (2)
$

 
$
86

 
$

 
$

 
$

Net income (expense) recognized on cash flow hedges
$

 
$
86

 
$

 
$

 
$


152





 
Year Ended December 31, 2016
 
Interest Income
 
Interest Expense
 
Non-interest expense
 
Debt securities-taxable
 
Loans, including fees
 
Deposits
 
Long-term borrowings
 
Other
 
(In millions)
Total amounts presented in the consolidated statements of income
$
563

 
$
3,066

 
$
117

 
$
196

 
$
987

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) on fair value hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives
$
(9
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
12

 
$

   Recognized on derivatives

 

 

 

 
(33
)
   Recognized on hedged items

 

 

 

 
30

Net income (expense) recognized on fair value hedges
$
(9
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
12

 
$
(3
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) on cash flow hedging relationships: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) reclassified from AOCI into net income (2)
$

 
$
143

 
$

 
$

 
$

Net income (expense) recognized on cash flow hedges
$

 
$
143

 
$

 
$

 
$

____
(1) See Note 15 for gain or (loss) recognized for cash flow hedges in AOCI.
(2) Pre-tax


The following table presents the carrying amount and associated cumulative basis adjustment related to the application of hedge accounting that is included in the carrying amount of hedged assets and liabilities in fair value hedging relationships.
 
December 31, 2018
 
Hedged Items Currently Designated
 
Hedged Items No Longer Designated
 
Carrying Amount of Assets/(Liabilities)
 
Hedge Accounting Basis Adjustment
 
Carrying Amount of Assets/(Liabilities)
 
Hedge Accounting Basis Adjustment
 
(In millions)
Debt securities available for sale
$
85

 
$

 
$
604

 
$
4

Long-term borrowings
(3,103
)
 
50

 

 


DERIVATIVES NOT DESIGNATED AS HEDGING INSTRUMENTS
The Company holds a portfolio of interest rate swaps, option contracts, and futures and forward commitments that result from transactions with its commercial customers in which they manage their risks by entering into a derivative with Regions. The Company monitors and manages the net risk in this customer portfolio and enters into separate derivative contracts in order to reduce the overall exposure to pre-defined limits.  For both derivatives with its end customers and derivatives Regions enters into to mitigate the risk in this portfolio, the Company is subject to market risk and the risk that the counterparty will default.  The contracts in this portfolio are not designated as accounting hedges and are marked-to market through earnings (in capital markets income) and included in other assets and other liabilities, as appropriate.
Regions enters into interest rate lock commitments, which are commitments to originate mortgage loans whereby the interest rate on the loan is determined prior to funding and the customers have locked into that interest rate. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , Regions had $191 million and $197 million , respectively, in total notional amount of interest rate lock commitments. Regions manages market risk on interest rate lock commitments and mortgage loans held for sale with corresponding forward sale commitments. Residential mortgage loans held for sale are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in mortgage income. Commercial mortgage loans held for sale are recorded at the lower of cost or market or at fair value based on management's election. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , Regions had $429 million and $481 million , respectively, in total notional amount related to these forward sale commitments. Changes in mark-to-market from both interest rate lock commitments and corresponding forward sale commitments related to residential mortgage loans are included in mortgage income. Changes in mark-to-market from both interest rate lock commitments and corresponding forward sale commitments related to commercial mortgage loans are included in capital markets income.
Regions has elected to account for residential MSRs at fair market value with any changes to fair value being recorded within mortgage income. Concurrent with the election to use the fair value measurement method, Regions began using various derivative

153





instruments, in the form of forward rate commitments, futures contracts, swaps and swaptions to mitigate the effect of changes in the fair value of its residential MSRs on its consolidated statements of income. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , the total notional amount related to these contracts was $5.7 billion and $4.8 billion , respectively.
The following table presents the location and amount of gain or (loss) recognized in income on derivatives not designated as hedging instruments in the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31 :
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Capital markets income:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
19

 
$
11

 
$
13

Interest rate options
28

 
28

 
23

Interest rate futures and forward commitments
3

 
10

 
4

Other contracts
5

 
(10
)
 
(3
)
Total capital markets income
55

 
39

 
37

Mortgage income:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
(12
)
 
2

 
(2
)
Interest rate options

 
(7
)
 
(2
)
Interest rate futures and forward commitments
(8
)
 
(3
)
 
8

Total mortgage income
(20
)
 
(8
)

4

 
$
35

 
$
31


$
41


Credit risk, defined as all positive exposures not collateralized with cash or other assets or reserved for, at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , totaled approximately $130 million and $251 million , respectively. This amount represents the net credit risk on all trading and other derivative positions held by Regions.
CREDIT DERIVATIVES
Regions has both bought and sold credit protection in the form of participations on interest rate swaps (swap participations). These swap participations, which meet the definition of credit derivatives, were entered into in the ordinary course of business to serve the credit needs of customers. Swap participations, whereby Regions has purchased credit protection, entitle Regions to receive a payment from the counterparty if the customer fails to make payment on any amounts due to Regions upon early termination of the swap transaction and have maturities between 2019 and 2026. Credit derivatives whereby Regions has sold credit protection have maturities between 2019 and 2038. For contracts where Regions sold credit protection, Regions would be required to make payment to the counterparty if the customer fails to make payment on any amounts due to the counterparty upon early termination of the swap transaction. Regions bases the current status of the prepayment/performance risk on bought and sold credit derivatives on recently issued internal risk ratings consistent with the risk management practices of unfunded commitments.
Regions’ maximum potential amount of future payments under these contracts as of December 31, 2018 was approximately $529 million . This scenario would only occur if variable interest rates were at zero percent and all counterparties defaulted with zero recovery. The fair value of sold protection at December 31, 2018 and 2017 was immaterial. In transactions where Regions has sold credit protection, recourse to collateral associated with the original swap transaction is available to offset some or all of Regions’ obligation.
Regions has bought credit protection in the form of credit default indices. These indices, which meet the definition of credit derivatives, were entered into in the ordinary course of business to economically hedge credit spread risk in commercial mortgage loans held for sale whereby the fair value option has been elected. Credit derivatives, whereby Regions has purchased credit protection, entitle Regions to receive a payment from the counterparty if losses on the underlying index exceed a certain threshold, dependent upon the tranche rating of the capital structure.
CONTINGENT FEATURES
Certain of Regions’ derivative instrument contracts with broker-dealers contain credit-related termination provisions and/or credit related provisions regarding the posting of collateral, allowing those broker-dealers to terminate the contracts in the event that Regions’ and/or Regions Bank’s credit ratings fall below specified ratings from certain major credit rating agencies. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with any credit-risk-related contingent features that were in a liability position on December 31, 2018 and 2017 , was $45 million and $91 million , respectively, for which Regions had posted collateral of $43 million and $90 million , respectively, in the normal course of business.

154





NOTE 22. FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
See Note 1 for a description of valuation methodologies for assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis. Assets and liabilities measured at fair value rarely transfer between Level 1 and Level 2 measurements. Marketable equity securities and debt securities available for sale may be periodically transferred to or from Level 3 valuation based on management’s conclusion regarding the observability of inputs used in valuing the securities. Such transfers are accounted for as if they occur at the beginning of a reporting period.The following table presents assets and liabilities measured at estimated fair value on a recurring basis and non-recurring basis as of December 31:
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3 (1)
 
Total
Estimated Fair Value
 
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3 (1)
 
Total
Estimated Fair Value
 
(In millions)
Recurring fair value measurements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
280

 
$

 
$

 
$
280

 
 
$
331

 
$

 
$

 
$
331

Federal agency securities

 
43

 

 
43

 
 

 
28

 

 
28

Mortgage-backed securities (MBS):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency

 
16,624

 

 
16,624

 
 

 
17,431

 

 
17,431

Residential non-agency

 

 
2

 
2

 
 

 

 
3

 
3

Commercial agency

 
3,835

 

 
3,835

 
 

 
3,714

 

 
3,714

Commercial non-agency

 
760

 

 
760

 
 

 
788

 

 
788

Corporate and other debt securities

 
1,182

 
3

 
1,185

 
 

 
1,105

 
3

 
1,108

Total debt securities available for sale
$
280

 
$
22,444

 
$
5

 
$
22,729

 
 
$
331

 
$
23,066

 
$
6

 
$
23,403

Loans held for sale
$

 
$
251

 
$

 
$
251

 
 
$

 
$
325

 
$

 
$
325

Marketable equity securities (2)
$
429

 
$

 
$

 
$
429

 
 
$
414

 
$

 
$

 
$
414

Residential mortgage servicing rights
$

 
$

 
$
418

 
$
418

 
 
$

 
$

 
$
336

 
$
336

Derivative assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$

 
$
193

 
$

 
$
193

 
 
$

 
$
314

 
$

 
$
314

Interest rate options

 
96

 
5

 
101

 
 

 
18

 
5

 
23

Interest rate futures and forward commitments

 
4

 

 
4

 
 

 
6

 

 
6

Other contracts
2

 
70

 

 
72

 
 
2

 
49

 

 
51

Total derivative assets
$
2

 
$
363

 
$
5

 
$
370

 
 
$
2

 
$
387

 
$
5

 
$
394

Derivative liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$

 
$
237

 
$

 
$
237

 
 
$

 
$
573

 
$

 
$
573

Interest rate options

 
20

 

 
20

 
 

 
15

 

 
15

Interest rate futures and forward commitments

 
9

 

 
9

 
 

 
5

 

 
5

Other contracts
2

 
69

 
3

 
74

 
 
2

 
46

 

 
48

Total derivative liabilities
$
2

 
$
335

 
$
3

 
$
340

 
 
$
2

 
$
639

 
$

 
$
641

Non-recurring fair value measurements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held for sale
$

 
$

 
$
10

 
$
10

 
 
$

 
$

 
$
20

 
$
20

Equity investments without a readily determinable fair value (3)

 

 
27

 
27

 
 

 

 

 

Foreclosed property and other real estate

 
16

 
3

 
19

 
 

 
24

 
9

 
33

_________
(1)
All following disclosures related to Level 3 recurring and non-recurring assets do not include those deemed to be immaterial.
(2)
Marketable equity securities were reclassified from trading account securities and securities available for sale to other earning assets, beginning in the first quarter of 2018, with the adoption of new accounting guidance. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to current period presentation.
(3)
With the adoption of new accounting guidance, effective January 1, 2018, equity investments without a readily determinable fair value are required to be adjusted prospectively to estimated fair value when an observable price transaction for a same or similar investment with the same issuer occurs.


155





Assets and liabilities in all levels could result in volatile and material price fluctuations. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on Level 3 assets represent only a portion of the risk to market fluctuations in Regions’ consolidated balance sheets. Further, derivatives included in Levels 2 and 3 are used by ALCO in a holistic approach to managing price fluctuation risks.
The following tables illustrate rollforwards for all material assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively. The net changes in realized gains (losses) included in earnings related to Level 3 assets and liabilities held at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 are not material.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
Total Realized /
Unrealized
Gains or Losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Opening Balance January 1, 2018
 
Included
in
Earnings
 
Included
in Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)
 
Purchases
 
Sales
 
Issuances
 
Settlements
 
Transfers
into
Level 3
 
Transfers
out of
Level 3
 
Closing
Balance
December 31, 2018
 
(In millions)
Level 3 Instruments Only
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights
$
336

 
(29
)
(1)   

 
111

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
418

 
Year Ended December 31, 2017
 
Opening
Balance
January 1,
2017
 
Total Realized /
Unrealized
Gains or Losses
 
Purchases
 
Sales
 
Issuances
 
Settlements
 
Transfers
into
Level 3
 
Transfers
out of
Level 3
 
Closing
Balance
December 31, 2017
 
Included
in Earnings
 
Included
in Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)
 
 
(In millions)
Level 3 Instruments Only
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights
$
324

 
(52
)
(1)   

 
64

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
336

 
Year Ended December 31, 2016
 
 
Opening
Balance
January 1,
2016
 
Total Realized /
Unrealized
Gains or Losses
 
Purchases
 
Sales
 
Issuances
 
Settlements
 
Transfers
into
Level 3
 
Transfers
out of
Level 3
 
Closing Balance December 31, 2016
 
Included
in Earnings
 
Included
in Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)
 
 
(In millions)
Level 3 Instruments Only
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights
$
252

 
(36
)
(1)   

 
108

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
324

_________
(1) Included in mortgage income.

The following table presents the fair value adjustments related to non-recurring fair value measurements for the years ended December 31:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Loans held for sale
$
(13
)
 
$
(22
)
Foreclosed property and other real estate
(15
)
 
(31
)
Equity investments without a readily determinable fair value
8

 


156





The following tables present detailed information regarding material assets and liabilities measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) as of December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 . The tables include the valuation techniques and the significant unobservable inputs utilized. The range of each significant unobservable input as well as the weighted-average within the range utilized at December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 are included. Following the tables are descriptions of the valuation techniques and the sensitivity of the techniques to changes in the significant unobservable inputs.
 
December 31, 2018
 
Level 3
Estimated Fair Value at
December 31, 2018
 
Valuation
Technique
 
Unobservable
Input(s)
 
Quantitative Range of
Unobservable Inputs and
(Weighted-Average)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Recurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights (1)
$418
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average CPR (%)
 
4.4% - 42.6% (9.0%)
 
 
 
 
 
OAS (%)
 
5.7% - 15.0% (7.6%)
 
December 31, 2017
 
Level 3
Estimated Fair Value at
December 31, 2017
 
Valuation
Technique
 
Unobservable
Input(s)
 
Quantitative Range of
Unobservable Inputs and
(Weighted-Average)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Recurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights (1)
$336
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average CPR (%)
 
7.9% - 28.1% (9.9%)
 
 
 
 
 
OAS (%)
 
8.1% - 15.0% (8.6%)
 
December 31, 2016
 
Level 3
Estimated Fair Value at
December 31, 2016
 
Valuation
Technique
 
Unobservable
Input(s)
 
Quantitative Range of
Unobservable Inputs and
(Weighted-Average)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Recurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights (1)
$324
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average CPR (%)
 
5.7% - 24.3% (7.6%)
 
 
 
 
 
OAS (%)
 
8.2% - 13.6% (10.5%)
_________
(1) See Note 7 for additional disclosures related to assumptions used in the fair value calculation for residential mortgage servicing rights.
RECURRING FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS USING SIGNIFICANT UNOBSERVABLE INPUTS
Residential mortgage servicing rights
The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of residential MSRs are OAS and CPR. This valuation requires generating cash flow projections over multiple interest rate scenarios and discounting those cash flows at a risk adjusted rate. Additionally, the impact of prepayments and changes in the OAS are based on a variety of underlying inputs including servicing costs. Increases or decreases to the underlying cash flow inputs will have a corresponding impact on the value of the MSR asset. The net change in unrealized gains (losses) included in earnings related to MSRs held at period end are disclosed as the changes in valuation inputs or assumptions included in the MSR rollforward table in Note 7. See Note 7 for these amounts and additional disclosures related to assumptions used in the fair value calculation for MSRs.

157





FAIR VALUE OPTION
Regions has elected the fair value option for all FNMA and FHLMC eligible residential mortgage loans and certain commercial mortgage loans originated with the intent to sell. These elections allow for a more effective offset of the changes in fair values of the loans and the derivative instruments used to economically hedge them without the burden of complying with the requirements for hedge accounting. Regions has not elected the fair value option for other loans held for sale primarily because they are not economically hedged using derivative instruments. Fair values of residential mortgage loans held for sale are based on traded market prices of similar assets where available and/or discounted cash flows at market interest rates, adjusted for securitization activities that include servicing values and market conditions, and are recorded in loans held for sale in the consolidated balance sheets.
The following table summarizes the difference between the aggregate fair value and the aggregate unpaid principal balance for mortgage loans held for sale measured at fair value at December 31 :
 
2018
 
2017
 
Aggregate
Fair Value
 
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
Aggregate Fair
Value Less
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
Aggregate
Fair Value
 
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
Aggregate Fair
Value Less
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
(In millions)
Mortgage loans held for sale, at fair value
$
251

 
$
242

 
$
9

 
$
325

 
$
314

 
$
11

Interest income on mortgage loans held for sale is recognized based on contractual rates and is reflected in interest income on loans held for sale in the consolidated statements of income. The following table details net gains and losses resulting from changes in fair value of these loans, which were recorded in mortgage income in the consolidated statements of income for the years presented. These changes in fair value are mostly offset by economic hedging activities. An immaterial portion of these amounts was attributable to changes in instrument-specific credit risk.
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Net gains (losses) resulting from changes in fair value
$
(2
)
 
$
5

The carrying amounts and estimated fair values, as well as the level within the fair value hierarchy, of the Company’s financial instruments as of December 31, 2018 are as follows:
 
2018
 
Carrying
Amount
 
Estimated
Fair
Value (1)
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
(In millions)
Financial assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
3,538

 
$
3,538

 
$
3,538

 
$

 
$

Debt securities held to maturity
1,482

 
1,460

 

 
1,460

 

Debt securities available for sale
22,729

 
22,729

 
280

 
22,444

 
5

Loans held for sale
304

 
304

 

 
287

 
17

Loans (excluding leases), net of unearned income and allowance for loan losses (2)(3)
81,054

 
79,386

 

 

 
79,386

Other earning assets (4)
1,350

 
1,350

 
429

 
921

 

Derivative assets
370

 
370

 
2

 
363

 
5

Financial liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities
340

 
340

 
2

 
335

 
3

Deposits
94,491

 
94,531

 

 
94,531

 

Short-term borrowings
1,600

 
1,600

 

 
1,600

 

Long-term borrowings
12,424

 
12,610

 

 
12,408

 
202

Loan commitments and letters of credit
79

 
435

 

 

 
435


158





_________
(1)
Estimated fair values are consistent with an exit price concept. The assumptions used to estimate the fair values are intended to approximate those that a market participant would use in a hypothetical orderly transaction. In estimating fair value, the Company makes adjustments for estimated changes in interest rates, market liquidity and credit spreads in the periods they are deemed to have occurred.
(2)
The estimated fair value of portfolio loans assumes sale of the loans to a third-party financial investor. Accordingly, the value to the Company if the loans were held to maturity is not reflected in the fair value estimate. In the current whole loan market, financial investors are generally requiring a higher rate of return than the return inherent in loans if held to maturity. The fair value discount on the loan portfolio's net carrying amount at December 31, 2018 was $1.7 billion or 2.1 percent.
(3)
Excluded from this table is the capital lease carrying amount of $1.1 billion at December 31, 2018 .
(4)
Excluded from this table is the operating lease carrying amount of $369 million at December 31, 2018 .
The carrying amounts and estimated fair values, as well as the level within the fair value hierarchy, of the Company's financial instruments as of December 31, 2017 are as follows:
 
2017
 
Carrying
Amount
 
Estimated
Fair
Value (1)
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
(In millions)
Financial assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
3,981

 
$
3,981

 
$
3,981

 
$

 
$

Debt securities held to maturity
1,658

 
1,667

 

 
1,667

 

Debt securities available for sale
23,403

 
23,403

 
331

 
23,066

 
6

Loans held for sale
348

 
348

 

 
328

 
20

Loans (excluding leases), net of unearned income and allowance for loan losses (2)(3)
77,942

 
76,871

 

 

 
76,871

Other earning assets (4)
1,402

 
1,402

 
414

 
988

 

Derivative assets
394

 
394

 
2

 
387

 
5

Financial liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities
641

 
641

 
2

 
639

 

Deposits
96,889

 
96,927

 

 
96,927

 

Short-term borrowings
500

 
500

 

 
500

 

Long-term borrowings
8,132

 
8,517

 

 
7,757

 
760

Loan commitments and letters of credit
79

 
540

 

 

 
540

_________
(1)
Estimated fair values are consistent with an exit price concept. The assumptions used to estimate the fair values are intended to approximate those that a market participant would use in a hypothetical orderly transaction. In estimating fair value, the Company makes adjustments for estimated changes in interest rates, market liquidity and credit spreads in the periods they are deemed to have occurred.
(2)
The estimated fair value of portfolio loans assumes sale of the loans to a third-party financial investor. Accordingly, the value to the Company if the loans were held to maturity is not reflected in the fair value estimate. In the current whole loan market, financial investors are generally requiring a higher rate of return than the return inherent in loans if held to maturity. The fair value discount on the loan portfolio's net carrying amount at December 31, 2017 was $1.1 billion or 1.4 percent.
(3)
Excluded from this table is the capital lease carrying amount of $1.1 billion at December 31, 2017 .
(4)
Excluded from this table is the operating lease carrying amount of $489 million at December 31, 2017 .
NOTE 23. BUSINESS SEGMENT INFORMATION
Each of Regions’ reportable segments is a strategic business unit that serves specific needs of Regions’ customers based on the products and services provided. The segments are based on the manner in which management views the financial performance of the business. The Company has three reportable segments: Corporate Bank, Consumer Bank, and Wealth Management, with the remainder split between Discontinued Operations and Other.
The application and development of management reporting methodologies is a dynamic process and is subject to periodic enhancements. As these enhancements are made, financial results presented by each reportable segment may be periodically revised.
The Corporate Bank segment represents the Company’s commercial banking functions including commercial and industrial, commercial real estate and investor real estate lending. This segment also includes equipment lease financing, as well as capital markets activities, which include securities underwriting and placement, loan syndication and placement, foreign exchange, derivatives, merger and acquisition and other advisory services. Corporate Bank customers include corporate, middle market, and commercial real estate developers and investors. Corresponding deposit products related to these types of customers are also included in this segment.

159





The Consumer Bank segment represents the Company’s branch network, including consumer banking products and services related to residential first mortgages, home equity lines and loans, branch small business loans, indirect loans, consumer credit cards and other consumer loans, as well as the corresponding deposit relationships. These services are also provided through alternative channels such as the internet and telephone banking.
The Wealth Management segment offers individuals, businesses, governmental institutions and non-profit entities a wide range of solutions to help protect, grow and transfer wealth. Offerings include credit related products, trust and investment management, asset management, retirement and savings solutions and estate planning.
Discontinued operations includes all brokerage and investment activities associated with the sale of Morgan Keegan which closed on April 2, 2012, as well as the sale of Regions Insurance Group, Inc. and related affiliates, which closed on July 2, 2018. See Note 3 "Discontinued Operations" for related discussion.
Other includes the Company’s Treasury function, the securities portfolio, wholesale funding activities, interest rate risk management activities and other corporate functions that are not related to a strategic business unit. Also within Other are certain reconciling items in order to translate the segment results that are based on management accounting practices into consolidated results. Management accounting practices utilized by Regions as the basis of presentation for segment results include the following:
Net interest income and other financing income is presented based upon an FTP approach, for which market-based funding charges/credits are assigned within the segments. By allocating a cost or a credit to each product based on the FTP framework, management is able to more effectively measure the net interest margin contribution of its assets/liabilities by segment. The summation of the interest income/expense and FTP charges/credits for each segment is its designated net interest income and other financing income. The variance between the Company’s cumulative FTP charges and cumulative FTP credits is offset in Other.
Provision for loan losses is allocated to each segment based on an estimated loss methodology. The difference between the consolidated provision for loan losses and the segments’ estimated loss is reflected in Other.
Income tax expense (benefit) is calculated for the Corporate Bank, Consumer Bank and Wealth Management based on a consistent federal and state statutory rate. Discontinued Operations reflects the actual income tax expense (benefit) of its results. Any difference between the Company’s consolidated income tax expense (benefit) and the segments’ calculated amounts is reflected in Other.
Management reporting allocations of certain expenses are made in order to analyze the financial performance of the segments. These allocations consist of operational and overhead cost pools and are intended to represent the total costs to support a segment.

The following tables present financial information for each reportable segment for the year ended December 31 :
 
2018
 
Corporate Bank
 
Consumer
Bank
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
Consolidated
 
(In millions)
Net interest income and other financing income (loss)
$
1,385

 
$
2,261

 
$
194

 
$
(105
)
 
$
3,735

 
$
1

 
$
3,736

Provision (credit) for loan losses
215

 
314

 
17

 
(317
)
 
229

 

 
229

Non-interest income
546

 
1,144

 
316

 
13

 
2,019

 
349

 
2,368

Non-interest expense
915

 
2,049

 
345

 
261

 
3,570

 
79

 
3,649

Income (loss) before income taxes
801

 
1,042

 
148

 
(36
)
 
1,955

 
271

 
2,226

Income tax expense (benefit)
200

 
261

 
37

 
(111
)
 
387

 
80

 
467

Net income (loss)
$
601

 
$
781

 
$
111

 
$
75

 
$
1,568

 
$
191

 
$
1,759

Average assets
$
51,530

 
$
35,066

 
$
2,287

 
$
34,415

 
$
123,298

 
$
82

 
$
123,380


160





 
2017
 
Corporate Bank
 
Consumer
Bank
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
Consolidated
 
(In millions)
Net interest income and other financing income (loss)
$
1,422

 
$
2,141

 
$
190

 
$
(214
)
 
$
3,539

 
$
1

 
$
3,540

Provision (credit) for loan losses
258

 
297

 
20

 
(425
)
 
150

 

 
150

Non-interest income
498

 
1,118

 
302

 
44

 
1,962

 
146

 
2,108

Non-interest expense
860

 
2,051

 
333

 
247

 
3,491

 
128

 
3,619

Income (loss) before income taxes
802

 
911

 
139

 
8

 
1,860

 
19

 
1,879

Income tax expense (benefit)
305

 
346

 
56

 
(88
)
 
619

 
(3
)
 
616

Net income (loss)
$
497

 
$
565

 
$
83

 
$
96

 
$
1,241

 
$
22

 
$
1,263

Average assets
$
51,680

 
$
34,938

 
$
2,459

 
$
34,739

 
$
123,816

 
$
160

 
$
123,976

 
2016
 
Corporate Bank
 
Consumer
Bank
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
Consolidated
 
(In millions)
Net interest income and other financing income (loss)
$
1,449

 
$
2,048

 
$
174

 
$
(273
)
 
$
3,398

 
$

 
$
3,398

Provision (credit) for loan losses
286

 
290

 
22

 
(336
)
 
262

 

 
262

Non-interest income
515

 
1,126

 
279

 
91

 
2,011

 
147

 
2,158

Non-interest expense
873

 
1,962

 
317

 
331

 
3,483

 
131

 
3,614

Income (loss) before income taxes
805

 
922

 
114

 
(177
)
 
1,664

 
16

 
1,680

Income tax expense (benefit)
306

 
350

 
43

 
(189
)
 
510

 
7

 
517

Net income (loss)
$
499

 
$
572

 
$
71

 
$
12

 
$
1,154

 
$
9

 
$
1,163

Average assets
$
54,006

 
$
34,545

 
$
2,585

 
$
34,198

 
$
125,334

 
$
172

 
$
125,506

NOTE 24. COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENCIES AND GUARANTEES
COMMERCIAL COMMITMENTS
Regions issues off-balance sheet financial instruments in connection with lending activities. The credit risk associated with these instruments is essentially the same as that involved in extending loans to customers and is subject to Regions’ normal credit approval policies and procedures. Regions measures inherent risk associated with these instruments by recording a reserve for unfunded commitments based on an assessment of the likelihood that the guarantee will be funded and the creditworthiness of the customer or counterparty. Collateral is obtained based on management’s assessment of the creditworthiness of the customer.
Credit risk associated with these instruments as of December 31 is represented by the contractual amounts indicated in the following table:
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Unused commitments to extend credit
$
51,406

 
$
45,705

Standby letters of credit
1,428

 
1,348

Commercial letters of credit
44

 
76

Liabilities associated with standby letters of credit
28

 
26

Assets associated with standby letters of credit
29

 
28

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments
51

 
53


161





Unused commitments to extend credit —To accommodate the financial needs of its customers, Regions makes commitments under various terms to lend funds to consumers, businesses and other entities. These commitments include (among others) credit card and other revolving credit agreements, term loan commitments and short-term borrowing agreements. Many of these loan commitments have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of these commitments are expected to expire without being funded, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future liquidity requirements.
Standby letters of credit —Standby letters of credit are also issued to customers which, commit Regions to make payments on behalf of customers if certain specified future events occur. Regions has recourse against the customer for any amount required to be paid to a third party under a standby letter of credit. Historically, a large percentage of standby letters of credit expire without being funded. The contractual amount of standby letters of credit represents the maximum potential amount of future payments Regions could be required to make and represents Regions’ maximum credit risk.
Commercial letters of credit —Commercial letters of credit are issued to facilitate foreign or domestic trade transactions for customers. As a general rule, drafts will be drawn when the goods underlying the transaction are in transit.
LEASE COMMITMENTS
Regions and its subsidiaries lease land, premises and equipment under cancelable and non-cancelable leases, some of which contain renewal options under various terms. The leased properties are used primarily for banking purposes. Total rental expense on operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 was $166 million , $162 million and $167 million , respectively.
The approximate future minimum rental commitments as of December 31, 2018 , for all non-cancelable leases with initial or remaining terms of one year or more are shown in the following table. Included in these amounts are all renewal options reasonably assured of being exercised.
 
Premises
 
Equipment
 
Total
 
(In millions)
2019
$
103

 
$
22

 
$
125

2020
95

 
21

 
116

2021
82

 
7

 
89

2022
70

 

 
70

2023
62

 

 
62

Thereafter
251

 

 
251

 
$
663

 
$
50

 
$
713

LEGAL CONTINGENCIES
Regions and its subsidiaries are subject to loss contingencies related to litigation, claims, investigations and legal and administrative cases and proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. Regions evaluates these contingencies based on information currently available, including advice of counsel. Regions establishes accruals for those matters when a loss contingency is considered probable and the related amount is reasonably estimable. Any accruals are periodically reviewed and may be adjusted as circumstances change. Some of Regions' exposure with respect to loss contingencies may be offset by applicable insurance coverage. In determining the amounts of any accruals or estimates of possible loss contingencies however, Regions does not take into account the availability of insurance coverage. To the extent that Regions has an insurance recovery, the proceeds are recorded in the period the recovery is received.
In addition, Regions has agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all legal matters resulting from pre-closing activities in conjunction with the sale of Morgan Keegan and recorded an indemnification obligation at fair value in the second quarter of 2012.
When it is practicable, Regions estimates possible loss contingencies, whether or not there is an accrued probable loss. When Regions is able to estimate such possible losses, and when it is reasonably possible Regions could incur losses in excess of amounts accrued, Regions discloses the aggregate estimation of such possible losses. Regions currently estimates that it is reasonably possible that it may experience losses in excess of what Regions has accrued in an aggregate amount of up to approximately $20 million as of December 31, 2018, with it also being reasonably possible that Regions could incur no losses in excess of amounts accrued. However, as available information changes, the matters for which Regions is able to estimate, as well as the estimates themselves will be adjusted accordingly. The reasonably possible estimate includes legal contingencies that are subject to the indemnification agreement with Raymond James.
Assessments of litigation and claims exposure are difficult because they involve inherently unpredictable factors including, but not limited to, the following: whether the proceeding is in the early stages; whether damages are unspecified, unsupported, or uncertain; whether there is a potential for punitive or other pecuniary damages; whether the matter involves legal uncertainties, including novel issues of law; whether the matter involves multiple parties and/or jurisdictions; whether discovery has begun or

162





is not complete; whether meaningful settlement discussions have commenced; and whether the lawsuit involves class allegations. Assessments of class action litigation, which is generally more complex than other types of litigation, are particularly difficult, especially in the early stages of the proceeding when it is not known whether a class will be certified or how a potential class, if certified, will be defined. As a result, Regions may be unable to estimate reasonably possible losses with respect to some of the matters disclosed below, and the aggregated estimated amount discussed above may not include an estimate for every matter disclosed below.
Regions is involved in formal and informal information-gathering requests, investigations, reviews, examinations and proceedings by various governmental regulatory agencies, law enforcement authorities and self-regulatory bodies regarding Regions’ business, Regions' business practices and policies, and the conduct of persons with whom Regions does business. Additional inquiries will arise from time to time. In connection with those inquiries, Regions receives document requests, subpoenas and other requests for information. The inquiries, including the one described below, could develop into administrative, civil or criminal proceedings or enforcement actions that could result in consequences that have a material effect on Regions' consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows as a whole. Such consequences could include adverse judgments, findings, settlements, penalties, fines, orders, injunctions, restitution, or alterations in our business practices, and could result in additional expenses and collateral costs, including reputational damage.    
Regions is cooperating with an investigation by the United States Attorney’s Office for the Eastern District of New York pertaining to Regions' banking relationship with a former customer and accounts maintained by related entities and individuals affiliated with the customer who may be involved in criminal activity, as well as related aspects of Regions' Anti-Money Laundering and Bank Secrecy Act compliance program.
While the final outcome of litigation and claims exposures or of any inquiries is inherently unpredictable, management is currently of the opinion that the outcome of pending and threatened litigation and inquiries will not have a material effect on Regions’ business, consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows as a whole. However, in the event of unexpected future developments, it is reasonably possible that an adverse outcome in any of the matters discussed above could be material to Regions’ business, consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows for any particular reporting period of occurrence.
GUARANTEES
INDEMNIFICATION OBLIGATION
As discussed in Note 2, on April 2, 2012 (“Closing Date”), Regions closed the sale of Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James. In connection with the sale, Regions agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all legal matters related to pre-closing activities, including matters filed subsequent to the Closing Date that relate to actions that occurred prior to closing. Losses under the indemnification include legal and other expenses, such as costs for judgments, settlements and awards associated with the defense and resolution of the indemnified matters. The maximum potential amount of future payments that Regions could be required to make under the indemnification is indeterminable due to the indefinite term of some of the obligations. As of December 31, 2018 , the carrying value and fair value of the indemnification obligation were immaterial.
FANNIE MAE DUS LOSS SHARE GUARANTEE
Regions is a DUS lender. The DUS program provides liquidity to the multi-family housing market. Regions services loans sold to Fannie Mae and is required to provide a loss share guarantee equal to one-third of the principal balance for the majority of its DUS servicing portfolio. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company's DUS servicing portfolio totaled approximately $3.6 billion and $2.9 billion , respectively. Regions' maximum quantifiable contingent liability related to its loss share guarantee was approximately $1.2 billion and $923 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.The Company would be liable for this amount only if all of the loans it services for Fannie Mae, for which the Company retains some risk of loss, were to default and all of the collateral underlying these loans was determined to be without value at the time of settlement. Therefore, the maximum quantifiable contingent liability is not representative of the actual loss the Company would be expected to incur. The estimated fair value of the associated loss share guarantee recorded as a liability on the Company's consolidated balance sheets was approximately $4 million at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. Refer to Note 1 for additional information.
VISA INDEMNIFICATION
As a member of the Visa USA network, Regions, along with other members, indemnified Visa USA against litigation. On October 3, 2007, Visa USA was restructured and acquired several Visa affiliates. In conjunction with this restructuring, Regions' indemnification of Visa USA was modified to cover specific litigation (“covered litigation”).
A portion of Visa's proceeds from its IPO was put into escrow to fund the covered litigation. To the extent that the amount available under the escrow arrangement, or subsequent fundings of the escrow account resulting from reductions in the class B share conversion ratio, is insufficient to fully resolve the covered litigation, Visa will enforce the indemnification obligations of Visa USA's members for any excess amount. At this time, Regions has concluded that it is not probable that covered litigation exposure will exceed the class B share value.

163





NOTE 25. REVENUE RECOGNITION
The Company records revenue when control of the promised products or services is transferred to the customer, in an amount that reflects the consideration Regions expects to be entitled to receive in exchange for those products or services. Refer to Note 1 for descriptions of the accounting and reporting policies related to revenue recognition.
The following tables present total non-interest income disaggregated by major product category for each reportable segment for the period indicated.
 
Year Ended December 31, 2018
 
Corporate Bank
 
Consumer
Bank
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other Segment Revenue
 
Other (1)
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
(In millions)
Service charges on deposit accounts
$
145

 
$
554

 
$
3

 
$

 
$
8

 
$
710

 
$

Card and ATM fees
52

 
404

 
1

 
(1
)
 
(18
)
 
438

 

Investment management and trust fee income

 

 
235

 

 

 
235

 

Capital markets income
76

 

 

 

 
126

 
202

 

Mortgage income

 

 

 

 
137

 
137

 

Investment services fee income

 

 
71

 

 

 
71

 

Commercial credit fee income

 

 

 

 
71

 
71

 

Bank-owned life insurance

 

 

 

 
65

 
65

 

Securities gains, net

 

 

 

 
1

 
1

 
(1
)
Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - defined benefit

 

 

 

 
(6
)
 
(6
)
 

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - other

 

 

 

 
(5
)
 
(5
)
 

Insurance commissions and fees

 

 
1

 
3

 

 
4

 
69

Gain on sale of business (1)

 

 

 

 

 

 
281

Other miscellaneous income
13

 
42

 
3

 
(1
)
 
39

 
96

 

 
$
286

 
$
1,000

 
$
314

 
$
1

 
$
418

 
$
2,019

 
$
349

 
Year Ended December 31, 2017 (2)
 
Corporate Bank
 
Consumer
Bank
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other Segment Revenue
 
Other (1)
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
(In millions)
Service charges on deposit accounts
$
140

 
$
530

 
$
3

 
$
1

 
$
9

 
$
683

 
$

Card and ATM fees
47

 
382

 

 
1

 
(13
)
 
417

 

Investment management and trust fee income

 

 
230

 

 

 
230

 

Capital markets income
48

 

 

 

 
113

 
161

 

Mortgage income

 

 

 

 
149

 
149

 

Investment services fee income

 

 
60

 

 

 
60

 

Commercial credit fee income

 

 

 

 
71

 
71

 

Bank-owned life insurance

 

 

 

 
81

 
81

 

Securities gains, net

 

 

 

 
19

 
19

 
3

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - defined benefit

 

 

 

 

 

 

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - other

 

 

 

 
16

 
16

 

Insurance commissions and fees

 

 
1

 
4

 

 
5

 
140

Other miscellaneous income
13

 
45

 
4

 

 
8

 
70

 
3

 
$
248

 
$
957

 
$
298

 
$
6

 
$
453

 
$
1,962

 
$
146


164





 
Year Ended December 31, 2016 (2)
 
Corporate Bank
 
Consumer
Bank
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other Segment Revenue
 
Other (1)
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
(In millions)
Service charges on deposit accounts
$
137

 
$
516

 
$
3

 
$
(1
)
 
$
9

 
$
664

 
$

Card and ATM fees
43

 
363

 

 
1

 
(5
)
 
402

 

Investment management and trust fee income

 

 
213

 

 

 
213

 

Capital markets income
66

 

 

 

 
86

 
152

 

Mortgage income

 

 

 

 
173

 
173

 

Investment services fee income

 

 
58

 

 

 
58

 

Commercial credit fee income

 

 

 

 
73

 
73

 

Bank-owned life insurance

 

 

 

 
95

 
95

 

Insurance proceeds

 

 

 
50

 

 
50

 

Securities gains, net

 

 

 

 
6

 
6

 

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - defined benefit

 

 

 

 

 

 

Market value adjustments on employee benefit assets - other

 

 

 

 
3

 
3

 

Insurance commissions and fees

 

 
1

 
6

 

 
7

 
142

Other miscellaneous income
6

 
44

 
3

 
12

 
50

 
115

 
5

 
$
252

 
$
923

 
$
278

 
$
68

 
$
490

 
$
2,011

 
$
147

_________
(1)
This revenue is not impacted by the new accounting guidance and continues to be recognized when earned in accordance with the Company's existing revenue recognition policy.
(2)
The amounts included for 2017 and 2016 have not been adjusted under the modified retrospective method.
Regions elected the practical expedient related to contract costs and will continue to expense sales commissions and any related contract costs when incurred because the amortization period would have been one year or less.
Regions also elected the practical expedient related to remaining performance obligations and therefore did not disclose the value of unsatisfied performance obligations for 1) contracts with an original expected length of one year or less and 2) contracts for which revenue is recognized at the amount to which Regions has the right to invoice for services performed.

165





NOTE 26. PARENT COMPANY ONLY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Presented below are condensed financial statements of Regions Financial Corporation:
 Balance Sheets
 
December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
(In millions)
Assets
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits in other banks
$
1,863

 
$
1,693

Loans to subsidiaries
20

 
20

Debt securities available for sale
20

 
18

Premises and equipment, net
44

 
46

Investments in subsidiaries:
 
 
 
Banks
15,953

 
16,548

Non-banks
172

 
446

 
16,125

 
16,994

Other assets
332

 
303

Total assets
$
18,404

 
$
19,074

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
 
Long-term borrowings
$
3,102

 
$
2,702

Other liabilities
212

 
180

Total liabilities
3,314

 
2,882

Stockholders’ equity:
 
 
 
Preferred stock
820

 
820

Common stock
11

 
12

Additional paid-in capital
13,766

 
15,858

Retained earnings
2,828

 
1,628

Treasury stock, at cost
(1,371
)
 
(1,377
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net
(964
)
 
(749
)
Total stockholders’ equity
15,090

 
16,192

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
18,404

 
$
19,074









 








166





Statements of Income
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Income:
 
 
 
 
 
Dividends received from subsidiaries
$
2,190

 
$
1,300

 
$
1,190

Interest from subsidiaries
3

 
7

 
7

Other
7

 
2

 
4

 
2,200

 
1,309

 
1,201

Expenses:
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and employee benefits
52

 
65

 
56

Interest
123

 
81

 
73

Furniture and equipment expense
4

 
4

 
3

Other
76

 
69

 
91

 
255

 
219

 
223

Income before income taxes and equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
1,945

 
1,090

 
978

Income tax benefit
(64
)
 
(65
)
 
(66
)
Income from continuing operations
2,009

 
1,155

 
1,044

Discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes
271

 
8

 
8

Income tax expense
80

 
2

 
3

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
191

 
6

 
5

Income before equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries and preferred dividends
2,200

 
1,161

 
1,049

Equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries:
 
 
 
 
 
Banks
(454
)
 
74

 
102

Non-banks
13

 
28

 
12

 
(441
)
 
102

 
114

Net income
1,759

 
1,263

 
1,163

Preferred stock dividends
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
Net income available to common shareholders
$
1,695

 
$
1,199

 
$
1,099


167






Statements of Cash Flows
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
(In millions)
Operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
1,759

 
$
1,263

 
$
1,163

Adjustments to reconcile net cash from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
441

 
(102
)
 
(114
)
Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
3

 
2

 
2

Loss on sale of assets

 
1

 

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
14

(Gain) on sale of business
(281
)
 

 

Net change in operating assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
Other assets
(35
)
 
(19
)
 
33

Other liabilities
(8
)
 
2

 
(38
)
Other
31

 
41

 
68

Net cash from operating activities
1,910

 
1,188

 
1,128

Investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
(Investment in) / repayment of investment in subsidiaries
146

 
142

 
(60
)
Principal advances on loans to subsidiaries

 

 
(10
)
Proceeds from sales and maturities of debt securities available for sale
8

 
9

 
8

Purchases of debt securities available for sale
(10
)
 
(6
)
 
(8
)
Net (purchases of) / proceeds from sales of assets

 
6

 
(1
)
Proceeds from disposition of business, net of cash transferred
357

 

 

Other, net

 
2

 

Net cash from investing activities
501

 
153

 
(71
)
Financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in short-term borrowings
(101
)
 

 

Proceeds from long-term borrowings
500

 
999

 
1,107

Payments on long-term borrowings

 

 
(658
)
Cash dividends on common stock
(452
)
 
(346
)
 
(317
)
Cash dividends on preferred stock
(64
)
 
(64
)
 
(64
)
Repurchase of common stock
(2,122
)
 
(1,275
)
 
(839
)
Other
(2
)
 
(5
)
 
(2
)
Net cash from financing activities
(2,241
)
 
(691
)
 
(773
)
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
170

 
650

 
284

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
1,693

 
1,043

 
759

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$
1,863

 
$
1,693

 
$
1,043



168





Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
Not Applicable.
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
Based on an evaluation, as of the end of the period covered by this Form 10-K, under the supervision and with the participation of Regions’ management, including its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer have concluded that Regions’ disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) are effective. During the fourth fiscal quarter of the year ended December 31, 2018 , there have been no changes in Regions’ internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, Regions’ control over financial reporting.
The Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and the attestation report of registered public accounting firm on registrant's internal control over financial reporting are included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.  
Item 9B. Other Information
Not applicable.  




169

Table of Contents




PART III
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Information about the Directors and Director nominees of Regions included in Regions’ Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on April 24, 2019 (the “Proxy Statement”) under the captions “PROPOSAL 1—ELECTION OF DIRECTORS—Who are this year's nominees?,” “—What criteria were considered by the NCG Committee in selecting the nominees?,” and “—What skills and characteristics are currently represented on the Board?” and the information incorporated by reference pursuant to Item 13. below are incorporated herein by reference. Information regarding Regions’ executive officers is included below.
Information regarding Regions’ Audit Committee included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Audit Committee” is incorporated herein by reference.
Information regarding timeliness of filings under Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “OWNERSHIP OF REGIONS COMMON STOCK—Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” is incorporated herein by reference.
Information regarding Regions’ Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “CORPORATE PURPOSE, CULTURE, AND ESG—Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers” is incorporated herein by reference.
Information included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Family Relationships” is incorporated herein by reference.
Executive officers of the registrant as of December 31, 2018 , are as follows:
Executive Officer
 
Age
 
Position and
Offices Held with
Registrant and Subsidiaries
 
Executive
Officer
Since
O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr.  
 
61
 
Executive Chairman and Director of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously served as Chairman, President, and Chief Executive Officer.
 
1993
John M. Turner, Jr.
 
57
 
President and Chief Executive Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously served as Senior Executive Vice President; Head of Corporate Banking Group and as South Region President of Regions Bank. Prior to joining Regions, served as President of Whitney National Bank and Whitney Holding Corporation.
 
2011
David J. Turner, Jr.
 
55
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of registrant and Regions Bank.
 
2010
John B. Owen
 
57
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously Head of Regional Banking Group; Head of the Business Groups.
 
2009
Fournier J. “Boots” Gale, III
 
74
 
Senior Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously a founding partner of Maynard Cooper & Gale, P.C. in Birmingham, Alabama.
 
2011
C. Matthew Lusco
 
61
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Risk Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously managing partner of KPMG LLP’s offices in Birmingham, Alabama and Memphis, Tennessee.
 
2011
Kate R. Danella
 
39
 
Executive Vice President and Head of Strategic Planning and Corporate Development of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously served as Head of Private Wealth Management and as Wealth Strategy and Effectiveness Executive of Regions Bank. Prior to joining Regions, served as Vice President of Capital Group Companies.
 
2018

170

Table of Contents




C. Keith Herron
 
54
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Corporate Responsibility and Community Engagement of registrant and Regions Bank. Director of Regions Foundation. Previously served as Regional President, South Region of Regions Bank and as Head of Strategic Planning and Execution of registrant and Regions Bank.
 
2010
David R. Keenan
 
51
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer of registrant and Regions Bank.
 
2010
Scott M. Peters
 
57
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Consumer Banking Group of registrant and Regions Bank. Director of Regions Investment Services, Inc. Previously Consumer Services Group Head.
 
2010
William D. Ritter
 
48
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Wealth Management of registrant and Regions Bank.
 
2010
Ronald G. Smith
 
58
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Corporate Banking Group of registrant and Regions Bank. Director of Regions Equipment Finance Corporation and Regions Foundation of Tennessee. Manager of RFC Financial Services Holding LLC. Previously Regional President, Mid-America Region of Regions Bank.
 
2010

On December 31, 2018, at 11:59p.m., O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr. retired as Executive Chairman of the Company and from the Company’s Board.


171

Table of Contents




Item 11. Executive Compensation
All information presented under the captions “COMPENSATION DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS,” “COMPENSATION OF EXECUTIVE OFFICERS,” “COMPENSATION AND HUMAN RESOURCES COMMITTEE REPORT,” “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation” and “—Relationship of Compensation Policies and Practices to Risk Management,” and “PROPOSAL 1—ELECTION OF DIRECTORS—How are Directors compensated?” of the Proxy Statement are incorporated herein by reference. 
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
All information presented under the caption “OWNERSHIP OF REGIONS COMMON STOCK” of the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.
Equity Compensation Plan Information
The following table gives information about the common stock that may be issued upon the exercise of options, warrants and rights under all of Regions’ existing equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2018 .  
Plan Category
Number of Securities
to be Issued Upon
Exercise of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights (a)
 
Weighted Average
Exercise Price of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
Number of Securities
Remaining Available Under  Equity
Compensation Plans
(Excluding Securities
in First Column)
 
Equity Compensation Plans Approved by Stockholders
1,724,723

  
$
6.86

42,561,810

(b) 
Equity Compensation Plans Not Approved by Stockholders

 
$


  
Total
1,724,723

  
$
6.86

42,561,810

  
 
(a)
Does not include outstanding restricted stock units of 11,445,943.
(b)
Consists of shares available for future issuance under the Regions Financial Corporation 2015 Long Term Incentive Plan. In 2015, all prior long-term incentive plans were closed to new grants.
Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence     
All information presented under the captions “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Transactions with Directors,” “—Other Business Relationships and Transactions,” “—Policies Relating to Transactions with Related Persons” and “—Director Independence” of the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services
All information presented under the caption “ PROPOSAL 2 - RATIFICATION OF APPOINTMENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM” of the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.

172

Table of Contents




PART IV
Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
(a) 1. Consolidated Financial Statements.  The following reports of independent registered public accounting firm and consolidated financial statements of Regions and its subsidiaries are included in Item 8. of this Form 10-K:
Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm;
Consolidated Balance Sheets—December 31, 2018 and 2017;
Consolidated Statements of Income—Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016;
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income—Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016;
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity—Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016; and
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows—Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
2. Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules.   The following consolidated financial statement schedules are included in Item 8. of this Form 10-K:
None. The Schedules to consolidated financial statements are not required under the related instructions or are inapplicable.
(b) Exhibits.   The exhibits indicated below are either included or incorporated by reference as indicated.
SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
3.1
 
 
3.2
 
 
3.3
 
 
3.4
 
 
4.1
Instruments defining the rights of security holders, including indentures. The registrant hereby agrees to furnish to the Commission upon request copies of instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of the registrant and its consolidated subsidiaries; no issuance of debt exceeds 10 percent of the assets of the registrant and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis.
 
 
4.2
 
 
4.3
 
 
4.4
 
 
4.5

173

Table of Contents




SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
4.6
 
 
4.7
 
 
10.1*
 
 
10.2*
 
 
10.3*
 
 
10.4*
 
 
10.5*
 
 
10.6*
 
 
10.7*
 
 
10.8*
 
 
10.9*
 
 
10.10*
 
 
10.11*
 
 
10.12*
 
 

174

Table of Contents




SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
10.13*
 
 
10.14*
 
 
10.15*
 
 
10.16*
 
 
10.17*
 
 
10.18*
 
 
10.19*
 
 
10.20*
 
 
10.21*
 
 
10.22*
 
 
10.23*
 
 
10.24*
 
 
10.25*
 
 
10.26*
 
 

175

Table of Contents




SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
10.27*
 
 
10.28*
 
 
10.29*
 
 
10.30*
 
 
10.31*
 
 
10.32*
 
 
10.33*
 
 
10.34*
 
 
10.35*
 
 
10.36*
 
 
10.37*
 
 
10.38*
 
 
10.39*
 
 
10.40*
 
 

176

Table of Contents




SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
10.41*
 
 
10.42*
 
 
10.43*
 
 
10.44*
 
 
10.45*
 
 
10.46*
 
 
10.47*
 
 
10.48*
 
 
10.49*
 
 
10.50*
 
 
10.51*
 
 
10.52*
 
 
10.53*
 
 
10.54*
 
 

177

Table of Contents




SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
10.55*
 
 
10.56*
 
 
10.57*
 
 
10.58*
 
 
10.59*
 
 
10.60
 
 
21
 
 
23
 
 
24
 
 
31.1
 
 
31.2
 
 
32
 
 
101
Interactive Data File
 
 
______  
* Compensatory plan or agreement.
Copies of exhibits not included herein may be obtained free of charge, electronically through Regions’ website at www.regions.com or through the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov or upon request to:
Investor Relations
Regions Financial Corporation
1900 Fifth Avenue North
Birmingham, Alabama 35203
(205) 264-7040


178

Table of Contents




Item 16. Form 10-K Summary
Not applicable.

179

Table of Contents




SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
 
 
 
DATE:
February 22, 2019
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/ S /    J OHN  M. T URNER , J R .
 
 
 
John M. Turner, Jr.
President and Chief Executive Officer
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated
Signature
 
Title
Date
 
 
 
 
/ S /    J OHN  M. T URNER , J R .
 
President and Chief Executive Officer, and Director (principal executive officer)
February 22, 2019
John M. Turner, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/ S /    D AVID  J. T URNER , J R .        
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (principal financial officer)
February 22, 2019
David J. Turner, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/ S /    H ARDIE  B. K IMBROUGH , J R .        
 
Executive Vice President and Controller (principal accounting officer)
February 22, 2019
Hardie B. Kimbrough, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Carolyn H. Byrd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Don DeFosset
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Samuel A. Di Piazza, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Eric C. Fast
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Zhanna Golodryga
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
John D. Johns
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Ruth Ann Marshall
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

180

Table of Contents




Signature
 
Title
Date
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Susan W. Matlock
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
John E. Maupin, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Charles D. McCrary
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
James T. Prokopanko
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Lee J. Styslinger III
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
José S. Suquet
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 22, 2019
Timothy Vines
 
 
 
 
* Fournier J. Gale, III, by signing his name hereto, does sign this document on behalf of each of the persons indicated above pursuant to powers of attorney executed by such persons and filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
 
 
 
By:
/ S /    F OURNIER  J. G ALE , III        
 
Fournier J. Gale, III
 
Attorney in Fact


 


181
EXHIBIT 10.26




REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
DIRECTORS’ DEFERRED RESTRICTED STOCK UNIT PLAN

ARTICLE 1
PURPOSE

1.1.      PURPOSE . The purpose of the Regions Financial Corporation Directors’ Deferred Restricted Stock Unit Plan is to provide individuals who are not employees of Regions Financial Corporation or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates the opportunity to defer receipt of Common Stock payable upon the vesting and settlement of Restricted Stock Units granted under an Equity Compensation Plan.

1.2.      ELIGIBILITY . Non-Employee Directors of the Company are eligible to participate in the Plan.

ARTICLE 2
DEFINITIONS

2.1.      DEFINITIONS . Unless the context clearly indicates otherwise, the following terms shall have the following meanings:

(a)      “Award Agreement” means a written or electronic agreement, contract or other instrument or document between the Company and a Non-Employee Director setting forth the terms and conditions of an award of Restricted Stock Units granted under an Equity Compensation Plan.

(b)      “Board” means the Board of Directors of the Company and/or the Board of Directors of Regions Bank.

(c)      “Change in Control” has the same meaning as “change in control” in the Equity Compensation Plan.

(d)      “Committee” means the Compensation and Human Resources Committee of the Board.

(e)      “Common Stock” means the common stock, par value $0.01 per share, of the Company.

(f)      “Company” means Regions Financial Corporation, a Delaware corporation.

(g)      “Deferral Account” means a separate bookkeeping account with respect to each Non-Employee Director for the purpose of accounting for deferred Restricted Stock Units and Dividend Equivalents in accordance with the provisions of the Plan.

(h)      “Dividend Equivalents” means the amount of cash dividends and value of other distributions declared and paid (as determined by the Committee in its sole discretion) with respect to the Common Stock that would have been payable to a Non-Employee Director had he or she been the owner, on the record dates for the payment of such dividends and distributions, of the number of shares of Common Stock equal to the number of Restricted Stock Units in the Non-Employee Director’s Deferral Account on such record dates.

(i)      “Election Form” means a form approved by the Committee pursuant to which a Non-Employee Director may elect to defer settlement of Restricted Stock Units, as provided in Section 5.2 hereof.

(j)      “Equity Compensation Plan” means the Regions Financial Corporation 2015 Long Term Incentive Plan, as the same may be amended, and any subsequent equity compensation plan approved by the stockholders of the Company and designated by the Committee as an Equity Compensation Plan for purposes of the Plan. Capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined shall have the meanings given to such terms in the Equity Compensation Plan.

(k)      “Non-Employee Director” means a director of the Company and/or Regions Bank who is not an



EXHIBIT 10.26


employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates.

(l)      “Plan” means this Regions Financial Corporation Directors’ Deferred Restricted Stock Unit Plan, as amended from time to time.

(m)      “Restricted Stock Units” means the right, granted under an Equity Compensation Plan, to receive shares of Common Stock on a designated future date, either on or after the date such rights vest and become non-forfeitable, as provided in Article 5 of the Plan. Each Restricted Stock Unit represents the right to receive one share of Common Stock in the future.

ARTICLE 3
ADMINISTRATION

3.1.      ADMINISTRATION . The Plan shall be administered by the Committee. Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Committee shall be authorized to interpret the Plan, to establish, amend and rescind any rules and regulations relating to the Plan, and to make all other determinations necessary or advisable for the administration of the Plan. The Committee’s interpretation of the Plan, and all actions taken and determinations made by the Committee pursuant to the powers vested in it hereunder, shall be conclusive and binding upon all parties concerned, including the Company, its stockholders and participants. The Committee may appoint a plan administrator to carry out the ministerial functions of the Plan, but the plan administrator shall have no other authority or powers of the Committee.

3.2.      RELIANCE . In administering the Plan, the Committee may rely upon any information furnished by the Company, its public accountants and other experts. No individual shall have personal liability by reason of anything done or omitted to be done by the Company or the Committee in connection with the Plan. This limitation of liability shall not be exclusive of any other limitation of liability or rights to indemnification which any such person may be entitled under the Company’s certificate of incorporation, bylaws or otherwise.

ARTICLE 4
SHARES

4.1.      SOURCE OF SHARES . The Restricted Stock Units and shares of Common Stock that may be issued upon settlement of Restricted Stock Units shall be issued under the Equity Incentive Plan, subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Equity Incentive Plan. In the event of any actual or alleged conflict between the provisions of the Equity Incentive Plan and the provisions of the Plan, the provisions of the Equity Incentive Plan shall be controlling and determinative. The Plan does not constitute a separate source of shares for equity awards described herein.

ARTICLE 5
DEFERRAL OF RESTRICTED STOCK UNITS

5.1.      GRANT OF RESTRICTED STOCK UNITS . In accordance with the Company’s compensation program for Non-Employee Directors, each Non-Employee Director may be awarded a grant of Restricted Stock Units with a specified grant date value under an Equity Compensation Plan. Such Restricted Stock Units shall be converted to shares of Common Stock on the vesting date set forth in the applicable Award Agreement (the “Vesting Date”) in accordance with the Equity Compensation Plan, unless an election to defer settlement of the Restricted Stock Units is made pursuant to Section 5.2.
    
5.2.      ELECTION TO DEFER SETTLEMENT AND CONVERSION OF RESTRICTED STOCK UNITS .
    
(a)      Timing and Manner of Deferral Election . A Non-Employee Director may defer the settlement of Restricted Stock Units into shares of Common Stock from the Vesting Date to a later date (and thereby defer the taxable event), by making an election pursuant to this Section 5.2. A Non-Employee Director who wishes to defer his or her Restricted Stock Units must irrevocably elect to do so by delivering a valid Election Form to the Committee or the plan administrator prior to December 31 of the calendar year preceding the calendar year in which Restricted Stock Units are to be granted, or in the case of a new Non-Employee Director, before or within thirty days following the date



EXHIBIT 10.26


the Non-Employee Director is first appointed or elected to serve on the Board, provided that the election to defer may only apply to Restricted Stock Units earned following the date of the appointment or election. A Non-Employee Director’s election to defer Restricted Stock Units shall be effective as of the first day of the calendar year beginning after the Committee or the plan administrator receives the Non-Employee Director’s Election Form. For example, in order to defer the settlement of Restricted Stock Units granted in April 2020, the Election Form must be received on or before December 31, 2019. The Election Form delivered by the Non-Employee Director shall become irrevocable as of December 31 with respect to the immediately following calendar year. However, prior to the next December 31, a Non-Employee Director may change his or her election for future calendar years by executing and delivering a new Election Form indicating a different election.
    
(b)      Deferral Account. The Committee shall maintain a Deferral Account for each Non-Employee Director for the purpose of accounting for the Non-Employee Director’s deferred Restricted Stock Units.

(c)      Dividend Equivalents. Any Dividend Equivalents shall be credited to the Non-Employee Director’s Deferral Account as of the record date of the cash dividend or other distribution declared and made with respect to the Common Stock and shall be converted into additional Restricted Stock Units based on the fair market value of the Common Stock on such record date.

(d)      Conversion to Common Stock . Restricted Stock Units that have been deferred pursuant to this Section 5.2 shall be converted to shares of Common Stock on the date designated by the Non-Employee Director in his or her Election Form, which may be either:

(i)      the date of the Non-Employee Director’s termination of service as a director of the Company for any reason after the Vesting Date, or

(ii)      an anniversary of the grant date of the Restricted Stock Units, but no earlier than the first anniversary of the Vesting Date and no later than the tenth anniversary of the grant date.

The Non-Employee Director will be taxed on the fair market value of such shares of Common Stock as of the conversion date. Such shares of Common Stock shall be registered on the books of the Company in the name of the Non-Employee Director (or in street name to the Non-Employee Director’s brokerage account) as of the conversion date and shall be delivered to the Non-Employee Director in certificated or uncertificated (book-entry) form.

(e)      Change in Control . Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, upon a Change in Control, the Restricted Stock Units credited to a Non-Employee Director’s Deferral Account shall be distributed to the Non-Employee Director within thirty days following the Change in Control.

(f)      Death . Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in the event of the death of a Non-Employee Director, any Restricted Stock Units credited to the Non-Employee Director’s Deferral Account shall be distributed to the Non-Employee Director’s beneficiary within sixty days following the Non-Employee Director’s death.

5.3.      RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER . Restricted Stock Units may not be sold, transferred, exchanged, assigned, pledged, hypothecated or otherwise encumbered to or in favor of any party other than the Company, or be subjected to any lien, obligation, or liability of a Non-Employee Director to any other party other than the Company or an affiliate of the Company.

5.4.      RIGHTS AS STOCKHOLDER . A Non-Employee Director shall not have voting or any other rights as a stockholder of the Company with respect to Restricted Stock Units. Upon settlement of Restricted Stock Units into shares of Common Stock, the Non-Employee Director shall obtain full voting and other rights as a stockholder of the Company.

5.5.      AWARD CERTIFICATES . All awards of Restricted Stock Units shall be evidenced by the written Award Agreement between the Company and the Non-Employee Director, including without limitation the provisions



EXHIBIT 10.26


relating to the Non-Employee Director’s right to receive Dividend Equivalents with respect to such Restricted Stock Units, if applicable, in accordance with the terms of the Equity Compensation Plan.

ARTICLE 6
AMENDMENT, MODIFICATION AND TERMINATION

6.1.      AMENDMENT, MODIFICATION AND TERMINATION . The Board or the Committee may, at any time and from time to time, amend, modify or terminate the Plan.

ARTICLE 7
CODE SECTION 409A

7.1      GENERAL . The Plan shall be interpreted and administered in a manner so that any amount or benefit payable hereunder shall be paid or provided in a manner that is either exempt from or compliant with the requirements of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (the “Code”) and applicable Internal Revenue Service guidance and Treasury Regulations issued thereunder (and any applicable transition relief under Section 409A of the Code).

7.2      DEFINITIONAL RESTRICTIONS . Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, to the extent that any amount or benefit that would constitute non-exempt “deferred compensation” for purposes of Section 409A of the Code (“Non-Exempt Deferred Compensation”) would otherwise be payable or distributable hereunder by reason of a Change in Control or a Non-Employee Director’s termination of service termination of service as a director of the Company, such Non-Exempt Deferred Compensation shall not be payable or distributable to the Non-Employee Director by reason of such circumstance unless the circumstances giving rise to such Change in Control or termination of service, as the case may be, meet any description or definition of “change in control event” or “separation from service,” as the case may be, in Section 409A of the Code and applicable regulations (without giving effect to any elective provisions that may be available under such definition). This provision does not affect the dollar amount or prohibit the vesting of any Non-Exempt Deferred Compensation upon a Change in Control or termination of service, however defined. If this provision prevents the payment or distribution of any Non-Exempt Deferred Compensation, such payment or distribution shall be made at the time and in the form that would have applied absent the non-409A-conforming event.


* * * * *



EXHIBIT 10.37




[Regions logo]

[Date]

[Name and Address]

Re:     Change in Control Agreement

Dear _________________:
This is your Change in Control Agreement (the “ Agreement ”) with Regions Financial Corporation (the “ Company ”).
1. Purpose, Effectiveness and Interpretation.
(a) Purpose. The purpose of this Agreement is to provide you with protection upon termination of your employment if there is a future Change in Control of the Company. You should review this Agreement carefully for the terms and conditions that will apply.
(b) Interpretation. Some of terms used in this Agreement are defined in the attached Annex, which also includes some of the general provisions that govern this Agreement. The Annex is a part of this Agreement, and you should refer to the Annex as you review the rest of this Agreement.
(c) Effectiveness. If you agree to the terms and conditions of this Agreement in consideration for future employment with the Company, please execute and return a copy of this Agreement to the Executive Compensation Department of Regions. This Agreement will become effective on execution by both you and the Company.
2. Term of this Agreement
The term of this Agreement will begin on the date it becomes effective and will continue until December 31, 2019. On December 31, 2019, and on each December 31 after that, the term of this Agreement will be automatically extended for one additional year unless (1) a Change in Control occurs or (2) the Company gives you 60 days prior written notice of the intention to not extend this Agreement; provided , however , that the Company may not provide you with a notice of non-extension within one year following the occurrence of a Potential Change in Control or while a Potential Change in Control is pending.
3. Terms of Employment Following Change in Control
If a Change in Control occurs during the term of this Agreement, a “ Protected Employment Period ” will begin and the following employment terms will be effective. Your Protected Employment Period will end on the second anniversary of the Change in Control or your separation of service with the Company if earlier.
(a) Compensation and Benefits .
(1) Annual Base Salary . During the Protected Employment Period, you will be entitled to receive annual base salary at a rate that is at least equal to the rate of your annual base salary as in effect immediately before the Change in Control.



EXHIBIT 10.37


(2) Annual Bonus Opportunity . During the Protected Employment Period, you will be entitled to have an annual bonus opportunity that is at least materially equivalent to your annual bonus opportunity in effect for the year during which the Change in Control occurred.
(3) Long-Term Incentive Opportunity . During the Protected Employment Period, you will be entitled to participate in long term incentive plans, practices, policies and programs applicable generally to other peer executives of the Company and be entitled to receive periodic grants under such plans, practices, policies and programs that are no less than market-competitive for the position you held with the Company immediately before the Change in Control as reasonably determined by the Company (on the same basis as such determination is made for other peer executives of the Company).
(4) Employee Benefit Plans . During the Protected Employment Period, you will be entitled to participate in employee benefit plans, programs and arrangements (including tax-qualified and non-qualified pension, retirement savings, health and other welfare benefit plans) that, in the aggregate, are at least substantially similar to the Company employee benefit plans, programs and arrangements that you were eligible to participate in immediately before the Change in Control. However, nothing in this Section 3(a)(4) will entitle you to any particular type of employee benefit or limit in any way the Company’s or the Surviving Company’s ability to establish, amend or terminate any employee benefit plan, program or arrangement.
(b) Employment at Will . Notwithstanding that a Protected Employment Period may occur, you and the Company acknowledge that your employment with the Company is “at will” and may be terminated by you or by the Company at any time and for any reason, either before or after a Change in Control occurs.
4. Severance Protection
(a) Important Definitions . This Section 4 uses the following defined terms:
(1) Cause ” means the occurrence of one or more of the following:  
(A) your willful and continued failure to substantially perform your reasonably assigned duties with the Company or any of its affiliates (other than any such failure resulting from incapacity due to physical or mental illness), which failure continues for a period of at least 30 days after a written demand for substantial performance, signed by a duly authorized officer of the Company, has been delivered to you specifying the manner in which you have failed substantially to perform;
(B) your breach of fiduciary duty involving personal profit, your commission of a felony or a crime involving fraud or moral turpitude, or your material breach of any provision of this Agreement;
(C) your willfully engaging in illegal conduct or gross misconduct that is materially injurious to the Company;
(D) your willfully impeding, endeavoring to influence, obstruct or impede or failing to materially cooperate with an investigation authorized by the Board, a self-regulatory organization empowered with self-regulatory responsibilities under federal securities or state laws or any substantially equivalent foreign statute or regulation or a governmental department or agency; or
(E) your disqualification or bar by any governmental or self-regulatory authority from carrying out the duties and responsibilities of your position with the Company or any of its affiliates (as constituted from



EXHIBIT 10.37


time to time, the “ Group ”) or your loss of any governmental or self-regulatory license that is reasonably necessary for you to perform your responsibilities to the Group.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, no termination of your employment shall be for Cause until (i) there shall have been delivered to you a notice of termination, and (ii) within 15 days thereafter, you shall have been provided an opportunity to be heard in person by a review panel appointed by the Compensation Committee of the Board (or any successor to such Compensation Committee). For purposes of determining whether an event constituting Cause has occurred, no act or failure to act, on your part, shall be considered “willful” unless it is done, or omitted to be done, by you in bad faith or without reasonable belief that your action or omission was legal, proper, and in the best interests of the Company. Any act, or failure to act, based upon authority and directives given pursuant to a resolution duly adopted by the Board or upon the instructions of a senior officer of the Company or based upon the advice of counsel for the Company shall be conclusively presumed to be done, or omitted to be done, by you in good faith and in the best interests of the Company. Notwithstanding anything set forth in the Agreement to the contrary, no failure to perform by you after a notice of termination is given by you to the Company shall constitute Cause for the purposes of this Agreement.
(2) Good Reason ” means the occurrence of one or more of the following:
(A) an adverse change in your responsibilities as in effect immediately before the Change in Control other than any change that is immaterial. For the avoidance of doubt, a change in your title, lines of reporting, or internal job classification will not in and of itself, result in Good Reason;
(B) a material diminution in the budget over which you retain authority as compared with the budget over which you had control immediately before the Change in Control;
(C) a material breach of the compensation provisions of Section 4(a) of this Agreement; or
(D) the Company requiring you to be based at any location that is more than 50 miles from your regular place of employment immediately before the Change in Control.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, no termination of your employment shall be for Good Reason unless you give the Company written notice within 90 days of your obtaining knowledge of circumstances giving rise to Good Reason (describing in reasonable detail the circumstances and the Good Reason event that has occurred) and the Company does not remedy these circumstances within 30 days of receipt of your notice. In addition, an event will not give rise to Good Reason if it is made with your express written consent.
(b) Severance For Certain Terminations During the Protected Employment Period . If (i) your employment with the Company is terminated during the Protected Employment Period and (ii) the termination is either by the Company without Cause or by you for Good Reason, then :
(1) The Company will pay you (A) your annual base salary as pro-rated through the termination date, to the extent not already paid, (B) reimbursement (in accordance with the Company's expense reimbursement policy) for reasonable and necessary business expenses incurred by you on behalf of the Company before the termination date, (C) your accrued and unused vacation pay (in accordance with the Company's vacation policy) to the extent not already paid, and (D) bonuses and incentive compensation to which you are entitled under the terms of applicable bonus or incentive plans or awards maintained by the Company (together, your “ Accrued Compensation ”). In addition, the Company will pay or provide you, to the extent not already paid or provided, any amounts or benefits required to



EXHIBIT 10.37


be paid or provided or which you are eligible to receive under any plan, program, policy or practice or other contract or agreement of the Group through the termination date (your “ Accrued Other Benefits ”).
(2) The Company will pay severance of two times the sum of your Base Salary and Bonus Amount. For purposes of this Agreement, “ Base Salary ” means the greater of your annual base salary at the rate in effect immediately before a Change in Control and your annual base salary at the rate in effect as of your termination date, in each case, determined without regard to any deferred compensation elections made by you. For purposes of this Agreement, “ Bonus Amount ” means the greater of (A) the average annual cash bonus paid or payable to you by the Company for the three full fiscal year period ending immediately before the occurrence of a Change in Control, and (B) your target annual cash bonus for the fiscal year of termination (in each case determined without regard to any deferred compensation elections made by you).
(3) To the extent not included in your Accrued Compensation, the Company will pay you a pro-rata bonus amount for the year of termination, based on your Bonus Amount.
(4) In addition, for two years after termination of your employment, the Company will continue, at the active employee rates, your medical and dental coverage (and coverage for your eligible dependents) at a level at least equal to the level that such benefits would have been provided to you in accordance with the Company’s employee benefit plans if your employment had not terminated; provided that the Company shall cease to provide such coverage if you obtain alternate employment and are eligible for substantially comparable group medical coverage with such employer. Notwithstanding the foregoing, for purposes of determining your eligibility for retiree medical benefits pursuant to any plan, program or arrangement maintained by the Company (but not for purposes of determining the time of commencement of any such benefits), you shall be deemed to have remained employed by the Company until two years after your termination date.
(5) Solely for purposes of vesting and eligibility under any pension plan (including any pension related supplemental executive retirement plan) in which you may participate, you will be credited with the additional years (or partial years) of age and service with the Company that you would have accrued if you had remained employed by the Company through the second anniversary of the Change in Control.
(6) The Company shall also provide you with reasonable outplacement services for the period through the last day of the second calendar year following the calendar year during which your termination of employment occurred.
(c) For Certain Termination Following a Potential Change in Control. If during the term of this Agreement, (i) a Potential Change in Control has occurred, (ii) your employment with the Company is terminated while the Potential Change in Control is pending either by the Company without Cause or by you for Good Reason and (iii) the termination of your employment (or the circumstances giving rise to Good Reason) was at the request of a third party who has taken steps reasonably calculated to effect a Change in Control or otherwise arose in connection with or anticipation of a Change in Control, then the Company will make the same payments and provide the same benefits set forth in Section 4(b) (substituting “Potential Change in Control” for all references to “Change in Control” in that Section).
(d) Other Terminations . If the term of this Agreement expires before a Change in Control and before termination of your employment with the Company or if your employment with the Company terminates other than as contemplated under Section 4(a) or (b), this Agreement will automatically terminate and there will be no obligation or liability of any kind under this Agreement.



EXHIBIT 10.37


(e) Payments and Benefits Subject to Applicable Law . The provisions of this Agreement are subject to and shall be interpreted to be consistent with Applicable Law, which terms control over the terms of this Agreement in the event of any conflict between Applicable Law and this Agreement. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, no payment or benefit will be paid or provided to you or be vested or accrued if any such payment or benefit, vesting or accrual would violate Applicable Law and, to the extent any such payment or benefit that has been paid, provided, vested or accrued is determined to be in violation of Applicable Law, any such payment or benefit shall be subject to recoupment or cancellation. In the event of any such violation, you and the Company will cooperate in good faith to endeavor to meet the requirements of Applicable Law in a manner that preserves to the greatest extent possible the intent and purposes of this Agreement. “Applicable Law” means the laws, statutes, rules, regulations, treaties, directives, guidelines, ordinances, codes, administrative or judicial precedents or authorities and orders of any Governmental Authority, as well as the interpretation or administration thereof by any Governmental Authority charged with the enforcement, interpretation or administration thereof, and all applicable administrative orders, decisions, judgments, directed duties, requests, licenses, authorizations, decrees and permits of, and agreements with any Governmental Authority, to which the Group or you are a party or by which it or you are bound, in each case whether or not having the force of law, and all orders, decisions, judgments and decrees of all courts or arbitrators in proceedings or actions to which the Group or you are a party or by which it or you are bound. “Governmental Authority” means the United States of America, any state or territory thereof and any federal, state, provincial, city, town, municipality, county or local authority, including without limitation the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve, the Department of Treasury and any department, commission, board, bureau, instrumentality, agency or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.
5. Terms and Conditions to Your Severance Protection
(a) Form and Time of Payment. The cash amounts provided for in Section 4 above shall be paid in a single lump sum payment on the regularly scheduled payroll day immediately following the 55th day after your termination date (but in no event later than March 15 th following the calendar year in which occurs the later of the time the legally binding right to the payment arises or the time such right first ceases to be subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture). It is intended that these payments constitute short-term deferred compensation within the meaning of the applicable Treasury regulations pursuant to Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”). Notwithstanding the preceding two sentences, if you are a “specified employee” at the time you separate from service with Company and any payment or benefit under Section 4 is determined to constitute non-qualified deferred compensation, such payment shall be made or such benefit shall be provided on the first payroll of the seventh month after your separation from service with the Company, all as determined in accordance with Section 409A of the Code. For purposes of this Agreement, any reference to a termination of employment will be determined consistent with the rules relating to a “separation from service” as defined in Section 409A of the Code.
(b) Condition. The Company’s obligation to pay or provide the payments and benefits described in Sections 4(b)(2) through (6) shall be contingent upon your signing (and failing to revoke during any applicable revocation period) within 55 days following separation from service, a general release of claims in favor of the Company and its affiliates. In the event the general release of claims in favor of the Company and its affiliates is not signed, or is revoked, within the 55 days following separation from service, you will forfeit all rights to the payments and benefits described in Sections 4(b)(2) through (6).
(c) Exclusive Severance Benefit. The severance pay provided for in Section 4 shall be in lieu of any other severance



EXHIBIT 10.37


pay to which you may otherwise be eligible to receive under any severance policy, plan, agreement or arrangement maintained by the Company or any of its affiliates from time to time. Your entitlement to any other benefits (other than additional severance pay) shall be determined in accordance with the Company's employee benefit plans and other applicable programs and practices then in effect.
6. Change in Control Excise Tax.
(a)    This Section 6 will apply to all Payments. Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, in the event it shall be determined that (i) any Payment (or any acceleration of any Payment) to or for your benefit would be subject to the Excise Tax, and (ii) the reduction of the amounts payable to you under this Agreement or otherwise to the Excise Limit would provide you with a greater after-tax amount than if such amounts were not reduced, then the amounts payable to you under this Agreement shall be reduced (but not below zero) by an amount sufficient to reduce the Parachute Value of the Payments to the Excise Limit. The reduction of the Parachute Value of the Payments, if applicable, shall be made by reducing the payments and benefits under the following sections of this Agreement in the following order: (i) Section 4(b)(2) hereof, (ii) Section 4(b)(3) hereof and (iii) Section 4(b)(5) hereof unless an alternative method of reduction was elected by Executive prior to the date set forth in the first paragraph of this Agreement. If the reductions described in the preceding sentence are not sufficient to reduce the Parachute Value of the Payments to the Excise Limit, further reduction of the Parachute Value of the Payments or such other payments shall be made in the manner which has the least economic cost to you.
(b)    All determinations required to be made under this Section 6, including the Excise Limit, whether and when an Excise Tax is due, the amount of Excise Tax and the assumptions to be utilized in arriving at such determinations, shall be made by the Accounting Firm. The Accounting Firm shall provide detailed supporting calculations both to the Company and you within 15 business days of the receipt of notice from you that there has been a Payment or such earlier time as is requested by the Company. In the event that the Accounting Firm is serving as accountant or auditor for the individual, entity or group effecting the Change of Control, you may appoint another nationally recognized accounting firm to make the determinations required hereunder (which accounting firm shall then be referred to as the Accounting Firm hereunder). All fees and expenses of the Accounting Firm shall be borne solely by the Company. Any determination by the Accounting Firm shall be binding upon the Company and you. If the Accounting Firm determines that no Excise Tax is payable by Executive, it shall furnish Executive with a written opinion to such effect, and to the effect that failure to report the Excise Tax, if any, on Executive’s applicable federal income tax return will not result in the imposition of a negligence or similar penalty. In the event the Accounting Firm determines that the Parachute Value of the Payments shall be reduced to the Excise Limit, it shall furnish Executive with a written opinion to such effect. The determination by the Accounting Firm shall be binding upon the Company and Executive (except as provided in paragraph (c) below).
(c)    If it is established pursuant to a final determination of a court or the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) proceeding, which has been finally and conclusively resolved, that Payments have been made to, or provided for the benefit of, Executive by the Company, which are in excess of the limitations provided in this Section 6 (hereinafter referred to as an “Excess Payment”), such Excess Payment shall be deemed for all purposes to be a loan to Executive made on the date Executive received the Excess Payment and Executive shall repay the Excess Payment to the Company on demand, together with interest on the Excess Payment at the applicable federal rate (as defined in Section 1274(d) of the Code) from the date of Executive’s receipt of such Excess Payment until the date of such repayment. As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Code at the time of the determination, it is possible that Payments which will not have been made by the Company should have been made (an “Underpayment”), consistent with the calculations required to be made under this



EXHIBIT 10.37


Section 6. In the event that it is determined (i) by the Accounting Firm, the Company (which shall include the position taken by the Company, or together with its consolidated group, on its federal income tax return) or the IRS or (ii) pursuant to a determination by a court, that an Underpayment has occurred, the Company shall pay an amount equal to such Underpayment to Executive within ten (10) days of such determination together with interest on such amount at the applicable federal rate from the date such amount would have been paid to Executive until the date of payment. Executive shall cooperate, to the extent his or her expenses are reimbursed by the Company, with any reasonable requests by the Company in connection with any contests or disputes with the IRS in connection with the Excise Tax or the determination of the Excess Payment.
7.      Fees and Expenses; Governing Law.
(a)     Fees and Expenses . The Company agrees to pay, to the full extent permitted by law, all legal fees and expenses reasonably incurred by you as a result of any contest by the Company, you or others of the validity or enforceability of, or liability under, any provision of this Agreement or any guarantee thereof. Reimbursement of your fees and expenses shall be made within 30 days of the date you submit a request for reimbursement, but in no event shall any such amount be reimbursed after the last day of the calendar year following the calendar year in which you incurred such fees and expenses. However, the Company shall not be liable for any such fees or expenses if a court determines that the position taken by you with respect to such contest is an unreasonable position or is frivolous. In the event the determination described in the preceding sentence is made, you shall promptly repay to the Company any reimbursement of fees and expenses that you received from the Company before the date of such determination, together with interest at the applicable federal rate (as defined in Section 1274(d) of the Code). The amount of reimbursement for fees and expenses for which you may be reimbursed during a calendar year shall not affect the amount of fees and expenses for which you are eligible for reimbursement in any other calendar year. Your right to reimbursement for fees and expenses is not subject to liquidation or exchange for another benefit.
(b)     Governing Law . This Agreement will be governed by and construed in accordance with the law of the State of Alabama applicable to contracts made and to be performed entirely within that state.
(c)     Waiver of Jury Trial . To the extent permitted by law, you and the Company waive any and all rights to a jury trial with respect to any Employment Matter.
(d) Jurisdiction and Choice of Forum . You and the Company irrevocably submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of any state or federal court located in Birmingham, Alabama over any contest related to this Agreement, your employment or termination of your employment. This includes any action or proceeding to compel arbitration or to enforce an arbitration award. Both you and the Company (1) acknowledge that the forum stated in this Section 7(d) has a reasonable relation to this Agreement and to the relationship between you and the Company and that the submission to the forum will apply even if the forum chooses to apply non-forum law, (2) waive, to the extent permitted by law, any objection to personal jurisdiction or to the laying of venue of any action or proceeding covered by this Section 7(d) in the forum stated in this Section, (3) agree not to commence any such action or proceeding in any forum other than the forum stated in this Section 7(d), and (4) agree that, to the extent permitted by law, a final and non-appealable judgment in any such action or proceeding in any such court will be conclusive and binding on you and the Company. However, nothing in this Agreement precludes you or the Company from bringing any action or proceeding in any court for the purpose of enforcing the provisions of this Section 7(d).
(e) Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which will constitute an original and



EXHIBIT 10.37


all of which, when taken together, will constitute one agreement.
If you agree to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, please execute and return a copy of this Agreement to the Executive Compensation Department of the Company. This Agreement may be reviewed by the Company’s Compensation Committee.
        
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
                                    
By:             
Name:
Title:
Date:


AGREED AND ACKNOWLEDGED:

                                
Signature

Date:     
                        




















EXHIBIT 10.37


Annex to Change In Control Agreement of [Name]

Some of the terms used in the attached Agreement are defined in this Annex, which also includes some of the general provisions that govern the Agreement. This Annex is a part of this Agreement, and you should refer to this Annex as you review the Agreement.


1.
Definitions.
For purposes of the Change in Control Agreement, the following terms have the meanings indicated:
Terms Relating to Change in Control :
Change in Control” means any of the following events:
(1)    the acquisition by any “ Person ” (as the term “person” is used for the purposes of Section 13(d) or 14(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “ Exchange Act ”)) of direct or indirect beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 20% or more of the combined voting power of the then-outstanding securities of the Company entitled to vote in the election of directors (the “ Voting Securities ”); or
(2)    individuals (the “ Incumbent Directors ”) who, as of the date hereof, constitute the Board of Directors of the Company (the “ Board ”) cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board; provided , however , that any individual becoming a director subsequent to the date hereof whose election, or nomination for election, was approved by a vote of at least two-thirds of the Incumbent Directors who are then on the Board (either by specific vote or by approval, without prior written notice to the Board objecting to the nomination, of a proxy statement in which the individual was named as nominee) shall be an Incumbent Director, unless such individual is initially elected or nominated as a director of the Company as a result of an actual or threatened election contest with respect to the election or removal of directors (“ Election Contest ”) or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of a Person other than the Board (“ Proxy Contest ”), including by reason of any agreement intended to avoid or settle any Election Contest or Proxy Contest; or
(3)    consummation of a merger, consolidation, reorganization, statutory share exchange, or similar form of corporate transaction involving the Company or involving the issuance of shares by the Company, the sale or other disposition (including by way of a series of transactions or by way of merger, consolidation, stock sale or similar transaction involving one or more subsidiaries) of all or substantially all of the Company's assets or deposits, or the acquisition of assets or stock of another entity by the Company (each a “ Business Combination ”), unless such Business Combination is a “Non-Control Transaction.” A “ Non-Control Transaction ” is a Business Combination immediately following which the following conditions are met:
(A)    the stockholders of the Company immediately before such Business Combination own, directly or indirectly, more than 55% of the combined voting power of the then-outstanding voting securities entitled to vote in the election of directors (or similar officials in the case of a non-corporation) of the entity resulting from such Business Combination (including, without limitation, an entity that as a result of such Business Combination



EXHIBIT 10.37


owns the Company or all or substantially all of the Company’s assets, stock or ownership units either directly or through one or more subsidiaries) (the “ Surviving Corporation ”) in substantially the same proportion as their ownership of the Company Voting Securities immediately before such Business Combination;
(B)    at least a majority of the members of the board of directors of the Surviving Corporation were Incumbent Directors at the time of the Board’s approval of the execution of the initial Business Combination agreement; and
(C)    no person other than (i) the Company or any of its subsidiaries, (ii) the Surviving Corporation or its ultimate parent corporation, or (iii) any employee benefit plan (or related trust) sponsored or maintained by the Company immediately before such Business Combination beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, 20% or more of the combined voting power of the Surviving Corporation’s then-outstanding voting securities entitled to vote in the election of directors; or
(4)    Approval by the stockholders of the Company of a complete liquidation or dissolution of the Company.
Notwithstanding the foregoing and anything in the Agreement to the contrary, a Change in Control shall not be deemed to occur solely because any Person (the “ Subject Person ”) acquired Beneficial Ownership of more than the permitted amount of the outstanding Voting Securities as a result of the acquisition of Voting Securities by the Company which, by reducing the number of Voting Securities outstanding, increases the proportional number of shares Beneficially Owned by the Subject Person, provided that if a Change in Control would occur (but for the operation of this sentence) and after such acquisition of Voting Securities by the Company, the Subject Person becomes the Beneficial Owner of any additional Voting Securities, then a Change in Control shall occur.
Potential Change in Control ” means the occurrence of any one of the following:
(1)    the Company enters into a definitive written agreement, the consummation of which would result in the occurrence of a Change in Control; or
(2)    the Board adopts a resolution to the effect that, for purposes of this Agreement, a Potential Change in Control has occurred.
A Potential Change in Control shall cease occurring (A) in the case of (1) above, when the Change in Control occurs or the relevant agreement terminates and (B) in the case of (2) above, when the Board so determines by resolution.
Terms Relating to Excise Tax
Accounting Firm ” means any independent, nationally recognized public accounting firm that (1) the Company selects before a Change in Control or (2) that is reasonably acceptable to you and selected by the surviving company after a Change in Control.
Excise Limit ” means the greatest amount of Payments that could be made to you without giving rise to Excise Tax.
Excise Tax ” means the excise tax imposed by Section 4999 of the Code and any related interest or penalties incurred by you.
Parachute Value ” of a Payment shall mean the present value as of the date of the change of control for purposes of



EXHIBIT 10.37


Section 280G of the Code of the portion of such Payment that constitutes a “parachute payment” under Section 280G(b)(2), as determined by the Accounting Firm for purposes of determining whether and to what extent the Excise Tax will apply to such Payment.
Payment ” means any payment made or benefit provided, including any awards and distributions, to you or for your benefit (i) by the Group, whether or not pursuant to this Agreement, or (ii) by any other entity in connection with a change in the ownership or effective control of any member of the Group or a change in the ownership of a substantial portion of the assets of the Group.
2.      Effect on Other Agreements.
(a)      Prior Employment Agreements and Severance Rights . This Agreement will supersede any and all prior employment agreement provisions related to change in control severance and similar rights and any earlier change in control severance or similar rights you may have with any member of the Group.
(b)      Effect on Other Agreements; Entire Agreement . This Agreement is the entire agreement between you and the Company with respect to the benefits contemplated by this Agreement and supersedes any earlier agreement, written or oral, with respect to the subject matter of this Agreement. In entering into this Agreement, no party has relied on or made any representation, warranty, inducement, promise or understanding that is not in this Agreement.
3.      Successors.
(a)      Assignment by You . You may not assign this Agreement without the Company’s consent. Also, except as required by law, your right to receive payments or benefits under this Agreement may not be subject to execution, attachment, levy or similar process. Any attempt to effect any of the preceding in violation of this Section 3(a), whether voluntary or involuntary, will be void.
(b)      Assumption by any Surviving Company . Before the effectiveness of any Business Combination, the Company will cause (i) the Surviving Company to unconditionally assume this Agreement in writing and (ii) a copy of the assumption to be provided to you. After the Business Combination, the Surviving Company will be treated for all purposes as the Company under this Agreement.
4.      General Provisions.
(a)      Construction .
(i)     References to the following terms have the meanings stated:
1.    To Sections are to sections of this Agreement unless otherwise stated.
2.    To any contract (including this Agreement) are to the contract as amended, modified, supplemented or replaced from time to time.
3.    To any statute, rule or regulation are to the statute, rule or regulation as amended, modified, supplemented or replaced from time to time (and, in the case of statutes, include any rules and regulations promulgated under the statute) and to any section of any statute, rule or regulation include any successor to the section.
4.    To any g overnmental authority include any successor to the governmental authority.
5.    To any plan include any programs, practices and policies.



EXHIBIT 10.37


6.    To any entity include any corporation, limited liability company, partnership, association, business trust and similar organization and include any governmental authority.
7.    To any affiliate of any entity are to any person or other entity directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under common control with the first entity.
(ii)    The various headings in this Agreement are for convenience of reference only and in no way define, limit or describe the scope or intent of any provisions or Sections of the Agreement or this Annex.
(iii)    Unless the context requires otherwise, (A) words describing the singular number include the plural and vice versa , (B) words denoting any gender include all genders and (C) the words “ include ”, “ includes ” and “ including ” will be deemed to be followed by the words “without limitation.”
(iv)    It is your and the Group’s intention that this Agreement not be construed more strictly with regard to you or the Group.
(b)      Withholding . You and the Group will treat all payments to you under this Agreement as compensation for services. Accordingly, the Group may withhold from any payment any taxes that are required to be withheld under any law, rule or regulation.
(c)      Severability . If any provision of this Agreement is found by any court of competent jurisdiction (or legally empowered agency) to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable for any reason, then (i) the provision will be amended automatically to the minimum extent necessary to cure the illegality or invalidity and permit enforcement and (ii) the remainder of this Agreement will not be affected.
(d)      No Set-off or Mitigation . Your and the Company’s respective obligations under this Agreement will not be affected by any set-off, counterclaim, recoupment or other right you or any member of the Group may have against each other or anyone else. You do not need to seek other employment or take any other action to mitigate any amounts owed to you under this Agreement, and those amounts will not be reduced if you do obtain other employment.
(e)      Notices . All notices, requests, demands and other communications under this Agreement must be in writing and will be deemed given (i) on the business day sent, when delivered by hand or facsimile transmission (with confirmation) during normal business hours, (ii) on the business day after the business day sent, if delivered by a nationally recognized overnight courier or (iii) on the third business day after the business day sent if delivered by registered or certified mail, return receipt requested, in each case to the following address or number (or to such other addresses or numbers as may be specified by notice that conforms to this paragraph (e):
If to you, to:

                                        
                                        
                                        

If to the Company or any other member of the Group, to:
Regions Financial Corporation



EXHIBIT 10.37


P.O. Box 11007
Birmingham, Alabama 35288
Attention: General Counsel
Facsimile: 205-xxx-xxxx
with a copy to:
Sullivan & Cromwell
125 Broad Street
New York, New York 10004
Attention: Marc Trevino
Facsimile: 212-xxx-xxxx
(f)      Consideration . This Agreement is in consideration of the mutual covenants contained in it. You and the Company acknowledge the receipt and sufficiency of the consideration to this Agreement and intend this Agreement to be legally binding.
(g)      Amendments and Waivers . Any provision of this Agreement may be amended or waived but only if the amendment or waiver is in writing and signed, in the case of an amendment, by you and the Company or, in the case of a waiver, by the party that would have benefited from the provision waived. Except as this Agreement otherwise provides, no failure or delay by you or the Group to exercise any right or remedy under this Agreement will operate as a waiver, and no partial exercise of any right or remedy will preclude any further exercise.
(h)      Third Party Beneficiaries . Subject to Section 6 of the Agreement, this Agreement will be binding on, inure to the benefit of and be enforceable by the parties and their respective heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns. This Agreement does not confer any rights, remedies, obligations or liabilities to any entity or person other than you and the Company and your and the Company’s permitted successors and assigns, although this Agreement will inure to the benefit of the Group and Section 3(a) of this Annex will inure to the benefit of the most recent persons named in a notice under that Section.
(i)      No Golden Parachute Payments; Application to the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency . If any Payment would otherwise be a golden parachute payment within the meaning of Section 18(k) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, the Payment will not be made unless permitted under applicable law. The Company will use best efforts promptly to apply to the appropriate federal banking agency for a determination that any golden parachute payment is permissible. Any Payment that is determined permissible will be paid in accordance with its terms or, if due before the date of determination, will be paid within 30 days of determination together with interest at the applicable federal rate (as defined in Section 1274(d) of the Code).



EXHIBIT 10.46


AMENDMENT NUMBER FOUR
TO THE
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION SUPPLEMENTAL 401(k) PLAN
RESTATED AS OF JANUARY 1, 2014


Regions Financial Corporation hereby amended the Regions Financial Corporation Supplemental 401(k) Plan, effective as of January 1, 2019, as follows:
    
1.      Section 4.2(b) of the Plan is hereby amended by replacing, in said subsection, the two instances of “4% (6% before January 1, 2012)” with the following: “5% (4% between January 1, 2012-December 31, 2018 and 6% before January 1, 2012)”.

2.      Section 4.3(b)(i) of the Plan is hereby amended by replacing, in said subsection, the one instance of “4% (6% before January 1, 2012)” with the following: “5% (4% between January 1, 2012-December 31, 2018 and 6% before January 1, 2012)”.

3. Except as otherwise amended herein, the Plan shall continue in full force and effect.


* * * * *



EXHIBIT 21
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
SUBSIDIARIES AT DECEMBER 31, 2018



1.
2050 Holdings, LLC (2)
2.
A-F Leasing, Ltd. (2)
3.
BAP Advisors LLC (7)
4.
Barthel Tide Holding LLC (4)
5.
BlackArch Partners LLC (7)
6.
BlackArch Securities LLC (7)
7.
Broussard Tide Holding LLC (4)
8.
CPMOB Holdings, LLC (2)
9.
Dalfrey Tide Holding LLC (4)
10.
First Sterling Associates, No. 8 LLC (8)
11.
First Sterling Associates No. 9 LLC (4)
12.
First Sterling Associates No. 10 LLC (4)
13.
First Sterling Associates No. 11 LLC (4)
14.
First Sterling Associates No. 12 LLC (8)
15.
First Sterling Associates No. 14 LLC (8)
16.
First Sterling Associates No. 15 LLC (8)
17.
First Sterling Associates No. 16 LLC (8)
18.
First Sterling Associates No. 17 LLC (8)
19.
First Sterling Associates No. 18 LLC (8)
20.
First Sterling Associates No. 19 LLC (8)
21.
First Sterling Associates No. 52 LLC (8)
22.
First Sterling Associates No. 53 LLC (8)
23.
First Sterling Associates No. 54 LLC (8)
24.
First Sterling Associates No. 55 LLC (8
25.
First Sterling Investor 167 LLC (8)
26.
First Sterling Investor 168 LLC (8)
27.
First Sterling Investor 172 LLC (8)
28.
First Sterling Investor 173 LLC (8)
29.
First Sterling Investor 178 LLC (8)
30.
First Sterling Investor 179 LLC (8)
31.
First Sterling Investor 184 LLC (8)
32.
First Sterling Investor 185 LLC (8)
33.
First Sterling Investor 186 LLC (8)
34.
First Sterling Investor 188 LLC (8)
35.
First Sterling Investor 189 LLC (8)
36.
First Sterling Investor 190 LLC (8)
37.
First Sterling Investor 191 LLC (8)
38.
First Sterling Investor 192 LLC (8)
39.
First Sterling Investor 193 LLC (8)
40.
First Sterling Investor 194 LLC (8)
41.
First Sterling Investor 195 LLC (8)
42.
First Sterling Investor 196 LLC (8)
43.
First Sterling Investor 197 LLC (8)
44.
First Sterling Investor 198 LLC (8)
45.
First Sterling Investor 199 LLC (8)
46.
First Sterling Partners LLC (8)
47.
First Sterling Partners No. 4 LLC (8)
48.
First Sterling Partners No. 5 LLC (8)
49.
First Sterling Partners No. 6 LLC (8)
50.
First Sterling Partners No. 7 LLC (4)
51.
FMLS, Inc. (6)



EXHIBIT 21
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
SUBSIDIARIES AT DECEMBER 31, 2018


52.
Fortier Tide Holding LLC (4)
53.
FS Monroe LLC (8)
54.
LMIW Acquisition Management, LLC (5) (f/k/a Regions Acquisition Management, LLC)
55.
LMIW I, LLC (5)
56.
LMIW IV, LLC (5)
57.
LMIW VII, LLC (2)
58.
LMIW IX, LLC (fka Crestmoor Two, LLC) (4)
59.
Monroe Court Associates LLC (8)
60.
Orion Summit Services LLC (8)
61.
RAH Investor 200 LLC (10)
62.
RAH Investor 201 LLC (10)
63.
RAH Investor 202 LLC (10)
64.
RAH Investor 203 LLC (10)
65.
RAH Investor 205 LLC (10)
66.
RAH Investor 206 LLC (10)
67.
RAH Investor 207 LLC (10)
68.
RAH Investor 208 LLC (10)
69.
RAH Investor 209 LLC (10)
70.
RAH Investor 210 LLC (10)
71.
RAH Investor 211 LLC (10)
72.
RAH Investor 212 LLC (10)
73.
RAH Investor 213 LLC (10)
74.
RAH Investor 214 LLC (10)
75.
RAH Investor 215 LLC (10)
76.
RAH Investor 217 LLC (10)
77.
RAH Investor 218 LLC (10)
78.
RAH Investor 219 LLC (10)
79.
RAH Investor 220 LLC (10)
80.
RB Affordable Housing, Inc. (2)
81.
RB Affordable Housing (Arkansas River) GP, LLC (3)
82.
RB Affordable Housing (Arrington II) GP, LLC (3)
83.
RB ARM 2007 GP, LLC (2)
84.
RB Crestmoor AL Three GP, LLC (2)
85.
RB Greenwood SC Six GP, LLC (2)
86.
RB SLP General Partner, LLC (2)
87.
RB Thunder Ridge GP Upper Tier, LLC (2)
88.
Regions Affordable Housing LLC (fka RDEPF LLC) (4)
89.
Regions Bank (1)
90.
Regions Business Capital Corporation (4)
91.
Regions Capital Advantage, Inc. (fka UPB Investment, Inc.) (6)
92.
Regions Commercial Equipment Finance, LLC (fka A-F Leasing, LLC) (2)
93.
Regions Equipment Finance Corporation (2)
94.
Regions Equipment Finance, Ltd. (2)
95.
Regions Investment Management, Inc. (fka Morgan Asset Management, Inc.) (6)
96.
Regions Investment Services, Inc. (2)
97.
Regions Securities LLC (4)
98.
RFC Financial Services Holding LLC (4)
99.
Sterling Affordable Housing LLC (4)
100.
Sterling Corporate Services LLC (8)
101.
Thunder Ridge Upper-Tier, LP (2)
102.
Upper-Tier Clearwater Apartments, LP (2)
103.
Upper-Tier Esplanade, LP (2)



EXHIBIT 21
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
SUBSIDIARIES AT DECEMBER 31, 2018



Tax credit fund entities held as .01% General Partner or Managing Member:
104.
First Sterling Affordable Housing Fund I LLC (4)
105.
Knightstown Historic L.P. (8
106.
National Credit Partners XVII Limited Partnership (4)
107.
National Tax Credit Fund 27 L.P. (8)
108.
National Tax Credit Fund 37 L.P. (8)
109.
RAH Corporate Partners Fund 55 LLC (f/k/a: Sterling Corporate Partners
Fund 55 LLC) (8)
110.
Sterling Corporate Partners Fund 51, L.P. (8)
111.
Sterling Corporate Partners Fund 52, L.P. (8)
112.
Sterling Corporate Partners Fund 53, L.P. (8)
113.
Sterling Corporate Partners Fund 54, L.P. (8)
114.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund IV, L.P. (8)
115.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund V, L.P. (8)
116.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund VI, L.P. (8)
117.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund VIII, L.P. (9)
118.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund X, L.P. (8)
119.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XVI, L.P. (8)
120.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XVIII, L.P. (8)
121.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XIX, L.P. (4)
122.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXIV, L.P. (4)
123.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXV, L.P. (8)
124.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXVI, L.P. (4)
125.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXVI-B, L.P. (4)
126.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXVIII, L.P. (4)
127.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXIX, L.P. (4)
128.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXX, L.P. (8)
129.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXXI, L.P. (8)
130.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXXII, L.P. (4)
131.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXXIV, L.P. (8)
132.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXXV, L.P. (4)
133.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XXXIX, L.P. (8)
134.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XL, L.P. (4)
135.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLI, L.P. (8)
136.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLII, L.P. (4)
137.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLIII, L.P. (4)
138.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLIV, L.P. (4)
139.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLV, L.P. (4)
140.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLVI, L.P. (4)
141.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLVII, L.P. (4)
142.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLVIII LLC (8)
143.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund XLIX LLC (8)
144.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund 63 LLC (8)
145.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund 64 LLC (8)
146.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund 65 LLC (4)
147.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund 67 LLC (8)
148.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund 68 LLC (8)
149.
Sterling Corporate Tax Credit Fund 69 LLC (8)






EXHIBIT 21
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
SUBSIDIARIES AT DECEMBER 31, 2018


Non-profit entities:
Regions Community Development Corporation (6)
Regions Foundation (f/k/a Regions Financial Corporation Foundation) (2)
Regions Foundation (of Tennessee) (6)


(1) Affiliate state bank chartered under the banking laws of Alabama.
(2) Incorporated/Organized under the laws of Alabama.
(3) Organized under the laws of Arkansas.
(4) Incorporated/Organized under the laws of Delaware.
(5) Incorporated/Organized under the laws of Florida.
(6) Incorporated under the laws of Tennessee.
(7) Organized under the laws of North Carolina.
(8) Organized under the laws of New York.
(9) Organized under the laws of Massachusetts.
(10) Organized under the laws of Mississippi.





EXHIBIT 23


Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
We consent to the incorporation by reference in the following Registration Statements and the related Prospectuses of Regions Financial Corporation, of our reports dated February 22, 2019, with respect to the consolidated financial statements of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries, and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries, included in this Annual Report (Form 10-K) for the year ended December 31, 2018:
Form S-8 No. 333-135604 pertaining to the stock options and other equity interests issuable under the Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan.
Form S-8 No. 333-138460 pertaining to the stock options and other equity interests issued, issuable, or assumed under:
AmSouth Bancorporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation 1996 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan
First American Corporation 1999 Broad-Based Employee Stock Option Plan
Deposit Guaranty Corporation Long Term Incentive Plans
First American Corporation 1991 Employee Stock Incentive Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation Amended and Restated 1991 Employee Stock Incentive Plan
Pioneer Bancshares, Inc. Long Term Incentive Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors
AmSouth Bancorporation Thrift Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation Deferred Compensation Plan and Amended and Restated Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors of AmSouth Bancorporation
AmSouth Bancorporation Employee Stock Purchase Plan
Form S-8 No. 333-117272 pertaining to the stock options and other equity interests issued, issuable, or assumed under:
Regions Financial Corporation 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan
Regions Financial Corporation Amended and Restated 1991 Long-Term Incentive Plan
Regions Financial Corporation Amended and Restated Directors’ Stock Incentive Plan
Regions Financial Corporation 401(k) Plan
Regions Financial Corporation Supplemental 401(k) Plan
First Alabama Bancshares, Inc. 1988 Stock Option Plan
Union Planters Corporation 1998 Stock Incentive Plan for Officers and Employees
Union Planters Corporation Amended and Restated 1992 Stock Incentive Plan
Union Planters Corporation 401(k) Retirement Savings Plan
Union Planters Corporation Amended and Restated 1996 Deferred Compensation Plan For Executives
Form S-3 No. 333-124337 pertaining to the registration of $2,000,000,000 debt and equity securities.
Form S-3 No. 333-126797 pertaining to the securities registered on Form S-3 No. 333-124337.
Form S-3 ASR No. 333-142839 pertaining to the registration of debt and equity securities.
Form S-8 No. 333-161603 pertaining to common stock in connection with various employee benefit plans and other equity interests issued, issuable, or assumed under:
AmSouth Bancorporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation 1996 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan
First American Corporation 1999 Broad-Based Employee Stock Option Plan
Deposit Guaranty Corporation Long Term Incentive Plans
First American Corporation 1991 Employee Stock Incentive Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation Amended and Restated 1991 Employee Stock Incentive Plan
AmSouth Bancorporation Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors
Regions Financial Corporation 401(k) Plan (formerly AmSouth Bancorporation Thrift Plan)
AmSouth Bancorporation Deferred Compensation Plan and Amended and Restated Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors of AmSouth Bancorporation
AmSouth Bancorporation Employee Stock Purchase Plan
Form S-3 ASR No. 333-165056 pertaining to the registration of debt and equity securities.
Form S-8 No. 333-166924 pertaining to the stock options and other equity interests issuable under the Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan.
Form S-3 ASR No. 333-186811 pertaining to the registration of debt and equity securities.
Form S-8 No. 333-203597 pertaining to common stock and other equity interests issuable under the Regions Financial Corporation 2015 Long Term Incentive Plan.
Form S-3 ASR No. 333-209657 pertaining to the registration of debt and equity securities.
Form S-8 No. 333-216230 pertaining to common stock issuable under the Regions Financial Corporation 401(k) Plan.
EYLLPSIGNATURE201510KA47.JPG     
Birmingham, Alabama
February 22, 2019


EXHIBIT 24

POWER OF ATTORNEY
KNOWN BY ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned Director of Regions Financial Corporation, a Delaware corporation (the “Company”), by his or her execution hereof or upon an identical counterpart hereof, does hereby constitute and appoint Fournier J. Gale, III and/or Hope D. Mehlman and either of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and re-substitution, for the undersigned and in the undersigned’s name, place, and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2018 (the “2018 Annual Report”) to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”), including any and all amendments or supplements to the 2018 Annual Report, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto and all documents in connection therewith, with the Commission pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and hereby grants unto each of said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and either of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully to all intents and purposes as the undersigned might or could do in person, and the undersigned hereby ratifies and confirms all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or either of them, or their substitutions, shall do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
This power of attorney will be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Delaware. The execution of this power of attorney is not intended to, and does not, revoke any prior powers of attorney.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the undersigned has hereunto set his or her hand as of this 7th day of February, 2019.

/s/ Carolyn H. Byrd
Carolyn H. Byrd
/s/ Susan W. Matlock
Susan W. Matlock
/s/ Don DeFosset
Don DeFosset
/s/ John E. Maupin, Jr.
John E. Maupin, Jr.
/s/ Samuel A. Di Piazza, Jr.
Samuel A. Di Piazza, Jr.
/s/ Charles D. McCrary
Charles D. McCrary
/s/ Eric C. Fast
Eric C. Fast
/s/ James T. Prokopanko
James T. Prokopanko
/s/ Zhanna Golodryga
Zhanna Golodryga
/s/ Lee J. Styslinger III
Lee J. Styslinger III
/s/ John D. Johns
John D. Johns
/s/ José S. Suquet
José S. Suquet
/s/ Ruth Ann Marshall
Ruth Ann Marshall
/s/ Timothy Vines
Timothy Vines




EXHIBIT 31.1
CERTIFICATIONS
I, John M. Turner, Jr., certify that:
1.
I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Regions Financial Corporation;
2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.
The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
b)
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
c)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
d)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.
The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: February 22, 2019
 
/ S /    J OHN  M. T URNER , J R .
John M. Turner, Jr.
President and Chief Executive Officer




EXHIBIT 31.2
CERTIFICATIONS
I, David J. Turner, Jr., certify that:
1.
I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Regions Financial Corporation;
2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.
The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
b)
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
c)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
d)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.
The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: February 22, 2019
 
/ S /    D AVID  J. T URNER , J R .
David J. Turner, Jr.
Senior Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer






EXHIBIT 32
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO
18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO
SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
In connection with the Annual Report of Regions Financial Corporation (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2018 (the “Report”), I, John M. Turner, Jr., Chief Executive Officer of the Company, and David J. Turner, Jr., Chief Financial Officer of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, as adopted pursuant to § 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that to our knowledge:
1)
The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
2)
The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
 
/ S /    J OHN  M. T URNER , J R .
 
/ S /    D AVID  J. T URNER , J R .
John M. Turner, Jr.
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
David J. Turner, Jr.
Chief Financial Officer
DATE: February 22, 2019
A signed original of this written statement required by Section 906, or other document authenticating, acknowledging, or otherwise adopting the signatures that appear in typed form within the electronic version of this written statement required by Section 906, has been provided to Regions Financial Corporation and will be retained by Regions Financial Corporation and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.